MAYBACH
Order No. 6515 4416 13 Part No. 240 584 62 81 USA Edition A 2005
OPERATOR’S MANUAL
OPERATOR’S MANUAL
Grafik in der Größe 216x79 mm
in den Grafikrahmen importieren!
MAYBACH
Order No. 6515 4416 13 Part No. 240 584 62 81 USA Edition A 2005
OPERATOR’S MANUAL
OPERATOR’S MANUAL
Grafik in der Größe 216x79 mm
in den Grafikrahmen importieren!
Maybach 57
Maybach 62
Our company congratulates you on the
purchase of your new Maybach.
Your selection of our product is a demonstration of your trust in Maybach
Manufaktur. Furthermore, it exemplifies
your desire to own an automobile that
will be as easy as possible to operate and
provide years of service.
Your Maybach represents the efforts of
many skilled engineers and craftsmen.
To help assure your driving pleasure and
also the safety of you and your passengers, we ask you to make a small investment of your time:
Please read this manual carefully,
then return it to your vehicle where it
will be handy for your reference.
Please follow the recommendations
contained in this manual. They are
designed to acquaint you with the
operation of your Maybach.
Please pay attention to the warnings
and cautions contained in this manual. They are designed to help improve
the safety of the vehicle operator and
occupants.
Should you have any questions,
please contact your Maybach Studio
MRM (Maybach Relationship
Manager) or call us at
1-866-FOR-MAYBach (in the USA) or
1-888-881-6611 (in Canada).
We extend our best wishes for many
miles of safe, pleasurable driving.
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC
A DaimlerChrysler Company
Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Product information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Operator’s Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Service and warranty information 10
Important notice for California
retail buyers and lessees of
Maybach automobiles . . . . . . . . . 11
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Roadside Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Change of address or ownership . 12
Operating your vehicle outside
the USA or Canada . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Where to find it . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Operating safety. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Proper use of the vehicle . . . . . . . 16
Problems with your vehicle . . . . . . . . 17
Reporting safety defects . . . . . . . . . . 18
Reporting safety defects . . . . . . . 18
Vehicle data recording . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Information regarding electronic
recording devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
At a glance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cockpit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Instrument cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Multifunction steering wheel . . . . . . .
Front center console . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Upper part . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Lower part . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Overhead control panel . . . . . . . . . . .
Driver’s door control panel . . . . . . . . .
Rear passenger compartment . . . . . . .
Maybach 57 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maybach 62 without partition* . .
Maybach 62 with partition* . . . . .
Rear seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maybach 57 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maybach 62 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
21
22
24
26
27
27
28
30
31
32
32
34
36
38
38
40
Rear 3-place seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maybach 57 with
rear center seat* . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maybach 62 with
rear center seat* . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear center console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maybach 57 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maybach 62 with power
tilt/sliding sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maybach 62 with
electrotransparent roof*. . . . . . . .
Rear door control panel . . . . . . . . . . .
Maybach 57 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maybach 62 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
42
42
44
46
46
47
48
49
49
50
3
Contents
Getting started . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Unlocking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Unlocking with the SmartKey . . .
Unlocking with KEYLESS-GO** . .
Starter switch positions. . . . . . . . .
Adjusting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fastening the seat belts . . . . . . . .
Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . .
Parking brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Switching on headlamps. . . . . . . .
Turn signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Windshield wipers. . . . . . . . . . . . .
Problems while driving . . . . . . . . .
Parking and locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Parking brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Switching off headlamps . . . . . . .
Turning off the engine . . . . . . . . .
Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4
51
52
52
53
54
57
57
60
61
63
63
65
68
68
70
71
71
73
74
74
75
75
76
Safety and Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Occupant safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Seat belts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Children in the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 87
Override switch for rear
passenger compartment . . . . . . . . 94
Panic alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Activating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Deactivating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Driving safety systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
ABS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
BAS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
ESP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
The SBC brake system. . . . . . . . . . 101
Anti-theft systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Anti-theft alarm system . . . . . . . . 104
Tow-away alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Controls in detail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Locking and unlocking . . . . . . . . . . .
SmartKey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO** . .
Opening the doors
from the inside. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Closing the rear doors
automatically from
the inside (Maybach 62) . . . . . . .
Opening the trunk. . . . . . . . . . . .
Closing the trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trunk lid emergency release . . . .
Power closing assist for
doors and trunk lid . . . . . . . . . . .
Automatic central locking . . . . . .
Locking and unlocking
from the inside. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
107
108
108
111
117
117
118
119
123
124
124
125
Contents
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Easy-entry/exit feature . . . . . . . .
Rear seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting front passenger seat
position from rear. . . . . . . . . . . .
Multicontour seats . . . . . . . . . . .
Seat heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Seat ventilation*. . . . . . . . . . . . .
Memory function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Storing positions in memory . . .
Recalling positions from memory
Storing exterior rear view mirror
parking position . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Lighting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Exterior lamp switch . . . . . . . . . .
Combination switch . . . . . . . . . .
Hazard warning flasher . . . . . . .
Interior lighting in the front . . .
Interior lighting in the rear . . . .
127
127
129
135
136
138
139
140
141
141
142
143
143
147
147
148
150
Instrument cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Instrument cluster illumination. .
Coolant temperature gauge . . . .
Trip odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tachometer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Outside temperature indicator . .
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Control system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Multifunction display. . . . . . . . . .
Multifunction steering wheel . . .
Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standard display menu . . . . . . . .
Audio menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Telephone menu . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Navigation menu . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Distronic** menu . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trip computer menu . . . . . . . . . .
Vehicle status message
memory menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Settings menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
153
153
154
154
155
155
156
156
157
157
158
160
162
163
165
168
168
169
Automatic transmission . . . . . . . . . .
One-touch gearshifting. . . . . . . .
Gear ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Gear selector lever position . . . .
Automatic shift program . . . . . .
Driving tips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Emergency operation
(Limp Home Mode) . . . . . . . . . . .
Good visibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Headlamp cleaning system . . . . .
Rear view mirrors. . . . . . . . . . . . .
Sun visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear window defroster . . . . . . . .
Automatic climate control . . . . . . . .
Cockpit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear passenger compartment. . .
Solar panel* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
185
186
187
188
189
190
191
192
192
192
197
198
199
200
210
217
171
172
5
Contents
Power windows. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Opening and closing
the windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Synchronizing power windows .
Summer opening feature . . . . . .
Convenience closing feature . . .
Power tilt/sliding sunroof. . . . . . . . .
Opening and closing
the power tilt/sliding sunroof
(Maybach 57) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Synchronizing
the power tilt/sliding sunroof
(Maybach 57) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Opening and closing
the power tilt/sliding sunroof
(Maybach 62) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Synchronizing
the power tilt/sliding sunroof
(Maybach 62) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electrotransparent roof* . . . . . . . . .
Operating the
electrotransparent roof . . . . . . .
6
218
218
220
220
221
222
222
224
225
229
230
230
Driving systems. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
Cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
Distronic** . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
Airmatic DC (Dual Control) . . . . . 247
Parktronic (Parking assist) . . . . . . 251
Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
Cargo tie-down hooks . . . . . . . . . 256
Loading instructions . . . . . . . . . . . 256
Useful features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Vanity mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Storage compartments. . . . . . . . . 258
Umbrella . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
Cup holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Ashtrays. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
Cigarette lighters . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
Non-smokers package* . . . . . . . . 274
Folding table*
(standard on Maybach 62;
optional on Maybach 57) . . . . . . . 275
Refrigerator**
in rear center console. . . . . . . . . . 277
12-V socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
Battery charge maintenance
socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
Rear window curtain . . . . . . . . . .
Rear side window curtains* . . . .
Partition* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Two-way intercom*
(Maybach 62: standard
with partition*) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External communication
(special order equipment) . . . . . .
Telephone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tele Aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Garage door opener . . . . . . . . . .
Infrared reflecting windshield . .
Heated steering wheel . . . . . . . .
Pocket PC remote control* . . . . . . . .
Pocket PC holder . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pocket PC 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pocket PC 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Operation via main menu
function buttons and
navigation button . . . . . . . . . . . .
Operation via touch-screen . . . . .
Pocket PC troubleshooting . . . . .
280
281
284
287
288
289
294
304
308
308
309
310
312
315
317
318
320
339
Contents
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
The first 1000 miles (1500 km) . . . . .
Driving instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Drive sensibly – save fuel . . . . . .
Drinking and driving . . . . . . . . .
Pedals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Driving off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Hydroplaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tire traction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tire speed rating. . . . . . . . . . . . .
Winter driving instructions . . . .
Standing water . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Passenger compartment. . . . . . .
Driving abroad . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Control and operation of
radio transmitters . . . . . . . . . . . .
Catalytic converter . . . . . . . . . . .
Emission control . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Coolant temperature . . . . . . . . .
341
342
343
343
343
343
343
344
345
345
346
346
347
347
348
349
349
349
349
350
350
351
At the gas station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Refueling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check regularly and before
a long trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Transmission fluid level . . . . . . . .
Coolant level. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Windshield washer and
headlamp cleaning system . . . . .
Tires and wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Important guidelines . . . . . . . . . .
Life of tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direction of rotation . . . . . . . . . .
Checking tire pressure . . . . . . . . .
Rotating tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Winter driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tire speed rating
for winter tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Winter tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
352
352
354
355
355
356
359
360
361
362
363
363
364
364
364
370
371
371
372
372
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Clearing the maintenance
service indicator. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maintenance service
term exceeded . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Calling up the maintenance
service indicator. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Resetting the maintenance
service indicator. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Vehicle care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cleaning and care of vehicle. . . .
Practical hints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
What to do if … . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Lamps in instrument cluster . . . .
Lamp in center console . . . . . . . .
Vehicle status messages
in the multifunction display . . . .
Where will I find ...? . . . . . . . . . . . . .
First aid kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Vehicle jack, vehicle tool kit,
luggage bowl, spare wheel. . . . .
373
373
373
374
374
375
375
383
384
384
390
391
422
422
422
7
Contents
Unlocking/locking
in an emergency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Unlocking the vehicle . . . . . . . . .
Locking the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . .
Opening/closing in an emergency . .
Power tilt/sliding sunroof
(Maybach 57) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power tilt/sliding sunroof
(Maybach 62) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pocket PC*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the memory card. . . . .
Resetting the Pocket PC . . . . . . .
Replacing SmartKey batteries . . . . .
Replacing bulbs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Replacing bulbs
for front lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
License plate lamp . . . . . . . . . . .
Replacing wiper blades . . . . . . . . . .
Removing wiper blades . . . . . . .
Installing wiper blades . . . . . . . .
Flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Preparing the vehicle . . . . . . . . .
Mounting the spare wheel . . . . .
423
423
424
425
425
426
427
427
427
428
430
430
432
433
434
434
435
436
436
436
Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 441
Disconnecting the batteries . . . . . 443
Charging and reinstalling
the batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 443
Reconnecting the batteries . . . . . 444
Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445
Towing the vehicle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447
Installing towing eye bolt . . . . . . 449
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 450
Aids for replacing fuses . . . . . . . . 451
Fuse boxes in engine
compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 451
Fuse box in passenger
compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 452
Fuse box in the trunk . . . . . . . . . . 452
Technical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 453
Parts service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 454
Warranty coverage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 455
Loss of Service and Warranty
Information Booklet. . . . . . . . . . . 455
Identification labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 456
Layout of poly-V-belt drive . . . . . . . . 457
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 458
Rims and tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Same size tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Spare wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electrical system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Main dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc. . . . . .
Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine oils . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine oil additives . . . . . . . . . . .
Air conditioning refrigerant . . . .
Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Premium unleaded gasoline . . . .
Fuel requirements . . . . . . . . . . . .
Gasoline additives . . . . . . . . . . . .
Coolants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Windshield and headlamp
washer system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Consumer information . . . . . . . . . . .
Uniform tire quality grading. . . .
459
460
460
461
462
463
464
464
465
465
465
466
466
466
467
467
469
470
470
Technical terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471
Index. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
8
Introduction
Product information
Product information
Please observe the following in your own
best interest:
We recommend using genuine parts as
well as conversion parts and accessories
explicitly approved for use on Maybach
vehicles and your model.
We have tested these parts to determine
their reliability, safety and special suitability for Maybach vehicles.
We are unable to make an assessment
for other products and therefore cannot
be held responsible for them, even if in
individual cases an official approval or
authorization by governmental or other
agencies should exist. Use of such parts
and accessories could adversely affect
the safety, performance or reliability of
your vehicle. Please do not use them.
Genuine parts as well as conversion parts
and accessories approved by us for use
on Maybach vehicles are available at
your authorized Maybach Studio where
you will receive comprehensive information, also on permissible technical modifications, and where proper installation
will be performed.
9
Introduction
Operator’s Manual
This Operator’s Manual contains a great
deal of useful information. We urge you
to read it carefully and familiarize yourself with the vehicle before driving.
For your own safety and longer service
life of the vehicle, we urge you to follow
the instructions and warnings contained
in this manual. Ignoring them could result in damage to the vehicle or personal
injury to you or others. Vehicle damage
caused by failure to follow instructions is
not covered by the Maybach Limited
Warranty.
Your vehicle may have some or all of the
equipment described in this manual.
Therefore, you may find explanations for
optional equipment not installed in your
vehicle. If you have any questions about
the operation of any equipment, your
authorized Maybach Studio will be glad
to demonstrate the proper procedures.
10
We continuously strive to improve our
product, and ask for your understanding
that we reserve the right to make changes in design and equipment. Therefore,
information, illustrations and descriptions in this Operator’s Manual might
differ from your vehicle.
Service and warranty information
The Service and Warranty Information
Booklet contains detailed information
about the warranties covering your
Maybach, including:
New Car Limited Warranty
Optional equipment is also described in
this manual, including operating instructions wherever necessary. Since they are
special-order items, the descriptions and
illustrations herein may vary slightly
from the actual equipment of your vehicle.
Emission System Warranty
California, Maine, Massachusetts,
and Vermont Emission Control System Warranty
(California, Maine, Massachusetts,
and Vermont only)
State Warranty Enforcement Laws
(Lemon Laws)
If there are any equipment details that
are not shown or described in this Operator’s Manual, your authorized Maybach
Studio will be glad to inform you of correct care and operating procedures.
The Operator’s Manual and Maintenance Booklet are important documents
and should be kept with the vehicle.
Introduction
Operator’s Manual
Important notice for California retail
buyers and lessees of
Maybach automobiles
Under California law you may be entitled
to a replacement of your vehicle or a refund of the purchase price or lease price,
if Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC and/or its authorized repair or service facilities fail to
fix one or more substantial defects or
malfunctions in the vehicle that are covered by its express warranty after a reasonable number of repair attempts.
During the period of 18 months from
original delivery of the vehicle or the accumulation of 18000 miles (approximately 29000 km) on the odometer of
the vehicle, whichever occurs first, a reasonable number of repair attempts is
presumed for a retail buyer or lessee if
one or more of the following occurs:
(1) the same substantial defect or malfunction results in a condition that is
likely to cause death or serious bodily
injury if the vehicle is driven, that defect or malfunction has been subject
to repair two or more times, and you
have directly notified Mercedes-Benz
USA, LLC in writing of the need for its
repair,
(2) the same substantial defect or malfunction of a less serious nature than
category (1) has been subject to repair four or more times and you have
directly notified us in writing of the
need for its repair, or
(3) the vehicle is out of service by reason
of repair of the same or different substantial defects or malfunctions for a
cumulative total of more than
30 calender days.
Written notification should be sent to us,
not a Maybach Studio, at Maybach
Assistance Center, Mercedes-Benz USA,
LLC, Three Paragon Drive, Montvale,
NJ 07645.
11
Introduction
Operator’s Manual
Maintenance
The Maintenance Booklet describes all
the necessary maintenance work which
should be performed at regular intervals.
Always have the Maintenance Booklet
with you when you take the vehicle to
your authorized Maybach Studio for service. The service advisor will record each
service in the booklet for you.
Roadside Assistance
The Maybach Roadside Assistance Program provides factory trained technical
help in the event of a breakdown. Calls
to the toll-free Roadside Assistance number
1-866-FOR-MAYBach (in the USA)
1-888-881-6611 (in Canada)
will be answered by Maybach Assistance
Representatives 24 hours a day, 365 days
a year.
For additional information refer to the
Maybach Roadside Assistance Program
brochure in your glove box.
12
Change of address or ownership
If you change your address, be sure to
send in the "Change of Address Notice"
found in the Service and Warranty Information Booklet, or simply call the
Maybach Assistance Center at
1-866-FOR-MAYBach (in the USA) or
1-888-881-6611 (in Canada). It is in your
own interest that we can contact you
should the need arise.
If you sell your Maybach, please leave all
literature with the vehicle to make it
available to the next operator.
If you bought this vehicle used, be sure
to send in the "Notice of Purchase of
Used Car" found in the Service and Warranty Information Booklet, or call the
Maybach Assistance Center at
1-866-FOR-MAYBach (in the USA) or
1-888-881-6611 (in Canada).
Introduction
Operator’s Manual
Operating your vehicle outside the
USA or Canada
If you plan to operate your vehicle in foreign countries, please be aware that:
Certain Maybach models are available
for delivery in Europe under our European Delivery Program. For details, consult
an authorized Maybach Studio or write
to:
Service facilities or replacement parts
may not be readily available.
Unleaded gasoline for vehicles with
catalytic converters may not be available; the use of leaded fuels will damage the catalysts.
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC
European Delivery Department
One Mercedes Drive
Montvale, NJ 07645-0350
Gasoline may have a considerably
lower octane rating, and improper
fuel can cause engine damage.
In Canada:
In the USA:
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.
European Delivery Department
98 Vanderhoof Avenue
Toronto, Ontario M4G 4C9
13
Introduction
Where to find it
This Operator’s Manual is designed to
provide comprehensive support information for you, the vehicle operator. Each
section has its own reference color so you
can find information quickly.
At a glance
Here you will find an overview of all the
controls that can be operated in the vehicle’s interior.
Getting started
Controls in detail
Technical data
Here you will find detailed information
about the equipment installed in your
vehicle. This section expands on the
"Getting started" section and also describes technical innovations.
All important technical data for your
Maybach can be found in this section.
Operation
Here you will find all the information
you need for the proper operation of
your Maybach.
Indexes
The glossary provides explanations of
the most important technical terms.
The table of contents and the index are
designed to help you find information
quickly and easily.
The following publications are part of
your vehicle documentation:
Here you will find all the information
you need for your first drive.
Practical hints
this Operator’s Manual
the Maintenance Booklet
Safety and Security
This section provides fast assistance for
dealing with problems you may encounter.
Here you will find descriptions of the
safety and security features of your Maybach.
14
Separate operating instructions will be
provided as required depending on the
equipment options installed in your vehicle.
Introduction
Symbols
Symbols
The following symbols are found in this
Operator’s Manual:
*
Optional equipment is identified
with an asterisk. Since standard
equipment varies between models,
the descriptions and illustrations in
this manual may differ slightly from
the actual equipment of your Maybach.
** Two asterisks designates standard
equipment which the purchaser of
the vehicle had the option to delete
at the time the vehicle was ordered.
Warning!
!
This symbol points to instructions for
Highlights hazards that may result in
damage to your vehicle.
A number of these symbols appear-
you to follow.
ing in succession indicates a multiplestep procedure.
i
Helpful hints or further information
you may find useful.
page
This symbol tells you where to
look for further information
on a topic.
This continuation symbol
marks an interrupted procedure which will be continued
on the next page.
->
In the glossary of technical
terms, this symbol is used to indicate cross-references to term
definitions.
DISPLAY
Words appearing in the multifunction display are printed in
the type shown here.
G
Warning notices draw your attention to
hazards that may endanger your health or
life, or the health or life of others.
15
Introduction
Operating safety
Warning!
G
Work improperly carried out on electronic
components and associated software
could cause them to cease functioning. Because the vehicle’s electronic components
are interconnected, any modifications
made may produce an undesired effect on
other systems. Electronic malfunctions
could seriously impair the operating safety
of your vehicle.
See an authorized Maybach Studio for repairs or modifications to electronic components.
Other improper work or modifications on
the vehicle could also have a negative impact on the operating safety of the vehicle.
Some safety systems only function while
the engine is running. You should therefore never turn off the engine while driving.
16
Warning!
G
Heavy blows against the vehicle underbody or tires/wheels, for example when
running over an obstacle, road debris or a
pothole, may cause serious damage and
impair the operating safety of your vehicle. If you feel a sudden significant vibration or ride disturbance, or you suspect
that damage to your vehicle has occurred,
you should turn on your hazard warning
flashers, carefully slow down, and drive
with caution to an area which is a safe distance from the road.
Inspect the vehicle underbody and tires/
wheels for possible damage. If the vehicle
appears unsafe, have it towed to the nearest authorized Maybach Studio or other
qualified maintenance or repair facility for
further inspection or repairs.
Proper use of the vehicle
Proper use of the vehicle requires that
you are familiar with the following information and rules:
the safety precautions in this manual
the "Technical data" section in this
manual
traffic rules and regulations
motor vehicle laws and safety standards
Warning!
G
Various warning labels are attached to
your vehicle. These warning labels are intended to make you and others aware of
various risks. You should not remove any
of these warning labels unless explicitly instructed to do so by information on the label itself. Removal of any of these labels
may cause you and others to be unaware
of certain risks which may result in an accident and/or personal injury.
Introduction
Problems with your vehicle
Problems with your vehicle
If you should experience a problem with your vehicle, particularly one that you believe may affect its safe operation, we urge
you to immediately contact your Maybach Relationship Manager at an authorized Maybach Studio to have the problem diagnosed and corrected if required. If the matter is not handled to your satisfaction, please discuss the problem with the Maybach
Studio management, or if necessary contact us at one of the following addresses:
In the USA:
Maybach Assistance Center
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC
Three Paragon Drive
Montvale, NJ 07645
In Canada:
Customer Relations Department
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.
98 Vanderhoof Avenue
Toronto, Ontario M4G 4C9
17
Introduction
Reporting safety defects
For the USA only:
The following text is published as required of manufacturers under Title 49, Code of U.S. Federal Regulations, Part 575 pursuant
to the "National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act of 1966".
Reporting safety defects
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately
inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles,
it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your
Maybach Studio, the Maybach Assistance Center, or Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC.
To contact NHTSA, you may either call the Auto Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (or 366-0123 in Washington, D.C. area)
or write to: NHTSA, U.S. Department of Transportation, Washington, D.C. 20590. You can also obtain other information about
motor vehicle safety from the Hotline.
18
Introduction
Vehicle data recording
Vehicle data recording
Information regarding electronic recording devices
(Including notice pursuant to California Code § 9951)
Please note that your vehicle is equipped with devices that can record vehicle systems data and, if equipped with the Tele Aid
system, may transmit some data in certain accidents.
This information helps, for example, to diagnose vehicle systems after a collision and to continuously improve vehicle safety.
DaimlerChrysler may access the information and share it with others
for safety research or vehicle diagnosis purposes
with the consent of the vehicle owner or lessee
in response to an official request by law enforcement or other government agency
for use in dispute resolution involving DaimlerChrysler, its affiliates or sales/service organization and/or
as otherwise required or permitted by law.
Please check the Tele Aid subscription service agreement for details regarding the information that may be recorded or transmitted via that system.
19
20
At a glance
Cockpit
Instrument cluster
Multifunction steering wheel
Front center console
Overhead control panel
Driver’s door control panel
Rear passenger compartment
Rear seats
Rear 3-place seat
Rear center console
Rear door control panel
21
At a glance
Cockpit
22
At a glance
Cockpit
Item
1 Exterior lamp switch
2 Headlamp washer button
Page
70,
143
192
High beam
70
Turn signals
71
Windshield wipers
71
4 Cruise control lever
Cruise control
233
Distronic**
236
5 Multifunction steering
wheel
60,
158
6 Horn
7 Instrument cluster
24,
153
Page
8 Lever for voice control system, see separate operating instructions
9 Starter switch
3 Combination switch
Item
54
Item
Page
e Glove box lid release
259
f Glove box lock
259
g Front center console
27
60
a Front Parktronic warning
indicator
254
h Steering wheel adjustment
stalk
b Air vent grille with storage
box
258
j Heated steering wheel
switch
308
k Remote trunk lid switch
119
c Overhead control panel
30
d Compartment for front
telephone
260
290
The Roadside Assistance
button • and the Information button ¡ are located in the compartment
for front telephone.
298
l Parking brake pedal
m Hood lock release
74
355
n Parking brake release
74
o Door control panel
31
23
At a glance
Instrument cluster
24
At a glance
Instrument cluster
Item
Page
Item
1 Coolant temperature
gauge
154
9 -
2 Fuel gauge with fuel
reserve warning lamp
389
3 L
Left turn signal indicator lamp
Item
Antilock Brake System (ABS) indicator
lamp
385
k H
High beam headlamp indicator lamp
147
l Knob for instrument cluster
illumination
153
a A
m ?
Reset button
Seat belt telltale
Engine malfunction
indicator lamp, USA
only
389
b J
±
Engine malfunction
indicator lamp, Canada only
389
n ;
Brake warning lamp,
USA only
388
3
Brake warning lamp,
Canada only
388
o 1
Supplemental
Restraint System
(SRS) indicator lamp
387
71
4 Speedometer
156
c <
5 v
Antilock Brake System (ABS)/Electronic
Stability Program
(ESP) warning lamp
384
d Digital clock
(see COMAND and RearCabin Audiovisual System
operating instructions)
6 l
Distance warning
lamp1
385
7 K
Right turn signal indicator lamp
8 Tachometer
1
Page
71
154
386
e Gear selector lever position
and program mode
185
f Main odometer
157
g Trip odometer
157
h Multifunction display
157
j Outside temperature indicator
155
Page
Tire pressure warning lamp
389
Vehicles without Distronic**: Warning lamp
without function. It illuminates when the ignition is on. It should go out when the engine is
running.
25
At a glance
Multifunction steering wheel
Item
Page
1 Multifunction display
Operating control system
2 Selecting the submenu or
setting the volume:
Press button
æ
up/to increase
ç
down/to decrease
3 Telephone:
Press button
26
s
to take a call
to dial a call
t
to end a call
to reject an
incoming call
157
158
Item
Page
4 Menu systems:
Press button
è
for next menu
ÿ
for previous menu
5 Moving within a menu:
Press button
j
for next display
k
for previous display
At a glance
Front center console
Front center console
Upper part
Item
Page
Item
1 Hazard warning flasher on/
off switch
147
7 Automatic climate control
2 Anti-theft alarm system indicator lamp
105
8 Chrome label for opening
cover of:
3 Central locking switch
125
4 Central unlocking switch
125
5 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
6 COMAND (see separate COMAND and Rear-Cabin Audiovisual System operating
instructions)
89
Page
199
Cup holders
269
Switch for opening/closing rear window curtain
280
Switch for opening/closing rear side window
curtains*
281
27
At a glance
Front center console
Lower part
Maybach 57 and Maybach 62 without
partition*
Item
Page
1 KEYLESS-GO** start/stop
button
55,
66
2 Gear selector lever for automatic transmission
66
3 Button for retracting/extending rear seat head restraints
133
4 Parking assist (Parktronic
system) deactivation button
255
5 Two-way intercom* on/off
button
287
Item
Page
6 Chrome label for opening
cover of:
Ashtray
272
Lighter
273
Storage compartment*
274
7 Thumbwheel for setting
distance in Distronic**
243
8 Distance warning function** on/off button
243
9 Level control button
249
a Airmatic DC button
248
b Electronic Stability Program
(ESP) control switch
100
c Program mode selector
switch for automatic transmission
189
i
Depending on equipment, the arrangement of switches and buttons
may vary.
28
At a glance
Front center console
Maybach 62 with partition*
Item
Page
1 KEYLESS-GO** start/stop
button
55,
66
2 Gear selector lever for automatic transmission
66
3 Button for retracting/extending rear seat head restraints
133
4 Parking assist (Parktronic
system) deactivation button
255
5 Two-way intercom on/off
button
287
6 Switch for opening/closing
partition* curtain
7 Partition* opening/closing
switch
Item
Page
7 Chrome label for opening
cover of:
Ashtray
272
Lighter
273
Storage compartment*
274
9 Thumbwheel for setting
distance in Distronic**
243
a Distance warning function** on/off button
243
b Level control button
249
c Airmatic DC button
248
285
d Electronic Stability Program
(ESP) control switch
100
284
e Program mode selector
switch for automatic transmission
189
i
Depending on equipment, the arrangement of switches and buttons
may vary.
29
At a glance
Overhead control panel
Item
30
Page
1 Left reading lamp on/off
148
2 Rear interior lighting on/off
148
3 Interior lighting control
148
4 Right reading lamp on/off
148
5 Front interior lighting on/
off
148
6 Tow-away alarm button
106
7 Rear view mirror
61,
192
8 Garage door opener
304
Item
Page
9 Automatic antiglare function on/off
192
a Tele Aid (emergency call
system) button
294
b Switch for opening/closing
power tilt/sliding sunroof
(Maybach 57)
222
Switch for opening/closing
power tilt/sliding sunroof
(Maybach 62)
225
Switch for operating
electrotransparent roof*
screen
230
At a glance
Driver’s door control panel
Driver’s door control panel
Item
Page
1 Door handle
117
2 Memory function (for storing seat, mirror and steering wheel settings)
142
3 Seat adjustment
Item
7 Override switch for rear
passenger compartment
Page
94
8 Switches for opening/closing rear door windows
218
195
9 Button for opening storage
compartment
261
4 Button for folding exterior
mirrors in and out
261
5 Exterior mirror adjustment
61
a Handle for opening storage
compartment
6 Switches for opening/closing front door windows
218
b Seat ventilation*
139
c Seat heating
138
57
31
At a glance
Rear passenger compartment
Maybach 57
32
At a glance
Rear passenger compartment
Item
Page
Item
Page
Item
Page
1 Vanity mirror, left
257
7 Automatic climate control
panel
214
156
4 Outside temperature
gauge
155
2 Speedometer
3 Clock (see COMAND and
Rear-Cabin Audiovisual System operating instructions)
156
5 Vanity mirror, right
257
8 Button for opening storage
compartment/drawer
263
6 Video monitor, right (see
COMAND and Rear-Cabin
Audiovisual System operating instructions)
9 Video monitor, left (see COMAND and Rear-Cabin Audiovisual System operating
instructions)
33
At a glance
Rear passenger compartment
Maybach 62 without partition*
34
At a glance
Rear passenger compartment
Item
Page
Item
1 Vanity mirror, left
257
5 Vanity mirror, right
2 Speedometer
156
3 Clock (see COMAND and
Rear-Cabin Audiovisual System operating instructions)
156
6 Video monitor, right (see
COMAND and Rear-Cabin
Audiovisual System operating instructions)
4 Outside temperature
gauge
155
7 Button for opening upper
storage compartment
Page
257
264
Item
Page
8 Automatic climate control
panel
214
9 Button for opening storage
compartment/drawer
263
a Video monitor, left (see COMAND and Rear-Cabin Audiovisual System operating
instructions)
35
At a glance
Rear passenger compartment
Maybach 62 with partition*
36
At a glance
Rear passenger compartment
Item
Page
Item
Page
1 Vanity mirror, left
257
5 Vanity mirror, right
2 Speedometer
156
3 Clock (see COMAND and
Rear-Cabin Audiovisual System operating instructions)
156
6 Video monitor, right (see
COMAND and Rear-Cabin
Audiovisual System operating instructions)
4 Outside temperature
gauge
155
7 Button for opening upper
storage compartment
264
8 Storage pocket, right
265
257
Item
Page
9 Automatic climate control
panel
214
a Button for opening storage
compartment/drawer
263
b Storage pocket, left
265
c Video monitor, left (see COMAND and Rear-Cabin Audiovisual System operating
instructions)
37
At a glance
Rear seats
Maybach 57
38
At a glance
Rear seats
v
Item
Page
1 Rear Parktronic warning indicator
253
2 Button for opening upper
storage compartment with
insert for two champagne
flutes
266
3 Chrome label for opening
DVD player, AUX sockets
and headphone jacks (see
COMAND and Rear-Cabin
Audiovisual System operating instructions)
266
4 Chrome label for opening
CD changer compartment
(see COMAND and RearCabin Audiovisual System
operating instructions)
266
Item
5 Chrome label for opening
middle storage compartment
6 Door control panel, left
Page
266
49
7 Handle for opening left
door storage compartment
for headphones
261
8 Handle for opening left
door storage compartment
261
9 Center armrest with
Item
a Rear center console
Page
46
b Rear-cabin beverage holder
269
c 12-V socket
278
d Adjustment switch for left
multicontour seat
136
e Folding table*
275
f Folding table*
275
g Adjustment switch for right
multicontour seat
136
Storage compartment
for telephone
291
h Handle for opening right
door storage compartment
261
Storage compartment
underneath
266
261
Refrigerator** underneath
277
j Handle for opening right
door storage compartment
for headphones
k Door control panel, right
49
39
At a glance
Rear seats
Maybach 62
40
At a glance
Rear seats
Item
Page
Item
Page
1 Rear Parktronic warning indicator
253
6 Door control panel, left
261
2 Button for opening upper
storage compartment with
insert for two champagne
flutes
266
7 Handle for opening left
door storage compartment
for headphones
8 Handle for opening left
door storage compartment
261
3 Chrome label for opening
DVD player, AUX sockets
and headphone jacks (see
COMAND and Rear-Cabin
Audiovisual System operating instructions)
266
4 Chrome label for opening
CD changer compartment
(see COMAND and RearCabin Audiovisual System
operating instructions)
266
5 Chrome label for opening
middle storage compartment
266
49
Item
d Rear center console
Page
46
e Rear-cabin beverage holder
269
f 12-V socket
278
g Folding table
275
h Folding table
275
136
9 Button for opening storage
compartment
262
j Adjustment switch for right
multicontour seat
a Storage compartment
262
261
b Adjustment switch for left
multicontour seat
136
k Handle for opening right
door storage compartment
for headphones
c Center armrest with
291
l Handle for opening right
door storage compartment
261
m Button for opening storage
compartment
262
n Storage compartment
262
Storage compartment
for telephone
Storage compartment
underneath
266
Refrigerator** underneath
277
o Door control panel, right
49
41
At a glance
Rear 3-place seat
Maybach 57 with rear center seat*
42
At a glance
Rear 3-place seat
v
Item
1 Rear Parktronic warning indicator
Page
Item
Page
253
3 Door control panel, left
261
DVD player compartment, CD changer compartment, AUX sockets
and headphone jacks located behind backrest
(see COMAND and RearCabin Audiovisual System operating instructions)
267
4 Handle for opening left
door storage compartment
for headphones
5 Handle for opening left
door storage compartment
for ashtray
Storage compartment
between the rear outer
seats located behind
backrest
267
Center armrest with
storage compartment
for telephone (backrest
folded down)
291
2 Rear center backrest
Item
Page
9 Switch for rear center seat
head restraints
134
a Cup holder
270
b Adjustment switch for right
multicontour seat
136
261
261
6 Cup holder
270
c Handle for opening right
door storage compartment
for ashtray
7 Adjustment switch for left
multicontour seat
136
261
8 12-V socket
278
d Handle for opening right
door storage compartment
for headphones
49
e Door control panel, right
49
43
At a glance
Rear 3-place seat
Maybach 62 with rear center seat*
44
At a glance
Rear 3-place seat
Item
1 Rear Parktronic warning indicator
Page
Page
253
3 Door control panel, left
261
DVD player compartment, CD changer compartment, AUX sockets
and headphone jacks located behind backrest
(see COMAND and RearCabin Audiovisual System operating instructions)
267
4 Handle for opening left
door storage compartment
for headphones
5 Handle for opening left
door storage compartment
for ashtray
Storage compartment
between the rear outer
seats located behind
backrest
267
Center armrest with
storage compartment
for telephone (backrest
folded down)
291
2 Rear center backrest
Item
Item
Page
b Switch for rear center seat
head restraints
134
c Cup holder
270
d Adjustment switch for right
multicontour seat
136
261
261
6 Adjustment switch for left
multicontour seat
136
e Handle for opening right
door storage compartment
for headphones
262
f Handle for opening right
door storage compartment
for ashtray
261
7 Button for opening storage
compartment
8 Storage compartment
262
262
9 Cup holder
270
g Button for opening storage
compartment
a 12-V socket
278
h Storage compartment
262
49
j Door control panel, right
49
45
At a glance
Rear center console
Maybach 57
Item
Page
Item
Page
1 Left reading lamp on/off
150
294
8 Switch for opening/closing
rear right-side window curtain*
281
2 Tele Aid (emergency call
system) button
3 Right reading lamp on/off
150
280
4 Ambient lighting on/off
150
9 Switch for opening/closing
rear window curtain
281
Rear interior lamps on/off
150
5 Thumbwheel for dimming
ambient lighting
150
a Switch for opening/closing
rear left-side window curtain*
287
b Two-way intercom*
on/off button
287
6 Two-way intercom* volume
thumbwheel
c Rear interior lamps on/off
150
7 Cover of compartment
with:
Switch for opening/closing
rear window curtain
280
Ashtray
272
d Central unlocking switch
125
Lighter
274
e Central locking switch
125
Storage compartment*
274
i
Depending on equipment, the arrangement of switches and buttons
may vary.
46
At a glance
Rear center console
Maybach 62 with power tilt/sliding
sunroof
Item
Page
1 Left reading lamp on/off
151
2 Tele Aid (emergency call
system) button
294
3 Right reading lamp on/off
151
4 Ambient lighting on/off
151
5 Headliner lamps and pillar
uplights on/off
Depending on equipment, the arrangement of switches and buttons
may vary.
Page
a Switch for raising/lowering
power tilt/sliding sunroof
227
b Switch for opening/closing
rear right-side window curtain*
281
151
c Switch for opening/closing
rear window curtain
280
6 Thumbwheel for dimming
ambient lighting and headliner lamps and pillar uplights
151
d Switch for opening/closing
rear left-side window curtain*
281
284
7 Two-way intercom* volume
thumbwheel
287
e Switch for opening/closing
partition*
f Switch for opening/closing
partition* curtain
284
g Two-way intercom*
on/off button
287
h Rear interior lamps on/off
151
j Central unlocking switch
125
k Central locking switch
125
8 Cover of compartment
with:
i
Item
Ashtray
272
Lighter
274
Storage compartment*
274
9 Switch for opening/closing
power tilt/sliding sunroof
227
47
At a glance
Rear center console
Maybach 62 with electrotransparent
roof*
Item
Page
1 Left reading lamp on/off
151
2 Tele Aid (emergency call
system) button
294
3 Right reading lamp on/off
151
4 Ambient lighting on/off
151
5 Roof lighting on/off
151
6 Thumbwheel for dimming
ambient lighting or roof
lighting
7 Two-way intercom* volume
thumbwheel
Depending on equipment, the arrangement of switches and buttons
may vary.
48
Page
a Switch for making electrotransparent roof*
opaque/transparent
232
b Switch for opening/closing
rear right-side window curtain*
281
c Switch for opening/closing
rear window curtain
280
151
281
287
d Switch for opening/closing
rear left-side window curtain*
e Switch for opening/closing
partition*
284
f Switch for opening/closing
partition* curtain
284
g Two-way intercom*
on/off button
287
h Rear interior lamps on/off
151
j Central unlocking switch
125
k Central locking switch
125
8 Cover of compartment
with:
i
Item
Ashtray
272
Lighter
274
Storage compartment*
274
9 Switch for opening/closing
electrotransparent roof*
screen
232
At a glance
Rear door control panel
Rear door control panel
Maybach 57
Item
1
Page
1 Adjustment switch for right
front passenger seat1
135
2 Adjustment switch for right
rear seat1
135
3 Memory button for storing
rear seat positions
142
4 Door handle
117
5 Seat ventilation*
139
6 Seat heating
138
7 Seat adjustment
130
8 Switches for opening/closing rear door window
218
These switches are located on the right rear passenger side only.
49
At a glance
Rear door control panel
Maybach 62
Item
1
50
Page
1 Adjustment switch for right
front passenger seat1
135
2 Adjustment switch for right
rear seat1
135
3 Memory button for storing
rear seat positions
142
4 Door handle
117
5 Switch for moving seat to
fully reclined position
132
6 Seat ventilation*
139
7 Seat heating
138
8 Switch for moving seat to
to upright position
132
9 Seat adjustment
132
a Switches for opening/closing rear door window
218
These switches are located on the right rear passenger side only.
Getting started
Unlocking
Adjusting
Driving
Parking and locking
51
Getting started
Unlocking
The "Getting started" section provides
an overview of the vehicle's most basic
functions.
Press unlock button Œ on the
Unlocking with the SmartKey
SmartKey.
All turn signal lamps flash once. The
vehicle unlocks. The locking knobs in
the doors move up. The anti-theft
alarm system is disarmed.
If you are already familiar with the basic
functions described here, the "Controls
in detail" section will provide you with
further information. The corresponding
page references are located at the end of
each segment.
i
The SBC brake system is activated
( page 101).
Get in the vehicle and insert the
SmartKey in the starter switch.
SmartKey with remote control
1
2
3
4
 Panic button ( page 95)
Š Unlock button for trunk lid
Œ Unlock button
‹ Lock button
Warning!
G
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey from the starter switch, take
it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not
leave children unattended in the vehicle,
or with access to an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment may
cause an accident and/or serious personal
injury.
52
For more information, see "SmartKey"
( page 108).
Getting started
Unlocking
Unlocking with KEYLESS-GO**
With KEYLESS-GO you can open and start
your vehicle without using the buttons
on the SmartKey.
i
To unlock the vehicle, the SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO must be outside the
vehicle, no further than approximately 3 feet (1 meter) away from the
door.
Warning!
G
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO with you, and
lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to
an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of
vehicle equipment may cause an accident
and/or serious personal injury.
Grasp the outside door handle.
All turn signal lamps flash once. The
vehicle unlocks. The locking knobs in
the doors move up. The anti-theft
alarm system is disarmed.
i
The SBC brake system is activated
( page 101).
Get in the vehicle.
For more information, see "SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO**" ( page 111).
53
Getting started
Unlocking
Starter switch positions
Warning!
G
0
For removing SmartKey
i
1
Power supply to some electrical consumers, such as seat adjustment
2
Ignition (power supply for all electrical consumers) and driving position.
All lamps in the instrument cluster
come on. If a lamp in the instrument
cluster fails to come on when the ignition is switched on, have it checked
and replaced if necessary. If a lamp in
the instrument cluster remains on after starting the engine or comes on
while driving, refer to "Lamps in instrument cluster" ( page 384).
The SmartKey can only be removed
from the starter switch with the gear
selector lever in position P.
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO from the starter switch, take
it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not
leave children unattended in the vehicle,
or with access to an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment may
cause an accident and/or serious personal
injury.
SmartKey
3
Starting position
i
When you switch on the ignition, the
indicator and warning lamps in the
instrument cluster come on. This indicates that the respective systems are
operational. They should go out
when the engine is running.
Starter switch
54
!
If the SmartKey can still not be
turned, the battery may not be sufficiently charged.
Check the starter battery and
charge it if necessary
( page 441).
Get a jump start ( page 445).
To prevent accelerated battery discharge or a completely discharged
battery, always remove the SmartKey
from the starter switch.
For information on starting the engine
using the SmartKey, see "Starting with
the SmartKey" ( page 66).
Getting started
Unlocking
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO
The SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO must be
located in the vehicle.
Pressing the KEYLESS-GO start/stop button on the gear selector lever corresponds to turning the SmartKey to the
various starter switch positions.
Make sure the gear selector lever is
set to P.
Do not depress the brake pedal.
If you firmly depress the brake pedal during pressing KEYLESS-GO start/stop button, the engine starts automatically.
Position 0
i
The function of the SmartKey overrules the KEYLESS-GO function.
KEYLESS-GO start/stop button
Before you press the KEYLESS-GO start/
stop button, the vehicle's on-board electronics have status 0 (as with SmartKey
removed).
1 USA only
2 Canada only
55
Getting started
Unlocking
Position 1
Ignition (or position 2)
i
Press KEYLESS-GO start/stop
Press KEYLESS-GO start/stop
If you now press the KEYLESS-GO
start/stop button once, the power
supply is again switched off.
button 1 once.
button 1 twice.
This supplies power to some electrical
consumers, such as seat adjustment.
All lamps in the instrument cluster
come on. If a lamp in the instrument
cluster fails to come on when the ignition is switched on, have it checked
and replaced if necessary. If a lamp in
the instrument cluster remains on after starting the engine or comes on
while driving, refer to "Lamps in instrument cluster" ( page 384).
i
If you now press the KEYLESS-GO
start/stop button
56
once again, the ignition
(position 2) is switched on
twice, the power supply is again
switched off
i
When you switch on the ignition, the
indicator and warning lamps in the
instrument cluster come on. This indicates that the respective systems are
operational. They should go out
when the engine is running.
For information on starting the engine
using the KEYLESS-GO start/stop button,
see "Starting with KEYLESS-GO**"
( page 66).
Getting started
Adjusting
Adjusting
Warning!
G
All seat, head restraint, steering wheel,
and rear view mirror adjustments, as well
as fastening of seat belts, must be done before the vehicle is put into motion.
Seats
Warning!
G
Do not adjust the driver's seat while driving. Adjusting the seat while driving could
cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle.
Never ride in a moving vehicle with the
seat back in an excessively reclined position as this can be dangerous. You could
slide under the seat belt in a collision. If
you slide under it, the belt would apply
force at the abdomen or neck. That could
cause serious or fatal injuries. The seat
backrest and seat belts provide the best restraint when the wearer is in a nearly upright position and belts are properly
positioned on the body.
Only the reclining seat (in Maybach 62 rear
cabin) can be used in a reclined position
with seat belts properly fastened while the
vehicle is in motion. The reclining seat in
the Maybach 62 rear cabin includes a belt
system and kinematic electronic controls
that are designed to maintain proper support and restraint-system effectiveness in
all seat settings in the event of a collision
or similar situation.
Your seat must be adjusted so that you can
correctly fasten your seat belt ( page 63).
Never place hands under the seat or near
any moving parts while a seat is being adjusted.
Warning!
G
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle.
Even with the SmartKey or the SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO** removed from the
starter switch or the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** removed from the vehicle,
the power seats can be operated when the
respective door is open. Therefore, do not
leave children unattended in the vehicle,
or with access to an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment may
cause an accident and/or serious personal
injury.
57
Getting started
Adjusting
Warning!
G
Children 12 years old and under must never ride in the front seat, except in a
Maybach authorized BabySmartTM1 compatible child seat, which operates with the
BabySmartTM system installed in the vehicle to deactivate the passenger front airbag when it is properly installed.
Otherwise they will be struck by the airbag
when it inflates in a crash. If this happens,
serious or fatal injury will result.
According to accident statistics, children
are safer when properly restrained in the
rear seating positions than in the front
seating positions. Infants and small children must ride in back seats and be seated
in an appropriate infant or child restraint
system, which is properly secured with the
vehicle's seat belt and top tether strap, or
secured via lower anchors and top tether
strap, fully in accordance with the child
seat manufacturer's instructions.
1
BabySmartTM is a trademark of Siemens
Automotive Corp.
58
A child's risk of serious or fatal injuries is
significantly increased if the child restraints are not properly secured in the vehicle and the child is not properly secured
in the child restraint.
Seat adjustment
The seat adjustment switches are located
on each door.
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
or
Open the respective door.
Seat fore and aft adjustment
Press switch forward or backward in
direction of arrow 1.
Adjust to a comfortable seating position that still allows you to reach the
accelerator/brake pedal safely. The
position should be as far to the rear
as possible, corresponding to the
driver's ability to properly operate
the controls.
i
When moving the seat, be sure that
there are no items in the footwell or
behind the seats. Otherwise you
could damage the seats.
1
2
3
4
5
6
Seat fore and aft adjustment
Seat height
Seat cushion tilt
Seat backrest tilt
Seat cushion depth
Head restraint height
The memory function ( page 140)
lets you store settings for the seat positions together with the settings for
the steering wheel and rear view mirrors.
Getting started
Adjusting
Seat height
Head restraint height
Press switch up or down in direction
Press switch up or down in direction
of arrow 2.
Seat cushion tilt
Press switch up or down in direction
of arrow 3 until your upper legs are
lightly supported.
Seat backrest tilt
Press switch forward or backward in
direction of arrow 4 until your arms
are slightly angled when holding the
steering wheel.
Seat cushion depth
Press switch forward or backward in
direction of arrow 5 until your legs
are supported comfortably.
Head restraint tilt
of arrow 6.
i
Adjust the head restraint in such a
way that it is as close to the head as
possible.
Warning!
G
For your protection, drive only with properly positioned head restraints.
Manually adjust the angle of the head
restraint.
Adjust head restraint so that the center of
the head restraint supports the back of the
head at eye level. This will reduce the potential for injury to the head and neck in
the event of an accident or similar situation.
Push or pull on the lower edge of the
Do not drive the vehicle without the seat
head restraints. Head restraints are intended to help reduce injuries during an accident.
head restraint cushion.
i
Adjust the head restraint in such a
way that it is as close to the head as
possible.
For more information, see "Seats"
( page 127).
59
Getting started
Adjusting
Steering wheel
Warning!
G
Steering wheel adjustment
Adjusting steering column in or out
The stalk is located on the lower lefthand side of the steering wheel.
Move stalk forward or backward in
Do not adjust the steering wheel while
driving. Adjusting the steering wheel
while driving could cause the driver to lose
control of the vehicle.
Adjusting steering column up or down
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle.
Even with the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** removed from the starter
switch or the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** removed from the vehicle,
the steering wheel adjustment feature can
be operated when the driver’s door is
open. Therefore, do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to
an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of
vehicle equipment may cause an accident
and/or serious personal injury.
direction of arrow 1 until a comfortable steering wheel position is
reached with your arms slightly bent
at the elbow.
Move the stalk up or down in direc-
tion of arrow 2.
1 Adjusting steering column, in or out
2 Adjusting steering column, up or
down
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
or
Open the driver's door.
Make sure your legs can move freely
and that all of the displays (including
malfunction and indicator lamps) on
the instrument cluster are clearly visible.
i
The memory function ( page 140)
lets you store settings for the steering
wheel together with settings for the
rear view mirrors and seat positions.
For more information, see "Heated
steering wheel" ( page 308).
60
Getting started
Adjusting
Mirrors
Adjust the interior and exterior rear view
mirrors before driving so that you have a
good view of the road and traffic conditions.
Warning!
G
In the case of an accident liquid electrolyte
may escape the mirror housing if the mirror glass breaks.
Interior rear view mirror
Exterior rear view mirror
Manually adjust the interior rear view
mirror.
For more information, see "Rear view
mirrors" ( page 192).
Warning!
G
Exercise care when using the passengerside exterior rear view mirror. The mirror
surface is convex (outwardly curved surface for a wider field of view). Objects in
mirror are closer than they appear. Check
your interior rear view mirror or glance
over your shoulder before changing lanes.
Electrolyte has an irritating effect. Do not
allow the liquid to come into contact with
eyes, skin, clothing, or respiratory system.
In case it does, immediately flush affected
area with water, and seek medical help if
necessary.
!
Electrolyte drops coming into contact
with the vehicle paint finish can only
be completely removed while in their
liquid state and by applying plenty of
water.
61
Getting started
Adjusting
The buttons are located on the driver's
door.
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
i
Press button 1 for the driver’s side
The memory function ( page 140)
lets you save the rear-view mirror settings together with the settings for
the steering wheel and seat positions.
exterior rear view mirror or button 2
for the passenger-side exterior rear
view mirror.
Push adjustment button 3 up or
down, left or right according to the
desired setting.
!
1 Driver's side exterior rear view mirror
button
2 Passenger-side exterior rear view mirror button
3 Adjustment button
62
For information on how to reposition
the exterior mirror housing when it
was forcibly pushed forward (hit
from the rear) or forcibly pushed
rearward (hit from the front), see
"Folding the exterior mirrors in and
out manually" ( page 196).
i
At low ambient temperatures, the exterior rear view mirrors will be heated automatically.
For more information, see "Rear view
mirrors" ( page 192).
Getting started
Driving
Driving
Warning!
G
Do not lay any objects in the driver's footwell. Be careful that floor mats or carpets
in the driver's footwell have sufficient
clearance for the pedals.
During sudden driving or braking maneuvers the objects could get caught between
the pedals. You could then no longer
brake or accelerate.
G
Due to the considerably larger interior
compared to other vehicles, for occupants
in the rear of the vehicle not properly
wearing their seat belts, the risk of injury
in an accident is significantly increased.
They are much more likely to be thrown
around in the vehicle in slight frontal impacts or even during emergency braking
maneuvers.
Always fasten your seat belt before driving
off. Always make sure your passengers are
properly restrained, even those sitting in
the rear and pregnant women.
cle to deactivate the front passenger airbag when it is properly installed. Otherwise they will be struck by the airbag when
it inflates in a crash. If this happens, serious
or fatal injury will result.
If you are ever in an accident, your injuries
can be considerably more severe without
your seat belt properly buckled. Without
your seat belt buckled, you are much more
likely to hit the interior of the vehicle or be
ejected from it. You can be seriously injured or killed.
According to accident statistics, children
are safer when properly restrained in the
rear seating positions than in the front
seating positions. Infants and small children must ride in back seats and be seated
in an appropriate infant or child restraint
system, which is properly secured with the
vehicle's seat belt and top tether strap, or
secured via lower anchors and top tether
strap, fully in accordance with the child
seat manufacturer's instructions.
In the same crash, the possibility of injury
or death is lessened if you are wearing
your seat belt. The airbags can only protect
as expected if the occupants are using their
seat belts ( page 78).
Fastening the seat belts
Warning!
Failure to wear and properly fasten and
position your seat belt greatly increases
your risk of injuries and their likely severity
in an accident. You and your passengers
should always wear seat belts.
Warning!
G
Children 12 years old and under must never ride in the front seat, except in a
Maybach authorized BabySmartTM1 compatible child seat, which operates with the
BabySmartTM system installed in the vehi1
BabySmartTM is a trademark of Siemens
Automotive Corp.
A child's risk of serious or fatal injuries is
significantly increased if the child restraints are not properly secured in the vehicle and the child is not properly secured
in the child restraint.
Warning!
G
Never let more people ride in the vehicle
than there are seat belts available. Be sure
everyone riding in the vehicle is correctly
restrained with a separate seat belt.
63
Getting started
Driving
Warning!
G
Never ride in a moving vehicle with the
seat backrest in an excessively reclined position as this can be dangerous. You could
slide under the seat belt in a collision. If
you slide under it, the belt would apply
force at the abdomen or neck. That could
cause serious or even fatal injuries. The
seat backrest and seat belt provide the
best restraint when the wearer is in a nearly upright position and the belt is properly
positioned on the body.
Warning!
Read and observe the additional warning
notices printed in the "Safety and Security" section ( page 82).
64
Pull the seat belt smoothly from the
seat belt outlet 1.
Place the shoulder portion of the belt
across the top of your shoulder and
the lap portion across your hips.
Push latch plate 2 into buckle 3 un-
til it clicks.
If necessary, tighten the lap portion
to a snug fit by pulling shoulder portion up.
Proper use of seat belts:
Only the reclining seat (in Maybach 62 rear
cabin) can be used in a reclined position
with seat belts properly fastened while the
vehicle is in motion. The reclining seat in
the Maybach 62 rear cabin includes a belt
system and kinematic electronic controls
that are designed to maintain proper support and restraint-system effectiveness in
all seat settings in the event of a collision
or similar situation.
Keep the door storage compartments
closed while the vehicle is in motion. Failure to do so may cause the seat belt to
catch at the rear and prevent proper positioning of the seat belt.
G
1
2
3
4
Seat belt outlet
Latch plate
Buckle
Release button
Do not twist the belt when fastening.
Adjust seat belt so that the shoulder
portion is located as close as possible
to the middle of the shoulder (it
should not touch the neck or pass under the arm).
Position the lap belt as low as possible on your hips (over hip joint) and
not across the abdomen.
Place the seat backrest in a nearly upright position.
Never use a seat belt for more than
one person at a time.
Getting started
Driving
Do not fasten a seat belt around a
person and another object at the
same time. When using a seat belt to
secure infant or toddler restraints or
children in booster seats, always follow the child seat manufacturer's instructions.
Check your seat belt during travel to
make sure it is properly positioned.
Make sure the seat belt is always fitted snugly. You should avoid wearing
bulky clothing, such as winter coats,
when traveling in the vehicle. Place
the seat backrest in a nearly upright
position.
Warning!
G
Do not pass belts over sharp edges. They
could tear.
Do not allow the belt to get caught in the
door or in the seat adjustment mechanism.
This could damage the belt.
Never attempt to make modifications to
seat belts. This could impair the effectiveness of the belts.
Do not bleach or dye seat belts as this may
severely weaken them. In a crash they may
not be able to provide adequate protection.
Damaged seat belts or belts that were
highly stressed in an accident must be replaced. Contact an authorized Maybach
Studio.
Starting the engine
Warning!
G
Inhalation of exhaust gas is hazardous to
your health. All exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide, and inhaling it can cause
unconsciousness and lead to death.
Do not run the engine in confined areas
(such as a garage) which are not properly
ventilated. If you think that exhaust gas
fumes are entering the vehicle while driving, have the cause determined and corrected immediately. If you must drive
under these conditions, drive with at least
one window fully open.
65
Getting started
Driving
Automatic transmission
Starting with the SmartKey
Starting with KEYLESS-GO**
Make sure the gear selector lever is
You can start your vehicle without a
SmartKey using the KEYLESS-GO start/
stop button on the gear selector lever.
set to P.
Do not depress the accelerator.
Turn the SmartKey in the starter
switch to position 3 and hold until
the engine starts ( page 54).
i
Gearshift pattern for automatic transmission
P
Park position with gear selector lever
lock
R Reverse gear
N Neutral
D Drive position
For more information, see "Automatic
transmission" ( page 185).
You can also use the "touch-start"
function. Turn the SmartKey to position 3 and release it again immediately. The engine then starts
automatically.
In order to start the engine with the
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO:
The SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO must
be located in the vehicle.
All the doors must be closed.
Firmly depress the brake pedal.
The gear selector lever lock is released.
For more information, see "Turning off
the engine with the SmartKey"
( page 75).
KEYLESS-GO start/stop button
1 USA only
2 Canada only
66
Getting started
Driving
i
Starting difficulties
If the SmartKey’s battery is discharged, you cannot start the vehicle
using the KEYLESS-GO function. Use
the SmartKey instead.
If the engine does not start as described,
carry out the following steps:
If you are starting the engine with
the SmartKey, turn SmartKey in starter switch to position 0 and repeat
starting procedure.
Make sure the gear selector lever is
set to P.
Do not depress the accelerator.
If you are starting the engine with
KEYLESS-GO**, close any doors that
may be open to allow for better detection of the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO**.
Firmly depress the brake pedal during
the starting procedure.
The gear selector lever lock is released.
Press KEYLESS-GO start/stop
button 1 once.
The engine starts automatically.
Repeat the starting procedure
( page 65). Remember that extend-
ed starting attempts can drain the
battery.
Get a jump start ( page 445).
If the engine does not start after several
starting attempts, there could be a malfunction in the engine electronics or in
the fuel supply system.
Notify an authorized Maybach
Studio.
or
Start the engine with the SmartKey as
radio signals from another source
may be interfering with the SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO**.
For more information, see "Turning off
the engine with KEYLESS-GO**"
( page 75).
67
Getting started
Driving
Parking brake
Warning!
G
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Children could release the parking brake,
which could result in an accident and/or serious injury.
1 Parking brake release handle
2 Parking brake pedal
Release the parking brake by pulling
on handle 1.
The warning lamp ; (USA only) or
3 (Canada only) in the instrument
cluster goes out.
68
Driving
Firmly depress brake pedal.
The gear selector lever lock is released.
Move gear selector lever in position D
or R.
Warning!
G
It is dangerous to shift the gear selector lever out of P or N if the engine speed is
higher than idle speed. If your foot is not
firmly on the brake pedal, the vehicle
could accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle
and hit someone or something. Only shift
into gear when the engine is idling normally and when your right foot is firmly on
the brake pedal.
Getting started
Driving
!
!
!
In order to avoid damaging the transmission,
If you hear a warning signal when
driving off, you have forgotten to release the parking brake.
Simultaneously depressing the accelerator pedal and applying the brake
reduces engine performance and
causes premature brake and
drivetrain wear.
wait for the gear selection process
to complete before setting the vehicle in motion
place the gear selector lever in
position R only when the vehicle is
stopped.
Release the brake pedal.
Carefully depress the accelerator ped-
Release the parking brake.
!
Do not run cold engine at high engine speeds. Running a cold engine at
high engine speeds may shorten the
service life of the engine.
al.
i
Once the vehicle is in motion, the automatic central locking system engages and the locking knobs move
down.
You can open a locked door from the
inside. Open door only when conditions are safe to do so.
You can deactivate the automatic
locking using the control system
( page 181).
Warning!
G
On slippery road surfaces, never downshift
in order to obtain braking action. This
could result in drive wheel slip and reduced vehicle control. Your vehicle’s ABS
will not prevent this type of loss of control.
For more information, see "Driving instructions" ( page 343).
69
Getting started
Driving
Switching on headlamps
Turn exterior lamp switch to
position B.
Low beam headlamps
The exterior lamp switch is located on
the dashboard to the left of the steering
wheel.
The green indicator lamp C in the
exterior lamp switch comes on.
High beam
The combination switch is located on the
left of the steering column.
i
The green indicator lamp C in the
exterior lamp switch always comes on
when the lights have been switched
on.
Combination switch
Exterior lamp switch
1 Off
2 Low beam headlamps on
1 High beam
2 High beam flasher
Push combination switch in direction
of arrow 1.
The high beam headlamp indicator
lamp A in the instrument cluster
comes on ( page 24).
For more information, see "Lighting"
( page 143).
70
Getting started
Driving
Turn signals
The combination switch is located on the
left of the steering column.
i
Switching on windshield wipers
To signal minor directional changes,
e.g. passing or changing lanes, move
combination switch to point of resistance only and release. The turn signal flashes three times.
Turn the combination switch to the
Windshield wipers
The combination switch is located on the
left of the steering column.
desired position depending on the intensity of the rain.
0
Windshield wipers off
I
Intermittent wiping
II
Normal wiper speed
III Fast wiper speed
i
Intermittent wiping interval is dependent on wetness of windshield. After
the initial wipe, pauses between
wipes are automatically controlled by
the rain sensor.
Combination switch
1 Turn signal, right
2 Turn signal, left
Press combination switch up 1 or
down 2.
The corresponding turn signal indicator lamp L or K flashes in the
instrument cluster ( page 24).
The combination switch resets automatically after major steering wheel movements.
Combination switch
1 Single wipe
2 Switching on windshield wipers
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
71
Getting started
Driving
!
Single wipe
Do not leave windshield wipers in intermittent setting when vehicle is
taken to an automatic car wash or
during windshield cleaning. Wipers
will operate in the presence of water
sprayed on the windshield, and wipers may be damaged as a result.
Press switch briefly in direction of
The switch should not be left in intermittent setting as the wipers will
wipe the windshield once every time
the engine is started. Dust that accumulates on the windshield might
scratch the glass and/or damage the
wiper blades when wiping occurs on
a dry windshield.
Intermittent wiping
Set the wiper switch to position I.
i
Intermittent wiping is interrupted
when the vehicle is at a standstill and
a front door is opened.
72
or
arrow 1.
The windshield wipers wipe one time
without washer fluid.
Wiping with windshield washer fluid
Push switch in direction of arrow 1
past the resistance point.
The windshield wiper operates with
washer fluid.
For information on filling up the washer
reservoir, see "Windshield washer and
headlamp cleaning system"
( page 362).
!
If anything blocks the windshield
wipers (leaves, snow, etc.), switch
them off immediately.
For safety reasons,
turn off the engine by turning
the SmartKey to position 0 and
withdraw SmartKey from
starter switch.
turn off the engine by pressing
the KEYLESS-GO** start/stop
button ( page 55) and open
the driver’s door (with the
driver’s door open, starter
switch is in position 0, same as
with SmartKey removed from
starter switch)
before attempting to remove any
blockage.
Remove blockage.
Turn the windshield wipers on
again.
If windshield wipers fail to function
at all in switch position I:
Set the combination switch to the
next highest wiper speed.
Have the windshield wipers
checked at the nearest authorized
Maybach Studio.
Getting started
Driving
Problems while driving
The engine runs erratically and misfires
An ignition cable may be damaged.
The engine electronics may not be
operating properly.
Unburned gasoline may have entered
the catalytic converter and damaged
it.
Give very little gas.
Have the problem repaired by an au-
thorized Maybach Studio as soon as
possible.
The coolant temperature is above 248°F
(120°C)
In case of accident
The coolant is too hot and is no longer
cooling the engine.
Do not start the engine under any cir-
Stop the vehicle as soon as possible
and turn off the engine. Allow engine and coolant to cool.
Check the coolant level and add coolant if necessary ( page 360).
If problem persists, call
1-866-FOR-MAYBach (in the USA) or
1-888-881-6611 (in Canada).
If the vehicle is leaking gasoline:
cumstances.
Notify local fire and/or police author-
ities.
If the extent of the damage cannot be
determined:
Notify an authorized Maybach
Studio.
If no damage can be determined on the
major assemblies
fuel system
engine mount:
Start the engine in the usual manner.
73
Getting started
Parking and locking
You have now completed your first drive.
You have properly stopped and parked
your vehicle. End your drive as follows.
Warning!
G
Wait until the vehicle is stationary before
removing the SmartKey from the starter
switch. The vehicle cannot be steered
when the SmartKey is removed.
Warning!
G
With the engine not running, there is no
power assistance for the brake and steering systems. In this case, it is important to
keep in mind that a considerably higher
degree of effort is necessary to brake or
steer the vehicle.
74
Warning!
G
Parking brake
Do not park this vehicle in areas where
combustible materials such as grass, hay or
leaves can come into contact with the hot
exhaust system, as these materials could be
ignited and cause a vehicle fire.
To reduce the risk of personal injury as a
result of inadvertent vehicle movement,
before turning off the engine and leaving
the vehicle always:
Keep right foot firmly on brake pedal.
Firmly depress parking brake pedal.
Move the gear selector lever to position P.
Slowly release brake pedal.
When parked on an incline, turn front
wheels towards the road curb.
Turn the SmartKey in the starter switch
to position 0 and remove the SmartKey
from the starter switch, or press
KEYLESS-GO** start/stop button
( page 55).
Take the SmartKey or the SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO** with you and lock
vehicle when leaving.
1 Parking brake release handle
2 Parking brake pedal
Step firmly on parking brake 2.
When the engine is running, the
warning lamp ; (USA only) or
3 (Canada only) in the instrument
cluster will be illuminated.
Getting started
Parking and locking
Warning!
G
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Children could release the parking brake
and/or move the gear selector lever from
position P, either of which could result in
an accident and/or serious injury.
Warning!
G
Getting out of your vehicle with the gear
selector lever not fully engaged in
position P is dangerous. Also, when parked
on an incline, position P alone may not
prevent your vehicle from moving, possibly
hitting people or objects.
Always set the parking brake in addition to
shifting to position P ( page 66).
When parked on an incline, turn front
wheels towards the road curb.
Switching off headlamps
Turn the exterior lamp switch to M
( page 70).
For more information, see "Lighting"
( page 143).
Turning off the engine
Place the gear selector lever in
position P.
i
Always set the parking brake in addition to shifting to position P.
On slopes, turn the front wheels towards the curb.
Turning off the engine with the
SmartKey
Turn the SmartKey in the starter
switch to position 0 and remove it.
The immobilizer is activated.
Press the seat belt release button
( page 64).
i
The SmartKey can only be removed
from the starter switch with the gear
selector lever in position P.
i
With the SmartKey removed and the
driver’s door open, a warning sounds
if the vehicle’s exterior lamps are not
switched off.
Turning off the engine with
KEYLESS-GO**
Place the gear selector lever in P.
Press the KEYLESS-GO start/stop button ( page 55) until the engine
shuts off.
With the driver’s door closed, the
starter switch is now in position 1.
With the driver‘s door open, the
starter switch is set to position 0,
same as SmartKey removed from the
starter switch. The immobilizer is activated.
Press the seat belt release button
( page 64).
75
Getting started
Parking and locking
!
If you hear a warning signal, you
have either
forgotten to switch off the vehicle’s exterior lamps, or
tried to turn off the engine while
the gear selector lever is not in P.
Turn off the lights or place the gear
selector lever in P.
Warning!
G
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment
may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury.
Locking
Warning!
G
To prevent possible personal injury, always
keep hands and fingers away from the
door openings when closing the doors. Be
especially careful when small children are
around.
Before closing doors, make sure there is no
possibility of someone getting caught in a
door during closing.
76
Locking with KEYLESS-GO**
Locking with the SmartKey
1 Lock button on the door handle
After exiting the vehicle press lock
After exiting the vehicle, press lock
button ‹ on the SmartKey
( page 52).
button 1 on the outside door handle
or on the trunk lid ( page 121).
The turn signal indicators come on
briefly. The vehicle locks. The locking
knobs in the doors move down. The
anti-theft alarm system is armed.
The turn signal indicators come on
briefly. The vehicle locks. The locking
knobs in the doors move down. The
anti-theft alarm system is armed.
For more information, see "SmartKey"
( page 108).
For more information, see "SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO**" ( page 111).
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
Panic alarm
Driving safety systems
Anti-theft systems
77
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
In this section you will learn the most important facts about the restraint systems
of the vehicle.
The 1 indicator lamp in the instrument cluster comes on
The restraint systems are:
Airbags
Seat belts
Emergency tensioning device
Child seats
Child seat recognition
Lower anchors and tethers for children (LATCH)
As independent systems, their protective
effects work in conjunction with each
other.
i
For information on infants and children traveling with you in the vehicle
and restraint systems for infants and
children, see "Children in the vehicle"
( page 87).
78
for about four seconds when you
turn the SmartKey in the starter
switch to position 1 or press the
KEYLESS-GO** start/stop button
( page 55) once. It then goes out
briefly, comes on again and remains
lit until you start the engine.
for about four seconds when you
start the engine by turning the
SmartKey or pressing the
KEYLESS-GO** start/stop button.
i
The 1 indicator lamp comes on
and remains lit if the SmartKey is
turned to position 2 and left there or
the KEYLESS-GO** start/stop button
is pressed twice. The indicator lamp
will go out when you start the engine.
The restraint systems are fully operational if the 1 indicator lamp is not lit
when the engine is running.
A malfunction in the system has been
detected if the 1 indicator lamp:
fails to go out after approximately
four seconds.
does not come on at all.
comes on after the engine was started or while driving.
For safety reasons, we strongly recommend that you visit an authorized
Maybach Studio immediately to have the
system checked.
For more information on SRS, see "Practical hints" ( page 387).
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
Warning!
G
In the event that the 1 indicator lamp
comes on during driving or does not come
on at all, the SRS self-check has detected a
malfunction. For your safety, we strongly
recommend that you visit an authorized
Maybach Studio immediately to have the
system checked; otherwise the SRS may not
be activated when needed in an accident,
which could result in serious or fatal injury,
or it might deploy unexpectedly and unnecessarily which could also result in
injury.
In addition, improper repair work on
the SRS creates a risk of rendering the SRS
inoperative or causing unintended airbag
deployment. Work on the SRS must therefore only be performed by qualified technicians. Contact an authorized Maybach
Studio.
Airbags
Warning!
Warning!
G
Airbags are designed to reduce the potential of injury and fatality in certain frontal
impacts (front airbags), side impacts (side
impact airbags and head protection window curtain airbags) or rollovers (head
protection window curtain airbags). However, no system available today can totally
eliminate injuries and fatalities.
The activation of the airbags temporarily
releases a small amount of dust from the
airbags. This dust, however, is neither injurious to your health, nor does it indicate a
fire in the vehicle. The dust might cause
some temporary breathing difficulty for
people with asthma or other breathing
trouble. To avoid this, you may wish to get
out of the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do
so. If you have any breathing difficulty but
cannot get out of the vehicle after the airbag inflates, then get fresh air by opening
a window or door.
G
To reduce the risk of injury when the front
airbags inflate, it is very important for the
driver and front passenger to always be in
a properly seated position and to wear
your seat belts.
For maximum protection in the event of a
collision always be in normal seated position with your back against the seat backrest. Fasten your seat belt and make sure it
is properly positioned on your body.
Since the airbag inflates with considerable
speed and force, a proper seating and
hands on steering wheel position will help
to keep you at a safe distance from the airbag. Occupants who are unbelted, out of
position or too close to the airbag can be
seriously injured by an airbag as it inflates
with great force in the blink of an eye:
Sit properly belted in a nearly upright
position with your back against the
seat backrest.
79
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
Adjust the driver seat as far as possible
rearward, still permitting proper operation of vehicle controls. The distance
from the center of the driver’s breastbone to the center of the airbag cover
on the steering wheel must be at least
10 in (25 cm) or more. You should be
able to accomplish this by a combination of adjustments to the seat and
steering wheel. If you have any problems, please see an authorized
Maybach Studio.
Occupants, especially children, should
never lean their heads in the area of
the door where the side airbag inflates. This could result in serious injuries or death should the airbag be
triggered. Always sit nearly upright,
properly use the seat belts and appropriate size infant or child restraint system.
Do not lean with your head or chest
close to the steering wheel or dashboard.
Keep hands on the outside of steering
wheel rim. Placing hands and arms inside the rim can increase the risk and
potential severity of hand/arm injury
when driver front airbag inflates.
Children 12 years old and under must
never ride in the front seat, except in a
Maybach authorized BabySmartTM1
compatible child seat, which operates
with the BabySmartTM system installed
in the vehicle to deactivate the passenger front airbag when it is properly installed. Otherwise they will be struck
by the airbag when it inflates in a
crash. If this happens, serious or fatal
injury will result.
Adjust the front passenger seat as far
as possible rearward from the dashboard when the seat is occupied.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in severe injuries to you or other occupants.
If you sell your vehicle, it is important that
you make the buyer aware of this safety information. Be sure to give the buyer this
Operator's Manual.
1
80
BabySmartTM is a trademark of Siemens
Automotive Corp.
Warning!
G
Accident research shows that the safest
place for children in an automobile is in
the rear seat. Should you choose to place a
child 12 years old or under in the front passenger seat of your vehicle, you must properly use a BabySmartTM child restraint
which will turn off the passenger front airbag. BabySmartTM will not, however, turn
off any side impact airbag.
It should be noted that with respect to
both front and rear side impact airbags
there is a possibility for a side airbag related injury if occupants, especially children,
are not properly seated or restrained when
next to a side airbag which needs to deploy rapidly in a side impact in order to do
its job.
To help avoid the possibility of injury,
please follow these guidelines:
(1) Occupants, especially children, should
never place their bodies or lean their
heads in the area of the door where
the side airbag inflates. This could result in serious injuries or death should
the side airbag be activated.
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
(2) Always sit nearly upright, properly use
the seat belts and use an appropriately
sized infant or child restraint system
for all children 12 years old or under.
(3) Always wear seat belts properly.
If you believe that, even with the use of
these guidelines, it would be safer for your
rear seat occupants to have both rear seat
mounted side airbags deactivated, then
deactivation can be accomplished upon
your written request to do so at an authorized Maybach Studio at an additional
cost.
Please contact your local authorized
Maybach Studio or call our Maybach
Assistance Center at
1-866-FOR-MAYBach (in the USA), or
1-888-881-6611 (in Canada).
i
Airbags are designed to activate only
in certain frontal impacts (front airbags), side impacts (side impact and
head protection window curtain airbags) which exceed preset thresholds
and in certain rollovers (head protection window curtain airbags). Only
during these events will they provide
their supplemental protection.
The driver and passengers should always wear their seat belts. Otherwise
it is not possible for airbags to provide their supplemental protection.
In case of other types of impacts and
impacts below airbag deployment
thresholds, airbags will not be activated. The driver and passenger will then
be protected to the extent possible by
a properly fastened seat belt. A properly fastened seat belt is also needed
to provide the best possible protection in a rollover.
We caution you not to rely on the
presence of the airbags in order to
avoid wearing your seat belt.
Your vehicle was originally equipped
with airbags that are designed to activate in certain impacts exceeding a
preset threshold to reduce the potential and severity of injury. It is important for your safety and the safety of
your passengers that you replace deployed airbags and repair any malfunctioning airbags to make sure the
vehicle will continue to provide supplemental crash protection for occupants.
81
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
Safety guidelines for the seat belt, emergency tensioning device and airbag
Warning!
82
G
Damaged seat belts or belts that were
highly stressed in an accident must be
replaced and their anchoring points
must also be checked. Use only belts installed or supplied by an authorized
Maybach Studio.
Airbags and emergency tensioning
devices (ETDs) are designed to function on a one-time-only basis. An airbag or ETD that was activated must be
replaced.
No modifications of any kind may be
made to any components or wiring of
the SRS. This includes changing or removing any component or part of the
SRS, the installation of additional trim
material, seat covers, badges etc. over
the steering wheel hub, passenger
front airbag cover, door trim panels, or
door frame trims, and installation of
additional electrical/electronic equipment on or near SRS components and
wiring.
Keep area between airbags and occupants free from objects (e.g. packages,
purses, umbrellas, etc.).
Do not pass belts over sharp edges.
They could tear.
Do not make any modification that
could change the effectiveness of the
belts.
Do not bleach or dye seat belts as this
may severely weaken them. In a crash
they may not be able to provide adequate protection.
Do not hang items such as coat hangers from the coat hooks or handles
over the door. These items may turn
into projectiles and cause head and
other injuries when curtain airbag is
deployed.
Never place your feet on the instrument panel, dashboard, or on the seat.
Always keep both feet on the floor in
front of the seat.
Airbag system components will be hot
after an air bag has inflated. Do not
touch.
In addition, improper repair work on
the SRS creates a risk of rendering
the SRS inoperative or causing unintended airbag deployment. Work on
the SRS must therefore only be performed by qualified technicians. Contact an authorized Maybach Studio.
For your protection and the protection
of others, when scrapping the airbag
unit or emergency tensioning device,
our safety instructions must be followed. These instructions are available
from your authorized Maybach Studio.
Given the considerable deployment
speed and the textile structure of the
airbags, there is the possibility of abrasions or other injuries resulting from
airbag deployment.
When you sell your vehicle, we strongly
urge you to give notice to the subsequent owner that it is equipped with an
SRS by alerting them to the applicable
section in the Operator’s Manual.
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
Warning!
Side impact airbags
G
The side impact airbags are deployed:
Only use seat covers which have been tested and approved by us for use on Maybach
vehicles. Using other seat covers may interfere with or prevent the deployment of
the side impact airbags. Contact an authorized Maybach Studio for availability.
Front airbags
Driver and front passenger airbags are
deployed:
in the event of a frontal impact
if impact exceeds a preset deployment threshold
The airbags will not deploy in impacts
which do not exceed the system’s deployment thresholds. You will then be protected by the fastened seat belts.
The passenger front airbag will only be
deployed if:
the front passenger seat is occupied
the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp in the center console is not
lit ( page 89)
in impacts exceeding a preset deployment threshold
on the impacted side of the vehicle
The side impact airbags are not deployed
in impacts which do not exceed the system’s deployment threshold.
the impact exceeds a preset deployment threshold
The front passenger side impact airbag
will only deploy if the system senses that
the front passenger seat is occupied.
1 Driver airbag
2 Passenger airbag
!
Do not place objects heavier than
20 lbs (9 kg) on the front passenger
seat. This could cause the front or side
impact airbag on the front passenger
side to deploy in a crash which exceeds the system's deployment
threshold.
1 Front side impact airbags
2 Rear side impact airbags
83
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
Window curtain airbags
The side window curtain airbags are deployed:
in impacts exceeding a preset deployment threshold
on the impacted side of the vehicle
in certain vehicle rollovers
Seat belts
When the engine is started, the seat belt
telltale < illuminates to remind you
and your passengers to fasten your seat
belts. If the driver’s seat belt is not fastened before the engine is started, the
seat belt telltale < illuminates and a
warning chime sounds for approximately
six seconds when the engine is started.
The use of seat belts and infant and child
restraint systems is required by law in
all 50 states, the District of Columbia,
the U.S. territories and all Canadian
provinces. Even where this is not the
case, all vehicle occupants should have
their seat belts fastened at all times
when driving or riding in the vehicle.
1 Front window curtain airbag
2 Rear window curtain airbag
The window curtain airbags fill up the
area between the A and C pillars (see arrows).
84
For more information on fastening seat
belts, see "Getting started" ( page 63).
i
For information on infants and children traveling with you in the vehicle
and restraint systems for infants and
children, see "Children in the vehicle"
( page 87).
Warning!
G
Due to the considerably larger interior
compared to other vehicles, for occupants
in the rear of the vehicle not properly
wearing their seat belts, the risk of injury
in an accident is significantly increased.
They are much more likely to be thrown
around in the vehicle in slight frontal impacts or even during emergency braking
maneuvers.
Always fasten your seat belt before driving
off. Always make sure your passengers are
properly restrained, even those sitting in
the rear and pregnant women.
Failure to wear and properly fasten and
position your seat belt greatly increases
your risk of injuries and their likely severity
in an accident. You and your passengers
should always wear seat belts.
If you are ever in an accident, your injuries
can be considerably more severe without
your seat belt properly buckled. Without
your seat belt buckled, you are much more
likely to hit the interior of the vehicle or be
ejected from it. You can be seriously injured or killed.
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
In the same crash, the possibility of injury
or death is lessened if you are properly
wearing your seat belt. Airbags can only
protect as they are designed if the occupants are properly wearing their seat belts.
Warning!
G
Never ride in a moving vehicle with the
seat backrest in an excessively reclined position as this can be dangerous. You could
slide under the seat belt in a collision. If
you slide under it, the belt would apply
force at the abdomen or neck. That could
cause serious or even fatal injuries. The
seat backrest and seat belt provide the
best restraint when the wearer is in a nearly upright position and the belt is properly
positioned on the body.
that are designed to maintain proper support and restraint-system effectiveness in
all seat settings in the event of a collision
or similar situation.
Keep the door storage compartments
closed while the vehicle is in motion. Failure to do so may cause the seat belt to
catch at the rear and prevent proper positioning of the seat belt.
Warning!
G
Never let more people ride in the vehicle
than there are seat belts available. Be sure
everyone riding in the vehicle is correctly
restrained with a separate seat belt.
Never use a seat belt for more than one
person at a time.
Warning!
G
Damaged seat belts or belts that were
highly stressed in an accident must be replaced and their anchoring points must
also be checked.
Only use seat belts which have been approved for Maybach vehicles.
Do not make any modifications to the seat
belts. This can lead to unintended activation or to failure.
Do not bleach or dye seat belts as this may
severely weaken them. In a crash, they may
not be able to provide adequate protection.
Have all work carried out only by qualified
technicians. Contact an authorized
Maybach Studio.
Only the reclining seat (in Maybach 62 rear
cabin) can be used in a reclined position
with seat belts properly fastened while the
vehicle is in motion. The reclining seat in
the Maybach 62 rear cabin includes a belt
system and kinematic electronic controls
85
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
Warning!
G
USE SEAT BELTS PROPERLY
86
Seat belts can only work when used
properly. Never wear seat belts in any
other way than as described in this section, as that could result in serious injuries in case of an accident.
Each occupant should wear their seat
belt at all times, because seat belts
help reduce the likelihood of and potential severity of injuries in accidents,
including rollovers. The integrated restraint system includes SRS (driver airbag, passenger front airbag, side
impact airbags, head protection window curtain airbags for side windows),
ETD (seat belt emergency tensioning
device), and front seat knee bolsters.
The system is designed to enhance the
protection offered to properly belted
occupants in certain frontal (front airbags and ETD) and side (side impact,
window curtain airbags and ETD) impacts which exceed preset deployment
thresholds and in certain rollovers
(window curtain airbags).
Never wear the shoulder belt under
your arm, against your neck or off your
shoulder. In a crash, your body would
move too far forward. That would increase the chance of head and neck injuries. The belt would also apply too
much force to the ribs or abdomen,
which could severely injure internal organs such as your liver or spleen.
Never wear belts over rigid or breakable objects in or on your clothing,
such as eyeglasses, pens, keys, etc., as
these might cause injuries.
Position the lap belt as low as possible
on your hips and not across the abdomen. If the belt is positioned across
your abdomen, it could cause serious
injuries in a crash.
Never use a seat belt for more than
one person at a time. Do not fasten a
seat belt around a person and another
person or other objects.
Belts should not be worn twisted. In a
crash, you wouldn’t have the full width
of the belt to manage impact forces.
The twisted belt against your body
could cause injuries.
Pregnant women should also use a lapshoulder belt. The lap belt portion
should be positioned as low as possible
on the hips to avoid any possible pressure on the abdomen.
Never place your feet on the instrument panel, dashboard or on the seat.
Always keep both feet on the floor in
front of the seat.
Emergency tensioning device (ETD), seat
belt force limiter
The seat belts for the front and rear outer seats are equipped with emergency
tensioning devices and belt force limiters.
The ETD is designed to activate in the following cases when:
in frontal or rear-end impacts exceeding a preset severity level
in certain vehicle rollovers
if the restraint systems are operational and functioning correctly.
See 1 indicator lamp ( page 78)
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
!
In an impact, emergency tensioning devices remove slack from the belts in such
a way that the seat belts fit more snugly
against the body. Belt force limiters reduce the force exerted by the seat belts
on occupants during a crash.
Do not place objects heavier than
20 lbs (9 kg) on the front passenger
seat. This could cause the front or side
impact airbag on the front passenger
side to deploy in a crash which exceeds the system's deployment
threshold.
i
The ETDs for the front seats will only
activate if the respective front seat
belt is fastened (latch plate properly
inserted into buckle).
The ETDs for the rear outer seats will
activate with or without the respective seat belt fastened.
Warning!
G
An emergency tensioning device (ETD)
that was activated must be replaced.
When disposing of the emergency tensioning device, our safety instructions must be
followed. These are available at your authorized Maybach Studio.
Automatic comfort-fit feature seat belt
An automatic comfort-fit feature for
front seats reduces the retracting force
of the seat belts when they are in normal
use.
Children in the vehicle
If an infant or child is traveling with you
in the vehicle:
Secure the child using an infant or
child restraint appropriate to the age
and size of the child.
Make sure the infant or child is properly secured at all times while the vehicle is in motion.
Infant and child restraint seats and information on choosing an appropriate restraint system can be obtained from any
Maybach Studio.
Infant and child restraint systems
Use only a BabySmartTM1 compatible
child restraint for the front passenger
seat in this vehicle.
We recommend all infants and children
be properly restrained at all times while
the vehicle is in motion.
All lap-shoulder belts except the driver’s
seat belt have special seat belt retractors
for secure fastening of child restraints.
To fasten a child restraint, follow child
restraint instructions for mounting. Then
pull the shoulder belt out completely
and let it retract. During seat belt retraction, a ratcheting sound can be heard to
indicate that the special seat belt retractor is activated. The belt is now locked.
Push down on child restraint to take up
any slack.
1
BabySmartTM is a trademark of Siemens
Automotive Corp.
87
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
To deactivate, release seat belt buckle
and let seat belt retract completely. The
seat belt can again be used in the usual
manner.
i
For more information on child seats
with mounting fittings for tether anchorages ( page 91).
For information on LATCH-type child
seat mounts ( page 92).
Warning!
G
Never release the seat belt buckle while
the vehicle is in motion, since the special
seat belt retractor will be deactivated.
!
The use of infant or child restraints is
required by law in all 50 states, the
District of Columbia, the U.S. territories and all Canadian provinces.
Infants and small children should be
seated in an appropriate infant or
child restraint system properly se-
88
cured by a lap-shoulder belt or, if so
equipped, a child restraint lower anchorage system that complies with
U.S. Federal Motor Vehicle Safety
Standards 213 and 225 and Canadian
Motor Vehicle Safety Standards 213
and 210.2.
Warning!
G
Children 12 years old and under must never ride in the front seat, except in a
Maybach authorized BabySmartTM1 compatible child seat, which operates with the
BabySmartTM system installed in the vehicle to deactivate the passenger front airbag when it is properly installed.
Otherwise they will be struck by the airbag
when it inflates in a crash. If this happens,
serious or fatal injury will result.
A statement by the child restraint
manufacturer of compliance with this
standard can be found on the instruction label on the restraint and in the
instruction manual provided with the
restraint.
According to accident statistics, children
are safer when properly restrained in the
rear seating positions than in the front
seating positions. Infants and small children must ride in back seats and be seated
in an appropriate infant or child restraint
system, which is properly secured with the
vehicle’s seat belt and top tether strap, or
secured via lower anchors and top tether
strap, fully in accordance with the child
seat manufacturer’s instructions.
When using any infant or child restraint system, be sure to carefully
read and follow all manufacturer’s instructions for installation and use.
Please read and observe warning labels affixed to inside of vehicle and to
infant or child restraints.
1
BabySmartTM is a trademark of Siemens
Automotive Corp.
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
Warning!
G
Infants and small children should never
share a seat belt with another occupant.
During an accident, they could be crushed
between the occupant and seat belt.
Children too big for child restraint systems
must ride in back seats using regular seat
belts. Position shoulder belt across chest
and shoulder, not face or neck. A booster
seat may be necessary to achieve proper
belt positioning for children from 41 lbs
until they reach a height where a lap/
shoulder belt fits properly without a booster.
Do not leave children unattended in the
vehicle; even if the children are secured in
a child restraint system. Unsupervised children in a child restraint system may use vehicle equipment and may cause serious
personal injury.
BabySmartTM airbag deactivation system
The PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp is located on the upper part of the
front center console.
The PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp 1 located on the upper part of the
front center console will be illuminated,
except with the SmartKey removed or in
starter switch position 0.
i
The system does not deactivate the
side impact airbag, the window curtain airbag and the emergency tensioning device.
A child’s risk of serious or fatal injuries is
significantly increased if the child restraints are not properly secured in the vehicle and the child is not properly secured
in the child restraint.
When the child restraint is not in use, remove it from the vehicle or secure it with
the seat belt to prevent the child restraint
from becoming a projectile in the event of
an accident.
Special BabySmartTM compatible child
seats, designed for use with the Maybach
system and available at any authorized
Maybach Studio are required for use
with the BabySmartTM airbag deactivation system. With the special child seat
properly installed, the passenger front
airbag will not deploy.
1 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp
89
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
Self-test BabySmartTM1 without special
child seat installed
After turning the SmartKey in the starter
switch to position 1 or 2 or the
KEYLESS-GO** start/stop button
( page 55) is pressed once or twice,
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp 1 located on the upper part of the
front center console comes on for approximately six seconds and then goes
out.
If the indicator lamp should not come on
or is continuously lit, the system is not
functioning. You must see an authorized
Maybach Studio before seating any child
on the front passenger seat.
For more information on PASSENGER
AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp, see "Practical hints" ( page 390).
1
BabySmartTM is a trademark of Siemens
Automotive Corp.
90
Warning!
G
Warning!
G
The BabySmartTM airbag deactivation system will ONLY work with a special child
seat designed to operate with it. It will not
work with child seats which are not
BabySmartTM compatible.
When using a BabySmartTM compatible
child seat on the front passenger seat, the
passenger front airbag will not deploy only
if the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp remains illuminated.
Never place anything between seat cushion and child seat (e.g. pillow), since it reduces the effectiveness of the deactivation
system. The bottom of the child seat must
make full contact with the passenger seat
cushion. An incorrectly mounted child seat
could cause injuries to the child in case of
an accident, instead of protecting the
child.
Please be sure to check the indicator every
time you use the special system child seat.
Should the light go out while the restraint
is installed, please check installation. If the
light remains out, do not use the
BabySmartTM restraint to transport children on the front passenger seat until the
system has been repaired.
Follow the manufacturer’s instructions for
installation of special child seats.
Warning!
G
Do not place powered-on laptops, cell
phones and like electronic devices on the
front passenger seat. Signals from such devices may interfere with the BabySmartTM
system. Such signal interference may cause
the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp not to come on during self-test or be
continuously lit, indicating that the system
is not functioning.
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
Installing infant and child restraint systems
This vehicle is equipped with tether anchorages for a top tether strap at each of
the rear seating positions.
Head restraint must be positioned such
that the top tether strap can pass freely
between the head restraint and top of
seat back.
i
For safety, please make sure the hook
has attached to the ring beyond the
safety catch, as illustrated.
Make sure the tether strap is not
twisted.
Once the top tether anchorage hook is
attached, the child restraint itself can be
secured. Tighten the top tether strap according to the child restraint manufacturer's instructions.
Close cover after removing the tether
strap.
Warning!
1 Cover of top anchorage ring
Bring the rear seat backrest to a fully
upright position.
Open cover 1 to access anchorage
ring.
Guide tether strap between head re-
straints and top of seat back.
2 Hook
3 Anchorage ring
Securely fasten hook 2, which is part
of the tether strap, to anchorage
ring 3.
G
Never adjust the rear seat position after installing the child restraint. Adjusting the
rear seat position after installing the child
restraint could damage the child restraint
and/or introduce undesirable slack into the
webbing and loosen or misposition the
child restraint, lessening the effectiveness
of the child restraint and thus increasing
the chance or severity of injury in an accident.
91
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
Child seat anchors – LATCH-type
Installing
This vehicle is equipped with two LATCH
(Lower Anchors and Tethers for
CHildren) type anchors (at each of the
outer rear seats) for the installation a
LATCH child seat with the matching anchor fittings.
Bring the rear seat backrest to a fully
If you have not installed a child seat, the
LATCH anchors can be folded back between the seat cushion and seat backrest.
upright position.
Adjust the seat angle to the lowest
possible position.
Fold out anchors 3 until they en-
gage.
Install the child seat restraint. Please
refer to the manufacturer’s installation instructions.
i
When the anchors are folded out,
seat adjustment is limited to:
seat, aft
seat cushion tilt, down
head restraint height, up
head restraint tilt, backwards
i
1 Indicates the position of the anchors
2 Release button
3 Anchor
92
The child seat must be firmly attached in the right and left side anchors.
Warning!
G
Never adjust the rear seat position after installing the child restraint. Adjusting the
rear seat position after installing the child
restraint could damage the child restraint
and/or introduce undesirable slack into the
webbing and loosen or misposition the
child restraint, lessening the effectiveness
of the child restraint and thus increasing
the chance or severity of injury in an accident.
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
Removing
Remove the child seat.
Press release button 2 and fold in
anchors 3 until they engage.
!
Vehicles with a rear center seat*:
Make sure the seat belt for the center
seat can operate freely with a child
seat installed.
Warning!
G
Children too big for child restraint systems
must ride in back seats using regular seat
belts. Position shoulder belt across chest
and shoulder, not face or neck. A booster
seat may be necessary to achieve proper
belt positioning for children from 41 lbs
until they reach a height where a lap/
shoulder belt fits properly without a booster.
i
Install child seat according to manufacturer’s instructions.
Non-LATCH type child seats may also
be used and can be installed using
the vehicle’s seat belt system. Install
child seat according to the manufacturer’s instructions.
The child seat must be firmly attached in
the right and left side anchors 3.
An incorrectly mounted child seat may
come loose during an accident which could
result in serious injury or death to your
child.
Damaged or impact damaged child seats
or child seat mounting fittings must be replaced.
Do not leave children unattended in the
vehicle, even if the children are secured in
a child restraint system.
93
Safety and Security
Occupant safety
Override switch for rear passenger
compartment
You can disable select functions in the
rear passenger compartment for added
safety (for instance when you have children riding in the rear passenger compartment).
The override switch is located in the driver’s door.
rear door window operation
( page 218)
cigarette lighter in the rear
( page 274)
adjusting the front passenger seat
position from the rear ( page 135)
12-V socket in the rear center console
( page 278)
closing the partition* from the rear
( page 284)
Warning!
G
Activate the override switch when children
are riding in the back seats of the vehicle.
The children may otherwise injure themselves, e.g. by becoming trapped in the
window opening.
1 Deactivating override switch
2 Activating override switch
Activating override switch
Press switch 2.
The functions in the rear are disabled.
i
The rear door windows can still be operated with the switches located in
the driver’s door.
94
Press switch 1.
The functions in the rear are enabled
again.
You can disable the following functions
in the rear passenger compartment:
Deactivating override switch
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment can
cause an accident and/or serious personal
injury.
For information, see "Power windows"
( page 218).
Safety and Security
Panic alarm
Panic alarm
An audible alarm and flashing exterior
lamps will operate for approximately
2½ minutes.
Activating
Press and hold button 1 for at least
one second.
Deactivating
Press button 1 again.
or
Insert the SmartKey in the starter
switch.
1 Â Panic button
i
For operation in the USA only: This
device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the
following two conditions:
(1) This device may not cause harmful
interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
Any unauthorized modification to
this device could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
95
Safety and Security
Driving safety systems
i
In this section you will find information
on the following driving safety systems:
ABS (Antilock Brake System)
BAS (Brake Assist System)
ESP (Electronic Stability Program)
SBC (Sensotronic Brake Control)
ABS
In winter operation, the maximum effectiveness of the ABS, BAS, ESP and
SBC is only achieved with winter tires
(M + S tires), or snow chains as required.
I
Warning!
G
The following factors increase the risk of
accidents:
96
Excessive speed, especially in turns
Wet and slippery road surfaces
Following another vehicle too closely
Warning!
G
Do not pump the brake pedal. Use firm,
steady brake pedal pressure instead.
Pumping the brake pedal defeats the purpose of the ABS and significantly reduces
braking effectiveness.
The ABS regulates the brake pressure so
that the wheels do not lock during braking. This allows you to maintain the ability to steer your vehicle.
The ABS, BAS, ESP and SBC cannot reduce
this risk.
The ABS is functional above a speed of
approximately 5 mph (8 km/h) independent of road surface conditions.
Always adjust your driving style to the prevailing road and weather conditions.
On slippery road surfaces, the ABS will
respond even to light brake pressure.
Safety and Security
Driving safety systems
Continuous steady brake pedal pressure
yields the advantages provided by
the ABS, namely braking power and the
ability to steer the vehicle.
If the ABS activates during braking, the
ABS/ESP warning lamp v in the instrument cluster dial flashes. Because of
the SBC brake system, you will not feel
any pulsation in the brake pedal.
Warning!
G
The ABS cannot prevent the natural laws
of physics from acting on the vehicle, nor
can it increase braking or steering efficiency beyond that afforded by the condition
of the vehicle brakes and tires or the traction afforded. The ABS cannot prevent accidents, including those resulting from
excessive speed in turns, following another
vehicle too closely, or hydroplaning. Only a
safe, attentive, and skillful driver can prevent accidents. The capabilities of an ABS
equipped vehicle must never be exploited
in a reckless or dangerous manner which
could jeopardize the user’s safety or the
safety of others.
ABS control
The - indicator lamp in the instrument cluster comes on when you switch
on ignition. It goes out when the engine
is running.
For more information on ABS, see "Practical hints" ( page 384).
BAS
The Brake Assist System (BAS) operates in
emergency situations. If you apply the
brakes very quickly, the BAS automatically provides full brake boost, thereby potentially reducing the braking distance.
Apply continuous full braking pres-
sure until the emergency braking situation is over.
The ABS will prevent the wheels from
locking.
When you release the brake pedal, the
brakes function again as normal.
The BAS is then deactivated.
Warning!
G
If the BAS is malfunctioning, the brake system is still functioning normally, but without the additional brake boost available
that BAS would normally provide in an
emergency braking maneuver. Therefore,
the braking distance may increase.
Warning!
G
The BAS cannot prevent the natural laws
of physics from acting on the vehicle, nor
can it increase braking efficiency beyond
that afforded by the condition of the vehicle brakes and tires or the traction. The
BAS cannot prevent accidents, including
those resulting from excessive speed in
turns, following another vehicle too closely, or hydroplaning. Only a safe, attentive,
and skillful driver can prevent accidents.
The capabilities of a BAS equipped vehicle
must never be exploited in a reckless or
dangerous manner which could jeopardize
the user’s safety or the safety of others.
97
Safety and Security
Driving safety systems
ESP
Warning!
The Electronic Stability Program (ESP) is
operational as soon as the engine is running and monitors the vehicle's traction
(force of adhesive friction between the
tires and the road surface) and handling.
The ESP recognizes when a wheel is spinning or if the vehicle starts to skid. By applying brakes to the appropriate wheel
and by limiting engine output, the ESP
works to stabilize the vehicle. The ESP is
especially useful while driving off and on
wet or slippery road surfaces. The ESP
also stabilizes the vehicle during braking
maneuvers.
The ABS/ESP warning lamp v in the
instrument cluster flashes when the ESP
is engaged.
The ABS/ESP warning lamp v in the
instrument cluster comes on when you
switch on ignition. It goes out when the
engine is running.
98
G
Never switch off the ESP when you see the
ABS/ ESP warning lamp v flashing in
the instrument cluster. In this case proceed
as follows:
While driving off, apply as little throttle as possible
While driving, ease up on the accelerator
Adapt your speed and driving style to
the prevailing road conditions
Failure to observe these guidelines could
cause the vehicle to skid.
The ESP cannot prevent accidents resulting
from excessive speed.
Warning!
G
The ESP cannot prevent the natural laws of
physics from acting on the vehicle, nor can
it increase the traction afforded. The ESP
cannot prevent accidents, including those
resulting from excessive speed in turns, or
hydroplaning. Only a safe, attentive, and
skillful driver can prevent accidents. The
capabilities of an ESP equipped vehicle
must never be exploited in a reckless or
dangerous manner which could jeopardize
the user’s safety or the safety of others.
i
The ESP will only function properly if
you use wheels of the recommended
tire size ( page 459).
Safety and Security
Driving safety systems
!
Switching off the ESP
Because of the ESP’s automatic operation, the engine must be shut off
(SmartKey in starter switch position 0
or 1) when
the parking brake is being tested
on a brake test dynamometer
the vehicle is being towed with
the front/rear axle raised.
Active braking action through
the ESP may otherwise seriously damage the brake system.
For more information on ESP, see "Practical hints" ( page 384).
Warning!
When you switch off the ESP
G
The ESP should not be switched off during
normal driving other than in the circumstances described below. Disabling of the
system will reduce vehicle stability in driving maneuvers.
To improve the vehicle's traction, turn
off the ESP in driving situations where it
would be advantageous to have the
drive wheels spin and thus cut into surfaces for better grip such as:
starting out on slippery surfaces and
in deep snow in conjunction with
snow chains
in sand or gravel
the ESP does not stabilize the vehicle
the engine output is not limited,
which allows the drive wheels to spin
and thus cut into surfaces for better
grip
the traction control will still brake a
spinning wheel
the ESP continues to operate when
you are braking
i
When the ESP is switched off and one
or more drive wheels are spinning,
the ABS/ESP warning lamp v in the
speedometer flashes. However, the
ESP will then not stabilize the vehicle.
99
Safety and Security
Driving safety systems
The switch is located on the lower part of
the front center console.
Warning!
G
When the ABS/ESP warning lamp v is
illuminated continuously, the ESP is
switched off.
Adapt your speed and driving to the prevailing road conditions and to the non-operating status of the ESP.
!
1 ESP switch (on/off)
Press switch 1 until the ABS/ESP
warning lamp v in the speedometer comes on.
The ESP is deactivated.
100
Avoid spinning of a drive wheel for
an extended period with the ESP
switched off. This may cause serious
damage to the drivetrain which is not
covered by the Maybach Limited
Warranty.
Switching on the ESP
Press switch 1 again.
The ABS/ESP warning lamp v in
the speedometer goes out.
You are now again in normal driving
mode with the ESP switched on.
!
Turn on the ESP immediately if the
aforementioned circumstances do
not apply anymore.
Safety and Security
Driving safety systems
The SBC brake system
The SBC brake system combines a hydraulic brake circuit with electronically
controlled brake servo assistance. You
have increased braking safety and improved braking comfort.
Warning!
G
Never ignore a brake malfunction indicated in the instrument cluster, for example
by the ; (USA only) or 3 (Canada
only) red brake warning lamp. Refer to the
"Practical hints" section ( page 388). Also
read and observe the messages in the instrument cluster display ( page 391).
Warning!
G
The SBC brake system requires electrical
power to operate.
A malfunction in the vehicle’s power supply or electrical system may impair brake
system operation and switch it into its
emergency operation mode. In such a case,
the red brake warning lamp ( page 388)
and warning messages in the instrument
cluster come on while driving
(see page 400 to page 401). To brake, the
driver must then apply significantly greater brake pedal pressure and depress the
pedal much further to obtain the expected
braking effect. If necessary, apply full pressure to the brake pedal. Brakes may only
be applied to the front wheels. Stopping
distance is increased!
If there is a malfunction in the SBC brake
system, we recommend that the vehicle be
transported with all wheels off the ground
using flatbed or appropriate wheel lift/dolly equipment. A tow bar must be used if
circumstances do not permit the use of the
recommended towing methods and the
vehicle requires towing with all four
wheels on the ground. Towing the vehicle
with all four wheels on the ground is only
permissible for distances up to 30 miles
(50 km) and at a speed not to exceed
30 mph (50 km/h). For more information,
refer to "Towing the vehicle"
( page 447).
101
Safety and Security
Driving safety systems
The SBC brake system is automatically activated when you:
unlock the vehicle with the SmartKey
or the KEYLESS-GO**
open the driver’s or passenger door
turn the SmartKey in the starter
switch to position 1
in vehicles with KEYLESS-GO**, press
the start/stop button ( page 55) on
gear selector lever once
depress the brake pedal
release the parking brake
i
If the SBC brake system is activated
when the brake pedal is first depressed, you may feel a reduced pedal resistance and longer pedal travel
than normal. When releasing the
pedal, you may also feel the brake
pedal pulsate and you may hear a
sound which is caused by the activation of the SBC pump. This is normal
and not an indication of a malfunction. Pedal travel returns to normal
when you release the brake pedal
and the sound soon ceases.
If you experience the above while
driving and the red brake warning
lamp ( page 388) illuminates and/or
warning messages appear in the instrument cluster (see page 400 to
page 401), the brake system is malfunctioning. Follow the instructions
of the warning message(s) and have
the brake system checked immediately.
102
Warning!
G
Have brake pad replacement and other
work on the SBC brake system carried out
by qualified technicians only. Contact an
authorized Maybach Studio for further information. The SBC brake system must be
deactivated prior to working on the system. High pressure is intermittently built
up in the system as part of its automatic
self-test. In addition, the system is automatically activated when the vehicle is unlocked by remote control, when the driver
or passenger door is opened, when the
starter switch is in position 1, when the
brake pedal is depressed or when the parking brake is released. Failure to deactivate
the system prior to maintenance will cause
brake pistons to extend and brake fluid to
leak, which may result in injuries (contusions and acid burns). Extended brake pistons may also cause injury.
Safety and Security
Driving safety systems
The SBC brake servo assistance switches
off automatically:
approximately two minutes after you
turned the SmartKey in the starter
switch to position 0 or removed the
SmartKey
approximately two minutes after you
pressed the KEYLESS-GO** start/stop
button ( page 55) to turn off the engine or power supply and opened the
driver’s door (with driver’s door
open, the starter switch is set to
position 0, same as SmartKey removed from starter switch)
approximately 20 seconds after you
locked the vehicle from outside.
Note on driving with the SBC
Following extended periods of only
minor loads to your brake system,
you should occasionally apply the
brakes when traveling at high speeds.
This improves the grip of the brake
pads.
Warning!
After driving on wet or snow-covered
roads, you should apply your brakes
firmly before parking your vehicle.
This produces heat which serves to
dry the brake disks and help prevent
corrosion.
On long and steep grades, shift to a
lower gear (gear range 1, 2 or 3) to
prevent the brakes from overheating
and to reduce brake wear.
After hard braking, it is advisable to
drive on for some time so that the air
stream will cool down the brakes
faster.
Only components approved by us for
use on Maybach vehicles (e.g. brake
pads) should be installed on your vehicle. Brake pads not approved by us
for use on Maybach vehicles may impair the safety of your vehicle.
G
Be very careful not to endanger other road
users when you apply the brakes.
103
Safety and Security
Anti-theft systems
Immobilizer
The immobilizer prevents unauthorized
persons from starting your vehicle.
With KEYLESS-GO**
Start the engine by means of the
The alarm system will also be triggered
when
KEYLESS-GO start/stop button on the
gear selector lever.
someone attempts to raise the vehicle
Activating
The immobilizer is deactivated.
With the SmartKey
i
the vehicle is opened with the mechanical key
Remove the SmartKey from the start-
In case the engine cannot be started
(yet the vehicle’s battery is charged),
the system is not operational. Contact
an authorized Maybach Studio or call
1-866-FOR-MAYBach (in the USA) or
1-888-881-6611 (in Canada).
someone opens a door from the inside if the vehicle was locked from
the outside with the SmartKey
someone opens the trunk lid with the
emergency release button
er switch.
The immobilizer is activated.
With KEYLESS-GO**
Turn off the engine by means of the
KEYLESS-GO start/stop button
( page 55) on the gear selector lever.
Open the driver’s door.
The immobilizer is activated.
Deactivating
With the SmartKey
Insert the SmartKey in the starter
switch.
The immobilizer is deactivated.
104
Anti-theft alarm system
Once the alarm system has been armed,
a visual and audible alarm is triggered
when someone opens
a door
the trunk
the hood
The alarm will stay on even if the activating element (a door, for example) is immediately closed.
i
If the alarm stays on for more than
30 seconds, a call to the Response
Center is initiated automatically by
the Tele Aid system provided Tele Aid
service was subscribed to and properly activated, and that necessary cellular service and GPS coverage are
available.
Safety and Security
Anti-theft systems
Arming the alarm system
i
Canceling the alarm
The indicator lamp located below the
hazard warning flasher switch in on the
upper part of the front center console.
If the turn signal lamps do not flash
three times, one of the following elements may not be properly closed:
To cancel the alarm:
a door
Insert the SmartKey in the starter
the trunk
the hood
Close the respective element and lock
the vehicle again.
1 Indicator lamp
Lock your vehicle.
The turn signal lamps flash three
times to indicate that the alarm system is activated. The indicator
lamp 1 flashes to indicate that the
alarm system is armed.
With the SmartKey
switch.
or
Press button Œ or ‹.
The alarm is canceled.
Disarming the alarm system
With KEYLESS-GO**
Unlock your vehicle.
Grasp the outside door handle.
The turn signal lamps flash once to indicate that the alarm system is deactivated.
i
The alarm system will rearm automatically again after approximately 40
seconds if no door was opened.
The SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO must
be within 3 ft (1 m) of the vehicle.
or
Press the KEYLESS-GO start/stop button ( page 55).
The SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO must
be inside the vehicle.
The alarm is canceled.
105
Safety and Security
Anti-theft systems
Tow-away alarm
Once the tow-away alarm is armed, a visual and audible alarm will be triggered
when someone attempts to raise the vehicle.
i
The tow-away protection alarm is
triggered, for example, if the vehicle
is lifted on one side.
Disarming the tow-away alarm
To prevent triggering the tow-away
alarm feature, switch off the tow-away
alarm before towing the vehicle, or
when parking on a surface subject to
movement, such as a ferry or auto train.
The button is located on the overhead
control panel.
If the alarm stays on for more than
30 seconds, a call to the Response
Center is initiated automatically by
the Tele Aid system provided Tele Aid
service was subscribed to and properly activated, and that necessary cellular service and GPS coverage are
available.
Arming the tow-away alarm
Lock your vehicle.
The tow-away alarm is automatically
armed after about 30 seconds.
106
Switch off the ignition and remove
the SmartKey from the starter switch.
i
You cannot disarm the tow-away
alarm if the ignition is switched on.
Press button 1.
The indicator lamp in the button
comes on briefly.
Exit the vehicle and lock it with the
SmartKey or (vehicles with
KEYLESS-GO**) with the lock button
at each outside door handle or trunk
lid.
i
1 Tow-away alarm off button
When you unlock your vehicle, the
tow-away protection disarms automatically.
The tow-away alarm remains disarmed until you lock your vehicle
again.
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
Seats
Memory function
Lighting
Instrument cluster
Control system
Automatic transmission
Good visibility
Automatic climate control
Power windows
Power tilt/sliding sunroof
Electrotransparent roof*
Driving systems
Loading
Useful features
Pocket PC remote control*
107
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
In the "Controls in detail" section, you
will find detailed information on how to
operate the equipment installed on your
vehicle. If you are already familiar with
the basic functions of your vehicle, this
section will be of particular interest to
you.
To quickly familiarize yourself with the
basic functions of the vehicle, refer to
the "Getting started" section of this
manual. The corresponding page numbers are given at the beginning of each
segment.
For more information on locking and unlocking, see "Getting started"
( page 52) and ( page 74).
SmartKey
Your vehicle comes supplied with two
SmartKeys, each with remote control
and a removable mechanical key.
The locking tabs for the mechanical key
portion of the two SmartKeys are a different color to help distinguish each
SmartKey unit.
The SmartKey provides an extended operating range. To prevent theft, however, it is advisable to only unlock the
vehicle when you are in close proximity
to it.
The SmartKey centrally locks and unlocks:
108
the doors
the trunk
the fuel filler flap
SmartKey with remote control
1
2
3
4
5
6
 Panic button ( page 95)
‹ Lock button
Š Opening button for trunk
Mechanical key locking tab
Œ Unlock button
Battery check lamp
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
Warning!
G
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey from the starter switch, take
it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not
leave children unattended in the vehicle,
or with access to an unlocked vehicle. It is
possible for children to open a looked door
from the inside, which could result in an
accident and/or serious personal injury.
!
To prevent possible malfunction,
avoid exposing the SmartKey to high
levels of electromagnetic radiation.
Factory setting
Global unlocking
Press button Œ.
All turn signal lamps flash once. The
locking knobs in the doors move up.
The anti-theft alarm system is
switched off.
The vehicle will lock again automatically
and reactivate the anti-theft alarm system within approximately 40 seconds of
unlocking if:
neither door nor trunk is opened
the SmartKey is not inserted in the
starter switch
i
When you unlock the vehicle, the SBC
brake system is activated
( page 101).
the central locking switch is not activated.
Global locking
Selective setting
If you frequently travel alone, you may
wish to reprogram the SmartKey so that
pressing Œ only unlocks the driver's
door and the fuel filler flap.
Press and hold buttons Œ and ‹
simultaneously for about six seconds
until battery check lamp 6 flashes
twice.
The SmartKey will then function as
follows:
Unlocking driver's door and fuel filler
flap
Press button Œ once.
All turn signal lamps flash once. The
locking knob in the driver's door
moves up. The anti-theft alarm system is switched off.
Press button ‹.
i
You can also open and close the power windows ( page 220) and tilt/
sliding sunroof ( page 220) using
the SmartKey.
All turn signal lamps flash three
times. The locking knobs in the doors
move down. The anti-theft alarm system is activated.
109
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
Global unlocking
!
Checking the batteries
Press button Œ twice.
If you can no longer lock or unlock
the vehicle with the SmartKey, then
either the batteries in the SmartKey
are discharged, the SmartKey is malfunctioning or the vehicle batteries
are drained.
Press button Œ or ‹.
All turn signal lamps flash once. The
locking knobs in the doors move up.
The anti-theft alarm system is
switched off.
Global locking
Check the batteries in the
SmartKey and replace them if necessary ( page 429).
Use the mechanical key to unlock
the driver’s door ( page 423) and
trunk ( page 424).
Press button ‹.
All turn signal lamps flash three
times. The locking knobs in the doors
move down. The anti-theft alarm system is activated.
Use the mechanical key to lock the
driver’s door ( page 423).
Have the vehicle batteries and
their connections checked
( page 441).
Restoring to factory setting
Press and hold buttons Œ and ‹
simultaneously for about six seconds
until battery check lamp 6 flashes
twice.
110
If the SmartKey is malfunctioning,
contact an authorized Maybach
Studio.
Battery check lamp 6 comes on
briefly to indicate that the SmartKey
batteries are in order.
i
If battery check lamp 6 does not
come on briefly during check, then
the SmartKey batteries are discharged.
Replace the batteries ( page 429).
You can obtain the required batteries
at any authorized Maybach Studio.
i
If the batteries are checked within
signal range of the vehicle, pressing
button Œ or ‹ will lock or unlock the vehicle accordingly.
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
Unlocking and opening the trunk
Loss of SmartKey or mechanical key
You can unlock and open the trunk separately.
If you lose a SmartKey or mechanical key,
you should do the following:
A minimum height clearance of 6.2 ft
(1.89 m) is required to open the trunk lid.
Have the SmartKey deactivated by an
Press and hold button Š until the
Report the loss of the SmartKey or
trunk lid unlocks and begins to open.
!
The trunk lid swings open upwards
automatically. Always make sure
there is sufficient overhead clearance.
To stop the opening procedure, press
button Š. The trunk lid stops moving.
authorized Maybach Studio.
the mechanical key immediately to
your car insurance company.
If necessary, have the mechanical lock
replaced.
Your authorized Maybach Studio will be
glad to supply you with a replacement.
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO**
Vehicles equipped with KEYLESS-GO
come with two SmartKeys with
KEYLESS-GO, each with remote control
and a removable mechanical key.
The locking tabs for the mechanical key
portion of the two SmartKeys with
KEYLESS-GO are a different color to help
distinguish each SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO unit.
The function of the SmartKey overrules
the KEYLESS-GO function.
The KEYLESS-GO function is integrated
into the SmartKey. On these vehicles, the
validity of the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO is checked every time you
grasp an outside door handle.
If the SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO is valid, your vehicle unlocks
the doors
the trunk
the fuel filler flap
111
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
Warning!
G
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO with you and
lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to
an unlocked vehicle. It is possible for children to open a looked door from the inside, which could result in an accident and/
or serious personal injury.
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO
1
2
3
4
5
6
 Panic button ( page 95)
‹ Lock button
Š Opening button for trunk
Mechanical key locking tab
Œ Unlock button
Battery check lamp
!
i
i
When any outside door handle other
than the driver’s outside door handle
is grasped, the vehicle is centrally unlocked.
112
To prevent possible malfunction,
avoid exposing the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO to high levels of electromagnetic radiation.
If the vehicle has been parked for a
longer period of time, you must grasp
the outside door handle in order to
activate the KEYLESS-GO function.
i
You can also open and close the power windows ( page 220) and tilt/
sliding sunroof ( page 220) using
the SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO.
i
When you unlock the vehicle, the SBC
brake system is activated
( page 101).
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
Important notes on using KEYLESS-GO
You can also use the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO like a normal SmartKey
( page 108).
You can combine KEYLESS-GO functions with normal SmartKey functions
(e.g. unlocking with KEYLESS-GO and
locking with button ‹).
Always carry the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO with you.
Never store the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO together with:
electronic items such as a cellular
phone or another SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO
metallic objects such as coins or
metal foil
Doing so could impair the function of
the KEYLESS-GO system.
To lock or unlock the vehicle, the
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO must be
located outside the vehicle within approximately 3 ft (1 m) of a door or the
trunk lid.
In order to start the engine with the
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO:
The SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO
must be located in the vehicle.
All the doors must be closed.
The brake pedal must be firmly
depressed. Do not depress the accelerator.
If the SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO is
positioned farther away from the vehicle, the system may no longer recognize the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO. The vehicle then cannot
be locked or the engine started via
the KEYLESS-GO system.
If the SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO is
removed from the vehicle while the
ignition is switched on (e.g. if passenger exits the vehicle with the
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO), the
message KEY NOT RECOGNIZED will appear in the multifunction display
while driving off.
If you have started the engine with
the KEYLESS-GO start/stop button
( page 55), you can only turn it off
again with this button, even if you
have put the SmartKey in the starter
switch in the meantime.
This does not apply if, after starting,
the gear selector lever is still in position P and the SmartKey is then inserted in the starter switch. The
SmartKey will then have priority over
the KEYLESS-GO function and the vehicle’s electrical system will operate
according to the position of the
SmartKey in the starter switch, even
stopping the engine.
Find the SmartKey or change its
present location immediately
(e.g. place it on the front passenger
seat or insert it in shirt pocket).
Remember that the engine can be
started by anyone with a SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO that is left inside
the vehicle. If you leave the SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO behind when exiting and locking the vehicle, the message KEY STILL IN VEHICLE will
appear in the multifunction display.
113
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
Factory setting
Global unlocking
Grasp the outside door handle.
All turn signal lamps flash once. The
locking knobs in the doors move up.
The anti-theft alarm system is
switched off.
The vehicle will lock again automatically
and reactivate the anti-theft alarm system within approximately 40 seconds of
unlocking if:
neither door nor trunk is opened
the central locking switch is not activated.
i
The vehicle could be inadvertently
unlocked if the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO is within 3 ft (1 m) of the
vehicle and
the outside door handle is
splashed with water, or
you attempt to clean the outside
door handle.
114
Global locking
Press the lock button at the outside
door handle ( page 76) or trunk lid
( page 115).
All turn signal lamps flash three
times. The locking knobs in the doors
move down. The anti-theft alarm system is activated.
Unlocking driver's door and fuel filler
flap
Grasp the driver’s outside door han-
dle.
All turn signal lamps flash once. The
locking knob in the driver's moves up.
The anti-theft alarm system is
switched off.
Selective setting
Global unlocking
If you frequently travel alone, you may
wish to reprogram the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO so when you grasp the driver’s outside door handle only the driver’s
door and the fuel filler flap unlocks.
Grasp any outside door handle other
Press and hold buttons Œ and ‹
simultaneously for about five seconds
until battery check lamp 6 flashes
twice.
The SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO will
then function as follows:
than the driver’s outside door handle.
All turn signal lamps flash once. The
locking knobs in the doors move up.
The anti-theft alarm system is
switched off.
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
Global locking
i
Press the lock button at outside door
handle ( page 76).
You can also lock the vehicle using
the lock button at outside door handle ( page 76) or KEYLESS-GO locking/closing switch ( page 122).
All turn signal lamps flash three
times. The locking knobs in the doors
move down. The anti-theft alarm system is activated.
Restoring to factory setting
Press and hold buttons Œ and ‹
i
You can also lock the vehicle using
the lock button at trunk lid
( page 115) or KEYLESS-GO locking/
closing switch ( page 122).
Global locking using the lock button at
trunk lid
i
To prevent a possible inadvertent
lockout, the trunk will open automatically if a SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO
is recognized inside the vehicle or in
the trunk.
1 Lock button at trunk lid
simultaneously for about six seconds
until battery check lamp 6 flashes
twice.
Press lock button at trunk lid 1.
!
All turn signal lamps flash three
times. The locking knobs in the doors
move down. The anti-theft alarm system is activated.
i
If the vehicle was previously centrally
locked with KEYLESS-GO, the trunk
will lock automatically after closing it.
The turn signals flash three times to
confirm locking.
If you can no longer lock or unlock
the vehicle with the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO, then either the batteries in the SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO
are discharged, the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO is malfunctioning or the
vehicle batteries are drained.
Check the batteries in the
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO and
replace them if necessary
( page 429).
Use the mechanical key to unlock
the driver’s door ( page 423) and
trunk ( page 424).
115
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
Use the mechanical key to lock the
driver’s door ( page 423).
Have the vehicle batteries and
their connections checked
( page 441).
If the SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO is
malfunctioning, contact an authorized Maybach Studio.
Checking the batteries
Press button Œ or ‹.
Battery check lamp 6 comes on
briefly to indicate that the SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO batteries are in order.
i
If battery check lamp 6 does not
come on briefly during check, then
the SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO batteries are discharged.
Replace the batteries ( page 429).
You can obtain the required batteries
at any authorized Maybach Studio.
116
i
Loss of the SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO
If the batteries are checked within
signal range of the vehicle, pressing
button Œ or ‹ will lock or unlock the vehicle accordingly.
If you lose your SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO or mechanical key, you
should do the following:
Unlocking and opening the trunk
You can unlock and open the trunk separately.
A minimum height clearance of 6.2 ft
(1.89 m) is required to open the trunk lid.
Press and hold button Š until the
trunk lid unlocks and begins to open.
!
The trunk lid swings open upwards
automatically. Always make sure
there is sufficient overhead clearance.
To stop the opening procedure, press
button Š. The trunk lid stops moving.
Have the SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO
deactivated by an authorized
Maybach Studio.
Report the loss of the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO or the mechanical key
immediately to your car insurance
company.
Have the mechanical lock replaced if
necessary.
Your authorized Maybach Studio will be
glad to supply you with a replacement.
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
Opening the doors from the inside
You can open a locked door from the inside. Open door only when conditions
are safe to do so.
Pull on door handle 2 on the respec-
tive rear door to open door.
i
If the vehicle has previously been
locked from the outside using the
SmartKey or KEYLESS-GO**, opening
a door from the inside will trigger the
anti-theft alarm system.
To cancel the alarm, do one of the
following:
1 Locking knob
2 Inside door handle
Press button Œ or ‹ on the
SmartKey.
Insert the SmartKey in the starter
switch.
G
To prevent possible personal injury, always
keep hands and fingers away from the
door opening when closing the door. Be
especially careful when small children are
around.
In case of danger, release the remote rear
door closing switch to stop the closing procedure.
Grasp the outside door handle.
The SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO
must be within 3 ft (1 m) of the
vehicle.
Pull on door handle 2 on the respec-
tive front door to open door.
Rear doors
Warning!
In vehicles with KEYLESS-GO**:
Front doors
If door was locked, locking knob 1
will move up.
Closing the rear doors automatically
from the inside (Maybach 62)
You can close the rear doors automatically.
Press the KEYLESS-GO**
start/stop button ( page 55).
The SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO
must be inside the vehicle.
Pull up locking knob 1 on the re-
spective rear door to unlock door.
117
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
The remote rear door closing switch is
above the rear door.
i
You can also close the rear doors by
hand.
In vehicles without KEYLESS-GO**: The
vehicle must be unlocked.
Pull on handle 1.
The trunk lid opens.
Opening the trunk
Opening the trunk from the outside
A minimum height clearance of 6.2 ft
(1.89 m) is required to open the trunk lid.
The handle is located above the rear license plate recess.
1 Remote rear door closing switch
If necessary, pull the door into its lock
by hand.
Release switch 1 to interrupt proce-
dure.
Only drive with the doors closed. Otherwise, one or more of the doors could open
while the vehicle is in motion, putting you
and/or others at risk.
118
To stop the opening procedure, press
button Š on the SmartKey or
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO*.
The trunk can also be opened using
button Š on the SmartKey or
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO**, or
from its inside in an emergency, see
"Trunk lid emergency release"
( page 123).
pletely closed.
G
The trunk lid swings open automatically. Always make sure there is sufficient overhead clearance.
i
Pull switch 1 until the door is com-
Warning!
!
1 Handle
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
Opening the trunk from the inside
!
You can open the trunk from the inside
if the vehicle is stationary.
The trunk lid swings open automatically. Always make sure there is sufficient overhead clearance.
A minimum height clearance of 6.2 ft
(1.89 m) is required to open the trunk lid.
The remote trunk lid switch is located on
the dashboard to the left of the steering
wheel.
To stop the opening procedure, press
or pull remote trunk lid switch 1.
The trunk can also be opened using
button Š on the SmartKey or
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO**, or from
its inside in an emergency, see "Trunk lid
emergency release" ( page 123).
Closing the trunk
Closing the trunk from the inside
Press the remote trunk lid switch
( page 119) until the message TRUNK
OPEN disappears from the instrument
cluster and the trunk is closed.
1 Remote trunk lid switch
Pull remote trunk lid switch 1 until
the trunk lid begins to open.
The trunk lid opens. You will see the
message TRUNK OPEN appear in the instrument cluster until you close the
trunk.
To interrupt the closing procedure:
Release the remote trunk lid switch.
i
You can also close the trunk by hand.
Warning!
G
Maintain sight of trunk area while operating the remote trunk lid switch. Monitor
the closing procedure carefully to make
sure no one is in danger of being injured.
To interrupt the closing procedure, release
the remote trunk lid switch.
Even with the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** removed from the starter
switch or the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** removed from the vehicle,
the remote trunk lid switch can be operated. Therefore, do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an
unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment may cause an accident
and/or serious personal injury.
Warning!
G
Only drive with the trunk closed as, among
other dangers such as visibility blockage,
exhaust fumes may enter the vehicle interior.
119
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
If the trunk lid comes into contact with
an object while closing (e.g. luggage that
has been piled too high) in the upper
motion sequence, the closing procedure
is stopped and the trunk re-opens slightly.
Closing the trunk from the outside
(vehicles without KEYLESS-GO**)
i
You can also close the trunk by hand.
If the trunk lid comes into contact with
an object while closing (e.g. luggage that
has been piled too high) in the upper
motion sequence, the closing procedure
is stopped and the trunk re-opens
slightly.
You can close the trunk separately.
Warning!
G
Monitor the closing procedure carefully to
make sure no one is in danger of being injured. To prevent possible personal injury,
always keep hands and fingers away from
the trunk opening when closing the trunk.
Be especially careful when small children
are around. To stop the closing procedure,
do one of the following:
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey from the starter switch, take
it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not
leave children unattended in the vehicle,
or with access to an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of equipment may cause an
accident and/or serious personal injury.
Warning!
G
Only drive with the trunk closed as, among
other dangers such as visibility blockage,
exhaust fumes may enter the vehicle interior.
i
Do not place the SmartKey in the
open trunk. You may lock yourself
out.
press the trunk lid closing switch 1
1 Trunk lid closing switch
press button Š on the SmartKey
i
Press trunk lid closing switch 1 brief-
press or pull the remote trunk lid
switch (on the dashboard to the left of
the steering wheel).
If the vehicle was previously centrally
locked, the trunk will lock automatically after closing it. The turn signals
flash three times to confirm locking.
ly.
The trunk lid closes.
120
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
Closing the trunk from the outside
(vehicles with KEYLESS-GO**)
You can close the trunk separately.
If the trunk lid comes into contact with
an object while closing (e.g. luggage that
has been piled too high) in the upper
motion sequence, the closing procedure
is stopped and the trunk re-opens slightly.
i
To prevent a possible inadvertent
lockout, the trunk lid will open automatically if a SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO is recognized inside the
vehicle or in the trunk.
1 Trunk lid closing switch
Warning!
G
Make sure you have the SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO with you.
Press switch 1 briefly.
The trunk lid closes.
i
You can also close the trunk by hand.
Monitor the closing procedure carefully to
make sure no one is in danger of being injured. To prevent possible personal injury,
always keep hands and fingers away from
the trunk opening when closing the trunk.
Be especially careful when small children
are around. To stop the closing procedure,
do one of the following:
press the trunk lid closing switch 1
press button Š on the SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO
press or pull the remote trunk lid
switch (on the dashboard to the left of
the steering wheel).
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO with you and
lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to
an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of
vehicle equipment may cause an accident
and/or serious personal injury.
Warning!
G
Only drive with the trunk closed as, among
other dangers such as visibility blockage,
exhaust fumes may enter the vehicle interior.
i
If the vehicle was previously centrally
locked, the trunk lid will lock automatically after closing it. The turn signals flash three times to confirm
locking.
121
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
Closing the trunk and locking the vehicle
from the outside (vehicles with
KEYLESS-GO**)
You can close the trunk and lock the vehicle simultaneously.
i
press the trunk lid closing switch 1
You can also close the trunk by hand.
press button Š on the SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO
If the trunk lid comes into contact with
an object while closing (e.g. luggage that
has been piled too high) in the upper
motion sequence, the closing procedure
is stopped and the trunk re-opens slightly.
press or pull the remote trunk lid
switch (on the dashboard to the left of
the steering wheel).
i
To prevent a possible inadvertent
lockout, the trunk lid will open automatically if a SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO is recognized inside the
vehicle or in the trunk.
1 KEYLESS-GO locking/closing switch
Make sure you have the SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO with you.
Press switch 1 briefly.
The vehicle is locked and the trunk lid
closes automatically. All turn signal
lamps flash three times. The locking
knobs in the doors move down. The
anti-theft alarm system is activated.
122
Warning!
G
Monitor the closing procedure carefully to
make sure no one is in danger of being injured. To prevent possible personal injury,
always keep hands and fingers away from
the trunk opening when closing the trunk.
Be especially careful when small children
are around. To stop the closing procedure,
do one of the following:
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO with you and
lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to
an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of
vehicle equipment may cause an accident
and/or serious personal injury.
Warning!
G
Only drive with the trunk closed as, among
other dangers such as visibility blockage,
exhaust fumes may enter the vehicle interior.
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
Trunk lid emergency release
The emergency release button is located
on the inside of the trunk lid.
Briefly press emergency release
button 1.
The trunk lid unlocks and opens
slightly.
Push up the trunk lid to fully open.
i
The emergency release button unlocks the trunk while the vehicle is
standing still or in motion.
Illumination of the emergency release
button:
1 Emergency release button
i
If the vehicle has previously been
locked from the outside using the
SmartKey or KEYLESS-GO**, opening
the trunk from the inside using the
emergency release button will trigger
the anti-theft alarm system.
To cancel the alarm, do one of the following:
Press button Œ or ‹ on the
SmartKey.
Insert the SmartKey in the starter
switch.
The button flashes for 30 minutes after opening the trunk.
The button flashes for 60 minutes after closing the trunk.
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO**:
The SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO
must be within 3 ft. (1 m) of the
vehicle.
i
The emergency release button does
not unlock the trunk if the vehicle
battery is discharged or disconnected.
Grasp the outside door handle.
Press the KEYLESS-GO**
start/stop button ( page 55).
The SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO
must be inside the vehicle.
123
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
Power closing assist for doors and
trunk lid
It is not necessary to slam the door or
trunk lid closed. A pneumatic power assist mechanism draws doors and trunk lid
closed quietly and automatically once
the door or trunk lid has been latched.
When the pneumatic power-assisted
mechanism has stopped, doors and/or
trunk can be re-opened.
Warning!
G
To prevent possible personal injury, always
keep hands and fingers away from the
door or trunk opening when closing a door
or the trunk lid. Be especially careful when
small children are around.
In case of danger, pull the inside or outside
door handle, or pull on trunk lid handle.
To prevent personal injury, never activate
the closing assist mechanism by tampering
with the door or trunk lid latch.
124
Power closing assist for doors
Press the doors gently past the initial
engage position into the lock.
The doors close automatically.
Warning!
G
Only drive with the doors closed. Otherwise, one or more of the doors could open
while the vehicle is in motion, putting you
and/or others at risk.
Power closing assist for trunk lid
Press the trunk lid gently into its lock.
The trunk closes automatically.
Warning!
G
Only drive with the trunk closed as, among
other dangers such as visibility blockage,
exhaust fumes may enter the vehicle interior.
Automatic central locking
The doors and the trunk automatically
lock when the ignition is switched on
and the wheels are turning at speeds of
approximately 9 mph (15 km/h) or more.
You can open a locked door from the inside. Open door only when conditions
are safe to do so.
i
The doors unlock automatically after
an accident if the force of the impact
exceeds a preset threshold.
The vehicle locks automatically when
the ignition is switched on and the
wheels are turning at vehicle speeds
of approximately 9 mph (15 km/h) or
more. You could therefore lock yourself out when the vehicle
is pushed or towed
is on a test stand
You can deactivate the automatic locking using the control system
( page 181).
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
Locking and unlocking from the inside
You can lock or unlock the doors and the
trunk from inside using the central locking switch. This can be useful, for example, if you want to lock the vehicle
before starting to drive.
Your vehicle is equipped with locking
and unlocking switches for the driver
and rear seat passengers.
The rear seat passengers switches are located on the rear center console between the rear seats.
The driver’s switches are located on the
upper part of the front center console.
The fuel filler flap will not be locked or
unlocked with the central locking or unlocking switch, respectively.
Warning!
G
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment
may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury.
Rear seat passengers switches (example illustration from Maybach 57)
Driver’s switches
1 Central locking switch
2 Central unlocking switch
1 Central locking switch
2 Central unlocking switch
125
Controls in detail
Locking and unlocking
Locking
i
Press central locking switch 1.
You can open a locked door from the
inside. Open door only when conditions are safe to do so.
If all doors are closed, the vehicle
locks.
Unlocking
Press central unlocking switch 2.
The vehicle unlocks.
126
If the vehicle was previously centrally
locked using the SmartKey or
KEYLESS-GO**, it will not unlock using the central unlocking switch 2.
If the vehicle was previously locked
with the central locking switch 1:
While in the global remote control
mode, the vehicle is unlocked
when a door is opened from the
inside.
While in the selective remote control mode, only the door opened
from inside is unlocked.
Controls in detail
Seats
Seats
For more information on seat adjustment, see "Adjusting" ( page 57).
Easy-entry/exit feature
This feature allows for easier entry into
and exit from the vehicle.
The easy-entry/exit feature can be activated or deactivated in the CONVENIENCE
submenu of the control system
( page 183).
Warning!
G
You must make sure no one can become
trapped or injured by the moving steering
wheel and driver’s seat when the easy-entry/exit feature is activated.
When exiting the vehicle, with the easyentry/exit feature activated and depending on your selection, the steering wheel
tilts upwards and/or the driver’s seat
moves a few inches to the rear when you
To cancel seat/steering wheel movement,
do one of the following:
or
Press seat adjustment switch
( page 58).
Move steering column stalk
( page 60).
Press one of the memory position buttons or the memory button M
( page 141).
remove the SmartKey from the starter switch,
open the driver’s door with the
SmartKey in starter switch position 0
or 1 or the KEYLESS-GO** start/stop
button ( page 55) in position 1.
The steering wheel and driver’s seat stop
moving.
Do not leave children unattended in the
vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. Children could open the driver’s door
and unintentionally activate the easy-entry/exit feature, which could result in an
accident and/or serious personal injury.
127
Controls in detail
Seats
i
If the current position for the steering wheel is in the uppermost tilt position, the steering wheel will no
longer be able to move upward when
the easy-entry/exit feature is activated.
If the current seat position falls into a
factory-set position range and the
system recognizes the current seat
position to be rearward enough for
easy entry and exit, the driver’s seat
will not move to the rear when the
easy-entry/exit feature is activated.
128
When entering the vehicle with the
easy-entry/exit feature activated, the
steering wheel or, depending on your selection, the steering wheel and driver’s
seat will return to their last set position
or a factory-set maximum forward position when you
close the driver’s door with the ignition switched on
insert the SmartKey into the starter
switch or press the KEYLESS-GO**
start/stop button ( page 55) once
with the driver’s door closed.
i
For safety reasons, the driver’s seat
will not return to its last set position
with the easy-entry/exit feature activated if the system recognizes the last
set position as an extreme forward
position. Instead, the driver’s seat will
remain at or move to a factory-set
maximum forward position. To again
fully return the driver’s seat to your
last set position or to memory position, adjust the seat to the desired
position or press and hold the respective memory position button
( page 141).
Controls in detail
Seats
In addition to adjusting the head re-
Rear seats
straint tilt using the corresponding
power control on the rear door control panel, the angle of the head restraint can also be adjusted manually.
Push or pull on the lower edge of the
head restraint cushion.
Head restraint tilt
For information on front seat head restraint adjustment, see "Adjusting"
( page 59).
i
Maybach 62
1 Head restraints
2 Head restraint side cushions
Adjust the side cushions of the head
restraints by hand.
Maybach 57
1 Head restraints
2 Head restraint side cushions
Adjust the head restraint in such a
way that it is as close to the head as
possible.
Rear seat adjustment (Maybach 57)
i
To adjust settings for the right rear
passenger seat, make sure the right
rear passenger seat adjustment button is selected ( page 135).
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
or
Open the respective door.
129
Controls in detail
Seats
Warning!
i
G
Adjust the head restraint in such a
way that it is as close to the head as
possible.
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle.
The seats can also be operated with the
door open. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an
unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment may cause an accident
and/or serious personal injury.
i
The rear center seat* cannot be adjusted.
Warning!
For your protection, drive only with properly positioned head restraints.
1
2
3
4
5
Head restraint height
Head restraint tilt
Seat backrest tilt
Seat fore and aft adjustment
Seat cushion tilt
Head restraint height
Press switch up or down in direction
of arrow 1.
Head restraint tilt
Press switch forward or backward in
direction of arrow 2.
130
G
Adjust head restraint so that the center of
the head restraint supports the back of the
head at eye level. This will reduce the potential for injury to the head and neck in
the event of an accident or similar situation.
Do not drive the vehicle without the seat
head restraints. Head restraints are intended to help reduce injuries during an accident.
Controls in detail
Seats
Seat backrest tilt
Seat fore and aft adjustment
Press switch forward or backward in
Press switch forward or backward in
direction of arrow 3 until your arms
are slightly angled when holding the
steering wheel.
i
Tilt the seat backrest to the rear for
easier removal and installation of the
head restraints.
direction of arrow 4.
i
When moving the seat, be sure that
there are no items in the footwell or
behind the seats. Otherwise you
could damage the seats.
The functions for adjusting backrest
tilt and seat fore and aft are linked
functions. When the seat is adjusted
fore and aft, the backrest tilt is adjusted simultaneously, and vice versa.
i
To adjust settings for the right rear
passenger seat, make sure the right
rear passenger seat adjustment button is selected ( page 135)
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
or
Seat cushion tilt
i
Rear seat adjustment (Maybach 62)
Open the respective door.
Press switch up or down in direction
of arrow 5 until your upper legs are
lightly supported.
Warning!
G
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle.
The seats can also be operated with the respective door open. Do not leave children
unattended in the vehicle, or with access
to an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use
of vehicle equipment may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury.
131
Controls in detail
Seats
Fully reclined/upright position
To adjust seat to fully reclined posi-
tion, press switch 1.
Press and hold switch 1 until seat is
in desired position.
To stop the seat adjustment procedure, release switch 1.
To adjust seat to upright position,
press switch 2.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
a
Fully reclined position
Upright position
Head restraint height
Head restraint tilt
Seat backrest tilt
Seat cushion depth
Seat cushion tilt
Seat fore and aft adjustment
Leg rest length
Leg rest tilt
i
The rear center seat* cannot be adjusted.
Press and hold switch 2 until seat is
in desired position.
To stop the seat adjustment procedure, release switch 2.
Head restraint height
Press switch up or down in direction
G
For your protection, drive only with properly positioned head restraints.
Adjust head restraint so that the center of
the head restraint supports the back of the
head at eye level. This will reduce the potential for injury to the head and neck in
the event of an accident or similar situation.
Do not drive the vehicle without the seat
head restraints. Head restraints are intended to help reduce injuries during an accident.
Seat backrest tilt
Press switch forward or backward in
Head restraint tilt
direction of arrow 5 until your arms
are slightly angled when holding the
steering wheel.
Press switch forward or backward in
i
of arrow 3.
direction of arrow 4.
i
Adjust the head restraint in such a
way that it is as close to the head as
possible.
132
Warning!
The functions for adjusting backrest
tilt and seat fore and aft are linked
functions. When the seat is adjusted
fore and aft, the backrest tilt is adjusted simultaneously, and vice versa.
Controls in detail
Seats
Seat cushion depth
Leg rest tilt
Retracting rear seat head restraints
Press switch forward or backward in
Press switch up or down in direction
The switch is located on the lower part of
the front center console.
direction of arrow 6 until your legs
are supported comfortably.
Seat cushion tilt
of arrow a to adjust the leg rest tilt.
Extending and retracting the rear seat
head restraints
Press switch up or down in direction
of arrow 7 until your upper legs are
lightly supported.
Seat fore and aft adjustment
Press switch forward or backward in
direction of arrow 8.
i
When moving the seat, be sure that
there are no items in the footwell or
behind the seats. Otherwise you
could damage the seats.
Leg rest length
Press switch up or down in direction
of arrow 9 to adjust the leg rest
length.
Warning!
G
For your protection, drive only with properly positioned head restraints.
Adjust head restraint so that the center of
the head restraint supports the back of the
head at eye level. This will reduce the potential for injury to the head and neck in
the event of an accident or similar situation.
Do not drive the vehicle without the seat
head restraints. Head restraints are intended to help reduce injuries during an accident.
1 Switch for rear seat head restraints
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Press switch 1.
The rear seat head restraints retract.
i
You can only retract the rear seat
head restraints when no rear seat
passenger is wearing a seat belt.
133
Controls in detail
Seats
Extending rear seat head restraints
Press switch 1 again.
or
A rear seat passenger fastens a seat
Extending/retracting the rear center
seat* head restraint
The switch is on the lower right side of
the rear center seat.
Press switch 1 and hold it.
The rear seat head restraint retracts
until you release the switch.
Press switch 2 and hold it.
belt.
The rear seat head restraint extends
until you release the switch.
The rear seat head restraints extend.
i
i
You can also adjust head restraints
with the seat adjustment switches in
the rear passenger compartment
( page 130) or ( page 132).
Vehicles with rear center seat*:
For operation with the Pocket PC remote control* ( page 331).
1 Extending
2 Retracting
134
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Controls in detail
Seats
Setting front passenger seat position
from rear
This function lets you adjust the position
of the front passenger seat from the
right rear passenger seat.
The switch is located on the right rear
passenger door.
Warning!
G
When adjusting the passenger seat, make
sure the seat, if occupied, is as far from the
passenger front airbag as possible.
Otherwise, the passenger could be seriously or even fatally injured in the event of an
accident or braking maneuver.
Make sure no one is caught or injured
while the seat is being adjusted.
Example illustration from Maybach 57
1
2
3
4
5
6
Front passenger seat adjustment
Right rear passenger seat adjustment
Seat fore and aft adjustment
Seat cushion tilt
Seat backrest tilt
Head restraint height
Even with the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** removed from the starter
switch or the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** removed from the vehicle,
the power seats can be operated when the
respective door is open. Therefore, do not
leave children unattended in the vehicle,
or with access to an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment may
cause an accident and/or serious personal
injury.
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
or
Open the right rear passenger door.
Press switch 1.
Adjust passenger seat to desired posi-
tion using switches 3 through 6.
To adjust right rear passenger seat,
press button 2.
i
Adjusting the front passenger seat
position from the rear is not possible
if you activate the override switch
( page 94).
!
Do not move the front passenger seat
completely forward if objects are
stored in the parcel net in the front
passenger-side footwell. Items in the
net may be damaged.
135
Controls in detail
Seats
Multicontour seats
The multicontour seat has a movable
seat cushion and inflatable air cushions
built into the seat backrest to provide additional lumbar and side support.
The switches for the front seats are located on the inner side of the seat.
The switches for the rear seats on
Maybach 57 are located on the inner side
of the seat.
The seat cushion movement, seat backrest cushion height and curvature can be
continuously varied with regulators on
the right side of the seat after switching
on ignition.
i
Vehicles with rear center seat*:
The rear center seat is not a multicontour seat.
136
Driver’s seat/front passenger seat
1
2
3
4
Lumbar region support
Shoulder region support
Side bolster adjustment
Massage function (PULSE)
Rear seats (Maybach 57)
1
2
3
4
Lumbar region support
Shoulder region support
Side bolster adjustment
Massage function (PULSE)
Controls in detail
Seats
The switches for the rear seats on
Maybach 62 are located on the outer side
of the seat.
Lumbar region support
Massage function (PULSE)
Press k or j on rocker
You can reduce muscle tension during
long trips by periodically using the massage function.
switch 1.
This selects the air cushion you wish
to adjust.
Press æ or ç on rocker
switch 1.
The air cushion inflates or deflates.
i
Press æ or ç on switch 2.
The massage function switches off
automatically after approximately
eight minutes. The indicator lamp
goes out.
Rear seats (Maybach 62)
Lumbar region support
Shoulder region support
Side bolster adjustment
Massage function (PULSE)
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
The indicator lamp on button 4
comes on. The air cushions in the lumbar region inflate and deflate rhythmically.
Shoulder region support
The air cushion inflates or deflates.
1
2
3
4
Press button 4.
Side bolster adjustment
Adjust the side bolsters so that they
provide good lateral support using
switch 3.
i
When the engine is turned off, the
last cushion setting is retained in
memory, and the cushion is automatically adjusted to this setting when
the engine is restarted.
137
Controls in detail
Seats
Seat heating
The red indicator lamps in the switch
show the heating level selected:
The switch is located on the respective
door.
i
If one or all of the lamps on the seat
heating switch are flashing, there is
insufficient voltage due to too many
electrical consumers are turned on.
The seat heating switches off automatically.
Three indicator lamps on.
After approximately
five minutes, seat heating is
automatically switched to
level 2.
2
1
off
Two indicator lamps on.
After approximately
ten minutes, seat heating is
automatically switched to
level 1.
Example illustration from Maybach with seat
ventilation*
One indicator lamp on.
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
After approximately
20 minutes, seat heating is automatically switched off.
Switching on seat heating
No indicator lamp on.
i
The rear center seat* cannot be heated.
138
Press switch 1 repeatedly until all in-
dicator lamps go out.
Level
3
Switching off seat heating
1 Seat heating switch
Press switch 1 twice.
Three red indicator lamps in the
switch come on.
Continue pressing switch 1 until de-
sired seat heating level is reached.
The seat heating will switch back on
again automatically as soon as sufficient voltage is available.
Controls in detail
Seats
Seat ventilation*
The switch is located on the respective
door.
i
Switching off seat ventilation
The rear center seat* cannot be ventilated.
Press switch 1 repeatedly until all in-
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Switching on seat ventilation
Press switch 1.
Three blue indicator lamps in the
switch come on.
Continue pressing switch 1 until the
desired seat ventilation level is
reached.
1 Seat ventilation switch
i
The blue indicator lamps in the switch
show the ventilation level selected:
The seat ventilation for the driver’s
seat can be activated using summer
opening feature ( page 220).
Level
3
Three indicator lamps on.
2
Two indicator lamps on.
1
One indicator lamp on.
off
No indicator lamp on.
dicator lamps go out.
i
If one or all of the lamps flash on the
seat ventilation switch, there is insufficient voltage due to too many electrical consumers being switched on.
The seat ventilation switches off automatically.
The seat ventilation will switch back
on again automatically as soon as sufficient voltage is available.
139
Controls in detail
Memory function
!
Prior to operating the vehicle, the
driver should check and adjust the
seat height, seat position fore and
aft, and seat backrest angle if necessary, to ensure adequate control,
reach and comfort. The head restraint should also be adjusted for
proper height. See also the section on
airbags ( page 79) for proper seat
positioning.
In addition, adjust the steering wheel
to ensure adequate control, reach,
operation and comfort. Both the inside and outside rear view mirrors
should be adjusted for adequate rear
vision.
Fasten seat belts. Infants and small
children should be seated in a properly secured restraint system that complies with U.S. Federal Motor Vehicle
Safety Standard 213 and 225 and
Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213 and 210.2.
140
You can store up to five different settings for each SmartKey or SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO**.
The following settings are saved for each
stored position:
Seat and seat backrest position
Settings for multicontour seat
The following additional settings can be
saved in the driver’s seat:
Steering wheel position
Interior rear view mirror position
Exterior rear view mirror position
Automatic climate control
In the driver’s seat, you can program keydependent memory settings. You can
store up to five different settings per
SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO**.
The key-dependent memory functions as
soon as you:
insert the SmartKey into the starter
switch
or in vehicles with KEYLESS-GO**
press the start/stop button
( page 55) on the gear selector lever.
These key-dependent memory settings
can be deactivated if desired. For more
information, see "Setting key
dependency" ( page 182).
Controls in detail
Memory function
Warning!
G
Do not activate the memory function while
driving. Activating the memory function
while driving could cause the driver to lose
control of the vehicle.
The memory button and stored position
switch are located on the respective
door.
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Recalling positions from memory
or
!
Open the respective door.
Do not operate the power seats using
the memory button if the seat backrest is in an extremely reclined position. Doing so could cause damage to
front or rear seats.
Storing positions in memory
Adjust the seats, steering wheel and
mirrors to the desired position
( page 57).
Press memory button M.
First move seat backrest to an upright
position.
Release memory button M and push
memory position button 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5
within three seconds.
All the settings are stored at the selected position.
Press and hold memory position
button 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5 until the seat,
steering wheel and mirrors have fully
moved to the stored positions.
i
Releasing the button immediately
stops movement to the stored positions.
Example illustration from Maybach 57
1 Memory button M
2 Memory position buttons 1 - 5
141
Controls in detail
Memory function
Storing exterior rear view mirror
parking position
For easier parking you can adjust the passenger exterior rear view mirror so that
you can see the right rear wheel as soon
as you engage reverse gear R.
The buttons are located on the driver’s
door.
with button 2 so that you see the
rear wheel and the road curb.
Press memory button 3.
Within three seconds, press bottom
of adjustment button 2.
The parking position is stored if the
mirror does not move.
i
1 Exterior rear view mirror (passengerside)
2 Adjustment button
3 Memory button M
Stop the vehicle.
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
142
The passenger-side exterior rear view
mirror is selected.
Adjust the exterior rear view mirror
For information on activating the parking position, see "Setting parking position for exterior rear view mirror"
( page 184).
You can store a parking position for
the passenger side exterior rear view
mirror for each SmartKey or
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO**.
Press button 1.
i
If the mirror does move, repeat the
above steps. After the setting is
stored, you can move the mirror
again.
Controls in detail
Lighting
Lighting
For information on how to switch on the
headlamps and use the turn signals,
see "Switching on headlamps"
( page 70) and "Turn signals"
( page 71).
Exterior lamp switch
The exterior lamp switch is located on
the dashboard to the left of the steering
wheel.
M
Off
Daytime running lamp mode
( page 145)
U
Automatic headlamp mode
Daytime running lamp mode
( page 145)
i
If you drive in countries where vehicles drive on the other side of the
road than the country where the vehicle is registered, you must have the
headlamps modified for symmetrical
low beams. Relevant information can
be obtained at an authorized
Maybach Studio.
Exterior lamp switch
C
Parking lamps (also side marker
lamps, tail lamps, license plate
lamps, instrument panel lamps)
B
Low beam headlamps (or high
beam headlamps when the combination switch is pushed forward) and parking lamps
ˆ
Standing lamps, right (turn left
one stop)
‚
Standing lamps, left (turn left two
stops)
C
Indicator lamp for parking lamps
‡
Indicator lamp for front fog lamps
†
Indicator lamp for rear fog lamp
143
Controls in detail
Lighting
i
G
With the SmartKey removed from the
starter switch or the engine turned
off with KEYLESS-GO** and the driver’s door open, a warning sounds if
the parking lamps or low beam headlamps are switched on.
Warning!
the headlamps may switch off unexpectedly when the system senses
bright ambient light, for example light
from oncoming traffic.
The message TURN OFF LIGHTS appears
in the multifunction display.
the headlamps will not be automatically switched on under foggy conditions.
Manual headlamp mode
The low beam headlamps and parking
lamps can be switched on and off with
the exterior lamp switch.
Automatic headlamp mode
The following lamps switch on and off
automatically depending on the brightness of the ambient light:
Low beam headlamps
Tail and parking lamps
License plate lamps
Side marker lamps
144
If the exterior lamp switch is set to U,
To minimize risk to you and to others, activate headlamps by turning exterior lamp
switch to B when driving or when traffic and/or ambient lighting conditions require you to do so.
In low ambient lighting conditions, only
switch from position U to B with
the vehicle at a standstill. Switching
from U to B will briefly switch off
the headlamps. Doing so while driving in
low ambient lighting conditions may result
in an accident.
The automatic headlamp feature is only an
aid to the driver. The driver is responsible
for the operation of the vehicle's lights at
all times.
i
The front fog lamps and rear fog
lamp cannot be switched on manually with exterior lamp switch in
position U. To activate the fog
lamps, turn exterior lamp switch to
position B and pull the exterior
lamp switch to first or second stop
( page 146).
Turn the exterior lamp switch to
position U.
With the SmartKey in starter switch
position 1 or the KEYLESS-GO** start/
stop button pressed once, only the
parking lamps will switch on and off
automatically.
When the engine is running, the low
beam headlamps, the tail and parking lamps, the license plate lamps,
and the side marker lamps will switch
on and off automatically.
Controls in detail
Lighting
Daytime running lamp mode
Canada only
USA only
Turn exterior lamp switch to
The daytime running lamp mode is mandatory and therefore in a constant mode.
By default, the daytime running lamp
mode is deactivated. Activate the daytime running lamp mode using the control system, see "Setting daytime
running lamp mode (USA only)"
( page 177).
position M or U.
When the engine is running, the low
beam headlamps are switched on.
In low ambient light conditions, the
following lamps will switch on additionally:
tail and parking lamps
license plate lamps
side marker lamps
For nighttime driving you should turn
the exterior lamp switch to position B
to permit activation of the high beam
headlamps.
i
With the daytime running lamp
mode activated and the exterior lamp
switch in position M, the high
beam headlamps cannot be switched
on.
When the engine is running, and you
shift from a driving position to
position N or P, the low beam headlamps
will switch off with a three-minute delay.
When the engine is running, and you
turn the exterior lamp switch to
position C, the parking lamps
switch on additionally.
turn the exterior lamp switch to
position B, the manual headlamp
mode has priority over the daytime
running lamp mode.
The corresponding exterior lamps
switch on ( page 430).
When the engine is running, and you
turn the exterior lamp switch to
position C or B, the manual headlamp mode has priority over the daytime
running lamp mode.
The corresponding exterior lamps switch
on ( page 430).
Locator lighting and night security illumination
Locator lighting and night security illumination are described in the control system section under "Setting locator
lighting" ( page 178) and "Setting
night security illumination"
( page 179).
The high beam flasher is available at
all times.
145
Controls in detail
Lighting
i
Switching on fog lamps
Warning!
G
In low ambient lighting or foggy conditions, only switch from position U
to B with the vehicle at a standstill.
Switching from U to B will briefly
switch off the headlamps. Doing so while
driving in low ambient lighting conditions
may result in an accident.
Fog lamps cannot be switched on
with exterior lamp switch in
position U. For switching on the
fog lamps, turn exterior lamp switch
to position B first.
Switch on the front fog lamps
( page 146).
Pull out exterior lamp switch to sec-
ond stop.
Switching on front fog lamps
The rear fog lamps are switched on.
Switch on the low beam headlamps
( page 70).
The green indicator lamp † in the
exterior lamp switch comes on
( page 143).
Pull out exterior lamp switch to first
i
stop.
Fog lamps will operate with the parking lamps and/or the low beam headlamps on. Fog lamps should only be
used in conjunction with low beam
headlamps. Consult your State or
Province Motor Vehicle Regulations
regarding permissible lamp operation.
The front fog lamps are switched on.
146
Switching on rear fog lamp (driver’s side
only)
The green indicator lamp ‡ in the
exterior lamp switch comes on
( page 143).
Push down the exterior lamp switch.
The front fog lamps are switched off.
The green indicator lamp ‡ in the
exterior lamp switch goes out.
Push down the exterior lamp switch
to first stop.
The rear fog lamps are switched off.
The green indicator lamp † in the
exterior lamp switch goes out.
The front fog lamps remain lit.
Controls in detail
Lighting
Combination switch
The combination switch is located on the
left side of the steering column.
High beam
Turn exterior lamp switch to
position B or U ( page 143).
Push the combination switch in direc-
tion of arrow 1 to switch on the high
beam.
The high beam indicator lamp A in
the instrument cluster comes on.
Pull the combination switch in direc-
tion of arrow 2 to its original position to switch off the high beam.
1 High beam
2 High beam flasher
The high beam headlamp indicator
lamp A in the instrument cluster
goes out.
Hazard warning flasher
The hazard warning flasher can be
switched on at all times, even with the
SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** removed from the starter
switch or with the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** removed from the vehicle.
The hazard warning flasher switches on
automatically when an airbag deploys.
The hazard warning flasher switch is located on the upper part of the front center console.
High beam flasher
Pull the combination switch briefly in
direction of arrow 2.
1 Hazard warning flasher switch
147
Controls in detail
Lighting
Switching on the hazard warning flasher
Press the hazard warning flasher
switch 1.
Interior lighting in the front
The controls are located in the overhead
control panel.
The interior lighting switches on in
darkness when you:
i
With the hazard warning flasher activated and the combination switch set
for either left or right turn, only the
respective left or right turn signal will
operate when the SmartKey in the
starter switch is in position 1 or 2 or
the KEYLESS-GO** start/stop button
( page 55) is pressed once or twice.
Press hazard warning flasher
switch 1 again.
1
2
3
4
5
Left front reading lamp on/off
Rear interior lighting on/off
Automatic control on/off
Front interior lighting on/off
Right front reading lamp on/off
i
i
If the hazard warning flasher was
activated automatically, also press
hazard warning flasher switch 1 to
switch off the hazard warning flasher.
Leaving an interior light switch in the
ON position for extended periods of
time with the engine turned off could
result in a discharged battery.
148
Activating
Press automatic control switch 3.
All turn signals flash.
Switching off the hazard warning
flasher
Automatic control
the vehicle is unlocked
remove the SmartKey from the
starter switch
open a door
The interior lighting switches off automatically following an adjustable time
delay.
For more information, see "Setting interior lighting delayed shut-off"
( page 180).
i
If the door remains open, the interior
lighting switches off automatically
after approximately five minutes.
Controls in detail
Lighting
Deactivating
Press automatic control switch 3
again.
The interior lighting remains
switched off in darkness, even when
you:
unlock the vehicle
remove the SmartKey from the
starter switch
open a door
Manual control
or 5 again to switch off the respective front reading lamp.
Front interior lighting
Press front interior lighting switch 4.
The front interior lighting switches
on.
Press front interior lighting switch 4
again.
The front interior lighting switches
off.
i
Rear interior lighting
The trunk lighting switches on when
you open the trunk. It switches off
when you close the trunk.
Press rear interior lighting switch 2.
If the trunk lid remains open, the
trunk lighting switches off automatically after approximately ten minutes.
Press front reading lamp switch 1
The rear interior lighting switches on.
Press rear interior lighting switch 2
again.
The rear interior lighting switches
off.
Front reading lamps
The front reading lamps are located in
the overhead control panel.
Courtesy lighting
For better orientation in the dark, courtesy lamps will illuminate the interior of
your vehicle as follows.
With the automatic control activated:
the inside door handles
the driver and passenger footwells
With the automatic control activated
and the SmartKey in the starter switch
position 1:
the inside door handles
the center console
i
If you turn the SmartKey in the starter
switch to position 0 and switch off
the exterior headlamps, the door entry lamps will remain lit for approximately five minutes.
Press front reading lamp switch 1
or 5 to switch on the desired front
reading lamp.
149
Controls in detail
Lighting
Interior lighting in the rear
The control panel is located between the
rear seats.
i
Leaving an interior light switch in the
ON position for extended periods of
time with the engine turned off could
result in a discharged battery.
i
Vehicles with rear center seat*:
For operation with the Pocket PC remote control* ( page 320).
150
Maybach 57 with rear side window curtains*
1
2
3
4
Left rear reading lamp on/off
Right rear reading lamp on/off
Ambient lighting on/off
Thumbwheel for dimming ambient
lighting
5 Rear interior lighting on/off
Maybach 57 without rear side window curtains*
1
2
3
4
Left rear reading lamp on/off
Right rear reading lamp on/off
Rear interior lighting on/off
Thumbwheel for dimming ambient
lighting
5 Ambient lighting on/off
Controls in detail
Lighting
Maybach 62 with tilt/sliding sunroof
Maybach 62 with electrotransparent roof*
1 Left rear reading lamp on/off
2 Right rear reading lamp on/off
3 Headliner lamps and pillar uplights
on/off
4 Thumbwheel for dimming ambient
lighting and headliner lamps and pillar uplights
5 Ambient lighting on/off
6 Rear interior lighting on/off
1
2
3
4
Left rear reading lamp on/off
Right rear reading lamp on/off
Roof lighting on/off
Thumbwheel for dimming ambient
lighting and roof lighting
5 Ambient lighting on/off
6 Rear interior lighting on/off
151
Controls in detail
Lighting
Manual control
Ambient lighting
Headliner lamps and pillar uplights*
Rear interior lighting
The ambient lighting switches on and off
automatically depending on the brightness of the ambient light.
In Maybach 62 with tilt/sliding sunroof,
the headliner and pillar can be illuminated.
You can switch on or off ambient lighting manually.
Press switch 3 to switch the headlin-
Press the switch at the ð symbol to
Press switch 3 to switch the headlin-
Press the switch at the ò symbol to
switch the rear interior lighting on.
Press the switch at the ò symbol
again to switch the rear interior lighting off.
Rear reading lamps
Press respective switch 1 or 2
at X symbol to switch the corresponding rear reading lamps on.
Press respective switch 1 or 2
at X symbol again to switch the
corresponding rear reading lamps
off.
152
switch the ambient lighting on.
Press the switch at the ð symbol to
switch the ambient lighting off.
Dimming ambient lighting, headliner
lamps and pillar uplights* and roof lighting*
Turn thumbwheel 4 until the cur-
rent ambient lighting has reached
the desired intensity.
er lamps and pillar uplights on.
er lamps and pillar uplights off.
Electrotransparent roof lighting*
In Maybach 62 with an electrotransparent roof, the roof lining can be illuminated when the screen is closed.
Press switch 3 to switch the roof
lighting on.
Press switch 3 to switch the roof
lighting off.
Controls in detail
Instrument cluster
Instrument cluster
For a full view illustration of the instrument cluster, see "At a glance"
( page 24).
Warning!
The instrument cluster is activated when
you:
No messages will be displayed if either the
instrument cluster or the multifunction display is inoperative.
open a door
switch on ignition ( page 54)
press reset button J ( page 25) in
the instrument cluster
switch on the exterior lamps
If you open a door or press reset
button J without turning on the ignition or the light, the multifunction display is only illuminated for
approximately 30 seconds.
You can change the instrument cluster
settings in the Instrument cluster submenu of the control system
( page 175).
G
Contact your nearest authorized Maybach
Studio.
Instrument cluster illumination
Use the knob for instrument cluster illumination ( page 25) to adjust the illumination brightness for the instrument
cluster.
i
Press the knob for instrument cluster
illumination.
The knob will pop out.
To brighten illumination
Turn the knob clockwise.
The instrument cluster illumination
will brighten.
To dim illumination
Turn the knob in the instrument clus-
ter counterclockwise.
The instrument cluster illumination
will dim.
The instrument cluster illumination is
dimmed or brightened automatically
to suit ambient light conditions.
The instrument cluster illumination
will also be adjusted automatically
when you switch on the vehicle’s exterior lamps.
153
Controls in detail
Instrument cluster
i
Coolant temperature gauge
Warning!
G
Driving when your engine is badly
overheated can cause some fluids
which may have leaked into the engine
compartment to catch fire. You could
be seriously burned.
Steam from an overheated engine can
cause serious burns and can occur just
by opening the hood. Stay away from
the engine if you see or hear steam
coming from it.
Turn off the engine, get out of the vehicle
and do not stand near the vehicle until the
engine has cooled down.
154
Excessive coolant temperature trigger a warning in the multifunction
display ( page 404).
During severe operating conditions, e.g.
stop-and-go traffic, the coolant temperature may rise close to 248°F (120°C),
i.e. close to the red zone of the coolant
temperature gauge.
The engine should not be operated with
the coolant temperature above 248° F
(120°C), i.e. in the red zone of the coolant temperature gauge. Doing so may
cause serious engine damage which is
not covered by the Maybach Limited
Warranty.
Trip odometer
Make sure you are viewing the trip
odometer display ( page 157).
If it is not displayed, press
button è or ÿ on the multifunction steering wheel repeatedly until
the trip odometer appears
( page 157).
Press and hold reset button J
( page 25) in the instrument cluster
until the trip odometer is reset.
Controls in detail
Instrument cluster
Tachometer
The red marking on the tachometer denotes excessive engine speed.
!
Avoid driving at excessive engine
speeds, as it may result in serious engine damage that is not covered by
the Maybach Limited Warranty.
To help protect the engine, the fuel supply is interrupted if the engine is operated within the red marking.
Outside temperature indicator
Warning!
G
The outside temperature indicator is not
designed to serve as an ice-warning device
and is therefore unsuitable for that purpose.
Indicated temperatures just above the
freezing point do not guarantee that the
road surface is free of ice. The road may
still be icy, especially in wooded areas or
on bridges.
The outside temperature is indicated in
the instrument cluster for the driver
( page 25) and in the roof lining
for the rear seat passengers
( pages 33, 35 or 37). For information
on how to select the unit of the displayed temperature, i.e. degrees
Celsius (°C) or degrees Fahrenheit (°F),
see "Selecting temperature display
mode" page 175).
Due to its location, the sensor can be affected by road or engine heat during
idling or slow driving. Therefore, the accuracy of the displayed temperature can
only be verified by comparison to a thermometer placed next to the sensor, not
by comparison to external displays (e.g.
bank signs etc.).
When moving the vehicle into colder ambient temperatures (e.g. when leaving
your garage), you will notice a delay before the lower temperature is displayed.
A delay also occurs when ambient temperatures rise. This prevents inaccurate
temperature indications caused by heat
radiated from the engine during idling
or slow driving.
155
Controls in detail
Instrument cluster
Speedometer
The speed is indicated in the instrument
cluster for the driver ( page 25) and in
the roof lining for the rear seat passengers ( pages 33, 35 or 37).
The segments in the speedometer of the
instrument cluster show you which speed
range is available to you.
Cruise control operation:
Segments come on from the stored
speed to the maximum speed.
Distronic** operation:
One or two segments come on in the
range for the stored speed.
156
Clock
The time is indicated in the instrument
cluster for the driver in the tachometer
display ( page 25) and in the roof lining
for the rear seat passengers
( pages 33, 35 or 37).
You can adjust the clock using the
COMAND system. Refer to the separate
COMAND and Rear-Cabin Audiovisual
System operating instructions.
Controls in detail
Control system
Control system
The control system is activated as soon as
the SmartKey in the starter switch is
turned to position 1. The control system
enables you to
call up information about your vehicle
change vehicle settings
For example, you can use the control system to find out when your vehicle is next
due for service, to set the language for
messages in the multifunction display,
and much more.
i
The displays for the audio systems
(radio, CD player) will appear in English, regardless of the language
selected.
Warning!
G
Multifunction display
A driver’s attention to the road and traffic
conditions must always be his/her primary
focus when driving.
For your safety and the safety of others, selecting features through the multifunction
steering wheel should only be done by the
driver when traffic and road conditions
permit it to be done safely.
1 Trip odometer
2 Main odometer
Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph
(approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is
covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14 m) every second.
The control system relays information to
the multifunction display.
157
Controls in detail
Control system
Multifunction steering wheel
The displays in the multifunction display
and the settings in the control system are
controlled by the buttons on the multifunction steering wheel.
1 Multifunction display
Operating control system
2 Selecting the submenu or setting
the volume:
Press button
æ
up/to increase
ç
down/to decrease
3 Telephone:
Press button
s
to take a call
to dial a call
t
to end a call
to reject an incoming call
4 Menu systems:
Press button
è
for next menu
ÿ
for previous menu
5 Moving within a menu:
Press button
158
j
for next display
k
for previous display
Controls in detail
Control system
Pressing any of the buttons on the multifunction steering wheel will alter what is
shown in the multifunction display.
It is helpful to think of the menus, and
the functions within each menu, as being
arranged in a circular pattern.
The information available in the multifunction display is arranged in menus,
each containing a number of functions
or submenus.
If you press button è or ÿ
repeatedly, you will pass through
each menu one after the other.
If you press button k or j
repeatedly, you will pass through
each function display, one after the
other, in the current menu.
The individual functions are then found
within the relevant menu (radio or CD
operations under AUDIO, for example).
These functions serve to call up relevant
information or to customize the settings
for your vehicle.
In the SETTINGS menu, instead of functions you will find a number of submenus
for calling up and changing settings. For
instructions on using these submenus,
see "Settings menu" ( page 172).
The number of menus available in the
system depends on which optional
equipment is installed in your vehicle.
The menus are described on the following pages.
159
Controls in detail
Control system
Menus
160
This is what you will see when you scroll
through the menus.
The table on the next page provides an
overview of the individual menus.
Controls in detail
Control system
Menus, submenus and functions
Menu 1
Menu 2
Menu 3
Menu 4
Menu 5
Menu 6
Standard
display
Audio
Telephone
Navigation
Distronic**
Trip computer Vehicle status mes- Settings
sage memory
( page 162) ( page 163) ( page 165) ( page 168) ( page 168) ( page 169)
Commands/submenus
Call up main- Select radio
tenance ser- station
vice display
Check tire
pressure
Select satel- Search for
lite radio sta- name in
tion*
phone book
Check enOperate the
gine oil level CD player
Digital
speedometer
Load phone
book
Activate
route
guidance
Call up
settings
Menu 7
( page 171)
Menu 8
( page 172)
Fuel consump- Call up vehicle mal- Reset to faction statistics
function, warning tory settings
after start
and system status
messages stored in
memory
Fuel consumption statistics
since the last
reset
Instrument
cluster
submenu
Call up range
Lighting
submenu
Vehicle
submenu
Convenience
submenu
161
Controls in detail
Control system
i
The headings used in the menus table
are designed to facilitate navigation
within the system and are not necessarily identical to those shown in the
control system displays.
Standard display menu
In basic mode, the multifunction display
shows the trip odometer and the main
odometer. This is known as the standard
display.
The first function displayed in each
menu will automatically show you
which part of the system you are in.
The following functions are available:
Function
Page
Calling up maintenance service
display
373
Checking tire pressure
365
Checking engine oil level
357
Calling up digital speedometer
162
Calling up digital speedometer
Press button k or j repeatedly
1 Trip odometer
2 Main odometer
until you see the digital speedometer
appear in the multifunction display.
In case you see another display, press
button è or ÿ repeatedly until the
standard display appears.
The current vehicle speed is shown in
the multifunction display.
You can select the functions in the standard display menu with button k
or j.
Current vehicle speed
162
Controls in detail
Control system
Audio menu
The functions in the AUDIO menu operate
the audio equipment which you currently have turned on.
If no audio equipment is currently turned
on, the message AUDIO OFF is shown in
the multifunction display.
Selecting radio station
Turn on the radio. Refer to the sepa-
rate COMAND and Rear-Cabin Audiovisual System operating instructions.
Page
Selecting radio station
163
The SIRIUS satellite radio is treated as a
radio application.
Press button è or ÿ repeatedly
Select satellite radio with the corre-
until you see the currently tuned station in the multifunction display.
sponding key on the COMAND
control panel.
Press button è or ÿ repeatedly
The following functions are available:
Function
Selecting satellite radio station
(USA only)
until you see the currently tuned station in the multifunction display.
Selecting satellite radio sta- 163
tion (USA only)
Operating the CD player
164
1 Station frequency
2 Waveband
Press button k or j repeatedly
until the desired station is found.
i
You can only store new stations using
the corresponding feature on the radio. Refer to the separate COMAND
and Rear-Cabin Audiovisual System
operating instructions.
1 SAT mode and preset number
2 Channel name or number
Press button k or j repeatedly
until the desired channel is found.
163
Controls in detail
Control system
i
Operating the CD player
A subscription to satellite radio service provider is required for satellite
radio operation. Contact an authorized Maybach Studio for details.
Turn on the radio and select the CD
For more information, refer to the
separate COMAND and Rear-Cabin
Audiovisual System operating instructions.
Press button è or ÿ repeatedly
player. Refer to the separate
COMAND and Rear-Cabin Audiovisual System operating instructions.
until the settings for the CD currently
being played are shown in the multifunction display.
1 Current track
164
Press button k or j repeatedly
until the desired track is selected.
i
You can only choose a CD using
COMAND. Refer to the separate
COMAND and Rear-Cabin Audiovisual System operating instructions.
Controls in detail
Control system
Telephone menu
Warning!
G
A driver’s attention to the road and traffic
conditions must always be his/her primary
focus when driving. For your safety and
the safety of others, we recommend that
you pull over to a safe location and stop
before making or taking a telephone call.
If you choose to use the telephone while
driving, please use the hands-free device
and only use the telephone when weather,
road and traffic conditions permit.
Some jurisdictions prohibit the driver from
using a cellular telephone while driving a
vehicle.
Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph
(approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is
covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14 m) every second.
Never operate radio transmitters equipped
with a built-in or attached antenna (i.e.
without being connected to an external
antenna) from inside the vehicle while the
engine is running. Doing so could lead to a
malfunction of the vehicle’s electronic system, possibly resulting in an accident and/
or personal injury.
You can use the functions in the PHONE
menu to operate your telephone, provided it is connected to a hands-free system
and switched on.
Switch on the telephone and
COMAND.
Press button ÿ or è on the
steering wheel repeatedly until you
see the PHONE menu in the multifunction display.
The standby message indicates that your
telephone is ready for use and you can
operate it using the control system.
Which messages will appear in the multifunction display field depends on whether your telephone is switched on or off:
If the telephone is off, the message in
the multifunction display is: PLEASE
TURN PHONE ON.
If the telephone is on:
The telephone will then search for a
network. During this time the multifunction display reads NO SERVICE.
As soon as the telephone has found a
network, READY is indicated in the
multifunction display.
165
Controls in detail
Control system
Answering a call
When your telephone is ready to receive
calls, you can answer a call at any time. In
the multifunction display you will then
see the message:
Press button s.
You have answered the call. In the
multifunction display you see the
length of the call positioned above
the number.
i
If you do not wish to accept a call,
press button t.
Ending a call
Press button t.
i
The caller’s number appears only if it
is transmitted.
The caller’s name appears only if the
number and the name are stored in
the phone book.
166
You have ended the call. In the multifunction display you will again see
the standby message.
Dialing a number from the phone book
If your telephone is ready to receive calls,
you may select and dial a number from
the phone book at any time.
Press button ÿ or è repeatedly
until you see the PHONE menu in the
multifunction display.
Press button j or k.
The control system reads the phone
book which is stored in the telephone. This may take up to
30 seconds. In the multifunction display you will see the message LOADING
PHBOOK!.
When the message LOADING PHBOOK!
disappears, the phone book has been
loaded.
Controls in detail
Control system
Press button j or k repeatedly
until the desired name appears in the
multifunction display.
The stored names are displayed in ascending or descending alphabetical
order.
Press button s.
The system dials the selected phone
number.
i
If the connection is successful, the
name of the party you called and
the duration of the call will appear in the multifunction display.
If you press and hold button j
or k for longer than one second,
the system scrolls rapidly through the
list of names until you release the
button again.
Cancel the quick search mode by
pressing t.
Redialing
The control system stores the most recently dialed phone numbers. This eliminates the need to search through your
entire phone book.
Press button ÿ or è repeatedly
until you see the PHONE menu in the
multifunction display.
Press button s.
In the multifunction display you see
the first number in the redial memory.
Press button j or k repeatedly
1 Caller’s name
If no connection is made, the control system stores the dialed number in the redial memory.
until the desired name appears in the
multifunction display.
i
If you do not want to use the telephone, press button t.
Press button s.
The control system dials the selected
phone number.
167
Controls in detail
Control system
Navigation menu
The NAVI menu contains the functions
needed to operate your navigation system.
until you see NAVI in the multifunction display.
Distronic** menu
Use the DISTRONIC menu to display the
current settings for your Distronic system. What information is shown in the
multifunction display depends on
whether the Distronic system is active or
inactive.
If the navigation system is switched
off, the message NAVI OFF is shown in
the multifunction display.
Please refer to the "Driving systems" section of this manual ( page 236) for instructions on how to activate Distronic.
If the navigation system is on and no
destination has been entered, you
will see the current direction in which
the vehicle is moving and the names
of streets in the multifunction display.
Press button è or ÿ repeatedly
Please refer to the separate COMAND
and Rear-Cabin Audiovisual System manual for instructions on how to activate
the route guidance system.
Press button è or ÿ repeatedly
until you see one of the following
two pictures in the multifunction display.
1 Vehicle ahead, if detected
2 Actual distance to vehicle ahead
3 Preset distance threshold to vehicle
ahead
4 Your vehicle
5 Symbol for activated distance warning function
Distronic activated
Distronic deactivated
When Distronic is deactivated, you will
see the standard display.
When you activate Distronic, you will see
the set speed for about five seconds in
the Distronic display. The following display then appears:
1 Distronic activated
168
Controls in detail
Control system
i
Trip computer menu
Use the trip computer menu to call up
statistical data on your vehicle. The following information is available:
Function
Page
Fuel consumption statistics
after start
169
Fuel consumption statistics
since last reset
170
When you restart the engine, the
AFTER START display flashes for:
a distance of approximately
1.25 miles (two kilometers)
or
Resetting fuel consumption sta- 170
tistics
Call up range (distance to
empty)
Each time you call up the trip computer, the last function used appears
as the first display.
Incorporating statistics from the previous journey in the consumption statistics
170
1
2
3
4
Distance driven since start
Time elapsed since start
Average fuel consumption since start
Average speed since start
a duration of two minutes
During this period, the data from the
previous journey can be incorporated as
follows:
Press reset button J ( page 25) in
the instrument cluster.
Fuel consumption statistics after start
The statistics will be incorporated.
Press button ÿ or è repeatedly
i
until you see the first function of the
trip computer menu.
Press button j or k repeatedly
If you do not press reset button J,
the consumption statistics will be reset to 0.
until you see AFTER START in the multifunction display.
169
Controls in detail
Control system
Fuel consumption since last reset
Resetting fuel consumption statistics
Call up range (distance to empty)
Press button ÿ or è repeatedly
Press button ÿ or è repeatedly
Press button ÿ or è repeatedly
until you see the first function of the
trip computer menu.
until you see the first function of the
trip computer menu.
until you see the first function of the
trip computer menu.
Press button j or k repeatedly
Press button j or k repeatedly
Press button j or k repeatedly
until you see AFTER RESET in the multifunction display.
until you see the reading that you
want to reset in the multifunction
display.
Press and hold reset button J
( page 25) in the instrument cluster
until the value is reset to 0.
1 Distance driven since last reset
2 Time elapsed since last reset
3 Average fuel consumption since last
reset
4 Average speed since last reset
170
until you see RANGE in the multifunction display.
In the multifunction display you will
see the calculated range based on the
current fuel tank level.
Controls in detail
Control system
Vehicle status message memory
menu
Use the vehicle status message memory
menu to scan malfunction and warning
messages that may be stored in the system. Such messages appear in the multifunction display and are based on
conditions or system status the vehicle’s
system has recorded.
Warning!
G
Malfunction and warning messages are
only indicated for certain systems and are
intentionally not very detailed. The malfunction and warning messages are simply
a reminder with respect to the operation
of certain systems and do not replace the
owner’s and/or driver’s responsibility to
maintain the vehicle’s operating safety by
having all required maintenance and safety checks performed on the vehicle and by
bringing the vehicle to an authorized
Maybach Studio to address the malfunction and warning messages ( page 391).
Press button è or ÿ repeatedly
until the vehicle status message memory appears in the multifunction display.
No vehicle status messages
If no conditions are recorded in the
memory, the message in the multifunction display is:
NO MESSAGES
Vehicle status messages have been recorded
If conditions have occurred causing status messages to be recorded, the number
of messages appears in the multifunction
display:
Press button k or j.
The stored messages will now be displayed in order. See the "Practical
hints" section for malfunction and
warning messages ( page 391).
Should the vehicle’s system record any
conditions while driving, the number of
messages will reappear in the multifunction display when the SmartKey in the
starter switch is turned to position 0 or
removed from the starter switch. If you
press reset button J ( page 25) on the
right hand side of the instrument cluster,
the next message will be displayed immediately.
i
The vehicle status message memory
will be cleared when you switch on
ignition. You will then only see highpriority messages in the multifunction display. These are highlighted in
red color ( page 391).
1 Number of messages
171
Controls in detail
Control system
Settings menu
In the SETTINGS menu there are two
functions:
The function TO RESET PRESS R BUTTON
FOR 3 SEC., with which you can reset
all the settings to the original factory
settings.
A collection of submenus with which
you can make individual settings for
your vehicle.
Press button è or ÿ repeatedly
until you see SETTINGS in the multifunction display.
Function
Page
i
Resetting all settings
172
Submenus in the Settings menu
173
The settings you have changed will
not be reset unless you confirm the
action by pressing reset button J
a second time. After approximately
five seconds, the SETTINGS menu appears again.
Resetting the functions of a sub- 173
menu
Instrument cluster submenu
175
Lighting submenu
176
Vehicle submenu
181
Convenience submenu
182
Resetting all settings
You can reset all the functions of all submenus to the factory settings.
Press reset button J ( page 25) in
the instrument cluster for approximately three seconds.
In the display you will see the request
to press reset button J again to confirm.
Press reset button J again.
The functions of all the submenus will
reset to factory settings.
172
Due to safety reasons, resetting all of
the settings while driving will not reset all of the values in the LIGHTING or
the VEHICLE menu.
Controls in detail
Control system
Submenus in the Settings menu
Resetting the functions of a submenu
i
Press button k or j.
For each submenu you can reset all the
functions to the factory settings.
The settings you have changed will
not be reset unless you confirm the
action by pressing reset button J
a second time. After approximately
five seconds, the SETTINGS menu appears again.
The various submenus appear in the
display.
Move to a function in the submenu.
Press reset button J ( page 25) in
the instrument cluster for approximately three seconds.
In the display you will see the request
to press reset button J again to confirm.
Press button æ or ç.
The selection marker moves to the
next submenu.
Due to safety reasons, resetting all of
the settings while driving will not reset all of the values in the LIGHTING or
the VEHICLE menu.
Press reset button J again.
All functions of the submenu will reset to factory settings.
The submenus are arranged by hierarchy. Scroll down with button ç, scroll
up with button æ.
Move within the submenus with
button k or j to the individual
functions.
The settings themselves are made with
button æ or ç.
173
Controls in detail
Control system
The table below shows what settings can
be changed within the various menus.
Detailed instructions on making individual settings can be found on the following pages.
:
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
LIGHTING
VEHICLE
CONVENIENCE
Selecting temperature display Setting daytime running lamp Setting automatic locking
mode
mode (USA only)
Setting key dependency
Selecting speedometer display Setting locator lighting
mode
Activating easy-entry/exit
feature
Selecting language
Setting night security illumination
Setting parking position for
exterior rear view mirrors
Setting interior lighting delayed shut-off
Setting fold-in function for exterior rear view mirrors
Setting ambient lighting
174
Controls in detail
Control system
Instrument cluster submenu
Selecting temperature display mode
Selecting speedometer display mode
Access the INST. CLUS. submenu via the
SETTINGS menu. Use the INST. CLUS. submenu to change the instrument cluster
display settings. The following functions
are available:
Move the selection marker with
Move the selection marker with
Function
Page
Selecting temperature display
mode
175
Selecting speedometer display
mode
175
Selecting language
176
button æ or ç to the INST.
CLUS. submenu.
button æ or ç to the INST.
CLUS. submenu.
Press button j or k repeatedly
Press button j or k repeatedly
until you see TEMP. INDICATOR in the
multifunction display.
until you see DISPLAY VALUES IN in the
multifunction display.
The selection marker is on the current
setting.
The selection marker is on the current
setting.
Press button æ or ç to set the
temperature unit to degrees Celsius
(°C) or degrees Fahrenheit (°F).
Press button æ or ç to set
speedometer unit to MILES or KM.
175
Controls in detail
Control system
Selecting language
Move the selection marker with
Press button æ or ç to select
the language to be used for the multifunction display messages.
Lighting submenu
German
until you see LANGUAGE in the multifunction display.
English
Access the LIGHTING submenu via the
SETTINGS menu. Use the LIGHTING submenu to change the lamp and lighting
settings on your vehicle. The following
functions are available:
The selection marker is on the current
setting.
French
Function
Page
Italian
Spanish
Setting daytime running lamp
mode (USA only)
177
Setting locator lighting
178
button æ or ç to the INST.
CLUS. submenu.
Press button j or k repeatedly
Available languages:
Setting night security illumina- 179
tion
176
Setting interior lighting delayed shut-off
180
Setting ambient lighting
180
Controls in detail
Control system
Setting daytime running lamp mode
(USA only)
Press button æ or ç to select
MANUAL or daytime running lamp
(CONSTANT) mode. This function is not
available in countries where daytime
running lamps are mandatory.
i
This function is not available in countries where the daytime running
lamp mode is mandatory and therefore in a constant mode.
Move the selection marker with
button æ or ç to the LIGHTING
submenu.
Press button j or k repeatedly
until you see LIGHTING CIRCUIT HEADLAMP MODE in the multifunction display.
The selection marker is on the current
setting.
With daytime running lamp mode activated and the exterior lamp switch in position M or U, the low beam
headlamps are switched on when the engine is running.
In low ambient light conditions the following lamps will switch on additionally:
Parking lamps
Tail lamps
License plate lamps
Side marker lamps
i
If you turn the exterior lamp switch to
another position, the respective
lamp(s) will switch on.
For safety reasons, resetting
the LIGHTING submenu to factory settings ( page 173) while driving will
not reset the daytime running lamp
mode.
In the display you will then see the
message: LIGHTING – CANNOT BE COMPLETELY RESET TO FACTORY SETTINGS
WHILE DRIVING.
For more information on the daytime
running lamp mode, see "Lighting"
( page 145).
177
Controls in detail
Control system
Setting locator lighting
With the locator lighting feature activated and the exterior lamp switch in
position U, the following lamps will
switch on when the vehicle is unlocked
with the SmartKey or KEYLESS-GO**
during darkness:
Parking lamps
Tail lamps
License plate lamps
Side marker lamps
Front fog lamps
Exterior rear view mirrors
178
The locator lighting switches off when
the driver’s door is opened.
The selection marker is on the current
setting.
If you do not open a door after unlocking with the SmartKey or KEYLESS-GO**,
the lamps will switch off automatically
after approximately 40 seconds.
Move the selection marker with
button æ or ç to the LIGHTING
submenu.
Press button j or k repeatedly
until you LOCATOR LIGHTING in the multifunction display.
Press button æ or ç to switch
the locator lighting function ON.
Turn the exterior lamp switch to
position U when exiting the vehicle ( page 143).
The locator lighting feature is activated.
Controls in detail
Control system
Setting night security illumination
(Headlamps delayed shut-off)
Use this function to set whether and how
long you would like the exterior lamps to
illuminate during darkness after exiting
the vehicle and all doors closed. With the
delayed shut-off feature activated and
the exterior lamp switch in position U
before the engine is turned off, the following lamps will switch on after you
have removed the SmartKey from the
starter switch:
To select delayed shut-off period:
Move the selection marker with
button æ or ç to the LIGHTING
submenu.
Press button æ or ç to select the
desired lamp-on period.
You can select:
0 S, the delayed shut-off feature is
deactivated.
15 S, 30 S, 45 S, or 60 S, the delayed shut-off feature is activated.
Press button j or k repeatedly
until you see HEADLAMPS DELAYED
SWITCH-OFF in the multifunction display.
The selection marker is on the current
setting.
Turn the exterior lamp switch to
position U before turning off the
engine.
Parking lamps
You can temporarily deactivate the delayed shut-off feature:
Tail lamps
Before leaving the vehicle, turn the
License plate lamps
Side marker lamps
Front fog lamps
If you do not open a door after removing
the SmartKey, the lamps will automatically shut off after 60 seconds.
i
You can reactivate this function within ten minutes by opening a door.
SmartKey in the starter switch to
position 0.
Turn the SmartKey in the starter
switch to position 2 and back to 0.
The delayed shut-off feature is deactivated. It will reactivate as soon as
you reinsert the SmartKey in the
starter switch.
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO**:
Press the KEYLESS-GO start/stop but-
ton on the gear selector lever
( page 55).
179
Controls in detail
Control system
Setting interior lighting delayed shutoff
Use this function to set whether and how
long you would like the interior lighting
to remain lit during darkness after you
have removed the SmartKey from the
starter switch.
Move the selection marker with
button æ or ç to the LIGHTING
submenu.
Press button j or k repeatedly
until you see INTERIOR LIGHTING DELAYED SWITCH-OFF in the multifunction display.
The selection marker is on the current
setting.
Press button æ or ç to select the
desired lamp-on time period.
180
You can select:
0 S, the delayed shut-off feature is
deactivated.
5 S, 10 S, 15 S, or 20 S, the delayed
shut-off feature is activated with the
desired lamp-on period.
The selection marker is on the current
setting.
Setting ambient lighting
Using this function, you can adjust the
brightness of the ambient lighting.
Move the selection marker with
button æ or ç to the LIGHTING
submenu.
Press button j or k repeatedly
until you see AMBIENT LIGHT in the
multifunction display.
Press button æ or ç to select the
brightness of the lighting.
The setting LEVEL 1 represents the
darkest level and setting LEVEL 5 the
brightest level.
The ambient light is switched off at
setting OFF.
Controls in detail
Control system
Vehicle submenu
Setting automatic locking
Access the VEHICLE submenu via the SETINGS menu. Use the VEHICLE submenu to
make general vehicle settings. The
following functions are available:
Function
Page
Use this function to activate or deactivate the automatic central locking. With
the automatic central locking system activated, the vehicle is centrally locked at
vehicle speeds of approximately 9 mph
(15 km/h).
Set automatic locking
181
Move the selection marker with
Press button j or k repeatedly
until you see AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCK in
the multifunction display.
The selection marker is on the current
setting.
button æ or ç to the Vehicle submenu.
Press button æ or ç to switch
AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCK ON or OFF.
181
Controls in detail
Control system
Convenience submenu
Setting key dependency
Access the CONVENIENCE submenu via the
SETTINGS menu. Use the CONVENIENCE submenu to change the settings for a number of convenience features. The
following functions are available:
Function
Page
Setting key dependency
182
Use this function to set whether the
memory settings for the seats, the steering wheel, the mirrors, the automatic climate control, the audio system and other
settings of the control system should be
stored separately for each SmartKey or
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO
( page 140).
Activating easy-entry/exit feature
183
Move the selection marker with
Setting parking position for ex- 184
terior rear view mirrors
Setting fold-in function for ex- 184
terior rear view mirrors
182
Press button j or k repeatedly
until you see SETTINGS KEY-DEPENDENT
in the multifunction display.
The selection marker is on the current
setting.
button æ or ç to the CONVENIENCE
submenu.
Press button æ or ç to set key
dependency to ON or OFF.
Controls in detail
Control system
Move the selection marker with
Activating easy-entry/exit feature
Use this function to activate and deactivate the easy-entry/exit feature
( page 127).
Warning!
G
You must make sure no one can become
trapped or injured by the moving steering
wheel and driver’s seat when the easy-entry/exit feature is activated.
button æ or ç to
the CONVENIENCE submenu.
The following settings are available for
the easy-entry/exit feature:
OFF
until you see EASY-ENTRY FEATURE ACTIVATE in the multifunction display.
The easy-entry/exit feature is deactivated.
STEER. COL
The selection marker is on the current
setting.
Only the steering column is moved.
ST.COL+SEAT
Both the steering column and the driver’s
seat are moved.
Press button j or k repeatedly
To cancel seat/steering wheel movement,
do one of the following:
Press seat adjustment switch
( page 58).
Move steering column stalk
( page 60).
Press button æ or ç to change
the easy-entry/exit setting.
Press the memory button
( page 141).
The steering wheel and driver’s seat stop
moving.
Do not leave children unattended in the
vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. Children could open the driver’s door
and unintentionally activate the easy-entry/exit feature, which could result in an
accident and/or serious personal injury.
183
Controls in detail
Control system
Setting parking position for exterior rear
view mirror
Setting fold-in function for exterior rear
view mirrors
Use the MIRROR SETTING WHEN PARKING
function to select whether the passenger
side exterior rear view mirror should be
turned downward during parking maneuvers when reverse gear is engaged.
For additional information ( page 194).
Using this function, you can set the exterior rear view mirrors to be automatically
folded in when you lock your vehicle
( page 195).
Move the selection marker to
the CONVENIENCE submenu using
button æ or ç.
Press button j or k repeatedly
until the message MIRROR SETTING
WHEN PARKING appears in the display.
The selection marker is on the current
setting.
Press button æ or ç to switch
function ON or OFF.
184
The selection marker is on the current
setting.
Move the selection marker to
the CONVENIENCE submenu using
button æ or ç.
Press button j or k repeatedly
until the message FOLD IN MIRRORS
WHEN LOCKING appears in the display.
Press button æ or ç to switch the
automatic fold-in setting for the mirrors ON or OFF when the vehicle is
locked.
Controls in detail
Automatic transmission
Automatic transmission
For information on driving with an automatic transmission, see "Automatic
transmission" ( page 66).
Your vehicles transmission adapts its
gear shifting process to your individual
driving style by continually adjusting the
shift points up or down. These shift point
adjustments are performed based on
current operating and driving conditions.
If the operating conditions change, the
automatic transmission reacts by adjusting its gear shift program.
i
During the brief warm-up the transmission upshifting is delayed. This allows the catalytic converter to heat
up more quickly to operating temperature.
Gearshift pattern for automatic transmission
The automatic transmission selects individual gears automatically, depending
on:
the gear selector lever position D
( page 188) with gear
ranges 4, 3, 2, 1 ( page 187)
the selected program mode (C/S)
( page 189)
the position of the accelerator pedal
( page 190)
the vehicle speed
1 Current gear range/gear selector lever position
2 Current program mode
The current gear range/gear selector lever position 1 and program mode 2
appear in the tachometer display.
185
Controls in detail
Automatic transmission
Warning!
G
It is dangerous to shift the gear selector lever out of P or N if the engine speed is
higher than idle speed. If your foot is not
firmly on the brake pedal, the vehicle
could accelerate quickly forward or reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle
and hit someone or something. Only shift
into gear when the engine is idling normally and when your right foot is firmly on
the brake pedal.
When the gear selector lever is in
position D, you can influence transmission shifting by:
limiting the gear range
changing gears manually
One-touch gearshifting
Even with an automatic transmission you
can change the gears manually when the
gear selector lever is in position D.
186
Downshifting
Upshifting
Briefly press the gear selector lever to
Briefly press the gear selector lever to
the left in the D– direction.
the right in the D+ direction.
The transmission will shift from the
current gear to the next lower gear.
This action simultaneously limits the
gear range of the transmission
( page 187).
The transmission will shift from the
current gear to the next higher gear
as permitted by the shift program.
This action simultaneously extends
the gear range of the transmission.
Warning!
G
On slippery road surfaces, never downshift
in order to obtain braking action. This
could result in drive wheel slip and reduced vehicle control. Your vehicle’s ABS
will not prevent this type of loss of control.
i
To avoid overrevving the engine
when the gear selector lever is moved
to the D– direction, the transmission
will not shift to a lower gear if the engine's max. speed would be exceeded.
Canceling gear range limit
Press and hold the gear selector lever
in the D+ direction until D reappears
in the tachometer display.
The transmission will shift from the
current gear range directly to gear
range D.
Shifting into optimal gear range
Press and hold the gear selector lever
in the D– direction.
The transmission will automatically
select the gear range suited for optimal acceleration and deceleration.
This will involve shifting down one or
more gears.
Controls in detail
Automatic transmission
Gear ranges
With the gear selector lever in
position D, you can limit the transmission’s gear range by pressing the lever to
the left (D-), and reverse the gear range
limit by pressing the lever to the right
(D+).
The selected gear range will appear in
the tachometer display ( page 185). If
you press on the accelerator when the
engine has reached its rpm limit, the
transmission will upshift beyond any
gear range limit selected.
Effect
Effect
é
The transmission shifts through
fourth gear only.
ç
è
The transmission shifts through
third gear only.
Allows the use of engine’s
braking power when driving
With this selection you can use
the braking effect of the engine.
on steep downgrades
in mountainous regions
under extreme operating
conditions
æ
The transmission shifts through
second gear only.
The transmission operates in
first gear only.
For maximum use of engine’s
braking effect on very steep or
lengthy downgrades.
187
Controls in detail
Automatic transmission
Gear selector lever position
Effect
ì
ë
Gear selector position when
the vehicle is parked. Only
place gear selector lever in
position P when vehicle is
stopped. The park position is
not intended to serve as a
brake when the vehicle is
parked. Rather, the driver
should always set the parking
brake in addition to placing the
gear selector lever in position P
to secure the vehicle.
í
Reverse gear
Place gear selector lever in
position R only when vehicle is
stopped.
188
!
Neutral
Coasting the vehicle, or driving for
any other reason with gear selector
lever in N can result in transmission
damage that is not covered by the
Maybach Limited Warranty.
No power is transmitted from
the engine to the drive axle.
When the brakes are released,
the vehicle can be moved freely
(pushed or towed).
Park position
The SmartKey can only be removed from the starter switch
with the gear selector lever in
position P. With the SmartKey
removed, the gear selector lever is locked in position P.
Effect
To avoid damage to the transmission, never engage N while
driving.
If the ESP is deactivated or malfunctioning:
Only move gear selector lever
to N if the vehicle is in danger
of skidding, e.g. on icy roads.
ê
Drive
The transmission shifts automatically. All five forward gears
are available.
Warning!
G
Getting out of your vehicle with the gear
selector lever not fully engaged in
position P is dangerous. Also, position P
alone is not intended to or capable of preventing your vehicle from moving, possibly
hitting people or objects.
Always set the parking brake in addition to
shifting to position P ( page 68).
When parked on an incline, turn the front
wheels towards the road curb.
Do not park this vehicle in areas where
combustible materials such as grass, hay or
leaves can come into contact with the hot
exhaust system, as these materials could be
ignited and cause a vehicle fire.
Controls in detail
Automatic transmission
Warning!
G
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Children could move the gear selector lever from position P, which could result in
an accident and/or serious personal injury.
Automatic shift program
The program mode selector switch is located on the lower part of the front center console.
!
Never change the program mode
when the gear selector lever is out of
position P. This could result in a
change of driving characteristics for
which you may not be prepared.
i
The last selected program mode
(C or S) is switched on when the engine is restarted in the automatic program mode.
1 Program mode selector switch
C Comfort
For comfort driving
S Sport
For standard driving
189
Controls in detail
Automatic transmission
Press program mode selector
switch 1 repeatedly until the letter
of the desired program mode appears in the tachometer display
( page 185).
Select C for comfort driving:
Stopping
Driving tips
Accelerator position
When you stop briefly, e.g. at traffic
lights:
Your driving style influences the transmission’s shifting behavior:
Leave the transmission in gear.
Less throttle
Earlier upshifting
Later upshifting
Hold the vehicle with the brake.
When you stop longer with the engine
idling or on an uphill gradient:
Traction and driving stability are
improved on icy roads.
More throttle
Upshifts occur earlier even when
you give more gas. The engine
then operates at lower rpms and
the wheels are less likely to spin.
Kickdown
Move gear selector lever to position
Use kickdown when you want maximum
acceleration.
Set the parking brake.
Press the accelerator past the point of
resistance.
The transmission shifts into a lower
gear.
Ease up on the accelerator when you
have reached the desired speed.
The transmission shifts up again.
190
P.
Controls in detail
Automatic transmission
Maneuvering
When you maneuver in tight areas, e.g.
when pulling into a parking space:
Control the vehicle speed by gradual-
ly releasing the brakes.
Accelerate gently.
Never abruptly step on the accelera-
tor.
Emergency operation
(Limp Home Mode)
If vehicle acceleration worsens or the
transmission no longer shifts, the transmission is most likely operating in limp
home mode (emergency operation). In
this mode, only second gear and reverse
gear can be activated.
Restart the engine.
Move gear selector lever to
position D (for second gear) or R.
Have the transmission checked at an
authorized Maybach Studio as soon
as possible.
Stop the vehicle.
Move gear selector lever to P.
Working on the vehicle
Turn off the engine.
Warning!
G
Wait at least ten seconds before re-
starting.
When working on the vehicle, set the parking brake and move gear selector lever to
position P. Otherwise the vehicle could roll
away.
191
Controls in detail
Good visibility
For information on the windshield wipers, see "Windshield wipers"
( page 71).
Headlamp cleaning system
The switch is located on the left side of
the dashboard.
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Press button 1.
The headlamps are cleaned with a
high-pressure water jet.
For information on filling up the washer
reservoir, see "Windshield and headlamp washer system" ( page 469).
Rear view mirrors
For information on setting the rear view
mirrors, see "Mirrors" ( page 61).
Automatic antiglare rear view mirrors
The reflection brightness of the exterior
rear view mirror on the driver’s side and
the interior rear view mirror will respond
automatically to glare when
the automatic antiglare function is
activated ( page 193)
the ignition is switched on
and
1 Headlamp washer button
192
incoming light from headlamps falls
on the sensor in the interior rear view
mirror
The rear view mirror will not react if
reverse gear is engaged
the interior lighting is turned on
Controls in detail
Good visibility
Warning!
G
The automatic antiglare function does not
react if incoming light is not aimed directly
at sensors in the interior rear view mirror.
The interior rear view mirror and the exterior rear view mirror on the driver’s side do
not react, for example, if the rear window
curtain is closed.
Glare can endanger you and others.
Warning!
G
In the case of an accident liquid electrolyte
may escape from the mirror housing if the
mirror glass breaks.
!
Deactivating
Electrolyte drops coming into contact
with the vehicle paint finish can be
completely removed only while in the
liquid state by applying plenty of water.
Warning!
G
Exercise care when using the passenger
side exterior rear view mirror. The mirror
surface is convex (outwardly curved surface for a wider field of view). Objects in
mirror are closer than they appear. Check
your interior rear view mirror or glance
over your shoulder before changing lanes.
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Press button 1.
The green indicator lamp in
button 1 goes out.
Electrolyte has an irritating effect. Do not
allow the liquid to come into contact with
eyes, skin, clothing, or respiratory system.
In case it does, immediately flush affected
area with water, and seek medical help if
necessary.
193
Controls in detail
Good visibility
Activating
Press button 1 again.
The green indicator lamp in
button 1 comes on.
Activating exterior rear view mirror
parking position
The buttons are located on the driver’s
door.
Follow these steps to activate the mirror
parking position so that the passengerside exterior rear view mirror will be
turned downward to the stored position.
Make sure you have stored a parking
i
position for the passenger-side exterior rear view mirror ( page 142).
The setting will remain stored even
when you remove the SmartKey from
the starter switch.
Make sure the MIRROR SETTING WHEN
PARKING function in the CONVENIENCE
submenu in the control system is
switched to ON ( page 184).
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Press button 2 for the passenger-
side exterior rear view mirror.
1 Driver’s side exterior rear view mirror
2 Passenger-side exterior rear view mirror
194
Place the gear selector lever in re-
verse gear R.
The passenger-side exterior rear view
mirror will be turned downward to
the stored position.
Controls in detail
Good visibility
The exterior rear view mirror returns to
its previously stored driving position:
10 seconds after you put the gear selector lever out of position R
immediately once you exceed a vehicle speed of approximately 6 mph
(10 km/h)
immediately when you press the button for driver’s side exterior rear view
mirror 1
Electrically folding exterior rear view
mirrors
!
Before you drive the vehicle through
an automatic car wash, fold the exterior mirrors in. Otherwise they may be
damaged.
Folding exterior rear view mirrors in and
out automatically
When the corresponding function in the
control system is activated ( page 184):
The exterior rear view mirrors automatically fold in as soon as the vehicle
is locked from the outside.
The exterior rear view mirrors automatically fold out as soon as the vehicle is unlocked and the driver’s or
passenger door are subsequently
opened.
195
Controls in detail
Good visibility
Folding the exterior rear view mirrors in
and out manually
The exterior rear view mirrors can vibrate
if they are not completely folded out.
The button is located on the driver’s
door.
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Briefly press button 1.
Press button 1 again.
The mirrors fold out.
The mirrors fold in.
!
i
If an exterior mirror housing is forcibly pushed forward (hit from the
rear), reposition it manually by applying firm pressure until it snaps back
into place.
If you are driving at more than approximately 9 mph (15 km/h), you
will not be able to fold the exterior
mirrors in.
If an exterior mirror is forcibly pushed
rearward (hit from the front) press
button 1 to fold mirrors in, then
press button 1 to fold mirrors out.
Do not force mirror by hand as it may
damage the adjustment mechanism.
1 Button for folding exterior mirrors in
and out
196
The mirror housing is now properly
positioned and you can adjust the
mirror normally.
Controls in detail
Good visibility
Glare from the front
Glare from the front and sides
i
1 Sun visor
For information on vanity mirrors
( page 257).
Swing sun visor 1 down.
1 Sun visor
2 Mounting
3 Additional sun visor
Sun visors
The sun visors protect you from sun glare
while driving.
Warning!
G
Do not use the vanity mirror while driving.
Keep the mirrors in the sun visors closed
while the vehicle is in motion. Reflected
glare can endanger you and others.
Swing sun visor 1 down.
Disengage sun visor 1 from
mounting 2.
Pivot sun visor to the side.
The sun visors are extendable.
Adjust the sun visors by pushing or
pulling in the direction of the arrows.
Swing additional sun visor 3 down.
197
Controls in detail
Good visibility
Rear window defroster
The rear window defroster consumes
high levels of energy. To keep battery
drain to a minimum, switch off the defroster as soon as the rear window is
clear. The heating time varies depending
on outside temperature and driving conditions, ranging from approximately
six minutes at temperatures above 43°F
to over 20 minutes at temperatures below -14°F and at high speed.
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Activating
Press button F ( page 202).
The indicator lamp on the button
comes on.
Deactivating
Warning!
G
Any accumulation of snow and ice should
be removed from the rear window before
driving. Visibility could otherwise be impaired, endangering you and others.
Press button F again.
The indicator lamp on the button
goes out.
!
If the indicator lamp F is flashing,
there is insufficient voltage due to
too many electrical consumers are
turned on. The rear window defroster switches off automatically.
The rear window defroster will switch
back on again automatically as soon
as sufficient voltage is available.
198
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
Automatic climate control
The automatic climate control is a 4-zone
intelligent climate control system. Your
vehicle interior is divided into four zones.
With the help of a sun sensor, the automatic climate control determines the relation of the sun to the vehicle and
automatically adjusts the inside temperature for every individual zone.
You can set the temperature for each of
the four zones separately. These settings
can be assigned to a SmartKey and
stored in memory ( page 140).
The automatic climate control is operational whenever the engine is running. It
cools the vehicle’s interior according to
the angle and intensity of the sun’s rays,
the outside temperature and the selected temperature.
i
The activated charcoal filter, when
switched on, markedly reduces odors
and removes pollutants from the air entering the passenger compartment.
Warning!
G
Follow the recommended settings for
heating and cooling given on the following pages. Otherwise the windows could
fog up, impairing visibility and endangering you and others.
Nearly all dust particles, pollutants and
odors are filtered out before outside air
enters the passenger compartment
through the air distribution system.
i
Severe conditions (e.g. strong air pollution) may require replacement of
the filter before its scheduled interval. A clogged filter will reduce the
air volume to the interior.
If the vehicle interior is hot, ventilate
the interior before driving off.
Keep the air intake grille in front of
the windshield free of snow, leaves,
sticks and any other debris.
Do not obstruct air volume by placing
objects on the air flow-through exhaust slots below the rear window.
The air conditioning will not engage (no
cooling) if the AC OFF mode is selected
( page 208).
Condensation may drip from underneath the vehicle. This is normal and
not an indication of a malfunction.
199
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
Cockpit
200
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
1
Side air vent, left, adjustable
7
Thumbwheel for right center air
vent
2
Center air vent, left, adjustable
3
Fixed air vent
8
Automatic climate control panel
4
Center air vent, right, adjustable
9
5
Side air vent, right, adjustable
Thumbwheel for left center air
vent
6
Thumbwheel for right side air
vent
a
Thumbwheel for left side air vent
Warning!
G
When operating the automatic climate
control, the air that enters the passenger
compartment through the air vents in the
footwell can be very hot or very cold (depending on the set temperature). This may
cause burn or frostbite on unprotected
skin in the immediate area of the air vents.
Always keep sufficient distance between
unprotected parts of the body and the
footwell air vents. If necessary, change the
air flow using the air distribution controls
to direct the air away from the footwell air
vents ( page 203).
201
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
1
Air distribution and air volume,
left (automatic)
8
Air distribution, right (manual)
d
AC cooling on/off
2
Air distribution, left (manual)
9
Air distribution and air volume,
right (automatic)
e
Residual heat and ventilation
3
f
Activated charcoal filter
Air volume, left
a
Rear window defroster
g
Air recirculation
4
Temperature control, left
b
h
5
Display
Rear air-conditioning remote control
Windshield and side window defroster
6
Temperature control, right
c
7
Air volume, right
Automatic climate control on/off
button
202
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
Activating the climate control system
i
Adjusting air distribution
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
When operating the climate control
system in automatic mode, you will
only rarely need to adjust the temperature, air volume and air distribution.
Use the air distribution controls 2
and 8 ( page 202) to separately adjust
the air distribution on each side of the
passenger compartment. The following
symbols are found on the controls:
Press button M or U.
Deactivating the climate control system
It is possible to completely deactivate the
automatic climate control system.
Press button M.
!
The fresh air supply to the vehicle interior is shut off. While driving, use
this setting only temporarily, otherwise the windshield could fog up.
Increasing
Push top of temperature control 4
and/or 6 until the display shows the
desired temperature.
The automatic climate control system
will accordingly adjust the interior air
temperature.
Decreasing
Setting the temperature
Use temperature controls 4 for the left
side or 6 ( page 202) for the right side
to separately adjust the air temperature
on each side of the passenger compartment. You should raise or lower the temperature setting in small increments,
preferably starting at 72°F (22°C).
Push bottom of temperature
Symbol Function
Ô
Directs air to the windows
Ø
Directs air to the windows,
footwells, center and side air
vents
Ó
Directs air to the footwell air
vents
Õ
Directs air to the center and
side air vents
control 4 and/or 6 until the display
shows the desired temperature.
The automatic climate control system
will accordingly adjust the interior air
temperature.
203
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
Adjusting manually
Press left or right air distribution
controls 2 and/or 8 ( page 202).
The indicator lamp on the U button goes out.
The air volume is controlled automatically while the air distribution is controlled manually in the respective
zone.
The selected air distribution is shown
in the display.
Adjusting automatically
Press left or right U button.
The indicator lamp on the button
comes on.
The air distribution is adjusted automatically.
Press button , to switch off the air
recirculation ( page 202).
The indicator lamp on the button
goes out.
Adjust left and right center air
vents 2 and 4 upwards
( page 201).
Set blower to the maximum speed.
Increase temperature setting.
Open the side air vents 1 and 5 and
direct them onto the side windows
( page 201).
i
In automatic mode, the automatic climate control is regulated to prevent
the windows from fogging up on the
inside.
Windshield fogged on the outside
Windows fogged on the inside
Press button AC OFF to switch on the
air conditioning ( page 202).
The indicator lamp on the button
goes out.
204
Switch the windshield wipers on.
Press on both U buttons.
The indicator lamp on the button
goes out.
Adjusting air volume
Adjusting manually
Seven blower speeds are available.
Press to decrease or Q to in-
crease air volume to the desired level.
The indicator lamp on the U button goes out.
The air volume is controlled manually
while the air distribution is controlled
automatically in the respective zone.
The selected blower speed is shown
in the display.
Adjusting automatically
Press left or right U button.
The indicator lamp on the button
comes on.
The selected blower speed in the display disappears.
The air volume is adjusted automatically.
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
Maximum cooling MAXCOOL
If the left and right air distribution controls as well as the air volume control are
set to U and there is a high need for
cooling, the display "AUTO MAXCOOL"
appears.
This provides the fastest possible cooling
of the vehicle interior (when windows
and tilt/sliding sunroof are closed).
Defrosting
i
These settings should only be selected for a short time.
Activating
Press button P ( page 202).
The indicator lamp on the button
comes on.
Press button , ( page 202).
The indicator lamp on the button
goes out.
Close center air vents.
Adjust side air vents upwards.
Warning!
G
When the outside temperature is below
41°F (5°C), only switch to air recirculation
mode for short periods to prevent window
fogging.
Deactivating
Press button P ( page 202).
The indicator lamp on the button
goes out. Defrosting is turned off.
Air recirculation mode
Switch to air recirculation mode to prevent unpleasant odors from entering the
vehicle from the outside. This setting cuts
off the intake of outside air and recirculates the air in the passenger compartment.
Activating
Press button , ( page 202).
The indicator lamp on the button
comes on.
i
If you press button , for approximately two seconds, the side windows and the tilt/sliding sunroof will
close.
Switch off air recirculation, if select-
ed.
205
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
Warning!
G
Never operate the side windows and the
tilt/sliding sunroof if there is the possibility
of anyone being harmed by the closing
procedure.
In the event that the procedure causes potential danger, the closing of the side windows can be immediately halted by
pressing the respective window switch.
The closing of the tilt/sliding sunroof can
be immediately halted by moving the tilt/
sliding sunroof switch in the overhead control panel in any direction.
The closing of the side windows and the
tilt/sliding sunroof can be reversed by
again pressing and holding
the , button.
i
i
The air recirculation mode is activated automatically:
If you press button , for approximately two seconds, the side windows and the tilt/sliding sunroof will
return to their previous position.
at high outside temperatures
if the concentration of carbon
monoxide and nitrogen oxide in
the outside air increases beyond a
predetermined level, for example
in a tunnel.
Please note that the charcoal filter
must be activated ( page 202) for
the air recirculation mode to be activated automatically.
If you have turned off the air conditioning ( page 202) or the outside
temperature is below 41°F (5°C), the
air recirculation mode will not switch
on automatically.
Deactivating
Press button , ( page 202).
The indicator lamp on the button
goes out.
206
The air recirculation mode is deactivated
automatically:
after five minutes if the outside temperature is below approximately 41°F
(5°C)
after five minutes if the air conditioning is turned off
after 30 minutes if the outside temperature is above approximately 41°F
(5°C)
if you press button AC OFF
At outside temperatures above 79°F
(26°C) the system will not automatically
switch back to outside air. A quantity of
outside air is added after approximately
30 minutes.
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
Charcoal filter
An activated charcoal filter markedly reduces bad odors and removes pollutants
from air entering the passenger compartment.
Activating
Press button e ( page 202).
The indicator lamp on the button
comes on.
i
If you press button e for approximately two seconds, the side windows and the tilt/sliding sunroof will
close.
Warning!
G
Never operate the side windows and the
tilt/sliding sunroof if there is the possibility
of anyone being harmed by the closing
procedure.
In the event that the procedure causes potential danger, the closing of the side windows can be immediately halted by
pressing the respective window switch.
The closing of the tilt/sliding sunroof can
be immediately halted by moving the tilt/
sliding sunroof switch in the overhead control panel in any direction.
The closing of the side windows and the
tilt/sliding sunroof can be reversed by
again pressing and holding
the e button.
Deactivating
Press button e ( page 202).
The indicator lamp on the button
goes out.
i
If you press button e for approximately two seconds, the side windows and the tilt/sliding sunroof will
return to their previous position.
The system switches automatically to the
air recirculation mode if the carbon
monoxide (CO) or nitrogen oxide (NOX)
concentration of the outside air increases beyond a predetermined level, for example in a tunnel.
The automatic air recirculation mode
does not function if AC OFF mode is selected or if the outside temperature has
fallen below 41°F (5°C).
The activated charcoal filter should be
switched off when windows fog up on
the inside, or if the passenger compartment needs to be quickly heated or
cooled down.
207
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
Air conditioning
The air conditioning is operational while
the engine is running and cools the interior air to the temperature set by the operator.
i
Condensation may drip out from
underneath the vehicle. This is normal and not an indication of a malfunction.
Deactivating
It is possible to deactivate the air conditioning (cooling) function of the automatic climate control system. The air in
the vehicle will then no longer be cooled
or dehumidified.
Press AC OFF again ( page 202).
The indicator lamp on the
button AC OFF goes out.
The air conditioning uses the refrigerant
R134a. This refrigerant is free of CFCs
which are harmful to the ozone layer.
Activating
Moist air can fog up the windows. You
can dehumidify the air with the air conditioning.
208
Turn the SmartKey in the starter
switch to position 1 or 0 or remove it
from the starter switch.
Press button T ( page 202).
The indicator lamp on button T
comes on.
i
If the AC OFF button on the automatic climate control panel starts to flash,
this indicates that the air conditioning is losing refrigerant. The compressor has turned itself off. The air
conditioning cannot be turned on
again.
Have the air conditioning checked at
the nearest authorized Maybach
Studio.
Press button AC OFF ( page 202).
The indicator lamp on the
button AC OFF comes on.
Activating
Residual heat and ventilation
With the engine switched off, it is possible to continue to heat or ventilate the
interior for up to 30 minutes. This feature makes use of the residual heat produced by the engine.
Deactivating
Press button T ( page 202).
The indicator lamp on button T
goes out.
The residual heat is automatically turned
off:
when the ignition is switched on
after about 30 minutes
if the battery voltage drops
i
How long the system will provide
heating depends on the coolant temperature and the temperature set by
the operator. The blower will run at
speed setting 1 regardless of the air
distribution control setting.
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
Temperature-controlled glove box
The glove box can be heated or cooled.
The air temperature is regulated according to the outside temperature and the
temperature set in the front air-conditioning control panel on the right.
The adjustable vent is in the glove box.
Turn adjustable vent 1 clockwise.
The glove box will be heated or
cooled.
Operating rear passenger compartment
settings at the cockpit control panel
Press the ™ button ( page 202)
on the front control panel.
Turn adjustable vent 1 counterclock-
wise.
The display switches over to show the
rear passenger compartment settings. At the same time, the indicator
lamps in the air distribution buttons
come on according to the air distribution set for the rear compartment.
The glove box will neither be heated
nor cooled.
i
If you are transporting perishable
goods (e.g. groceries) in the glove
box, close the air vent while heating
the passenger compartment.
You can adjust all settings for the rear
passenger compartment at the cockpit
control panel.
Standard display
1 Adjustable vent
Approximately five seconds after the last
button was pressed, the current display
disappears and the standard display is
called back up.
or
Press the ™ button again.
209
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
Rear passenger compartment
Overview of Maybach 57
210
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
1
Thumbwheel for upper left air
vent
7
Fixed air vent
8
Center air vent, right, adjustable
2
Upper left air vent
9
Thumbwheel for center air vent
3
Upper right air vent
a
Automatic climate control panel
4
Thumbwheel for upper right air
vent
b
Thumbwheel for center air vent
5
Thumbwheel for lower right air
vent
c
Center air vent, left, adjustable
d
Lower left air vent
6
Lower right air vent
e
Thumbwheel for lower left air
vent
Warning!
G
When operating the automatic climate
control, the air that enters the passenger
compartment through the air vents in the
footwell can be very hot or very cold (depending on the set temperature). This may
cause burn or frostbite to unprotected skin
in the immediate area of the air vents. Always keep sufficient distance between unprotected parts of the body and the
footwell air vents. If necessary, change the
air flow using the air distribution controls
to direct the air away from the footwell air
vents ( page 215).
211
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
Overview of Maybach 62
212
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
1
Thumbwheel for upper left air
vent
7
Fixed air vent
8
Center air vent, right, adjustable
2
Upper left air vent
9
Thumbwheel for center air vent
3
Upper right air vent
a
Automatic climate control panel
4
Thumbwheel for upper right air
vent
b
Thumbwheel for center air vent
5
Thumbwheel for lower right air
vent
c
Center air vent, left, adjustable
d
Lower left air vent
6
Lower right air vent
e
Thumbwheel for lower left air
vent
Warning!
G
When operating the automatic climate
control, the air that enters the passenger
compartment through the air vents in the
footwell can be very hot or very cold (depending on the set temperature). This may
cause burn or frostbite to unprotected skin
in the immediate area of the air vents. Always keep sufficient distance between unprotected parts of the body and the
footwell air vents. If necessary, change the
air flow using the air distribution controls
to direct the air away from the footwell air
vents ( page 215).
213
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
Automatic climate control panel
214
1
Air volume, left (manual)
7
Air distribution, right (manual)
2
Temperature control, left
8
AC cooling on/off
3
Display
9
4
Temperature control, right
5
Air volume, right (manual)
Residual heat and ventilation/
Automatic climate control on/off
button
6
Air distribution, right (automatic)
a
Air distribution, left (manual)
b
Air distribution, left (automatic)
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
Activating the climate control system
Increasing
Adjusting air distribution
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Push top of temperature control 4
and/or 6 ( page 214) until the dis-
Use the air distribution controls 7
and a ( page 214) to separately adjust
the air distribution on each side of the
passenger compartment. The following
symbols are found on the controls:
Press button M or U.
Deactivating the climate control system
It is possible to completely deactivate the
automatic climate control system.
Press button M.
!
The fresh air supply to the vehicle interior is shut off.
Setting the temperature
Use temperature controls 2 for the left
side or 4 ( page 214) for the right side
to separately adjust the air temperature
on each side of the passenger compartment. You should raise or lower the temperature setting in small increments,
preferably starting at 72°F (22°C).
play shows the desired temperature.
The automatic climate control system
will accordingly adjust the interior air
temperature.
Decreasing
Push bottom of temperature
control 4 and/or 6 ( page 214) un-
til the display shows the desired temperature.
The automatic climate control system
will accordingly adjust the interior air
temperature.
Symbol Function
Ü
Directs air to roof vents or upper side, center and lower side
vents
Û
Directs air to roof vents or upper side, footwell, center and
lower side vents
Ú
Directs air to footwell, center
and lower side vents
a
Directs air to center and lower
side vents
Y
Directs air to the footwell air
vents
i
When operating the climate control
system in automatic mode, you will
only rarely need to adjust the temperature, air volume and air distribution.
215
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
Adjusting manually
Adjusting air volume
Press the desired air distribution
control 7 and/or a ( page 214).
Adjusting manually
The indicator lamp on the U button goes out.
The air volume is controlled automatically while the air distribution is controlled manually in the respective
zone.
The selected air distribution is shown
in the display.
Adjusting automatically
Press left or right U button.
The indicator lamp on the button
comes on.
The air distribution is adjusted automatically.
Seven blower speeds are available.
Press to decrease or Q
( page 214) to increase air volume
to the desired level.
The indicator lamp on the U button goes out.
The air volume is controlled manually
while the air distribution is controlled
automatically in the respective zone.
The selected blower speed is shown
in the display.
Adjusting automatically
Press left or right U button.
The indicator lamp on the button
comes on.
The selected blower speed in the display disappears.
The air volume is adjusted automatically.
216
Air conditioning
The air conditioning is operational while
the engine is running and cools the interior air to the temperature set by the operator.
i
Condensation may drip out from
underneath the vehicle. This is normal and not an indication of a malfunction.
Deactivating
It is possible to deactivate the air conditioning (cooling) function of the automatic climate control system. The air in
the vehicle will then no longer be cooled
or dehumidified.
Press button AC OFF ( page 214).
The indicator lamp on the
button AC OFF comes on.
Controls in detail
Automatic climate control
Activating
Residual heat and ventilation
i
Moist air can fog up the windows. You
can dehumidify the air with the air conditioning.
With the engine switched off, it is possible to continue to heat or ventilate the
interior for up to 30 minutes. This feature makes use of the residual heat produced by the engine.
How long the system will provide
heating depends on the coolant temperature and the temperature set by
the operator. The blower will run at
speed setting 1 regardless of the air
distribution control setting.
Press AC OFF again ( page 214).
The indicator lamp on the
button AC OFF goes out.
The air conditioning uses the refrigerant
R134a. This refrigerant is free of CFCs
which are harmful to the ozone layer.
i
If the AC OFF button on the automatic climate control panel starts to flash,
this indicates that the air conditioning is losing refrigerant. The compressor has turned itself off. The air
conditioning cannot be turned on
again.
Have the air conditioning checked at
the nearest authorized Maybach
Studio.
Activating
Turn the SmartKey in the starter
switch to position 1 or 0 or remove it
from the starter switch.
Press button T ( page 214).
The indicator lamp on button T
comes on.
Deactivating
Press button T ( page 214).
The indicator lamp on button T
goes out.
Solar panel*
The solar cells convert natural light into
electrical energy. When the engine is
switched off, the energy generated automatically switches on the ventilation
fan. The constant air flow creates a cooler temperature for cars parked in the
sunlight.
The air flow depends on the intensity of
the solar radiation. The ventilation starts
two minutes after switching off the engine.
The residual heat is automatically turned
off:
when the ignition is switched on
after about 30 minutes
if the battery voltage drops
217
Controls in detail
Power windows
Opening and closing the windows
The side windows can be opened and
closed electrically. The switches for all of
the side windows are on the driver’s
door. The switches for the respective
windows are on the front passenger
door and the rear doors.
Power window switches on the driver’s door
1
2
3
4
5
Left front window
Right front window
Right rear window
Left rear window
Rear window override switch
( page 94)
218
Warning!
G
When closing the windows, make sure
there is no danger of anyone being
harmed by the closing procedure.
The closing of the door windows can be
immediately halted by releasing the switch
or, if switch was pressed past the resistance
point and released, by pressing the respective switch.
The door windows are equipped with the
express-close and automatic reversal function. If a door window encounters an obstruction that blocks its path in a
circumstance where you pressed the switch
past the resistance point and released it to
close the window, the automatic reversal
function will stop the window and open it
slightly.
If the window encounters an obstruction
that blocks its path in a circumstance
where you are closing the window by
pressing and holding the switch, by pressing and holding button ‹ on the
SmartKey, or by pressing and holding the
lock button (vehicles with KEYLESS-GO**)
on the outside door handle, the automatic
reversal function will not operate.
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment can
cause an accident and/or serious personal
injury.
i
You can also open or close the windows using the SmartKey,
see "Summer opening feature"
( page 220) and "Convenience closing feature" ( page 221).
You can close and reopen the windows using the air recirculation
button , ( page 205) or the charcoal filter button e ( page 207).
Controls in detail
Power windows
i
Opening the windows
Operating the windows from the rear
is not possible if you activate the
override switch ( page 94).
Press switch 1 to 4 at the
i
With the SmartKey in starter switch
position 0 or removed from the starter switch, the power windows can be
operated
until you open the driver’s or passenger door
Fully opening the windows
(Express-open)
symbol k to resistance point.
The corresponding window will move
downwards until you release the
switch.
Vehicles with rear side window curtains* ( page 281):
When opening a side window with
the rear side window curtain not
completely opened, the curtain will
open first.
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
symbol k past the resistance point
and release.
The corresponding window opens
completely.
Closing the windows
Press switch 1 to 4 at the
symbol j to resistance point.
The corresponding window will move
upwards until you release the switch.
for at least five minutes.
i
Press switch 1 to 4 at the
Warning!
G
If you press and hold the switch up when
closing the window, and upward movement of the window is blocked by some
obstruction including but not limited to
arms, hands, fingers, etc., the automatic
reversal will not operate.
Fully closing the windows
(Express-close)
Press switch 1 to 4 at the
symbol j past the point of resistance and release.
The corresponding window closes
completely.
Warning!
G
Driver's door only:
If within five seconds you again press the
switch past the resistance point and release, the automatic reversal will not func
tion.
219
Controls in detail
Power windows
!
If the upward movement of the window is blocked during the closing
procedure, the window will stop and
open slightly.
Remove the obstruction, press the respective power window switch at the
symbol j again past the resistance
point and release.
If the window still does not close
when there is no obstruction, press
and hold the respective power window switch at the symbol j. The
side window will then close without
the obstruction sensor function.
Stopping the power windows during Express-operation
Briefly press the respective power
window switch again.
220
Synchronizing power windows
The power windows must be synchronized
after the battery has been disconnected
if the power windows cannot be fully
opened (Express-open) or closed
(Express-close)
Each power window must be synchronized.
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Press and hold the power window
switches at the symbol j until the
windows are completely closed.
Keep pressing the switches for ap-
proximately one second.
The power windows are synchronized.
Summer opening feature
If the weather is warm, you can ventilate
the vehicle before driving off by simultaneously:
opening the side windows
opening the tilt/sliding sunroof
turning on the seat ventilation* for
the driver’s seat
i
The seat ventilation* for the driver’s
seat is automatically set to the highest level if activated via summer
opening feature.
Controls in detail
Power windows
Convenience closing feature
When you lock the vehicle, you can close
the windows and tilt/sliding sunroof simultaneously.
Aim transmitter eye of the SmartKey
or SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO** at
the front outside door handle
( page 220).
Press and hold button ‹ until the
Aim transmitter eye of the SmartKey
or SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO** at
the front outside door handle.
Press and hold button Œ until the
windows and tilt/sliding sunroof have
reached the desired position.
Release button Œ to interrupt pro-
cedure.
Warning!
When closing the windows and the tilt/
sliding sunroof, be sure that there is no
danger of anyone being harmed by the
closing procedure.
If potential danger exists, proceed as follows:
windows and tilt/sliding sunroof are
completely closed.
Release button ‹ to interrupt pro-
cedure.
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO**:
Press and hold button ‹ or the
lock button on the door handle
( page 76) until the windows and
tilt/sliding sunroof are completely
closed.
G
Release button ‹. To reverse direction of movement, press Œ for
opening or ‹ for closing.
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO**:
Release lock button on the outside
door handle ( page 76).
Pull on the outside door handle and
hold firmly. The side windows and the
tilt/sliding sunroof will open for as
long as the outside door handle is held
but the door not opened.
Release button ‹ or the lock but-
ton at door to interrupt procedure.
221
Controls in detail
Power tilt/sliding sunroof
Opening and closing the power tilt/
sliding sunroof (Maybach 57)
The tilt/sliding sunroof can be opened
and closed electrically. The switch for the
tilt/sliding sunroof is on the overhead
control panel.
Warning!
When closing the tilt/sliding sunroof, make
sure there is no danger of anyone being
harmed by the closing procedure.
5 Screen
With the sunroof closed or tilted open,
screen 5 can be slid into the roof opening to guard against sun rays. When sliding the sunroof open, the screen will also
retract.
Sunroof switch
1
2
3
4
Push back to slide sunroof open
Push forward to slide sunroof closed
Pull down to lower sunroof at rear
Push up to raise sunroof at rear
222
G
The opening/closing procedure of the tilt/
sliding sunroof can be immediately halted
by releasing the switch or, if the switch was
moved past the resistance point and released, by moving the switch in any direction.
The tilt/sliding sunroof is made out of
glass. In the event of an accident, the glass
may shatter. This may result in an opening
in the roof.
In a vehicle rollover, occupants not wearing their seat belts or not wearing them
properly may be thrown out of the opening. Such an opening also presents a potential for injury for occupants wearing
their seat belts properly as entire body
parts or portions of them may protrude
from the passenger compartment.
Controls in detail
Power tilt/sliding sunroof
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment can
cause an accident and/or serious personal
injury.
!
To avoid damaging the seals, do not
transport any objects with sharp edges which can stick out of the tilt/sliding sunroof.
Do not open the tilt/sliding sunroof if
there is snow or ice on the roof, as
this could result in malfunctions.
The tilt/sliding sunroof can be
opened or closed manually should an
electrical malfunction occur
( page 425).
i
You can also open or close the tilt/
sliding sunroof using the SmartKey,
see "Summer opening feature"
( page 220) and "Convenience closing feature" ( page 221).
You can close and reopen the tilt/sliding sunroof using the air recirculation
button , ( page 205) or the charcoal filter button e ( page 207).
i
With the SmartKey in starter switch
position 0 or removed from the starter switch, the tilt/sliding sunroof can
be operated
until you open the driver’s or passenger door
for up to approximately five minutes
Opening and closing the power tilt/sliding sunroof
To open, close, raise or lower the tilt/
sliding sunroof, move the switch to
the resistance point in the required
direction 1 to 4.
Release the sunroof switch when the
tilt/sliding sunroof has reached the
desired position.
Fully opening (Express-open) and closing (Express-close) the power sliding/
pop-up roof
To open, close, raise or lower the tilt/
sliding sunroof, move the switch past
the resistance point in the required
direction 1 to 4 and release.
The tilt/sliding sunroof opens or closes completely.
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
223
Controls in detail
Power tilt/sliding sunroof
Stopping the power tilt/sliding sunroof
Move the switch in any direction.
i
If the movement of the tilt/sliding
sunroof is blocked during the closing
procedure, the roof will stop and reopen slightly.
Synchronizing the power tilt/sliding
sunroof (Maybach 57)
The tilt/sliding sunroof must be synchronized
Remove the respective fuse from the
fuse box ( page 451).
after the consumer battery has been
disconnected
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
the tilt/sliding sunroof has been
closed manually
a malfunction
the tilt/sliding sunroof does not open
smoothly
Reinsert the fuse in the main fuse
box.
Move and hold the sunroof switch in
direction of arrow 4 until the tilt/
sliding sunroof is fully raised at the
rear.
Keep holding the sunroof switch in
direction of arrow 4 for approximately one second.
Check the Express-open feature
( page 223).
If the tilt/sliding sunroof opens completely, the roof is synchronized. Otherwise repeat the above steps.
224
Controls in detail
Power tilt/sliding sunroof
Opening and closing the power
tilt/sliding sunroof (Maybach 62)
The tilt/sliding sunroof can be opened
and closed electrically.
You can operate the tilt/sliding sunroof
from the cockpit or from the rear passenger compartment.
Warning!
G
When closing the tilt/sliding sunroof, make
sure there is no danger of anyone being
harmed by the closing procedure.
The opening/closing procedure of the tilt/
sliding sunroof can be immediately halted
by releasing the switch or, if the switch was
moved past the resistance point and released, by moving the switch in any direction.
The tilt/sliding sunroof is made out of
glass. In the event of an accident, the glass
may shatter. This may result in an opening
in the roof.
In a vehicle rollover, occupants not wearing their seat belts or not wearing them
properly may be thrown out of the opening. Such an opening also presents a potential for injury for occupants wearing
their seat belts properly as entire body
parts or portions of them may protrude
from the passenger compartment.
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment can
cause an accident and/or serious personal
injury.
Warning!
G
When closing the screen, make sure no one
can be caught and/or injured.
In case of danger, release the switch and, if
necessary, push the switch in direction
"open".
!
To avoid damaging the seals, do not
transport any objects with sharp edges which can stick out of the tilt/sliding sunroof.
Do not open the tilt/sliding sunroof if
there is snow or ice on the roof, as
this could result in malfunctions.
The tilt/sliding sunroof can be
opened or closed manually should an
electrical malfunction occur
( page 425).
i
You can also open or close the tilt/
sliding sunroof using the SmartKey,
see "Summer opening feature"
( page 220) and "Convenience closing feature" ( page 221).
You can close and reopen the tilt/sliding sunroof using the air recirculation
button , ( page 205) or the charcoal filter button e ( page 207).
225
Controls in detail
Power tilt/sliding sunroof
i
Operating from the cockpit
i
With the SmartKey in starter switch
position 0 or removed from the starter switch, the tilt/sliding sunroof can
be operated
The switch for the tilt/sliding sunroof is
on the overhead control panel.
If the screen is closed, the screen
opens first when you push the sunroof switch in direction of arrow 1.
until you open the driver’s or passenger door
Push the sunroof switch again in direction of arrow 1 to open the tilt/
sliding sunroof.
for up to approximately five minutes
The screen only operates with the tilt/
sliding sunroof closed.
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Opening and closing the screen
To open or close the screen, move the
Sunroof switch, front
1 Push back to slide screen or sunroof
open
2 Push forward to slide screen or sunroof closed
3 Pull down to lower sunroof at rear
4 Push up to raise sunroof at rear
226
sunroof switch to the resistance point
in the required direction of arrow 1
or 2.
Release the sunroof switch when the
screen has reached the desired position.
Controls in detail
Power tilt/sliding sunroof
Opening and closing the power tilt/sliding sunroof
Stopping the power tilt/sliding sunroof
during Express-operation
Operating from the rear passenger compartment
Open the screen if it is closed.
Move the switch in any direction.
The switches are in the storage compartment under the rear center armrest.
To open, close, raise, or lower the tilt/
sliding sunroof, move the sunroof
switch to resistance point in the required direction of arrows 1 to 4.
Release the sunroof switch when the
i
If the movement of the tilt/sliding
sunroof is blocked during the closing
procedure, the tilt/sliding sunroof
will stop and reopen slightly.
tilt/sliding sunroof has reached the
desired position.
Fully opening (Express-open) and closing (Express-close) the power tilt/sliding
sunroof
Open the screen if it is closed.
Sunroof switch, rear
To open, close, raise, or lower the tilt/
1
2
3
4
sliding sunroof, move the sunroof
switch past the resistance point in the
required direction of arrows 1 to 4
and release.
The tilt/sliding sunroof opens or closes completely.
Press to lower sunroof at rear
Press to slide screen or sunroof closed
Press to slide screen or sunroof open
Switch for screen and sliding portion
of roof
5 Press to raise rear roof at rear
6 Switch for tilt portion of roof
227
Controls in detail
Power tilt/sliding sunroof
i
If the screen is closed, the screen will
open first when you press sunroof
switch 4 at 3.
Opening and closing the power tilt/sliding sunroof
Stopping the power tilt/sliding sunroof
during Express-operation
Open the screen if it is closed.
Press sunroof switch 4 again.
To open or close the tilt/sliding sun-
Press sunroof switch 4 again at 3 to
open the tilt/sliding sunroof.
roof, press sunroof switch 4 to the
resistance point at 3 or 2.
The screen only operates with the tilt/
sliding sunroof closed.
Release sunroof switch 4 when the
tilt/sliding sunroof has reached the
desired position.
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Opening and closing the screen
To open or close the screen, press
Fully opening (Express-open) and closing (Express-close) the power tilt/sliding
sunroof
sunroof switch 4 at 3 or 2.
Open the screen if it is closed.
Release the sunroof switch when the
screen has reached the desired position.
To open or close the tilt/sliding sun-
Fully opening (Express-open) and closing (Express-close) the screen
To open or close the screen, press
sunroof switch 4 past the resistance
point at 3 or 2 and release.
The screen opens or closes complete-
ly.
228
roof, press sunroof switch 4 past the
resistance point at 3 or 2 and release.
The rear tilt/sliding sunroof opens or
closes completely.
i
If the movement of the tilt/sliding
sunroof is blocked during the closing
procedure, the tilt/sliding sunroof
will stop and reopen slightly.
Raising and lowering the power tilt/sliding sunroof
Open the screen if it is closed.
To raise or lower the tilt/sliding sun-
roof, press sunroof switch 6 to the
resistance point at 1 or 5.
Release sunroof switch 6 when the
tilt/sliding sunroof has reached the
desired position.
Controls in detail
Power tilt/sliding sunroof
Synchronizing the power tilt/sliding
sunroof (Maybach 62)
The tilt/sliding sunroof must be synchronized
Remove the respective fuse from the
fuse box ( page 451).
after the consumer battery has been
disconnected
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
the tilt/sliding sunroof has been
closed manually
switch again.
a malfunction
i
the tilt/sliding sunroof does not open
smoothly
Fully raising and lowering the power tilt/
sliding sunroof
Open the screen if it is closed.
To raise or lower the tilt/sliding sun-
roof, press sunroof switch 6 past the
resistance point at 1 or 5 and release.
To stop the procedure, press the
Vehicles with rear center seat*:
For operation with the Pocket PC remote control* ( page 332).
Reinsert the fuse in the main fuse
box.
If the tilt/sliding sunroof is raised at
the rear, lower and close it.
Move and hold the sunroof switch in
direction of arrow 4 ( page 226) or
press sunroof switch 6 at 5
( page 227) until the tilt/sliding sunroof is fully raised at the rear.
Keep pressing the respective switch
for approximately one second.
Check the Express-open feature
( page 227).
If the tilt/sliding sunroof opens completely, the roof is synchronized. Otherwise repeat the above steps.
229
Controls in detail
Electrotransparent roof*
Operating the electrotransparent
roof
You can operate the electrotransparent
roof from the cockpit or from the rear
passenger compartment.
Warning!
G
When closing the screen, make sure no one
can be caught and/or injured.
In case of danger, release the switch and, if
necessary, push the switch in direction
"open".
The electrotransparent roof is made out of
glass. In the event of an accident, the glass
may shatter. This may result in an opening
in the roof.
In a vehicle rollover, occupants not wearing their seat belts or not wearing them
properly may be thrown out of the opening. Such an opening also presents a potential for injury for occupants wearing
their seat belts properly as entire body
parts or portions of them may protrude
from the passenger compartment.
230
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment can
cause an accident and/or serious personal
injury.
Operating from the cockpit
The switch for the electrotransparent
roof is on the overhead control unit.
i
With the SmartKey in starter switch
position 0 or removed from the starter switch, the electrotransparent roof
can be operated
until you open the driver’s or passenger door
for up to approximately five minutes
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
1 Push back to slide screen closed
2 Push forward to slide screen open
3 Pull down to make the electrotransparent roof opaque/switch off roof
lighting
4 Push up to make the electrotransparent roof transparent/switch on roof
lighting
Controls in detail
Electrotransparent roof*
Opening the screen
Fully opening the screen (Express-open)
Slide the switch to the resistance
Move the switch past the resistance
point in direction of arrow 2.
Release the switch when the screen
has reached the desired position.
point in direction of arrow 2 and release.
The screen opens completely.
Closing the screen
Fully closing the screen (Express-close)
Move the switch to the resistance
Move the switch past the resistance
point in direction of arrow 1.
Release the switch when the screen
has reached the desired position.
point in direction of arrow 1 and release.
The electrotransparent roof turns
opaque and the screen closes completely.
Stopping the screen during
Express-operation
Move the switch in any direction.
Making the electrotransparent roof
transparent
The screen must be completely open.
Push the switch in direction of
arrow 4.
Making the electrotransparent roof
opaque
The screen must be completely open.
Pull the switch in direction of
arrow 3.
Switching on roof lighting
The screen must be completely closed.
Press the switch in direction of
arrow 4.
Switching off roof lighting
Pull the switch in direction of
arrow 3.
231
Controls in detail
Electrotransparent roof*
Operating from the rear passenger compartment
The switches are in the storage compartment under the rear center armrest.
Opening and closing the screen
To open or close the screen, press
switch 4 to the resistance point at 3
or 2.
Release the switch when the screen
has reached the desired position.
232
The screen opens automatically and
the electrotransparent roof turns
transparent.
Making the electrotransparent roof
opaque
To open or close the screen, press
If the screen is closed, open it com-
The screen opens or closes completely.
Press to make roof opaque
Press to slide screen closed
Press to slide screen open
Switch for screen
Press to make roof transparent
Switch for electrotransparent roof
Press switch 6 at 5.
Fully opening (Express-open) and closing (Express-close) the screen
switch 4 past the resistance point
at 3 or 2 and release.
1
2
3
4
5
6
Making the electrotransparent roof
transparent
Stopping the screen during
Express-operation
Press switch 4 again.
pletely.
Press switch 6 at 1.
The electrotransparent roof turns
opaque.
i
Vehicles with rear center seat*:
For operation with the Pocket PC remote control* ( page 330).
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Driving systems
The driving systems of your vehicle are
described on the following pages:
Cruise control and Distronic**, with
which the vehicle can maintain a preset speed.
Cruise control
Cruise control automatically maintains
the speed you set for your vehicle.
Airmatic DC adjusts the vehicle suspension characteristics automatically
and controls the vehicle level.
Use of cruise control is recommended for
driving at a constant speed for extended
periods of time. You can set or resume
cruise control at any speed over 20 mph
(30 km/h).
Vehicle level control, with which you
can change the vehicle level
The cruise control function is operated
by means of the cruise control lever.
Parktronic, which serves as a parking
assistant.
The cruise control lever is the uppermost
lever on the left-hand side of the steering column ( page 234).
For information on the BAS, ABS, ESP
and SBC driving systems, see "Driving
safety systems" ( page 96).
Warning!
G
Cruise control is a convenience system designed to assist the driver during vehicle
operation. The driver is and must remain at
all times responsible for the vehicle speed
and for safe brake operation.
Only use cruise control if the road, traffic
and weather conditions make it advisable
to travel at a steady speed.
The use of cruise control can be dangerous on winding roads or in heavy
traffic because conditions do not allow
safe driving at a steady speed.
The use of cruise control can be dangerous on slippery roads. Rapid changes in tire traction can result in wheel
spin and loss of control.
Deactivate cruise control when driving
in fog.
The "Resume" function should only be operated if the driver is fully aware of the
previously set speed and wishes to resume
this particular preset speed.
233
Controls in detail
Driving systems
The selected speed appears in the multifunction display for approximately 5 seconds, and the corresponding
speedometer segments from the selected speed to the vehicle maximum speed
are illuminated.
i
1
2
3
4
Sets current or higher speed
Sets current or lower speed
Cancels cruise control
Resumes at last set speed
Setting current speed
Accelerate or decelerate to the de-
On uphill or downhill grades, cruise
control may not be able to maintain
the set speed. Once the grade eases,
the set speed will be resumed.
Canceling cruise control
There are several ways to cancel cruise
control:
Step on the brake pedal.
Cruise control is canceled. The last
speed set is stored for later use.
sired speed.
Briefly lift the cruise control lever in
direction of arrow 1 or depress in direction of arrow 2.
The current speed is set.
Remove your foot from the accelera-
tor pedal.
Cruise control is activated.
234
or
Briefly push the cruise control lever in
direction of arrow 3.
Cruise control is canceled. The last
speed set is stored for later use.
!
Moving the gear selector lever to
position N while driving also cancels
cruise control. However, the gear selector lever should not be moved to
position N while driving, except to
coast when the vehicle is in danger of
skidding (e.g. on icy roads).
i
The last stored speed is canceled
when you turn off the engine.
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Setting a higher speed
i
Lift the cruise control lever in direc-
When you use the cruise control lever
to decelerate, the transmission will
automatically downshift if the engine’s braking power does not slow
the vehicle sufficiently.
tion of arrow 1 and hold it until the
desired speed is reached.
Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is set.
i
Depressing the accelerator pedal
does not deactivate cruise control.
After brief acceleration (e.g. for passing), cruise control resumes the last
speed set.
Fine adjustment in 1 mph
(Canada: 1 km/h) increments
Faster
Briefly tip the cruise control lever in
direction of arrow 1.
Setting a lower speed
Slower
Depress the cruise control lever in di-
Briefly tip the cruise control lever in
rection of arrow 2 and hold it until
the desired speed is reached.
Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is set.
direction of arrow 2.
Setting to last stored speed
("Resume" function)
Warning!
G
The speed stored in memory should only
be set again if prevailing road conditions
permit. Possible acceleration or deceleration differences arising from returning to
preset speed could cause an accident and/
or serious injury to you and others.
Briefly push the cruise control lever in
direction of arrow 4.
The cruise control resumes the last set
speed.
Remove your foot from the accelera-
tor pedal.
The selected speed appears in the multifunction display for approximately 5 seconds, and the corresponding
speedometer segments from the selected speed to the vehicle maximum speed
are illuminated.
235
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Distronic**
When activated, the Distronic adaptive
cruise control system increases driving
convenience afforded by the cruise control during travel on expressways and
other major roads.
If the Distronic distance sensor detects a slower moving vehicle directly
ahead, your vehicle speed will be reduced so that you follow that vehicle
at a preset distance.
If there is no vehicle directly ahead of
you, Distronic will function in the
same way as cruise control
( page 233).
Warning!
G
Distronic adaptive cruise control is no substitute for active driving involvement. It
does not react to stationary objects, nor
does it recognize or predict the curvature
and lane layout or the movement of vehicles ahead. Distronic can only apply a maximum of 20% of the vehicle’s braking
power.
236
It is the driver’s responsibility at all times to
be attentive to traffic and road conditions
and to provide the steering, braking and
other driving inputs necessary to retain
control of the vehicle.
Warning!
G
Distronic is a convenience system. Its speed
adjustment reduction capability is intended to make cruise control more effective
and usable when traffic speeds vary. However, it is not intended to, nor does it, replace the need for extreme care. The
responsibility for the vehicle speed and the
distance to the vehicle ahead, including
most importantly brake operation to assure safe stopping distance, always rests
with the driver.
Distronic cannot take street and traffic
conditions into account.
Warning!
G
Distronic requires familiarity with its operational characteristics. We strongly recommend that you review the following
information carefully before operating the
system.
i
For operation in the USA only: This
device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the
following two conditions:
(1) This device may not cause harmful
interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
Any unauthorized modification to
this device could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Warning!
G
Distronic cannot take street and traffic
conditions into account. Only use Distronic
if the road, weather and traffic conditions
make it advisable to travel at a steady
speed.
Warning!
G
Use of Distronic can be dangerous on slippery roads. Rapid changes in tire traction
can result in wheel spin and loss of control.
Distronic does not act upon adverse sight
distance conditions. Do not use Distronic
during conditions of fog and heavy rain,
snow or sleet.
Warning!
G
Close attention to road and traffic conditions is imperative at all times, regardless
of whether or not Distronic is activated.
Use of Distronic can be dangerous on
winding roads or in heavy traffic because
conditions do not allow safe driving at a
steady speed.
Warning!
G
The "Resume" function should only be operated if the driver is fully aware of the
previously set speed and wishes to resume
this particular preset speed.
Distronic displays in the speedometer
dial
Distronic will not react to stationary objects in the roadway (e.g. a stopped vehicle
in a traffic jam or a disabled vehicle). Distronic will also not respond to oncoming
vehicles.
Switch off Distronic:
when changing from the left to the
right lane if vehicles are moving more
slowly in the left lane
when entering a turn lane or highway
off ramp
in complex driving situations, such as in
highway construction zones
In these situations, Distronic will continue
to maintain the set speed unless deactivated. Distronic is designed and intended only
to maintain a set speed and keep a set distance from moving objects in front of it.
Set speed
If Distronic is activated, one or two segments come on around the set speed.
237
Controls in detail
Driving systems
i
The vehicle speed displayed on the
speedometer can briefly vary from
the speed setting on the Distronic system.
If Distronic detects a vehicle directly
ahead, the segments from the speed of
the vehicle ahead to the set speed come
on.
If Distronic calculates that there is a danger of collision
the distance warning lamp l in
the instrument cluster comes on red
an intermittent warning sounds
Immediately brake the vehicle to
avoid a collision.
Under no circumstances should the
driver await the intermittent warning
sound before braking. See the following warning note.
Segments
The intermittent warning sound ceases and the red distance warning
lamp l goes out when the necessary distance to the vehicle ahead is
again established.
Warning!
G
An intermittent warning sounds and the
distance warning lamp l in the instrument cluster is illuminated if the Distronic
system calculates that the distance to the
vehicle ahead and your vehicle’s current
speed indicate that Distronic will not be capable of slowing the vehicle sufficiently to
maintain the preset following distance,
which creates a danger of a collision.
Immediately brake the vehicle to increase
the distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle in front of you. The warning sound
is intended as a final caution that you have
not interceded with your own braking inputs to avoid a potentially dangerous situation. Do not wait for the operation of the
warning signal to intercede with your own
braking, as that will result in potentially
dangerous emergency braking which will
not always result in an impact being avoided.
Tailgating increases the risk of an accident.
238
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Warning!
G
Distronic brakes your vehicle with a maximum of 6.5 ft/s2 (2 m/s2). This corresponds
to about 20% of the maximum deceleration ability of your vehicle.
Distronic brakes the vehicle in an effort to
restore the preset distance or to maintain
the speed. The brake pedal is automatically applied as this happens which results in
the brake pedal moving.
Keep driver’s foot area clear at all times,
including the area under the brake pedal.
Objects stored in this area may impair pedal movement which could interfere with
the braking ability of the Distronic system.
Do not place your foot under the brake
pedal – your foot could become caught.
Distronic menu in the control system
In the Distronic menu you can read the
current settings for Distronic. What appears in the display depends on whether
Distronic and the distance warning function are turned on or off.
Press button è or ÿ repeatedly
until you see one of the following displays.
Distronic deactivated
If Distronic is deactivated, you can see
the standard display of Distronic in the
multifunction display.
Distronic activated
If you turn Distronic on, you will see the
set speed in the multifunction display for
about five seconds. If Distronic is
activated, you can see the following display in the multifunction display.
1 Distronic activated
1 Vehicle ahead, if detected
2 Actual distance to vehicle ahead
3 Preset distance threshold to vehicle
ahead
4 Your vehicle
5 Symbol for activated distance warning function
239
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Cruise control lever
Activating Distronic
Setting the current speed
The Distronic system is operated by
means of the cruise control lever.
You can activate Distronic if
Accelerate or decelerate to the de-
The cruise control lever is the uppermost
lever on the left-hand side of the steering column.
you are driving between 25 mph
(40 km/h) and 110 mph (180 km/h)
the ESP is activated ( page 100)
If Distronic has not been activated after
pressing the cruise control lever you will
see the message --- in the multifunction
display.
In the following cases you cannot activate Distronic:
1
2
3
4
Sets current or higher speed
Sets current or lower speed
Deactivates Distronic
Resumes at last set speed
240
up to two minutes after starting the
engine
when you brake
if you have set the parking brake
if the gear selector lever is in
position P, R or N
if the ESP is switched off
sired speed.
Briefly lift the cruise control lever in
direction of arrow 1 or depress in direction of arrow 2.
Distronic is activated and the current
speed is set.
Remove your foot from the accelera-
tor pedal.
i
If you do not take your foot off of the
accelerator completely, the following
message will appear in the multifunction display:
DISTRONIC OVERRIDE
Distronic will not work to maintain
the distance to slower moving vehicles in front of you. Your vehicle
speed will then be determined only
by the accelerator pedal position.
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Setting a higher speed
Setting a lower speed
Briefly tip the cruise control lever in
direction of arrow 1 ( page 240) to
Briefly tip the cruise control lever in
direction of arrow 2 ( page 240) to
increase vehicle speed in increments
of 5 mph (Canada: 10 km/h).
decrease vehicle speed in increments
of 5 mph (Canada: 10 km/h).
The new speed is set.
The new speed is set.
The stored speed is displayed in the
multifunction display for approximately five seconds, and one or two
segments around the stored speed
come on the speedometer
( page 237).
The stored speed is displayed in the
multifunction display for approximately five seconds, and one or two
segments around the stored speed
come on the speedometer
( page 237).
i
i
Depressing the accelerator pedal
does not deactivate Distronic. After
brief acceleration (e.g. for passing),
the cruise control resumes the last
speed set.
When you use the cruise control lever
to decelerate, the transmission will
automatically downshift if the rate of
deceleration is too low.
Fine adjustment in 1 mph
(Canada: 1 km/h) increments
Faster
Briefly tip the cruise control lever in
direction of arrow 4 ( page 240).
241
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Setting to last stored speed ("Resume"
function)
Warning!
G
The speed stored in memory should only
be set again if prevailing road conditions
permit. Possible acceleration or deceleration differences arising from returning to
preset speed could cause an accident and/
or serious injury to you and others.
Briefly tip the cruise control lever in
direction of arrow 4 ( page 240).
Distronic is set to the last stored
speed.
Remove your foot from the accelera-
tor pedal.
242
Deactivating Distronic
There are several ways to deactivate the
Distronic system:
Distronic deactivates automatically
when:
You set the parking brake.
Briefly tip the cruise control lever in
direction of arrow 3 ( page 240).
You drive slower than 22 mph
(35 km/h).
or
The ESP is active ( page 100) or you
deactivate the ESP.
You move the transmission gear selector lever into position N.
Step on the brake pedal.
Distronic is deactivated. The last
speed set is stored into memory.
i
The following message will appear in
the multifunction display for approximately five seconds: DISTRONIC OFF.
The last stored speed is deleted when
you turn off the engine.
A signal will sound. The DISTRONIC
OFF message appears in the multifunction display for approximately
five seconds.
Warning!
G
Distronic switches off and releases the
brakes when the vehicle decelerates below
the minimum speed of approximately
22 mph (35 km/h) by operation of the system. At that time the driver must apply the
brakes in order to reduce vehicle speed
further or bring it to a stop.
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Setting the following distance in
Distronic
You can set the specified following distance for Distronic by varying the time
setting between 1.0 and 2.0 seconds. Using this time setting and the current
speed of your vehicle, Distronic calculates and sets the required following distance to the vehicle ahead. The set
distance will be shown in the multifunction display field.
Warning!
The distance warning function on/off
button and thumbwheel for setting distance are located on the lower part of
the front center console.
arrow 4.
Decreasing distance
Decreasing the distance setting tells Distronic to maintain a shorter following
distance to the vehicle ahead.
Turn thumbwheel 3 direction of
arrow 5.
Distance warning function
G
It is up to the driver to exercise discretion
to select the appropriate setting given
road conditions, traffic, driver’s preferred
driving style and applicable laws and driving recommendations for safe following
distance.
Turn thumbwheel 3 direction of
1 Distance warning function on/off
button
2 Indicator lamp
3 Thumbwheel for setting distance
4 Increasing distance
5 Decreasing distance
Increasing distance
Increasing the distance setting tells Distronic to maintain a greater following
distance to the vehicle ahead.
When Distronic is deactivated, this function will continue to warn you when recognizing a stationary obstacle or a
slower vehicle moving in the vehicle’s
path and the danger of a collision exists:
The distance warning lamp l in
the instrument cluster comes on
An intermittent warning sounds.
If these warnings are issued, you must
brake manually to maintain a safe distance and avoid a collision with the vehicle ahead.
243
Controls in detail
Driving systems
When pressing the brake pedal, the
warning sound stops. The warning sound
also stops when the distance to the vehicle ahead is sufficient again without applying the brake pedal. In this case the
distance warning lamp l also extinguishes.
Warning!
G
If the distance warning lamp l in the
instrument cluster comes on while driving
and/or an intermittent warning sounds,
immediate attention on the part of the
driver is required.
As required by the traffic situation, apply
the brakes and navigate around a possible
obstacle. However, do not drive by relying
on the distance warning function, as this
will result in an emergency braking application. Especially depending on road surface conditions and driver reaction, this
will not always enable you to avoid a collision.
244
i
Complex driving situations are not
always fully recognized by Distronic.
This could result in wrong or missing
distance warnings.
Activating
Press button 1.
Indicator lamp 2 comes on. A loudspeaker symbol appears in the multifunction display ( page 239).
Warning!
Distronic works to maintain the speed selected by the driver unless a moving obstacle proceeding directly ahead of it in the
same travel direction is detected (e.g. following another vehicle ahead of you at a
distance set by Distronic). This means that:
Your vehicle can pass another vehicle
after you change lanes.
While in a sharp turn or if the vehicle in
front is in a sharp turn, Distronic could
lose sight of a vehicle traveling in front
of it, then your vehicle could accelerate
to the previously selected speed.
Deactivating
Press button 1.
The indicator lamp 2 on the button
goes out. No loudspeaker symbol appears in the multifunction display.
Driving with Distronic
This section describes a number of driving situations where special precaution is
required on the part of the driver. Be
prepared to brake in such situations. This
will deactivate the Distronic system.
G
Distronic regulates only the distance between your vehicle and those directly
ahead of it, but does not register stationary objects in the road, e.g.:
a stopped vehicle in a traffic jam
a disabled vehicle
an oncoming vehicle
The driver must always be on the alert,
observe all traffic and intercede as required by steering or braking the vehicle.
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Warning!
G
Distronic should not be used in snowy or
icy road conditions.
The most likely cause for a malfunctioning system is a dirty sensor (located behind the hood grille), especially at times
of snow and ice or heavy rain. In such a
case, Distronic will switch off, and the
message DISTRONIC CURRENTLY UNAVAILABLE SEE OPERATORS MANUAL appears in
the multifunction display.
For cleaning and care of the Distronic
sensor, see "Cleaning the Distronic system sensor" ( page 378).
i
Turns and bends
If the message DISTRONIC CURRENTLY
UNAVAILABLE SEE OPERATORS MANUAL
disappears during driving and last
speed stored flashes for approximately five seconds, the dirt (e.g. slush) has
dissolved; Distronic is again operational.
In turns or bends, Distronic may not detect a moving vehicle in front, or it may
detect one too soon. This may cause your
vehicle to brake late or unexpectedly.
245
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Offset driving
Lane changing
Narrow vehicles
A vehicle traveling in your lane but offset
from your direct line of travel may not be
detected by Distronic. There will be insufficient distance to the vehicle ahead.
Distronic has not yet detected the vehicle
changing lanes. There will be insufficient
distance to the lane changing vehicle.
Because of their narrow profiles, the vehicles traveling near the outer edges of
the lane have not yet been detected by
Distronic. There will be insufficient distance to the vehicle ahead.
246
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Airmatic DC (Dual Control)
Airmatic automatically selects the optimum suspension tuning and ride height
for your vehicle. Airmatic consists of
three components:
Adaptive Damping System (ADS)
Stiffness of spring
Vehicle level control
The ADS automatically selects the optimum damping for the respective driving
conditions. At the same time the suspension is set to either sporty or regular.
Damping and suspension are adjusted
automatically according to your driving
style and road conditions. In addition to
the automatic mode designed for your
convenience, you can adjust the suspension tuning yourself by selecting from
two other levels using the button on the
center console.
Suspension tuning
The suspension tuning is set according
to:
Your driving style
Road surface conditions
Your choice of suspension style,
"Comfort", "Sporty 1" or "Sporty 2",
which you select using the damping
button.
247
Controls in detail
Driving systems
1 Damping button
2 Indicator lamp
3 Indicator lamp
Start the engine.
Vehicle level control
Press damping button 1 until the de-
sired suspension style is set.
Your vehicle automatically adjusts its
ride height to
reduce fuel consumption
increase vehicle safety
If both indicator lamps are out,
you have chosen the automatic
mode for soft damping. The message AIRMATIC DC CONVENIENCE for
comfort suspension tuning appears in the multifunction display.
If one indicator lamp is on, the
control system supports a primarily dynamic style of driving. The
message AIRMATIC DC SPORTS 1 for
Sporty 1 suspension tuning appears in the multifunction display.
If both indicator lamps are on, the
system is set for a dynamic style of
driving. The message AIRMATIC DC
SPORTS 2 for Sporty 2 suspension
tuning appears in the multifunction display.
i
The selected suspension style is stored
in memory, even after the SmartKey
is removed from the starter switch.
248
Warning!
G
To help avoid personal injury, keep hands
and feet away from wheel housing area,
and stay away from under the vehicle
when lowering the vehicle chassis.
Controls in detail
Driving systems
The following vehicle level settings can
be selected when the vehicle is stationary:
Vehicle level
Suspension
when stationary tuning
Use for
Ride height increase
over normal
Automatic lowering
Indicator
(depending on vehicle speed) lamp
Normal
Comfort
For driving on normal roads. None
Max. approx. 0.4 in (10 mm)
Lamp off
Normal
Sporty 1 or 2 For driving on normal roads. None
Max. approx. 0.6 in (15 mm)
Lamp off
Raised
Comfort
For driving on rough roads
or with snow chains.
Approx. 0.8 in (20 mm) Max. approx. 1.2 in (30 mm)
Lamp on
Raised
Sporty 1 or 2 For driving on rough roads
or with snow chains.
Approx. 0.8 in (20 mm) Max. approx. 1.4 in (35 mm)
Lamp on
Start the engine.
The button is located on the lower part
of the front center console.
Briefly press button 1 to change
from one level setting to the other.
The message:
AIRMATIC
VEHICLE RISING!
1 Vehicle level control button
2 Indicator lamp
appears in the multifunction display
when changing from normal level to
raised level. The indicator lamp 2 is
then on. The display switches off
when the vehicle is raised.
249
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Press button 1 again to lower the
vehicle. The indicator lamp 1 is off.
The selected vehicle level setting remains
stored in memory even if the engine is
turned off and restarted except when
you
The vehicle chassis ride height is raised or
lowered according to the selected level
setting and to the vehicle speed.
exceed a speed of 75 mph (120 km/h)
maintain a speed of between 50 mph
(80 km/h) and 75 mph (120 km/h) for
more than five minutes
The vehicle then lowers to regular level.
The message:
At a speed above approximately
69 mph (110 km/h), ride height is reduced automatically by up to approximately 1.2 in (30 mm) in Comfort
suspension style or by up to approximately 1.4 in (35 mm) in Sporty 1/
Sporty 2 suspension style.
With decreasing speed, the ride
height is again raised to the "Normal" level.
Normal level
or
Raised level
At a speed above approximately
69 mph (110 km/h), ride height is reduced automatically by up to approximately 0.4 in (10 mm) in Comfort
suspension style or by up to approximately 0.6 in (15 mm) in Sporty 1/
Sporty 2 suspension style.
i
With decreasing speed, the ride
height is again raised to the "Normal" level.
These height adjustments are so small
that you may not notice any change.
AIRMATIC
LEVEL CANCELLED!
appears in the multifunction display and
the indicator lamp goes out. The display
switches off when the vehicle is raised.
250
Select the "Raised" level only when required by current driving conditions.
Otherwise
fuel consumption may increase
handling may be impaired
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Parktronic (Parking assist)
Warning!
Warning!
G
Parktronic is a supplemental system. It is
not intended to, nor does it replace, the
need for extreme care. The responsibility
during parking and other critical maneuvers always rests with the driver.
Special attention must be paid to objects
with smooth surfaces or low silhouettes
(e.g. trailer couplings, painted posts, or
road curbs). Such objects may not be detected by the system and can damage the
vehicle.
The operational function of the Parktronic
can be affected by dirty sensors, especially
at times of snow and ice, see "Cleaning the
Parktronic system sensors" ( page 378).
Interference caused by other ultrasonic signals (e.g. working jackhammers, car wash,
or the air brakes of trucks) can cause the
system to send erratic indications, and
should be taken into consideration.
G
Make sure no persons or animals are in the
area in which you are maneuvering. You
could otherwise injure them.
The Parktronic system monitors the surroundings of your vehicle with six sensors
in the front bumper and four sensors in
the rear bumper.
The Parktronic system is an electronic aid
designed to assist the driver during parking maneuvers. It visually and audibly indicates the relative distance between the
vehicle and an obstacle.
The Parktronic system is automatically
activated when you switch on the ignition, release the parking brake, and
placed the gear selector lever in position
D, R, or N. The Parktronic system deactivates at speeds over approximately
11 mph (18 km/h). At lower speeds the
Parktronic system turns on again. The
Parktronic system also deactivates when
you place the gear selector lever in position P or depress the parking brake pedal.
1 Sensors in the front bumper
Range of the sensors
To function properly, the sensors must be
free of dirt, ice, snow and slush. Clean
the sensors regularly, being careful not
to scratch or damage the sensors, see
"Cleaning the Parktronic system sensors"
( page 378).
251
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Front sensors
Minimum distance
Center
approx. 40 in (100 cm)
Center
approx. 8 in (20 cm)
Corners
approx. 24 in (60 cm)
Corners
approx. 6 in (15 cm)
Rear sensors
Center
approx. 48 in (120 cm)
Corners
approx. 32 in (80 cm)
!
During parking maneuvers, pay special attention to objects located
above or below the height of the sensors (e.g. planters or trailer hitches).
The Parktronic system will not detect
such objects at close range and damage to your vehicle or the object may
result.
Ultrasonic signals from outside sources (e.g. truck air brakes, car wash, or
jackhammers) may impair the operation of the Parktronic system.
252
If the system detects an obstacle in this
range, all the warning lamps come on
and you hear a warning signal. If the obstacle is closer than the minimum distance, the actual distance might no
longer be indicated by the system.
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Warning indicators
Visual signals indicate to the driver the
relative distance between the sensors
and an obstacle. The warning indicator
for the front area is located above the
center air vents in the dashboard. The
warning indicator for the rear area is integrated in the rear roof lining
( page 38).
In case you still cannot see the warning
indicator after lifting up the rear-view
mirror:
Adjust the interior rear view mirror
by hand until you can see the warning indicator
The interior rear view mirror returns to
its original position as soon as:
the gear selector lever is no longer in
position R
you exceed a speed of 5 mph
(8 km/h)
Maybach 62 with partition*
You have an additional warning indicator for the rear area in the roof lining, in
front of the partition.
In order for you to see this warning indicator, the interior rear-view mirror tilts
slightly upward if:
the partition and curtain are not
completely open
the gear selector lever is in position R
Warning indicator with eight warning
indicator lamps
1 Left front area warning indicator
2 Right front area warning indicator
If your vehicle is equipped with this
warning indicator, each warning indicator is divided into six yellow and two red
segments for either side of the vehicle.
The Parktronic system is operational
when the first yellow segment is faintly
illuminated.
253
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Warning indicator with seven warning
indicator lamps
Warning indicators activated
The position of the gear selector lever
determines which warning indicators
will be activated.
Gear selector Warning indicator
lever position
1 Left front area warning indicator
2 Right front area warning indicator
3 Readiness indicators
If your vehicle is equipped with this
warning indicator, each warning indicator is divided into five yellow and two
red segments for either side of the vehicle.
The Parktronic system is ready when the
green readiness indicators 3 are illuminated.
254
D
Front area activated
R or N
Rear and front area activated
P
Neither activated
As your vehicle approaches an object,
one or more segments will come on, depending on the distance between your
vehicle and the object. When the second
red segment comes on, you have reached
the minimum distance.
Front area: An intermittent acoustic
warning will sound as the first red
segment comes on and a constant
acoustic warning lasting a maximum
of two seconds will sound for the second red segment. The signal is canceled when the gear selector lever is
placed in position P or the parking
brake is activated.
Rear area: An intermittent acoustic
warning will sound as the first red
segment comes on and a constant
acoustic warning lasting a maximum
of two seconds will sound for the second red segment. The signal is canceled when the gear selector lever is
placed in position D, P, or the parking
brake is activated.
Controls in detail
Driving systems
Switching the Parktronic system on/off
Switching off the Parktronic system
The Parktronic system can be switched
off manually.
Press button 1.
The Parktronic button is located on the
lower part of the front center console.
Indicator lamp 2 comes on.
Switching on the Parktronic system
Press button 1 again.
Indicator lamp 2 goes out.
i
The Parktronic system is automatically switched on when the ignition is
switched on.
If only the red segments of the Parktronic warning indicator light up and no
warning sounds, then the sensors of the
Parktronic system are dirty or malfunctioning. Malfunction may also be caused
by interference from other radio or ultrasonic signals. The Parktronic system will
switch itself off after 20 seconds.
Clean Parktronic system sensors
( page 378).
Switch on the ignition.
or
Check Parktronic operation at anoth-
Parktronic malfunction
1 Parktronic on/off
2 Indicator lamp
There is a malfunction in the Parktronic
system if the red segments of the Parktronic warning indicator come on and a
warning sounds. The Parktronic system
will switch itself off after 30 seconds and
the indicator lamp on the Parktronic button comes on.
er location to rule out interference
from outside radio or ultrasonic signals.
Have the Parktronic system checked
by an authorized Maybach Studio as
soon as possible.
255
Controls in detail
Loading
Cargo tie-down hooks
Six hooks are located in the trunk.
Carefully secure cargo by applying even
load on all hooks with rope of sufficient
strength to hold down the cargo.
Loading instructions
The total load weight including vehicle
occupants and luggage/cargo should not
exceed the vehicle capacity weight indicated on the corresponding tag located
on the driver’s door B-pillar.
Warning!
G
Always fasten items being carried as securely as possible.
In an accident, during hard braking or sudden maneuvers, loose items will be thrown
around inside the vehicle and can cause injury to vehicle occupants unless the items
are securely fastened in the vehicle.
To help avoid personal injury during a collision or sudden maneuver, exercise care
when transporting cargo. Put luggage or
cargo in the trunk if possible. Do not pile
luggage or cargo higher than the seat
backs. Do not place anything on the rearwindow shelf.
Never drive vehicle with trunk open. Deadly carbon monoxide (CO) gases may enter
vehicle interior resulting in unconsciousness and death.
256
Controls in detail
Useful features
Useful features
To use mirror, lift up cover 2.
Vanity mirrors
Vanity mirror in the rear
Mirror lamp 1 comes on.
Vanity mirror in the sun visor
i
Warning!
G
Do not use the vanity mirror while driving.
Keep the mirrors in the sun visors closed
while the vehicle is in motion. Reflected
glare can endanger you and others.
If you disengage the sun visor from
mounting, mirror lamp 1 will switch
off ( page 197).
Adjusting the vanity mirror
Slide the mirror to the left or to the
right.
Images in the mirror appear in normal size or larger, depending on the
position of the mirror.
Example illustration from Maybach 57
3 Vanity mirror
4 Chrome label
Opening the vanity mirror
Press chrome label 4.
Vanity mirror 3 folds down and the
mirror lamp comes on.
1 Mirror lamp
2 Mirror cover
Closing the vanity mirror
Push vanity mirror 3 up until it en-
gages in place.
257
Controls in detail
Useful features
Ventilation grille with upper storage
box
Storage compartments
Warning!
G
Closing the upper storage box
Fold the cover down until it engages
in the lock.
Luggage nets cannot secure hard or heavy
objects.
braking
vehicle maneuvers or
an accident.
258
Press the chrome label.
The storage box opens.
To help avoid personal injury during a collision or sudden maneuver, exercise care
when stowing objects in the vehicle. Put
luggage or cargo in the cargo compartment if possible. Do not pile luggage or
cargo higher than the seat backs.
Keep compartment lids closed. This will
help to prevent stored objects from being
thrown around and injuring vehicle occupants during
Opening the upper storage box
1 Upper storage box
Controls in detail
Useful features
Glove box
i
Unlocking the glove box separately
An AUX socket is located in the glove
box. Portable audio devices can be
plugged in here.
Pull the mechanical key out of the
SmartKey ( page 423).
Insert the mechanical key into the
Opening
glove box lock and turn it to
unlocked position 3.
Press button 1.
You can now open the glove box.
The glove box lid 2 swings down.
Storage compartment in the glove box
Closing
1
2
3
4
Glove box lid release
Glove box lid
Unlocked position
Locked position
Push lid 2 up to close.
A storage compartment for pens, a flashlight and a coin holder is located in the
cover of the glove box.
Locking the glove box separately
Opening
i
You can lock the glove box separately,
e.g. when the vehicle is in the shop for
service.
The glove box can be heated or
cooled.
Pull the mechanical key out of the
SmartKey ( page 423).
Closing
Insert the mechanical key into the
Lightly push the cover plate up until
The glove box can get very warm due
to its confined space ( page 209).
When storing heat-sensitive objects
in the glove box, close the air vent
while heating the passenger compartment.
glove box lock and turn it to locked
position 4.
Lightly touch cover plate.
The cover opens automatically.
it engages in lock.
i
The separate locking status of the
glove box can only be canceled by
means of the mechanical key.
259
Controls in detail
Useful features
Compartment for the front telephone
Warning!
Closing
Press button 1 to close.
G
!
To prevent any damage, the telephone flap must be folded down before closing the telephone
compartment.
Always keep the compartment for the
front telephone closed while driving. The
protruding telephone could otherwise
cause injury to you and others during
braking
vehicle maneuvers or
an accident.
i
1 Compartment lid release
2 Compartment for telephone
Opening
Press button 1.
The compartment lid opens downward. The telephone handset swings
out.
260
The Roadside Assistance button •
and the Information button ¡
( page 298) are located in the compartment for the front telephone.
Controls in detail
Useful features
Storage compartments in the front
doors
Warning!
G
Always keep the door storage compartments closed while the vehicle is in motion.
Failure to do so may cause the seat belt to
catch at the rear and prevent proper positioning of the seat belt.
Opening the storage compartment
Lift the lid 1 up.
Storage compartments in the rear doors
(Maybach 57)
Closing the storage compartment
Press the lid 1 down.
Opening the storage compartment
Press button 2.
The storage compartment 3 opens.
Closing the storage compartment
Push the cover plate 3 up until it en-
gages in the lock.
1 Headphones storage compartment
2 Storage compartment (for ashtray in
vehicles with a rear center seat*)
Opening the storage compartment
Lift the lid 1 or 2 up.
Closing the storage compartment
1 Storage compartment
2 Opening button
3 Storage compartment with storage
space for change and CDs
Press the lid 1 or 2 down.
261
Controls in detail
Useful features
Storage compartments in the rear doors
(Maybach 62)
Opening the storage compartment
Lift the lid 1 or 2 up.
Storage compartment under the driver’s
seat
Closing the storage compartment
Press the lid 1 or 2 down.
Opening the storage compartment
Press button 3.
Storage compartment 4 opens.
Closing the storage compartment
1
2
3
4
Headphones storage compartment
Storage compartment
Opening button
Storage compartment (for ashtray in
vehicles with a rear center seat*)
Push the cover plate 4 up until it en-
gages in the lock.
1 Tabs
Opening the storage compartment
Press tabs 1 together.
Fold the cover forward.
Closing the storage compartment
Close the cover until both tabs 1 of
lock engage.
262
Controls in detail
Useful features
Storage compartment and storage compartment/drawer between the front
seats (Maybach 62 with partition*)
Opening storage compartment
Press button 2 briefly.
The storage compartment 1 opens
upward.
Storage compartments in rear center
console
Opening/closing the storage compartment/drawer in rear center console
Closing storage compartment
Push storage compartment 1 down-
ward until it engages in the lock.
Opening storage compartment/drawer
Press button 4 briefly.
1 Storage compartment
2 Opening button for storage compartment
3 Storage compartment/drawer
4 Opening button for storage compartment/drawer
The storage compartment/drawer 3
opens.
Closing storage compartment/drawer
Push storage compartment/
drawer 1 until it engages in the lock.
Example illustration from Maybach 57
1 Opening button for storage compartment/drawer
2 Storage compartment/drawer
i
The remote control for the rear-cabin
audiovisual system (see the separate
operating manual COMAND and
Rear-Cabin Audiovisual System) is located in the storage compartment/
drawer.
263
Controls in detail
Useful features
i
Maybach 62:
Maybach 62 with rear center seat*:
To open, press button 1.
In the storage compartment/drawer
are:
The storage compartment/drawer 2
opens slightly.
the Pocket PC* ( page 311)
If necessary:
an additional SOS button, only in
Maybach 62 vehicles with partition* or two-way intercom*
( page 298)
Close the champagne flute/bottle
holder ( page 271).
buttons for two-way intercom*
( page 287)
Maybach 57:
To open, press button 1.
The storage compartment/drawer 2
opens.
To close, push storage compartment/
drawer 2 in until it engages in the
lock.
Opening/closing the upper storage compartment in rear center console
(only Maybach 62)
or
Close the folding table*
( page 275).
Press button 1 again.
The storage compartment/drawer 2
opens fully.
To close, push storage compartment/
drawer 2 in until it engages in the
lock.
Example illustration from Maybach 62 with
partition*
1 Opening button for upper storage
compartment
2 Cover
To open, press button 1.
The cover 2 swings upward.
To close, press the cover 2 down-
ward.
The cover 2 engages automatically.
264
Controls in detail
Useful features
Storage pocket (only Maybach 62)
Warning!
G
Storage pockets for Maybach 62 without
partition*
Storage pockets for Maybach 62 with
partition*
Storage pockets are located on the left
and right side of the rear center console.
Storage pockets are located on the back
of the front seats.
1 Storage pocket
1 Storage pocket
The storage pocket is intended for storing
light-weight items only.
Heavy objects, objects with sharp edges or
fragile objects may not be transported in
the storage pocket.
The storage pocket cannot protect transported goods in the event of an accident.
265
Controls in detail
Useful features
Storage compartments between the rear
seats
Warning!
G
Always fold the rear center armrest 6
downward while the vehicle is in motion.
During an accident the rear center armrest
could open the storage compartment 5.
This will help to prevent stored objects
from being thrown around.
i
Example illustration from Maybach 57
1 Upper storage compartment with insert for champagne flutes
2 Opening button for upper storage
compartment
3 DVD player compartment and AUX
sockets, headphone jacks
4 CD changer compartment
5 Middle storage compartment
6 Rear center armrest with compartment for telephone, storage compartment/refrigerator** underneath
7 Release catch
8 Ashtray/storage compartment*
For more information on DVD player,
AUX sockets, headphone jacks and
CD changer refer to the separate
COMAND and Rear-Cabin Audiovisual System operating instructions.
Opening the upper storage compartment 1
Press the cover closed.
The cover engages automatically.
Opening/closing the storage compartment in the rear center armrest
To open, release catch 7 and swing
cover of the rear center armrest 6
upward.
To close, press the cover of the rear
center armrest 6 downward.
The cover engages automatically.
i
There is an additional storage compartment in front of the telephone
compartment.
Press button 2.
The upper storage compartment
opens upward.
Opening/closing the storage compartment under the rear center armrest
To open, lift up armrest 6.
Opening storage compartments 3, 4,
5 and 8
Press the chrome label on the cover.
The compartment opens.
266
Closing storage compartments 3, 4, 5
and 8
To close, press the armrest 6 down-
ward.
Controls in detail
Useful features
Storage compartments in vehicles with a
rear center seat*
Opening/closing the telephone
compartment
If the third seat is not occupied, you can
also use the seat backrest as an armrest.
Press release catch 6 and swing
cover 5 upward 8.
i
There is an additional storage compartment in front of the telephone
compartment.
Closing the telephone compartment
Press cover 5 down until it engages.
Opening the storage compartment
Press the chrome label on storage
Example illustration from Maybach 57
Example illustration from Maybach 57
compartment 7.
1 Rear armrest
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
The storage compartment slides out.
Pull the top of armrest 1 out and
fold it downward.
DVD player
CD changer
AUX sockets and, headphone jacks
Storage compartment
Cover
Release catch
Storage compartment
To open telephone compartment
Closing the storage compartment
Push storage compartment 7 in until
it engages.
267
Controls in detail
Useful features
i
Opening the compartment
For more information on DVD player,
AUX sockets, headphone jacks and
CD changer refer to the separate
COMAND and Rear-Cabin Audiovisual System operating instructions.
Turn handle 1 or 4 90°.
Storage compartments in trunk
Umbrella
An umbrella is located in the trunk.
Swing the cover down.
Closing the compartment
Swing the cover up.
Turn handle 1 or 4 90°.
1 Umbrella
2 Straps
Use straps 2 on the inside of the
trunk lid to store and secure
umbrella 1.
1 Handle
2 Compartment for navigation system
DVD drive
3 Storage compartment
4 Handle
268
Controls in detail
Useful features
Cup holders
Warning!
Cup holders, cockpit
G
In order to help prevent spilling liquids on
vehicle occupants, only use containers that
fit into the cup holder. Use lids on open
containers and do not fill containers to a
height where the contents, especially hot
liquids, could spill during braking, vehicle
maneuvers, or in an accident.
Closing
Push the cup holder in until it engag-
es.
Press the cover closed.
The cover engages automatically.
Rear cup/bottle holders
When not in use, keep the cup holder
closed. An open cup holder may cause injury to you or others when contacted during
braking, vehicle maneuvers, or in an accident.
1 Cup holder, left
2 Cup holder, right
Opening
Press the chrome label on the cover.
The compartment opens.
Press the chrome label of the desired
cup holder.
Keep in mind that objects placed in the cup
holder may come loose during braking, vehicle maneuvers, or in an accident and be
thrown around in the vehicle interior. Objects thrown around in the vehicle interior
may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury.
1 Rear cup holder
2 Release catch for champagne flute/
bottle holder
3 Release catch for cup holder
The cup holder slides out.
269
Controls in detail
Useful features
Opening
Closing
Press the release catch on cup
Take the cups out of the holder.
holder 3.
Press the holder back in until it en-
The cup holder slides out automatically.
Warning!
G
gages.
Cup holder (vehicles with a rear center
seat*)
In order to help prevent spilling liquids on
vehicle occupants, only use containers that
fit into the cup holder. Use lids on open
containers and do not fill containers to a
height where the contents, especially hot
liquids, could spill during braking, vehicle
maneuvers, or in an accident.
When not in use, keep the cup holder
closed. An open cup holder may cause injury to you or others when contacted during
braking, vehicle maneuvers, or in an accident.
Keep in mind that objects placed in the cup
holder may come loose during braking, vehicle maneuvers, or in an accident and be
thrown around in the vehicle interior. Objects thrown around in the vehicle interior
may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury.
270
Warning!
G
In order to help prevent spilling liquids on
vehicle occupants, only use containers that
fit into the cup holder. Use lids on open
containers and do not fill containers to a
height where the contents, especially hot
liquids, could spill during braking, vehicle
maneuvers, or in an accident.
When not in use, keep the cup holder
closed. An open cup holder may cause injury to you or others when contacted during
braking, vehicle maneuvers, or in an accident.
1 Cup holder, right
2 Cup holder, left
Keep in mind that objects placed in the cup
holder may come loose during braking, vehicle maneuvers, or in an accident and be
thrown around in the vehicle interior. Objects thrown around in the vehicle interior
may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury.
Opening
Closing
Press the label of the desired cup
Remove the cup.
holder.
The cup holder slides out.
Push the cup holder in until it engag-
es.
Controls in detail
Useful features
Champagne flute/bottle holder
Warning!
Warning!
G
When not in use, keep the champagne
flute/bottle holder closed while the vehicle
is in motion.
Place only champagne flutes from the
Maybach Accessory range into the champagne flute holder. Only use those flutes
designed for use with the holder. Make
sure the champagne flutes are held in
place by the retaining clips whenever the
flutes are placed in the holder. This will reduce the risk of the flutes becoming loose
during vehicle maneuvers.
Place only bottles that fit fully within the
bottle holder to reduce the possibility of
the bottle becoming loose and being
thrown around in the vehicle interior during vehicle maneuvers.
G
Always obey applicable state or province
laws regarding passengers consuming alcoholic beverages in the vehicle and/or carrying alcoholic beverages in the vehicle
interior.
Inserting champagne flutes
i
Use the champagne flutes from the
Maybach Accessory range. Only those
flutes are designed for use with the
holder.
Opening
Press the release catch on champagne
flute/bottle holder 2.
The champagne flute/bottle holder
slides out automatically.
Take the drip tray out of the opening
for the bottle and place it under the
opening on the carpet.
Magnets hold the drip tray in the correct position.
Example illustration from Maybach 57
Loose objects being thrown around in the
vehicle during vehicle maneuvers may
cause an accident and/or serious personal
injury.
271
Controls in detail
Useful features
Place the champagne flutes in the re-
Ashtrays
Removing ashtray insert
tainers and press them down lightly.
The champagne flutes are held in
place by the retaining clips.
Center console ashtray
Warning!
G
Remove front ashtray only with vehicle
standing still. Set the parking brake to secure vehicle from movement. Move gear
selector lever to position P. With gear selector lever in position P, turn off the engine.
To remove the champagne flutes,
pull them upright carefully.
Closing
Take the champagne flutes/bottle
out of the holder.
Push sliding button 1 to the right.
With the champagne flute/bottle
holder open, remove the drip tray
from the transmission tunnel and
place it in the opening for the bottle.
Press the holder closed until it engages.
1 Sliding button
2 Insert slides out
Opening ashtray
Tap lightly on the chrome label on
the cover.
The ashtray opens automatically.
272
The ashtray is disengaged and slides a
short way out 2.
Remove insert from ashtray frame.
Reinstalling the ashtray insert
Install insert by pushing back into
frame until it engages again.
Close the ashtray.
Controls in detail
Useful features
Rear compartment ashtray
Reinstalling the ashtray insert
Install insert by pushing back into
frame until it engages again.
Close the ashtray.
Ashtrays vehicles with a rear center
seat*
The ashtrays are located in the storage
compartments in the rear doors
( page 261).
1 Sliding button
2 Insert slides out
Cigarette lighters
Center console lighter
Warning!
Never touch the heating element or sides
of the lighter; they are extremely hot. Hold
the knob only.
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment
may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury.
Opening ashtray
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Tap lightly on the chrome label on
Push in cigarette lighter 1.
the cover.
G
The lighter will pop out automatically
when hot.
The ashtray opens automatically.
i
Removing ashtray insert
The lighter socket can be used to accommodate electrical accessories up
to a maximum 85 W.
Push sliding button 1 to the right.
The ashtray is disengaged and slides a
short way out 2.
1 Cigarette lighter
273
Controls in detail
Useful features
Rear compartment lighter
i
Non-smokers package*
The lighter socket can be used to accommodate electrical accessories up
to a maximum of 85 W.
Warning!
Storage compartment in front center
console
G
Never touch the heating element or sides
of the lighter; they are extremely hot. Hold
the knob only.
1 Cigarette lighter
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Push in cigarette lighter 1.
The lighter will pop out automatically
when hot.
i
Make sure the override switch is not
activated ( page 94). The rear lighter will not function if the override
switch is activated.
274
To avoid possible injury to children sitting
in the rear seat, deactivate the operation
of the rear door windows ( page 94). Deactivation of the rear windows also deactivates the rear compartment lighter.
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment
may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury.
1 Storage compartment
2 Chrome label
Tap lightly on chrome label 2 on the
cover.
Storage compartment 1 opens.
Controls in detail
Useful features
Storage compartment in rear center console
Opening the folding table
Folding table*
(standard on Maybach 62;
optional on Maybach 57)
Warning!
G
Keep the folding table closed while the vehicle is in motion. Otherwise, you could be
injured by the table or by objects flying off
the table during
1 Storage compartment
2 Chrome label
Tap lightly on chrome label 2 on the
cover.
Storage compartment 1 opens.
braking
vehicle maneuvers or
an accident.
Always fold the rear center armrest 1
downward while the vehicle is in motion.
During an accident the rear center armrest
could open the storage compartment. This
will help to prevent stored objects from
being thrown around.
1 To raise the armrest
2 Loop
3 Folding table
Lift up armrest 1.
Pull up folding table 3 vertically, us-
ing loop 2.
275
Controls in detail
Useful features
Closing the folding table
Fold the table halves together.
Swing the table upward vertically.
Press the table until it engages at the
base of the folding table.
If necessary, lift up the armrest.
Swing the folding table back com-
pletely.
4 To pull out the table
5 To swing the table to the side
6 Table
Pull table 6 out vertically 4.
Swing the table to the side 5.
Lower armrest 1.
7
8
9
a
Fold out table half
Table half
Move table surface fore and aft
Tilt table surface
Fold out table half 8 from 7.
Press button 9 and adjust the table
fore or aft to the desired position.
Press button a to adjust the table
surface tilt. When you have obtained
the desired tilt, release the button.
276
Lower the armrest.
Controls in detail
Useful features
Refrigerator** in rear center console
Warning!
G
Always fold the rear center armrest downward while the vehicle is in motion. During
an accident the rear center armrest could
open the storage compartment. This will
help to prevent stored objects from being
thrown around.
!
i
Opening the refrigerator
The refrigerator continues to operate
for up to 2 hours after the ignition
has been switched off. If the onboard voltage falls below the minimum level, the refrigerator will be
turned off automatically.
Lift up the rear center armrest up-
ward.
Reach into the opening and lift up re-
lease catch 1.
Open cover 2.
Therefore, do not leave any perishable goods in the refrigerator.
Do not leave any open groceries in
the refrigerator.
In especially humid regions, water can
condense inside the refrigerator. For
this reason, wipe out the refrigerator
regularly. For more information on
vehicle care ( page 375).
1 To release the cover
2 To open the refrigerator
3 Refrigerator
277
Controls in detail
Useful features
Refrigerator control
Regulating the temperature
Turn knob 4 to the desired position.
!
When setting max. cooling, the temperature in the refrigerator may fall
below freezing point. Objects stored
in the refrigerator such as water bottles may burst.
Closing the refrigerator
4
5
6
7
Control knob
To increase cooling
To decrease cooling
To turn off the refrigerator
Press the lid down until it engages.
1 Socket in the rear center console
(vehicles with a rear center seat*)
12-V socket
Turning refrigerator on
Turn knob 4 from OFF position 7
clockwise.
The refrigerator is on.
Turning refrigerator off
1 Socket in the trunk
Turn knob 4 counterclockwise to
OFF position 7. Make sure the rotary
control is turned fully counterclockwise, until an audible 'click' is heard.
278
1 Socket in the rear center console
Sockets 1 can accommodate electrical
accessories up to a maximum of 180 W.
Controls in detail
Useful features
i
In vehicles with non-smokers package*, an additional sockets is located
in the passenger footwell.
i
Make sure the override switch is not
activated ( page 94). The socket in
the rear center console will not function if the override switch is activated.
driving the vehicle for such extended periods of time may cause the charge in the
battery for electrical consumers to drop.
The socket is located in the storage compartment on the left side of the trunk.
Only the battery charge maintenance
unit should be connected to this socket.
!
nance unit to battery charge maintenance socket 2. Follow the
manufacturer’s operating instructions.
i
You can obtain the battery charge
maintenance unit at any authorized
Maybach Studio. Check with an authorized Maybach Studio for availability.
It is only possible to maintain the existing
charge in the battery for electrical consumers using the battery charge maintenance unit connected to battery charge
maintenance socket 2.
Make sure no fluids come into contact with the socket, as this could
cause a short circuit.
Battery charge maintenance socket
The vehicle is equipped with a battery
charge maintenance socket. The socket
allows for the connection of a battery
charge maintenance unit designed to
maintain the existing charge in the battery for electrical consumers while the
vehicle is parked and not being driven
for long periods of time (on average approximately three weeks or more). Not
Connect the battery charge mainte-
1 Handle
2 Battery charge maintenance socket
3 Storage compartment
Turn handle 1 90°.
Swing the cover down.
i
If the battery for electrical consumers
is discharged, it must be recharged using the battery charger. For more information, see "Practical hints"
( page 441).
279
Controls in detail
Useful features
Rear window curtain
The driver’s switch is in the lower part of
the front center console under the cover
for the cup holders. Depending on
equipment, the switch in the rear is either in the center console or in the top of
the center armrest.
Operating from the cockpit
To stop the procedure, press the
switch again.
Opening the curtain
Briefly press switch 2.
The curtain opens automatically.
To stop the procedure, press the
switch again.
Operating from the rear (only for vehicles without rear side window curtains*)
Closing the curtain
Briefly press switch 1.
The curtain closes automatically.
To stop the procedure, press the but-
ton again.
Opening the curtain
Briefly press switch 1.
The curtain opens automatically.
To stop the procedure, press the
switch again.
i
Vehicles with rear center seat*:
For operation with the Pocket PC remote control* ( page 326).
Switch in cockpit
1 To close the curtain
2 To open the curtain
Rear switch
Closing the curtain
1 To close/open the curtain
Briefly press switch 1.
The curtain closes automatically.
280
Controls in detail
Useful features
Operating from the rear (only for vehicles with rear side window curtains*)
Opening the curtain
Lightly press switch 2 to resistance
point.
The curtain will open until you release the switch.
Fully closing the curtain (Express-close)
Press switch 1 past the resistance
point and release.
Rear side window curtains*
The driver’s switches are in the lower
part of the front center console under
the cover for the cup holders. Depending
on equipment, the switch in the rear is
either in the center console or in the top
of the center armrest.
Operating from the cockpit
The curtain closes completely.
To stop the procedure, press the
Rear switch
1 To close the curtain
2 To open the curtain
Open the storage compartment in
the rear center armrest ( page 266).
Closing the curtain
switch again.
Fully opening the curtain (Express-open)
Press switch 2 past the resistance
point and release.
The curtain opens completely.
To stop the procedure, press the
switch again.
Switch in cockpit
point.
i
The curtain will close until you release the switch.
Vehicles with rear center seat*:
For operation with the Pocket PC remote control* ( page 326).
1
2
3
4
Lightly press switch 1 to resistance
To close the curtain
To open the curtain
Switch for rear left side window
Switch for rear right side window
281
Controls in detail
Useful features
i
If you open a side window without
rear side window curtain completely
open, the curtain will open first.
Closing the curtain
Briefly press upper part 1 of
switch 3 or 4.
The respective curtain closes.
To stop the procedure, press the
switch again
Opening the curtain
Briefly press lower part 2 of
switch 3 or 4.
The respective curtain opens.
To stop the procedure, press the
switch again.
Warning!
G
Operating from the rear
When operating the curtains, make sure
there is no danger of anyone being
harmed by the opening or closing procedure.
The opening or closing procedure can be
immediately halted by pressing the respective switch again.
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment
may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury.
Rear switch
1
2
3
4
To close the curtain
To open the curtain
Switch for rear left side window
Switch for rear right side window
Open the storage compartment in
the rear center armrest ( page 266).
Closing the curtain
Lightly press upper part 1 of
switch 3 or 4 to resistance point.
The respective curtain will close until
you release the switch.
282
Controls in detail
Useful features
Opening the curtain
Fully opening the curtain (Express-open)
Lightly press lower part 2 of
Press lower part 2 of switch 3 or 4
switch 3 or 4 to resistance point.
The respective curtain will open until
you release the switch.
Fully closing the curtain (Express-close)
Press upper part 1 of switch 3 or 4
past the resistance point and release.
The curtain closes completely.
To stop the procedure, press the
switch again.
past the point of resistance and release.
The curtain opens completely.
To stop the procedure, press the
switch again.
i
Vehicles with rear center seat*:
For operation with the Pocket PC remote control* ( page 322).
Warning!
G
When operating the curtains, make sure
there is no danger of anyone being
harmed by the opening or closing procedure.
The opening or closing procedure can be
immediately halted by pressing respective
switch 3 or 4.
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment
may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury.
283
Controls in detail
Useful features
Partition*
Operating the partition
Warning!
G
When operating the partition, make sure
there is no danger of anyone being
harmed by the opening or closing procedure.
The opening or closing procedure can be
immediately halted by releasing the switch
or, if the switch was pressed past the resistance point and released, by pressing the
respective switch again.
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment
may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury.
284
Switch in cockpit
Switch in rear passenger compartment
1 To close the partition
2 To open the partition
1 To close the partition
2 To open the partition
i
Closing the partition from the rear is
not possible if you activate the override switch ( page 94).
When operating from the rear, you
must first open the storage compartment in the rear center armrest
( page 266).
Closing the partition
Lightly press switch 1 to resistance
point.
The partition will close until you release the switch.
Controls in detail
Useful features
Opening the partition
Operating the partition curtain
Lightly press switch 2 to resistance
point.
The partition will open until you release the switch.
Fully closing the partition
(Express-close)
Press switch 1 past the resistance
point and release.
The partition closes completely.
To stop the procedure, press the
switch again.
Fully opening the partition
(Express-open)
Press switch 2 past the point of resis-
tance and release.
The partition opens completely.
Warning!
G
When operating the curtains, make sure
there is no danger of anyone being
harmed by the opening or closing procedure.
The opening or closing procedure can be
immediately halted by releasing the switch
or, if the switch was pressed past the resistance point and released, by pressing the
respective switch again.
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment
may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury.
Switch in cockpit
1 To close the curtain
2 To open the curtain
To stop the procedure, press the
switch again.
i
Vehicles with rear center seat*:
For operation with the Pocket PC remote control* ( page 327).
285
Controls in detail
Useful features
Closing the curtain
Fully closing the curtain (Express-close)
Lightly press switch 1 to resistance
Press switch 1 past the resistance
point.
point and release.
The curtain will close until you release the switch.
The curtain closes completely.
Opening the curtain
Lightly press switch 2 to resistance
point.
Switch in rear passenger compartment
1 To close the curtain
2 To open the curtain
By operating from the rear, open the
storage compartment in the rear center armrest ( page 266).
286
The curtain will open until you release the switch.
To stop the procedure, press the
switch again.
Fully opening the curtain (Express-open)
Press switch 2 past the resistance
point and release.
The curtain opens completely.
To stop the procedure, press the
switch again.
i
Vehicles with rear center seat*:
For operation with the Pocket PC remote control* ( page 322).
Controls in detail
Useful features
Two-way intercom* (Maybach 62:
standard with partition*)
With the partition closed, you can communicate between the cockpit and the
rear passenger compartment using the
two-way intercom.
You can only initiate a voice connection
from the rear passenger compartment.
The driver can only signal a connection
request from the cockpit.
Press button 1.
A gong sounds in the rear passenger
compartment, and the indicator lamp
on the button comes on.
Initiating a voice connection from the
rear
The buttons are on the rear center console (in Maybach 62 with a rear center
seat* in the storage compartment/drawer in rear center console).
Signaling a connection request from the
cockpit
The button is located on the lower part
of the front center console.
Maybach 62 with rear center seat*
1 Volume control
2 Speak button
Press button 2.
Maybach 62
1 Volume control
2 Speak button
A gong sounds in the cockpit, and a
voice connection is established between the cockpit and the rear passenger compartment.
1 On/off button
287
Controls in detail
Useful features
Adjusting the volume
Turn thumbwheel 1 until the de-
sired volume has been set.
Ending the voice connection
Press button 2 again in the rear pas-
senger compartment.
External communication (special
order equipment)
With the communication system, you can
communicate with persons outside the
vehicle over a loudspeaker and an outside microphone, without having to
open a door or window.
Take the control unit out of the glove
box.
Listening
Push microphone switch-over 5
downward.
You will hear what is being said outside of the vehicle.
Speaking
Press speak button 1 and keep it
pressed.
You can speak as long as you keep
button 1 pressed.
Adjust volume with the volume con-
trol button 2.
1
2
3
4
5
288
Speak button for inside microphone
Volume control
Loudspeaker for outside microphone
Inside microphone
Microphone switch-over
Controls in detail
Useful features
Telephone
Warning!
G
Never operate radio transmitters equipped
with a built-in or attached antenna
(i.e. without being connected to an external antenna) from inside the vehicle while
the engine is running. Doing so could lead
to a malfunction of the vehicle’s electronic
system, possibly resulting in an accident
and/or serious personal injury.
Radio transmitters, such as a portable
telephone or a citizens band unit, should
only be used inside the vehicle if they are
connected to an antenna that is installed
on the outside of the vehicle.
Warning!
G
Please do not forget that your primary responsibility is to drive the vehicle. A driver’s attention to the road must always be
his/her primary focus when driving. For
your safety and the safety of others, we
recommend that you pull over to a safe location and stop before placing or taking a
telephone call.
The external antenna must be approved
for Maybach vehicles. Please contact an
authorized Maybach Studio for information on the installation of an approved
external antenna. Refer to the radio
transmitter operation instructions regarding use of an external antenna.
If you choose to use the telephone1 while
driving, please use the hands-free device
and only use the telephone when road,
weather and traffic conditions permit.
Some jurisdictions prohibit the driver from
using a cellular telephone while driving a
vehicle.
Only operate the COMAND (Cockpit Management and Data System)1 if road,
weather and traffic conditions permit.
Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph
(approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is
covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14 m) every second.
1
Observe all legal requirements.
289
Controls in detail
Useful features
You can receive and place telephone
calls using the s and t buttons on
the steering wheel. To carry out other
telephone functions, use the control system ( page 165).
See the separate operating manual
COMAND and Rear-Cabin Audiovisual
System for instructions on how to use the
telephone.
Cellular phone in the front
1 Compartment lid release
2 Compartment lid
290
Opening
Closing
Press button 1.
Press button 1 to close.
The compartment lid 2 opens downward. The telephone handset swings
out.
Warning!
G
Always keep the compartment for the
front telephone closed while the vehicle is
in motion. The protruding telephone could
otherwise cause injury to you and others
during
braking
vehicle maneuvers or
an accident.
!
To prevent any damage, the cellular
phone flap must be folded down before closing the telephone compartment.
i
The Roadside Assistance button •
and the Information button ¡
( page 298) are located in the compartment for the front telephone.
Controls in detail
Useful features
Removing the cellular phone from the
cradle
Inserting the cellular phone in the cellular phone cradle
Remove the round aerial contact cov-
er on the back of the cellular phone.
1 Release button
2 Engage the cell phone in cradle
Push the top of the cellular phone in
1 Release button
Press the release button 1 and re-
move the cellular phone from the cradle.
Cellular phone in the rear
The cellular phone is located in the rear
armrest.
1 Insert the cellular phone
2 Connector contact
3 Cellular phone cradle
Slide the lower end of the cellular
phone into connector contact 2 on
cradle 3.
direction of arrow 2, until the lug on
the cellular phone release button 1
engages.
The battery will be charged depending on its charge status and the position of the SmartKey in the starter
switch. The charging process is shown
in the cellular phone display.
Open the storage compartment in
the rear center armrest ( page 266).
291
Controls in detail
Useful features
i
Making calls in private mode
If you insert the cellular phone in the
cradle and the SmartKey is not the
starter switch, the cellular phone will
remain on for approximately one
minute. If you make a call during this
time, the cellular phone will be
switched off approximately one
minute (delayed switch-off time) after you hang up.
When you remove the SmartKey from
the starter switch, the cellular phone
remains on for approximately one
minute.
1 Holder
2 Raise holder
Briefly press the top of the cell phone
in direction of arrow 2.
The holder 1 folds up.
292
1
2
3
4
Holder
Remove the cellular phone and cradle
Cellular phone flap
Cellular phone cradle
Remove the cellular phone, together
with the cradle, from the holder 2.
Fold the cellular phone flap 3 up.
Controls in detail
Useful features
Close the cellular phone flap.
Re-inserting the cellular phone
Hands-free mode is selected.
If you wish to change back to private
mode:
Open the cellular phone flap.
Remove the cellular phone from the
holder ( page 292).
1 Fold the cellular phone flap down
2 Insert the cellular phone and cradle
Fold the cellular phone flap 1 down.
Guide the cellular phone, together
with the cradle, into the holder 2.
1 Holder
2 Engage holder
Removing the cellular phone from the
cradle
Push the top of the cellular phone in
direction of arrow 2, until the
holder 1 engages.
!
To prevent any damage, the cellular
phone flap must be folded down before closing the telephone compartment.
Making calls in hands-free mode
Open the cellular phone flap.
Either accept the call or dial the de-
sired number.
1 Release button
2 Remove the cellular phone
Press the release button 1 and re-
move the cellular phone from the cradle.
293
Controls in detail
Useful features
Tele Aid
!
The initial activation of the Tele Aid
system may only be performed by
completing the subscriber agreement
and placing an acquaintance call using the Information button ¡, located in the phone compartment to
the left of the glove box. Failure to
complete either of these steps will result in a system that is not activated.
If the system is not activated, the indicator lamp in the SOS button stays on
after switching on ignition and the
message
TELE AID
NOT ACTIVATED
will be shown in the multifunction
display for approximately 10 seconds.
If you have any questions regarding
activation, please call the Maybach
Assistance Center at
1-866-FOR-MAY-Bach (in the USA) or
1-888-881-6611 (in Canada).
294
The Tele Aid system
(Telematic Alarm Identification on
Demand)
The Tele Aid system consists of three
types of response:
automatic and manual emergency
Roadside Assistance and
information
The Tele Aid system is operational providing that the vehicle’s battery is
charged, properly connected, not damaged and cellular and GPS coverage is
available.
The speaker volume of a Tele Aid call can
be adjusted when using the volume control on the multifunction steering wheel
or the volume control on the COMAND.
To raise, press button æ and to lower,
press button ç on the steering wheel
or use the volume knob on your
COMAND headunit. If the service uses
the back-up system the volume is fixed to
an appropriate level.
To activate, press one of the SOS but-
tons, the Roadside Assistance
button • or the Information
button ¡, depending on the type
of response required.
Warning!
G
Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph
(approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is
covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14 m) every second.
Controls in detail
Useful features
i
System self-check
The SOS button is located in the overhead control panel. An additional
SOS button is located in the middle
armrest of the rear seat or, in Maybach 62 vehicles with rear center
seat* and partition* or two-way intercom*, in the storage compartment/drawer in rear center console.
Initially, after switching on ignition, malfunctions are detected and indicated
(the indicator lamps in the SOS button,
the Roadside Assistance button • and
the Information button ¡ stay on
longer than 10 seconds or do not come
on). The message
Warning!
TELE AID MALFUNCTION
DRIVE TO WORKSHOP!
TELE AID MALFUNCTION
DRIVE TO WORKSHOP!
appears in the multifunction display.
is displayed in the multifunction display after the system self-check, a malfunction in
the system has been detected.
The Roadside Assistance button •
and the Information button ¡ are
located in the front telephone compartment.
Shortly after the completion of your
Tele Aid acquaintance call, you will receive a user ID and password.
i
G
If the indicator lamps in the SOS button, in
the Roadside Assistance button • and/
or in the Information button ¡ do not
come on during the system self-check or if
any of these indicators remain illuminated
constantly in red and/or the message
If a malfunction is indicated as outlined
above, the system may not operate as expected. Have the system checked at the
nearest authorized Maybach Studio as
soon as possible.
The Tele Aid system utilizes the cellular network for communication and
the GPS (Global Positioning System)
satellites for vehicle location. If either
of these signals are unavailable, the
Tele Aid system may not function and
if this occurs, assistance must be summoned by other means.
295
Controls in detail
Useful features
Emergency calls
An emergency call is initiated automatically following an accident in which the
emergency tensioning devices (ETDs) or
airbags deploy.
An emergency call can also be initiated
manually by opening the cover in the
overhead control panel labeled SOS,
then briefly pressing the button located
under the cover. An additional SOS button is located in the middle armrest of
the rear seat or, in Maybach 62 vehicles
with rear center seat* and partition* or
with rear center seat* and two-way intercom*, in the storage compartment/
drawer in rear center console.
For instructions on initiating an emergency call manually ( page 297).
Once the emergency call is in progress,
the indicator lamp in the SOS button will
begin to flash. The message
EMERGENCY CALL
CONNECTING CALL
appears in the multifunction display.
296
When the connection is established, the
message
The Tele Aid system is available if:
it has been activated and is operational. Activation requires a subscription for monitoring services,
connection and cellular air time.
the relevant cellular phone network
and GPS signals are available and pass
the information on to the Response
Center
EMERGENCY CALL
CALL CONNECTED
appears in the multifunction display.
All information relevant to the emergency, such as the location of the vehicle (determined by the GPS satellite location
system), vehicle model, identification
number and color are generated.
A voice connection between the Response Center and the occupants of the
vehicle will be established automatically
soon after the emergency call has been
initiated. When a voice connection is established, the audio system mutes and
the message
EMERGENCY CALL
CALL CONNECTED
appears in the multifunction display.
The Response Center will attempt to determine more precisely the nature of the
emergency provided they can speak to
an occupant of the vehicle.
i
Location of the vehicle on a map is
only possible if the vehicle is able to
receive signals from the GPS satellite
network and pass the information on
to the Response Center.
Controls in detail
Useful features
Warning!
G
Initiating an emergency call manually
If the indicator lamp in the SOS button is illuminated continuously and there was no
voice connection to the Response Center
established, then the Tele Aid system could
not initiate an emergency call (e.g. the relevant cellular phone network is not available). The message
EMERGENCY CALL
CALL FAILED
appears in the multifunction display for
approximately 10 seconds.
Should this occur, assistance must be summoned by other means.
SOS button in the rear center console
SOS button in the overhead control panel
1 Cover
2 SOS button
1 Cover
2 SOS button
297
Controls in detail
Useful features
For Maybach 62 with a rear center seat*
and partition* or Maybach 62 with a rear
center seat* and two-way intercom* the
additional SOS button is located in the
storage compartment/drawer in rear
center console.
Briefly press on the cover of the
emergency call button 1 with the
inscription SOS.
The cover will open.
Roadside Assistance button •
The Roadside Assistance button • is
located in the front telephone compartment.
Press SOS button 2 briefly.
The indicator lamp in SOS button 2
flashes until the emergency call is
concluded.
Wait for a voice connection to the Re-
sponse Center.
Close cover 1 after the emergency
call is concluded.
Warning!
SOS button* in the storage compartment/
drawer
1 Cover
2 SOS button
298
G
If you feel at any way in jeopardy when in
the vehicle (e.g. smoke or fire in the vehicle, vehicle in a dangerous road location),
please do not wait for voice contact after
you have pressed the emergency button.
Carefully leave the vehicle and move to a
safe location. The Response Center will automatically contact local emergency officials with the vehicle’s approximate
location if they receive an automatic SOS
signal and cannot make voice contact with
the vehicle occupants.
1 Compartment lid release
Press button 1.
The front telephone compartment lid
opens downward.
Controls in detail
Useful features
When the connection is established, the
message
The following is only available in the
USA:
ROADSIDE ASSISTANCE
CALL CONNECTED
appears in the multifunction display. The
Tele Aid system will transmit data generating the vehicle identification number,
model, color and location (subject to
availability of cellular and GPS signals).
1 Compartment lid release
2 Information button ¡
3 Roadside Assistance button •
Press and hold Roadside Assistance
button • (for longer than
2 seconds).
A call to a Maybach Roadside Assistance dispatcher will be initiated. The
button • flashes while the call is in
progress. The message
ROADSIDE ASSISTANCE
CONNECTING CALL
A voice connection between the Roadside Assistance dispatcher and the occupants of the vehicle will be established.
Describe the nature of the need for
assistance.
The Maybach Roadside Assistance dispatcher will either dispatch a qualified
Maybach technician or arrange to tow
your vehicle to the nearest authorized
Maybach Studio. For services such as labor and/or towing, charges may apply.
Refer to the Roadside Assistance manual
for more information.
Sign and Drive services: Services such
as a jump start, a few gallons of fuel
or the replacement of a flat tire with
the vehicle spare tire are obtainable.
i
The indicator lamp on the Roadside
Assistance button • remains illuminated in red for approximately
10 seconds during the system
self-check after switching on ignition
(together with the SOS button and
the Information button ¡).
See system self-check ( page 295)
when the indicator lamp does not
come on in red or stays on longer
than approximately 10 seconds.
will appear in the multifunction display.
299
Controls in detail
Useful features
If the indicator lamp on the Roadside
Assistance button • is illuminated
continuously and there was no voice
connection to the Response Center
established, then the Tele Aid system
could not initiate a Roadside Assistance call (e.g. the relevant cellular
phone network is not available). The
message
ROADSIDE ASSISTANCE
CALL FAILED
appears in the multifunction display.
Roadside Assistance calls can be terminated using the t button on
the multifunction steering wheel or
the respective button for ending a
telephone call on the COMAND headunit.
300
Information button ¡
The Information button ¡ is located
in the front telephone compartment
( page 299).
Press and hold Information
button ¡ (for longer than
2 seconds).
A call to the Customer Assistance
Center will be initiated. The
button ¡ flashes while the call is in
progress. The message
INFO
CONNECTING CALL
will appear in the multifunction display.
When the connection is established, the
message
INFO
CALL CONNECTED
appears in the multifunction display. The
Tele Aid system will transmit data generating the vehicle identification number,
model, color and location (subject to
availability of cellular and GPS signals).
A voice connection between the Customer Assistance Center representative and
the occupants of the vehicle will be established. When a voice connection is established, the audio system mutes and
the message
INFO
CALL CONNECTED
appears in the multifunction display. Information regarding the operation of
your vehicle, the nearest authorized
Maybach Studio or Maybach USA products and services is available to you.
Controls in detail
Useful features
i
The indicator lamp on the Information button ¡ remains illuminated
in red for approximately 10 seconds
during the system self-check after
switching on ignition (together with
the SOS button and the Roadside Assistance button •).
See system self-check ( page 295)
when the indicator lamp does not
come on in red or stays on longer
than approximately 10 seconds.
If the indicator lamp on the information button ¡ is illuminated continuously and there was no voice
connection to the Response Center
has been established, then the Tele
Aid system could not initiate an Information call (e.g. the relevant cellular
phone network is not available).
The message
INFO
CALL FAILED
Information calls can be terminated
using the t button on the multifunction steering wheel or the respective button for ending a
telephone call on the COMAND headunit.
!
If the indicator lamps do not start
flashing after pressing one of the buttons or remain illuminated (in red) at
any time, the Tele Aid system has detected a malfunction or the service is
not currently active, and may not initiate a call. Visit your Maybach Studio
and have the system checked or contact the Maybach Assistance Center
at 1-866-FOR-MAY-Bach (in the USA)
or 1-888-881-6611 (in Canada) as
soon as possible.
Upgrade signals
The Tele Aid system processes calls using
the following priority:
Automatic emergency - First priority
Manual emergency - Second priority
Roadside Assistance - Third priority
Information - Fourth priority
Should a higher priority call be initiated
while you are connected, an upgrade (alternating) tone will be heard, and the
appropriate indicator lamp flashes. If
certain information such as vehicle identification number or customer information is not available, the operator may
need to retransmit.
During this time you will hear a beep and
voice contact will be interrupted. Voice
contact will resume once the retransmission is completed. Once a call is included,
a beep will be heard and the respective
indicator lamp will stop flashing. The
COMAND system operation will resume.
appears in the multifunction display.
301
Controls in detail
Useful features
!
i
Remote door unlock
If the indicator lamp continues to
flash or the system does not reset,
contact the Maybach Assistance
Center at
1-866-FOR-MAYBach (in the USA) or
1-888-881-6611 (in Canada).
When a Tele Aid call has been initiated, the COMAND system audio is
muted and the selected mode (radio,
tape or CD) pauses. The cellular
phone switches off. If it is necessary
for you to use this phone, then the
vehicle must be parked. Disconnect
the coiled cord and place the call. The
COMAND navigation system (if engaged) will continue to run. The display in the instrument cluster is
available for use and spoken commands are only available by pressing
the button on the COMAND
unit. A pop-up window will appear in
the COMAND display to indicate that
a Tele Aid call is in progress.
In case that you have locked your vehicle
unintentionally (e.g. SmartKey inside vehicle), and the reserve SmartKey is not
handy:
i
The indicator lamp in the corresponding button flashes until the call is concluded. Calls can only be terminated
by a Response Center or Customer Assistance Center representative except
Roadside Assistance and Information
calls, which can also be terminated by
pressing button t on the multifunction steering wheel or the respective button for ending a
telephone call on the COMAND headunit.
Contact the Maybach Assistance Cen-
ter at
1-866-FOR-MAYBach (in the USA) or
1-888-881-6611 (in Canada).
You will be asked to provide your
password which you provided when
you completed the subscriber agreement.
Then return to your vehicle and pull
the trunk recessed handle for a minimum of 20 seconds until the SOS button is flashing.
The message
EMERGENCY CALL
CALL CONNECTED
appears in the multifunction display.
As an alternative, you may unlock the vehicle via Internet using the ID and password sent to you shortly after the
completion of your Acquaintance Call.
302
Controls in detail
Useful features
The Response Center will then unlock
your vehicle with the remote door unlocking feature.
i
The remote door unlock feature is
available if the relevant cellular
phone network is available.
The SOS button flashes and the message
EMERGENCY CALL
CALL CONNECTED
will appear in the multifunction display to indicate receipt of the door
unlock command.
Once the vehicle is unlocked, a Response Center specialist will attempt
to establish voice contact with the vehicle occupants.
Stolen Vehicle Recovery services
i
In the event your vehicle was stolen:
When the anti-theft alarm or the
tow-away alarm stays on for more
than 30 seconds, a call is initiated automatically to the Response Center.
See anti-theft alarm system
( page 104) and tow-away alarm
( page 106).
Report the incident to the police.
The police will issue a numbered incident report.
Pass this number on to the Maybach
Response Center along with your
password issued to you when you
subscribed to the service.
The Response Center will then attempt to covertly contact the vehicle’s Tele Aid system. Once the
vehicle is located, the Response Center will contact the local law enforcement and you. The vehicle’s location
will only be provided to law enforcement.
If the trunk recessed handle was
pulled for more than 20 seconds before door unlock authorization was
received by the Response Center, you
must wait 15 minutes before pulling
the trunk recessed handle.
303
Controls in detail
Useful features
Garage door opener
The built-in remote control is capable of
operating up to three separately controlled devices, for example garage door
openers, gate openers, or other devices
compatible with HomeLink® or some
other systems.
Warning!
Before programming the integrated remote control to a garage door opener or
gate operator, make sure people and objects are out of the way of the device to
prevent potential harm or damage.
You can program the signal transmitter
buttons.
Remote control integrated into the interior
rear view mirror
1
Indicator lamp
2 3 4 Signal transmitter button
304
G
5
Hand-held transmitter button
6
Hand-held remote control
transmitter (not part of vehicle
equipment)
When programming a garage door opener, the door moves up or down. When programming a gate operator, the gate opens
or closes.
Do not use the integrated remote control
with any garage door opener that lacks
safety stop and reverse features as required by U.S. federal safety standards
(this includes any garage door opener
model manufactured before April 1, 1982).
A garage door that cannot detect an object – signaling the door to stop and reverse – does not meet current U.S. federal
safety standards.
Controls in detail
Useful features
i
Certain types of garage door openers
are incompatible with the integrated
opener. If you should experience difficulties with programming the transmitter, contact an authorized
Maybach Studio, or call Maybach Customer Assistance Center at
1-866-FOR-MAYBach (in the USA) or
1-888-881-6611 (in Canada).
i
For operation in the USA only:
This device complies with Part 15 of
the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to
the following two conditions:
(1) This device may not cause harmful
interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
Any unauthorized modification to
this device could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
Programming or reprogramming the integrated remote control
Step 1:
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Step 2:
If you have previously programmed
an integrated signal transmitter button and wish to retain its programming, proceed to step 3. Otherwise,
press and hold the two outer signal
transmitter buttons 3 and 4 and release them only when the indicator
lamp 1 begins to flash after approximately 20 seconds (do not hold the
button for longer than 30 seconds).
This procedure erases any previous
settings for all three channels and initializes the memory. If you later wish
to program a second and/or third
hand-held transmitter to the remaining two signal transmitter buttons,
do not repeat this step and begin directly with step 3.
Step 3:
Hold the end of the hand-held re-
mote control transmitter 6 of the
device you wish to train approximately 2 to 5 in (5 to 12 cm) away from
the surface of the integrated remote
control located on the interior rear
view mirror, keeping the indicator
lamp 1 in view.
Step 4:
Using both hands, simultaneously
press the hand-held transmitter button 5 and the desired integrated signal transmitter button (2, 3 or 4).
Do not release the buttons until completing step 5.
The indicator lamp 1 on the integrated remote control will flash, first
slowly and then rapidly.
i
The indicator lamp 1 flashes the first
time the signal transmitter button is
programmed. If this button has already been programmed, the indicator lamp will only start flashing after
20 seconds.
305
Controls in detail
Useful features
Step 5:
When the indicator lamp 1 flashes
rapidly, release both buttons.
Step 6:
Press and hold the just-trained inte-
grated signal transmitter button and
observe the indicator lamp 1.
If the indicator lamp 1 stays on constantly, programming is complete
and your device should activate when
the integrated signal transmitter button is pressed and released.
i
If the indicator lamp 1 blinks rapidly
for about two seconds and then turns
to a constant light, continue with
programming steps 8 through 12 as
your garage door opener may be
equipped with the "rolling code"
feature.
Step 7:
To program the remaining two but-
tons, repeat the steps above starting
with step 3.
306
Rolling code programming
Step 10:
To train a garage door opener (or other
rolling code devices) with the rolling
code feature, follow these instructions
after completing the "Programming"
portion (steps 1 through 6) of this text.
(A second person may make the following training procedures quicker and easier.)
Firmly press, hold for two seconds
Step 8:
Locate "training" button on the ga-
rage door opener motor head unit.
Exact location and color of the button may vary by garage door opener
brand. Depending on manufacturer,
the "training" button may also be referred to as "learn" or "smart" button. If there is difficulty locating the
transmitting button, refer to the garage door opener operator’s manual.
Step 9
Press "training" button on the ga-
rage door opener motor head unit.
The "training light" is activated.
You have 30 seconds to initiate the following step.
and release the programmed integrated signal transmitter button
(2, 3 or 4).
Step 11:
Press, hold for two seconds and re-
lease same button a second time to
complete the training process.
Some garage door openers (or other rolling code equipped devices) may require
you to perform this procedure a third
time to complete the training.
Step 12:
Confirm the garage door operation
by pressing the programmed integrated signal transmitter button
(2, 3 or 4).
Step 13:
To program the remaining two but-
tons, repeat the steps above starting
with step 3.
Controls in detail
Useful features
Gate operator/Canadian programming
Canadian radio-frequency laws require
transmitter signals to "time-out"
(or quit) after several seconds of transmission which may not be long enough
for the integrated signal transmitter to
pick up the signal during programming.
Similar to this Canadian law, some U.S.
gate operators are designed to "timeout" in the same manner.
If you live in Canada or if you are having
difficulties programming a gate operator (regardless of where you live) by using the programming procedures,
replace step 4 with the following:
Proceed with programming step 5
and step 6 to complete.
Operation of remote control
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Select and press the appropriate inte-
If you sell your vehicle, erase the
codes of all three channels.
Reprogramming a single integrated signal transmitter button
grated signal transmitter button
(2, 3 or 4) to activate the remote
controlled device.
To program a device using a signal transmitter button previously trained, follow
these steps:
The integrated remote control transmitter continues to send the signal as
long as the button is pressed – up to
20 seconds.
Press and hold the desired signal
Erasing the remote control memory
Step 4:
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Continue to press and hold the inte-
Simultaneously hold down the signal
grated signal transmitter button
(2, 3 or 4) while you press and repress ("cycle") your hand-held remote control transmitter 6 every
two seconds until the frequency signal has been learned. Upon successful
training, the indicator lamp 1 will
flash slowly and then rapidly after
several seconds.
i
transmitter button (2, 3 or 4). Do
not release the button.
The indicator lamp 1 will begin to
flash after 20 seconds. Without releasing the integrated signal transmitter button, proceed with
programming starting with step 3.
transmitter buttons 3 and 4, for
approximately 20 seconds, until the
indicator lamp 1 blinks rapidly. Do
not hold for longer than 30 seconds.
The codes of all three channels are
erased.
307
Controls in detail
Useful features
Infrared reflecting windshield
)
Heated steering wheel
The steering wheel heating warms up
the leather area of the steering wheel.
The stalk is located on the lower lefthand side of the steering wheel.
Switching on
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Turn switch at the tip of stalk in direc-
tion of arrow 1.
The steering wheel is heated. Indicator lamp 2 comes on.
Switching off
Turn switch at the tip of stalk in direc-
tion of arrow 3.
The steering wheel heating is turned
off. Indicator lamp 2 goes out.
1 5.1 in (13 cm)
2 26 in (66 cm)
3 Infrared transparent area
(pass-through for electronic signals)
Your vehicle is equipped with infrared
reflecting glass which reduces the
amount of radiated heat entering the interior through the windows.
The infrared reflecting glass also prevents the transmission of signals through
the glass by in-vehicle electronic devices
(e.g. electronic toll collection devices).
To allow the use of these devices in the
vehicle, one infrared transparent area 3
is placed in the windshield.
308
i
1 Switching on
2 Indicator lamp
3 Switching off
The steering wheel heating does not
turn off automatically.
For information on steering wheel,
see "Steering wheel" ( page 60).
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Pocket PC remote control*
In vehicles with a rear center seat*, the
Pocket PC functions like a remote control.
Your vehicle is equipped with either
Pocket PC 1 ( page 312) or Pocket PC 2
( page 315).
Main menu
Main menu
Main menu
Main menu
Light
Privacy
Manual adjustments
Pocket PC settings
( page 320)
( page 321)
( page 326)
( page 333)
Operating the partition*
Keypad tones
Switching interior lighting on/ Operating the partition curoff
tain*
Commands/submenus
You can select from the following functions:
Opening and closing the pow- Daytime/Nighttime settings
er tilt/sliding sunroof
Display brightness
Operating the screen for the Time
Switching right reading lamp Making the electrotranspar- electrotransparent roof*
on/off
ent roof* opaque/transparent Extending/retracting the rear Automatic switch-off for display and device* (feature
Switching left reading lamp Operating the right rear side center seat head restraint
available on Pocket 2 only)
on/off
window curtain*
Raising and lowering the
Switching headliner lamps
Operating the rear window
power tilt/sliding sunroof
and pillar uplights* on/off
curtain
Switching ambient lighting
on/off
Operating the left rear side
window curtain*
Switching roof lighting* on/
off
Ambient lighting dimmer
309
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
i
For operation in the USA only: This
device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the
following two conditions:
Pocket PC holder
Maybach 57
The Pocket PC holder is on the back of
the front passenger seat backrest.
(1) This device may not cause harmful
interference, and
Press release button 2.
The holder 1 folds forwards slightly.
Press release button 5 and pull
Pocket PC 3 upward out of
cradle 4.
Inserting the Pocket PC
(2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
Insert Pocket PC 3 into cradle 4 un-
til it engages.
Press Pocket PC 3 towards the back-
Any unauthorized modification to
this device could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
rest until holder 1 engages.
Pocket PC 1 shown; Pocket PC 2 varies slightly
1
2
3
4
5
310
Removing the Pocket PC
Holder
Release button
Pocket PC
Cradle
Release button
The battery is charged depending on
its charge status and the position of
the SmartKey in the starter switch.
While charging, the yellow battery
charge indicator lamp ( page 312)
or ( page 315) in the top right corner flashes. Once the battery has
been fully charged, the indicator
lamp comes on continuously as long
as Pocket PC 3 is in cradle 4.
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
i
Maybach 62
If you aren’t using the Pocket PC 3,
always insert it into cradle 4. This
helps reduce the possibility that the
battery will become completely discharged.
The Pocket PC is in the storage compartment/drawer in the rear center console.
Remove Pocket PC 2 from cradle 1.
braking
vehicle maneuvers or
an accident.
Inserting the Pocket PC
Guide Pocket PC 2 into cradle 1.
Close storage compartment/drawer
( page 263).
G
Always make sure the Pocket PC in the cradle and the holder are securely engaged
while the vehicle is in motion and when
the Pocket PC is not being used. Otherwise,
the Pocket PC could be thrown around in
the vehicle interior and cause injury to you
and others during
Removing the Pocket PC
Open the storage compartment/
drawer 3 fully ( page 263).
After the ignition has been switched
off, the battery will continue to be
charged for a maximum of ten minutes.
Warning!
You can operate the Pocket PC without
having to remove it from cradle 1.
i
Pocket PC 1 shown; Pocket 2 varies slightly
1 Cradle
2 Pocket PC
3 Storage compartment/drawer
If you aren’t using the Pocket PC 2,
always insert it into cradle 1. This
helps reduce the possibility that the
battery will become completely discharged.
After the ignition has been switched
off, the battery will continue to be
charged for a maximum of ten minutes.
311
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Pocket PC 1
Your vehicle is equipped with either
Pocket PC 1 or Pocket PC 2 ( page 315).
312
1
Light sensor
2
Blue Bluetooth wireless indicator
lamp
3
Memory card inserted
4
Stylus
5
Yellow battery charge indicator
lamp
6
On/Off button
7
Display
8
Status line
9
Main menu function button:
Manual Adjustments
a
Main menu function button:
Pocket PC Settings
b
Navigation button
c
Main menu function button: Light
d
Main menu function button: Privacy
e
Bluetooth wireless connection display
f
Battery charge terminal
g
Reset button
Warning!
G
Only operate the Pocket PC remote control
from the rear passenger compartment.
Monitor the settings and operation of the
equipment you control using the Pocket PC
to make sure there is no danger of anyone
being harmed by the operating procedure.
Your Pocket PC can be operated in two
ways. You can select your preferred
mode of operation by doing one of the
following:
press main menu function button 9,
a, c or d and then choose your settings via navigation button b.
Tap on a menu symbol shown in dis-
play 7 (touch-screen) using your finger or stylus 4.
You can switch between these two
modes of operation at any time.
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Removing and inserting the stylus
Removing
Press down briefly on stylus 4.
Stylus 4 is ejected upward.
Inserting
The yellow battery charge indicator
lamp 5
is out when the battery is not being
charged
flashes when the battery is being
charged
comes on continuously when the battery is completely charged and the
Pocket PC is in the Pocket PC cradle.
Insert stylus 4 into the opening and
press downward until it engages.
Indicator lamps
The blue Bluetooth wireless connection
indicator lamp 2
comes on continuously when the
Bluetooth wireless connection between the Pocket PC and the vehicle
has been established
Switching the Pocket PC on and off
Switching on
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Press On/Off button 6.
The Bluetooth wireless connection indicator lamp 2 flashes.
In display 7 you will see the following in succession:
the Maybach logo for several seconds
the Bluetooth wireless connection
status e shown in the status
line 8 until the Bluetooth wireless connection between the
Pocket PC and the vehicle has
been established
the time and the battery charge
status shown in the status line 8.
is out when the Bluetooth wireless radio has been switched off
flashes slowly when the Bluetooth
wireless radio has been switched on
flashes quickly while the Bluetooth
wireless connection is being set up
flashes very quickly if there is a problem with the Bluetooth wireless connection
The display is in color and the Bluetooth wireless connection indicator
lamp 2 comes on continuously.
The Pocket PC is ready for use.
313
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
i
Switching off
The Bluetooth wireless connection
can only be established if:
Press On/Off button 6.
the ignition is switched on
or
for up to 15 minutes after the ignition was switched off
When you are not using the
Pocket PC, the display darkens after
approx. 30 seconds. This helps increase
the usable battery time. The Bluetooth wireless connection remains intact and the blue Bluetooth wireless
connection indicator lamp 2 remains
lit.
In order to reactivate the Pocket PC,
press
one of the main menu function
buttons 9, a, c or d
You will see the corresponding
menu.
314
On/Off button 6
or
Navigation button b
The Bluetooth wireless connection indicator lamp 2 goes out.
The Bluetooth wireless connection is
interrupted and the Pocket PC is
switched off.
i
The Pocket PC switches off automatically after approx. five minutes.
You can only switch off the Pocket PC
if it has been turned on and activated.
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Pocket PC 2
Your vehicle is equipped with either
Pocket PC 1 ( page 312) or Pocket PC 2.
1
Light sensor
d
Navigation button
2
Blue Bluetooth wireless indicator
lamp
e
Main menu function button: Light
f
Main menu function button: Privacy
g
Bluetooth wireless connection display
h
Reset button
j
Battery charge terminal
3
Antenna
4
Memory card inserted
5
Speaker
6
Yellow battery charge indicator
lamp
7
Stylus
8
On/Off button
9
Display
a
Status line
b
Main menu function button:
Manual Adjustments
c
Main menu function button:
Pocket PC Settings
Warning!
G
Only operate the Pocket PC remote control
from the rear passenger compartment.
Monitor the settings and operation of the
equipment you control using the Pocket PC
to make sure there is no danger of anyone
being harmed by the operating procedure.
315
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Your Pocket PC can be operated in two
ways. You can select your preferred
mode of operation by doing one of the
following:
Press main menu function button b,
c, e or f and then choose your settings via navigation button d.
Tap on a menu symbol shown in dis-
play 9 (touch-screen) using your finger or stylus 7.
You can switch between these two
modes of operation at any time.
Indicator lamps
Switching the Pocket PC on and off
The blue Bluetooth wireless connection
indicator lamp 2
Switching on
Press down briefly on stylus 7.
Stylus 7 is ejected upward.
Inserting
Insert stylus 7 into the opening and
press downward until it engages.
flashes slowly when the Bluetooth
wireless radio has been switched on
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Press On/Off button 8.
The Bluetooth wireless connection indicator lamp 2 flashes.
The yellow battery charge indicator
lamp 6
In display 9 you will see the following in succession:
is out when the battery is not being
charged
the Maybach logo for several seconds
flashes when the battery is being
charged
comes on continuously when the battery is completely charged and the
Pocket PC is in the Pocket PC cradle.
the Bluetooth wireless connection
status g shown in the status
line a until the Bluetooth wireless connection between the
Pocket PC and the vehicle has
been established
the time and the battery charge
status shown in the status line a.
Removing and inserting the stylus
Removing
is out when the Bluetooth wireless radio has been switched off
The display is in color and you will see
a Bluetooth wireless connection symbol in the status line a.
The Pocket PC is ready for use.
316
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
i
Switching off
The Bluetooth wireless connection
can only be established if:
Press On/Off button 8.
the ignition is switched on
or
for up to 15 minutes after the ignition was switched off
When you are not using the
Pocket PC, the display darkens after
an adjustable time ( page 338). This
helps increase the usable battery
time. The Bluetooth wireless connection remains intact and the blue Bluetooth wireless indicator lamp 2
continues to flash slowly.
In order to reactivate the Pocket PC,
press
one of the main menu function
buttons b, c, e or f
You will see the corresponding
menu.
On/Off button 8
or
Navigation button d.
Display
The Bluetooth wireless connection indicator lamp 2 goes out.
The Bluetooth wireless connection is
interrupted and the Pocket PC is
switched off.
i
The Pocket PC switches off automatically following an adjustable time
( page 338).
You can only switch off the Pocket PC
if it has been turned on and activated.
Pocket PC 1 shown; feature description also
applies to Pocket PC 2
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Main menu: Light
Main menu: Privacy
Main menu: Manual Adjustments
Main menu: Pocket PC Settings
Settings menu
Time
Status line
Battery charge status: the more segments displayed, the greater the battery's charge.
9 Submenus
The selected main menu, submenu and
settings menu are highlighted in the display.
317
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
1
2
3
4
5
6
Operation via main menu function
buttons and navigation button
An example of how to select settings is
described below.
7
8
9
a
b
Pocket PC 2
Pocket PC 1
318
Main menu: Light
Main menu: Privacy
Main menu: Manual Adjustments
Main menu: Pocket PC Settings
Settings menu
Main menu function button: Manual
Adjustments
Main menu function button:
Pocket PC Settings
Navigation button
Main menu function button: Light
Main menu function button: Privacy
Submenus
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Choosing a main menu (Pocket PC 1 and
Pocket PC 2)
Selecting a submenu and selecting
settings (Pocket PC 1 and Pocket PC 2)
Press the desired main menu function
Press the bottom of navigation
button 6, 7, 9 or a.
button 8.
The selected main menu 1, 2, 3 or
4 is highlighted in the display and
you will see the corresponding submenus b.
The first submenu is highlighted in
the display and you will see the corresponding settings menu 5.
i
You can also select a main menu 1,
2, 3 or 4 with navigation
button 8. Simply press the left or
right side of the navigation button.
Press the top or bottom of navigation
Press the left or right side of naviga-
tion button 8 in order to select one
of the symbols in settings menu 5.
You can select the desired setting by
pressing the top or bottom of navigation button 8.
Your choice is stored and/or carried
out immediately.
button 8 repeatedly until the desired submenu b is highlighted in
the display. In addition you will see
the corresponding settings menu 5.
319
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Operation via touch-screen
The following pages describe operation
of the Pocket PC using the touch-screen.
Illustrations show Pocket PC 1 except
where noted. Pocket PC 2 graphical interface may vary slightly. Symbols, feature description and operating
instructions, however, also apply to
Pocket PC 2 except where noted.
Switching interior lighting, ambient
lighting, reading lamps, roof lighting* or
headliner lamps and pillar uplights functions* on/off
i
Depending on equipment, the arrangement of function buttons may
vary.
Switching on the lights
Press the desired function button 1,
2, 3, 4, 5 or 6.
The corresponding light symbol 7
turns yellow.
Selecting main menu: Light
Switching off the lights
Press the desired function button 1,
2, 3, 4, 5 or 6.
1
2
3
4
5
1 Main menu: Light
Press main menu button: Light 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding submenus.
320
Function button: Interior lighting
Function button: Ambient lighting
Function button: Reading lamp, right
Function button: Reading lamp, left
Function button: Roof lighting*, in
vehicles with a electrotransparent
roof*
6 Function button: Headliner lamps
and pillar uplights*, in Maybach 62
with tilt/sliding sunroof
7 Light symbol
The corresponding light symbol 7
turns white.
i
If you would like to switch a selected
light on or off with the navigation
button, press the navigation button
in the center or
on the left or
on the right
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Selecting submenu: Ambient lighting
dimmer and selecting settings
Press submenu button: Ambient
Selecting main menu: Privacy
lighting dimmer 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding settings
menu 3.
Press symbol 4.
The ambient lighting becomes
brighter. Slide control 6 shows you
the current setting.
or
1
2
3
4
5
Submenu: Ambient lighting dimmer
Settings menu
To brighten lighting
To dim lighting
Slide control
i
The light symbol 2 turns yellow
when the ambient lighting is
switched on.
Press symbol 5.
The ambient lighting becomes dimmer. Slide control 6 shows you the
current setting.
1 Main menu: Privacy
i
Depending on equipment, the arrangement of function buttons may
vary.
Press main menu button: Privacy 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding submenus.
321
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Selecting submenu: Operating the partition curtain*
Warning!
G
When operating the curtains, make sure
there is no danger of anyone being
harmed by the opening or closing procedure.
The opening or closing procedure can be
immediately halted by releasing symbol 5
or 6 or by again pressing symbol 4 or 3.
1
2
3
4
5
6
Submenu: Partition curtain
Settings menu
To close curtain automatically
To open curtain automatically
To open curtain
To close curtain
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment
may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury.
Press and hold symbol 5.
The curtain opens until you release
symbol 5.
Closing the curtain
Press and hold symbol 6.
The curtain closes until you release
symbol 6.
Fully opening the curtain (Express-open)
Briefly press symbol 4.
The curtain opens completely.
To stop the procedure, press
symbol 4 again.
Fully closing the curtain (Express-close)
Press submenu button: Partition cur-
tain 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding settings
menu 2.
322
Opening the curtain
Briefly press symbol 3.
The curtain closes completely.
To stop the procedure, press
symbol 3 again.
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Selecting submenu: Operating the left
rear side window curtain*
Warning!
G
When operating the curtains, make sure
there is no danger of anyone being
harmed by the opening or closing procedure.
The opening or closing procedure can be
immediately halted by releasing symbol 5
or 6 or by again pressing symbol 4 or 3.
1 Submenu: Left rear side window curtain
2 Settings menu
3 To close curtain automatically
4 To open curtain automatically
5 To open curtain
6 To close curtain
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment
may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury.
Opening the curtain
Press and hold symbol 5.
The curtain opens until you release
symbol 5.
Closing the curtain
Press and hold symbol 6.
The curtain closes until you release
symbol 6.
Fully opening the curtain (Express-open)
Briefly press symbol 4.
The curtain opens completely.
To stop the procedure, press
symbol 4 again.
Fully closing the curtain (Express-close)
Press submenu button: Left rear side
window curtain 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding settings
menu 2.
Briefly press symbol 3.
The curtain closes completely.
To stop the procedure, press
symbol 3 again.
323
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Selecting submenu: Making the electrotransparent roof* opaque/transparent
Press submenu button: Electrotrans-
parent roof 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding settings
menu 2.
i
The electrotransparent roof lighting
is automatically switched off when
the screen is opened.
Warning!
Making the electrotransparent roof
opaque
If the screen is closed, open it com-
pletely.
Press symbol 3.
1 Submenu: Electrotransparent roof
2 Settings menu
3 To make electrotransparent roof
opaque
4 To make electrotransparent roof
transparent
324
The electrotransparent roof turns
opaque.
Making the electrotransparent roof
transparent
Press symbol 4.
The screen opens automatically and
the electrotransparent roof turns
transparent.
G
The electrotransparent roof is made out of
glass. In the event of an accident, the glass
may shatter. This may result in an opening
in the roof.
In a vehicle rollover, occupants not wearing their seat belts or not wearing them
properly may be thrown out of the opening. Such an opening also presents a potential for injury for occupants wearing
their seat belts properly as entire body
parts or portions of them may protrude
from the passenger compartment.
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment can
cause an accident and/or serious personal
injury.
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Selecting submenu: Operating the right
rear side window curtain*
Warning!
G
When operating the curtains, make sure
there is no danger of anyone being
harmed by the opening or closing procedure.
The opening or closing procedure can be
immediately halted by releasing symbol 4
or 3 or by again pressing symbol 5 or 6.
1 Submenu: Right rear side window
curtain
2 Settings menu
3 To close curtain
4 To open curtain
5 To open curtain automatically
6 To close curtain automatically
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment
may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury.
Opening the curtain
Press and hold symbol 4.
The curtain opens until you release
symbol 4.
Closing the curtain
Press and hold symbol 3.
The curtain closes until you release
symbol 3.
Fully opening the curtain (Express-open)
Briefly press symbol 5.
The curtain opens completely.
To stop the procedure, press
symbol 5 again.
Fully closing the curtain (Express-close)
Press submenu button: Right rear side
window curtain 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding settings
menu 2.
Briefly press symbol 6.
The curtain closes completely.
To stop the procedure, press
symbol 6 again.
325
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Selecting submenu: Operating the rear
window curtain
Opening the curtain
Press and hold symbol 4.
Selecting main menu: Manual adjustments
The curtain opens until you release
symbol 4.
Closing the curtain
Press and hold symbol 3.
The curtain closes until you release
symbol 3.
Fully opening the curtain (Express-open)
1
2
3
4
5
6
Submenu: Rear window curtain
Settings menu
To close curtain
To open curtain
To open curtain automatically
To close curtain automatically
Press submenu button: Rear window
curtain 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding settings
menu 2.
326
Briefly press symbol 5.
The curtain opens completely.
To stop the procedure, press
symbol 5 again.
Fully closing the curtain (Express-close)
Briefly press symbol 6.
The curtain closes completely.
To stop the procedure, press
symbol 6 again.
1 Main menu: Manual Adjustments
i
Depending on equipment, the arrangement of function buttons may
vary.
Press main menu button: Manual Ad-
justments 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding submenus.
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Selecting submenu: Operating the partition*
Warning!
G
When operating the partition, make sure
there is no danger of anyone being
harmed by the opening or closing procedure.
The opening or closing procedure can be
immediately halted by releasing symbol 5
or 6 or by again pressing symbol 4 or 3.
1
2
3
4
5
6
Submenu: Partition
Settings menu
To close partition automatically
To open partition automatically
To open partition
To close partition
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment
may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury.
Press submenu button: Partition 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding settings
menu 2.
Closing the partition
Press and hold symbol 6.
The partition closes until you release
symbol 6.
Opening the partition
Press and hold symbol 5.
The partition opens until you release
symbol 5.
Fully closing the partition (Express-close)
Briefly press symbol 3.
The partition closes completely.
To stop the procedure, press
symbol 3 again.
Fully opening the partition
(Express-open)
Briefly press symbol 4.
The partition opens completely.
To stop the procedure, press
symbol 4 again.
327
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Selecting submenu: Opening and closing
the power tilt/sliding sunroof
(Maybach 62)
Warning!
G
When closing the tilt/sliding sunroof, make
sure there is no danger of anyone being
harmed by the closing procedure.
The opening/closing procedure of the tilt/
sliding sunroof can be immediately halted
by releasing symbol 5 or 6 or by again
pressing symbol 4 or 3.
The tilt/sliding sunroof is made out of
glass. In the event of an accident, the glass
may shatter. This may result in an opening
in the roof.
1
2
3
4
5
6
Submenu: Tilt/sliding sunroof
Settings menu
To slide sunroof closed automatically
To slide sunroof open automatically
To slide sunroof open
To slide sunroof closed
328
In a vehicle rollover, occupants not wearing their seat belts or not wearing them
properly may be thrown out of the opening. Such an opening also presents a potential for injury for occupants wearing
their seat belts properly as entire body
parts or portions of them may protrude
from the passenger compartment.
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment can
cause an accident and/or serious personal
injury.
Press submenu button: Tilt/sliding
sunroof 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding settings
menu 2.
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Opening the screen and the power tilt/
sliding sunroof
Fully opening the screen and the tilt/sliding sunroof (Express-open)
Fully closing the tilt/sliding sunroof and
the screen (Express-close)
Press and hold symbol 5.
Briefly press symbol 4.
Briefly press symbol 3.
The sunroof opens when the screen
has opened completely.
Closing the screen and the power tilt/
sliding sunroof
Press and hold symbol 6.
The screen opens completely.
Briefly press symbol 4 again.
The sunroof opens completely.
To stop the procedure, press
symbol 4 again.
The sunroof closes completely.
Briefly press symbol 3 again.
The screen closes completely.
To stop the procedure, press
symbol 3 again.
The sunroof closes when the sunroof
has closed completely.
329
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Selecting submenu: Operating the electrotransparent roof*
Warning!
G
When closing the screen, make sure no one
can be caught and/or injured.
In case of danger, release symbol 5 or
press symbol 4 again.
The electrotransparent roof is made out of
glass. In the event of an accident, the glass
may shatter. This may result in an opening
in the roof.
1 Submenu: Electrotransparent roof
screen
2 Settings menu
3 Press to open screen automatically
4 Press to close screen automatically
5 Press to slide screen closed
6 Press to slide screen open
330
In a vehicle rollover, occupants not wearing their seat belts or not wearing them
properly may be thrown out of the opening. Such an opening also presents a potential for injury for occupants wearing
their seat belts properly as entire body
parts or portions of them may protrude
from the passenger compartment.
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment can
cause an accident and/or serious personal
injury.
Press submenu button: Electrotrans-
parent roof screen 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding settings
menu 2.
Opening the screen
Press and hold symbol 6.
The screen opens until you release
symbol 6.
The electrotransparent roof lighting
is automatically turned off when the
screen is closed.
Closing the screen
Press and hold symbol 5.
The screen closes until you release
symbol 5.
The electrotransparent roof turns
opaque when the screen is closed.
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Fully opening the screen (Express-open)
Briefly press symbol 3.
Selecting submenu: Extending/retracting the rear center seat head restraint
The screen opens completely and the
electrotransparent roof lighting is automatically turned off.
Press and hold symbol 3.
The rear center seat head restraint retracts until you release symbol 3.
or
Press and hold symbol 4.
To stop the procedure, press
The rear center seat head restraint
extends until you release symbol 4.
symbol 3 again.
Fully closing the screen (Express-close)
Warning!
Briefly press symbol 4.
The screen closes completely and the
electrotransparent roof turns
opaque.
To stop the procedure, press
symbol 4 again.
1 Submenu: Rear center seat head restraint
2 Settings menu
3 To raise head restraint
4 To lower head restraint
Press submenu button: Rear center
seat head restraint 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding settings
menu 2.
G
For your protection, drive only with properly positioned head restraints.
Adjust head restraint so that the center of
the head restraint supports the back of the
head at eye level. This will reduce the potential for injury to the head and neck in
the event of an accident or similar situation.
Do not drive the vehicle without the seat
head restraints. Head restraints are intended to help reduce injuries during an accident.
331
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Selecting submenu: Raising and lowering the power tilt/sliding sunroof
Warning!
G
When closing the tilt/sliding sunroof, make
sure there is no danger of anyone being
harmed by the closing procedure.
The opening/closing procedure of the tilt/
sliding sunroof can be immediately halted
by releasing symbol 4 or by again pressing symbol 5.
1
2
3
4
5
Submenu: Tilt/sliding sunroof
Settings menu
To raise tilt/sliding sunroof
To lower tilt/sliding sunroof
To lower tilt/sliding sunroof automatically
6 To raise tilt/sliding sunroof automatically
332
The tilt/sliding sunroof is made out of
glass. In the event of an accident, the glass
may shatter. This may result in an opening
in the roof.
In a vehicle rollover, occupants not wearing their seat belts or not wearing them
properly may be thrown out of the opening. Such an opening also presents a potential for injury for occupants wearing
their seat belts properly as entire body
parts or portions of them may protrude
from the passenger compartment.
When leaving the vehicle, always remove
the SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** from the starter switch,
take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment can
cause an accident and/or serious personal
injury.
Press submenu button: Tilt/sliding
sunroof 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding settings
menu 2.
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Raising the tilt/sliding sunroof
Selecting main menu: Pocket PC settings
Press and hold symbol 3.
In this menu, you can select the settings
for your Pocket PC.
The sunroof is raised until you release
symbol 3.
Lowering the tilt/sliding sunroof
Press and hold symbol 4.
The sunroof is lowered until you release symbol 4.
Pocket PC settings: Pocket PC 2
Fully raising the tilt/sliding sunroof
1 Main menu: Settings
Briefly press symbol 6.
The sunroof is raised completely.
To stop the procedure, press
symbol 6 again.
Press main menu button: Settings 1.
Pocket PC settings: Pocket PC 1
1 Main menu: Settings
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding submenus.
Fully lowering the tilt/sliding sunroof
Briefly press symbol 5.
The sunroof closes completely.
To stop the procedure, press
symbol 5 again.
333
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Selecting submenu: Keypad tones and
selecting settings
When you press a button or a symbol, an
acoustic tone sounds. This tone can be
switched on or off, and the volume can
be adjusted.
Press submenu button: Keypad
tones 1.
Selecting submenu: Daytime/Nighttime
settings and selecting settings
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding settings
menu 2.
Turning off keypad tones
Press symbol 5.
Turning on keypad tones
Press symbol 6.
Adjusting keypad tone volume
Press button 3 or 4 repeatedly until
the desired volume has been reached.
1
2
3
4
5
6
Submenu: Keypad tones
Settings menu
To increase keypad tone volume
To decrease keypad tone volume
To turn off keypad tones
To turn on keypad tones
334
1 Submenu: Daytime/Nighttime Settings
2 Settings menu
3 Manual mode
4 Automatic mode
5 Nighttime setting
6 Daytime setting
Press submenu button: Daytime/
Nighttime Settings 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding settings
menu 2.
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Choosing automatic mode
Press symbol 4.
Selecting submenu: Display brightness
and selecting settings
Depending on the ambient brightness, the display assumes either the
daytime or the nighttime setting.
Choosing automatic mode
Press symbol 4.
Depending on the ambient brightness, the display becomes either
brighter or darker.
Choosing manual mode
Choosing manual mode
Press symbol 3.
Press symbol 3.
Regardless of the ambient brightness,
the selected daytime or nighttime
setting is constant.
Regardless of the ambient brightness,
the selected display brightness remains constant.
or
1
2
3
4
5
6
Press symbol 5.
Press submenu button: Display
Choosing daytime or nighttime setting
Press symbol 6.
The display assumes the daytime setting.
The display assumes the nighttime
setting.
Submenu: Display Brightness
Settings menu
Manual mode
Automatic mode
To make display darker
To make display brighter
Adjusting display brightness
Press button 5 or 6 repeatedly until
the desired display brightness has
been reached.
Brightness 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding settings
menu 2.
335
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Selecting submenu: Time and selecting
settings (Pocket PC 1)
Press submenu button: Time 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding settings
menus 2 and 3.
Setting minutes forward or backward
Press symbol 4 or 5 until the min-
utes have been set.
Setting hour forward or backward
Press symbol 6 or 7 until the hour
has been set.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Submenu: Time
Settings menu for hours
Settings menu for minutes
To set minutes forward
To set minutes backward
To set hours backward
To set hours forward
336
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Selecting submenu: Time and selecting
settings (Pocket PC 2)
Setting time manually
Setting time display mode
Press symbol 4.
Press symbol 7 or 8 repeatedly until
You can set hours and minutes manually with the symbol 7 or 8.
Setting time synchronization with
COMAND
In settings menu for time display
mode 3 the desired display appears:
Press symbol 5.
The Pocket PC time is synchronized
with your COMAND. In the settings
menus 2 and 3 appears AUTO.
1
2
3
4
5
Submenu: Time
Settings menu for hours and minutes
Settings menu for time display mode
To set time manually
To set time synchronization with
COMAND
6 Display time in the status line
7 To set hours and minutes forward
8 To set hours and minutes backward
the desired display mode is set
according to either the 24-hour mode
or the 12-hour mode.
Setting hours and minutes forward or
backward
Press symbol 7 or 8 until the hours
24 for 24h time display mode
or
AM or PM for 12h time display
mode.
In addition, am or pm for 12h time
display mode appears in status
line 6.
and minutes have been set.
Press submenu button: Time 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding settings
menus 2 and 3.
337
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Selecting submenu: Automatic switchoff for display/equipment and selecting
settings (Pocket PC 2 only)
Press submenu button: Automatic
switch-off for display and device 1.
The selected symbol in button 1 is
highlighted in the display and you
will see the corresponding settings
menus 2 and 3.
Setting minutes for automatic
equipment switch-off forward or
backward
Press symbol 4 or 5 repeatedly until
the desired interval is set.
1 Submenu: Automatic switch-off for
display and device
2 Settings menu for automatic display
switch-off
3 Settings menu for automatic device
switch-off
4 To set time for automatic device
switch-off forward
5 To set time for automatic device
switch-off backward
6 To set time for automatic display
switch-off backward
7 To set time for automatic display
switch-off forward
338
When the set time has elapsed, the
Pocket PC automatically switches
itself off.
Setting minutes for automatic display
switch-off forward or backward
Press symbol 6 or 7 repeatedly until
the desired interval is set.
When the set time has elapsed, the
display darkens.
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Pocket PC troubleshooting
Problem
Possible cause
Suggested solution
The Bluetooth wireless connection can- The ignition is switched off and the
The receiver is switched off.
not be established or your Pocket PC
run-on time of 15 minutes has expired. Switch on ignition ( page 54).
has no control functions.
If necessary, switch off your Pocket PC and
You cannot make any settings, such as
then switch it on again ( page 313) or
switching the interior lights on or off.
( page 316).
In the status line, you may see the
The Bluetooth wireless connection has Switch off your Pocket PC ( page 313) or
Bluetooth wireless connection status
been interrupted because the
( page 316).
( page 312) or ( page 315) with a red Pocket PC is out of range.
Make sure the Pocket PC is inside the vehiexclamation point.
cle.
Wait a few seconds and switch on your
Pocket PC again.
The Bluetooth wireless connection indicator lamp comes on continuously
(Pocket PC 1) or you will see a Bluetooth
wireless connection symbol in the status
line (Pocket PC 2) as soon as the Bluetooth
wireless connection has been re-established.
Any other cause.
Switch off your Pocket PC and then switch
it on again ( page 313) or ( page 316).
339
Controls in detail
Pocket PC remote control*
Problem
Possible cause
You have switched on your Pocket PC The battery is discharged.
but do not automatically see the main
menu (i.e. the program does not start).
Suggested solution
Charge the battery for a few minutes
( page 310).
Switch on your Pocket PC ( page 313) or
( page 316).
The Pocket PC turns itself off automatically.
The battery is completely discharged. Charge the battery for a few minutes
The Pocket PC memory has been
( page 310).
erased.
Switch on your Pocket PC ( page 313) or
( page 316) and follow the instructions
which appear in the display.
The Pocket PC is automatically restarted
and the software is re-installed. Be sure not
to interrupt this process. After a brief period, the Bluetooth wireless connection is reestablished. (This can take up to two minutes.) Afterward, you will see the main
menu in the display.
Pocket PC no longer functions
although:
the ignition is switched on
( page 54)
the Pocket PC battery is charged
( page 310)
the Pocket PC is inside the vehicle
340
Your Pocket PC has an undefined
status.
Reset the Pocket PC ( page 427).
Operation
The first 1000 miles (1500 km)
Driving instructions
At the gas station
Engine compartment
Tires and wheels
Winter driving
Maintenance
Vehicle care
341
Operation
The first 1000 miles (1500 km)
In the "Operation" section, you will find
detailed information on operating,
maintaining and caring for your vehicle.
The more cautiously you treat your vehicle during the break-in period, the more
satisfied you will be with its performance
later on.
Drive your vehicle during the first
1000 miles (1500 km) at varying but
moderate vehicle and engine speeds.
During this period, avoid heavy loads
(full throttle driving) and excessive
engine speeds (no more than 2⁄3 of
maximum rpm in each gear).
Avoid accelerating by kickdown.
Do not attempt to slow the vehicle
down by shifting to a lower gear using the gear selector lever.
Select gear positions 3, 2 or 1 only
when driving at moderate speeds (for
hill driving).
After 1000 miles (1500 km) you may
gradually increase vehicle and engine
speeds to the permissible maximum.
342
!
All of the above instructions, as may
apply to your vehicle type, also apply
when driving the first 1000 miles
(1500 km) after the engine or the
rear differential has been replaced.
i
Always obey applicable speed limits.
Operation
Driving instructions
Driving instructions
Drive sensibly – save fuel
Fuel consumption, to a great extent, depends on driving habits and operating
conditions.
Drinking and driving
To save fuel you should:
Warning!
Pedals
G
Keep tires at the recommended inflation pressures.
Remove unnecessary loads.
Drinking and driving and/or taking drugs
and driving are very dangerous combinations. Even a small amount of alcohol or
drugs can affect your reflexes, perceptions
and judgement.
Allow engine to warm up under low
load use.
The possibility of a serious or even fatal accident are greatly increased when you
drink or take drugs and drive.
Avoid frequent acceleration and deceleration.
Have all maintenance work performed at the intervals specified in
the Maintenance Booklet and as required by the Maintenance System
(U.S. vehicles) or FSS (Canada vehicles). Contact an authorized Maybach
Studio.
Do not drink or take drugs and drive or allow anyone to drive who has been drinking or taking drugs.
Warning!
G
Keep driver’s foot area clear at all times.
Objects stored in this area may impair pedal movement.
Power assistance
Warning!
G
With the engine not running, there is no
power assistance for the brake and steering systems. In this case, it is important to
keep in mind that a considerably higher
degree of effort is necessary to brake and
steer the vehicle.
Fuel consumption is also increased by
driving in cold weather, in stop-and-go
traffic, on short trips and in hilly country.
343
Operation
Driving instructions
Brakes
Warning!
G
After driving in heavy rain for some time
without applying the brakes or through
water deep enough to wet brake components, the first braking action may be
somewhat reduced and increased pedal
pressure may be necessary to obtain expected braking effect. Maintain a safe distance from vehicles in front.
Resting your foot on the brake pedal will
cause excessive and premature wear of the
brake pads.
It can also result in the brakes overheating,
thereby significantly reducing their effectiveness. It may not be possible to stop the
vehicle in sufficient time to avoid an accident.
To help prevent brake disk corrosion after driving on wet road surfaces (particularly salted roads), it is advisable to brake
the vehicle with considerable force prior
to parking. The heat generated serves to
dry the brakes.
344
If your brake system is normally only subjected to moderate loads, you should occasionally test the effectiveness of the
brakes by applying above-normal braking pressure at higher speeds. This will
also enhance the grip of the brake pads.
!
Be very careful not to endanger other
road users when you apply the
brakes.
Refer to the description of the Brake
Assist System (BAS) ( page 97).
If the parking brake is released and the
brake warning lamp in the instrument
cluster stays on, the brake fluid level in
the reservoir is too low.
Brake pad wear or a leak in the system
may be the reason for low brake fluid in
the reservoir.
Have the brake system inspected immediately. Contact an authorized Maybach
Studio.
All checks and service work on the brake
system should be carried out by qualified
technicians only. Contact an authorized
Maybach Studio.
Only install brake pads and brake fluid
recommended by us for use on Maybach
vehicles.
Warning!
G
If other than recommended brake pads are
installed, or other than recommended
brake fluid is used, the braking properties
of the vehicle can be degraded to an extent that safe braking is substantially impaired. This could result in an accident.
!
When driving down long and steep
grades, relieve the load on the brakes
by shifting into a lower gear to use
the engine’s braking power. This
helps prevent overheating of the
brakes and reduces brake pad wear.
Operation
Driving instructions
!
After hard braking, it is advisable to
drive on for some time, rather than immediately parking, so that the air stream
can cool down the brakes faster.
Parking
Driving off
Apply the brakes to test them briefly after driving off. Perform this procedure
only when the road is clear of other traffic.
Do not park this vehicle in areas where
combustible materials such as grass, hay or
leaves can come into contact with the hot
exhaust system, as these materials could be
ignited and cause a vehicle fire.
Warm up the engine smoothly. Do not
place full load on the engine until the
operating temperature has been
reached.
When starting off on a slippery surface,
do not allow a drive wheel to spin for an
extended period with the ESP switched
off. Doing so may cause serious damage
to the drivetrain which is not covered by
the Maybach Limited Warranty.
i
Simultaneously depressing the accelerator pedal and applying the brake
reduces engine performance and
causes premature brake and drivetrain wear.
Warning!
G
Set the parking brake whenever
parking or leaving the vehicle.
In addition, move gear selector lever
to position P.
When parking on hills, turn front
wheels towards the curb.
To reduce the risk of personal injury as a
result of inadvertent vehicle movement,
before turning off the engine and leaving
the vehicle always:
Keep right foot firmly on brake pedal.
Firmly depress parking brake pedal.
Move the gear selector lever to
position P.
Slowly release brake pedal.
When parked on an incline, turn front
wheels towards the road curb.
Turn the SmartKey to starter switch
position 0 and remove the SmartKey
from the starter switch, or press the
start/stop button ( page 55) (vehicles
with KEYLESS-GO**).
Take the SmartKey or the SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO** with you and lock
vehicle when leaving.
345
Operation
Driving instructions
Tires
Warning!
Warning!
G
If you feel a sudden significant vibration or
ride disturbance, or you suspect that possible damage to your vehicle has occurred,
you should turn on the hazard warning
flashers, carefully slow down, and drive
with caution to an area which is a safe distance from the road.
Inspect the tires and the vehicle underbody
for possible damage. If the vehicle or tires
appear unsafe, have it towed to the nearest authorized Maybach Studio or tire
dealer for repairs.
Treadwear indicators (TWI) are required
by law. These indicators are located in six
places on the tread circumference and
become visible at a tread depth of approximately 1⁄16 in (1.6 mm), at which
point the tire is considered worn and
should be replaced.
The treadwear indicator appears as a solid band across the tread.
346
G
Although the applicable federal motor vehicle safety laws consider a tire to be worn
when the treadwear indicators (TWI) become visible at approximately 1⁄16 in
(1.6 mm), we recommend that you do not
allow your tires to wear down to that level.
As tread depth approaches 1⁄8 in (3 mm),
the adhesion properties on a wet road are
sharply reduced.
Depending upon the weather and/or road
surface (conditions), the tire traction varies
widely.
Specified tire pressures must be maintained. This applies particularly if the
tires are subject to extreme operating
conditions (e.g. high speeds, heavy loads,
high ambient temperatures).
Warning!
G
Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle. You may lose control of the vehicle.
Continued driving with a flat tire or driving at high speed with a flat tire will cause
excessive heat build-up and possibly a fire.
Hydroplaning
Depending on the depth of the water
layer on the road, hydroplaning may occur, even at low speeds and with new
tires. Reduce vehicle speed, avoid track
grooves in the road and apply brakes
cautiously in the rain.
Operation
Driving instructions
Tire traction
The safe speed on a wet, snow covered
or icy road is always lower than on a dry
road.
You should pay particular attention to
the condition of the road whenever the
outside temperatures are close to the
freezing point.
Warning!
G
If ice has formed on the road, tire traction
will be substantially reduced. Under such
weather conditions, drive, steer and brake
with extreme caution.
We recommend M+S rated radial-ply
tires for the winter season for all four
wheels to insure normal balanced handling characteristics. On packed snow,
they can reduce your stopping distance
in comparison to summer tires. Stopping
distance, however, is still considerably
greater than when the road is not covered with snow or ice. Exercise appropriate caution. Refer to "Rims and tires" in
the Technical data section ( page 459)
for a listing of winter tires approved by
us for use on Maybach vehicles.
!
Avoid spinning of a drive wheel. This
may cause serious damage to the
drivetrain which is not covered by the
Maybach Limited Warranty.
Tire speed rating
Regardless of the tire rating, local speed
limits should be obeyed. Use prudent
driving speeds appropriate to prevailing
conditions.
Your vehicle is factory equipped with
"W"-rated tires, which have a speed rating of 168 mph (270 km/h).
Warning!
G
Even when permitted by law, never operate a vehicle at speeds greater than the
maximum speed rating of the tires.
Exceeding the maximum speed for which
tires are rated can lead to sudden tire failure, causing loss of vehicle control and possibly resulting in an accident and/or
personal injury and possible death, for you
and for others.
i
For more Information, see "Tire
speed rating for winter tires"
( page 371).
An electronic speed limiter prevents your
vehicle from exceeding a speed of
155 mph (250 km/h).
347
Operation
Driving instructions
Winter driving instructions
The most important rule for slippery or
icy roads is to drive sensibly and to avoid
abrupt acceleration, braking and steering maneuvers. Do not use the cruise
control system under such conditions.
When the vehicle is in danger of skidding, move gear selector lever to
position N. Try to keep the vehicle under
control by corrective steering action.
i
For more Information on driving with
snow chains, see "Snow chains"
( page 372).
Warning!
G
On slippery road surfaces, never downshift
in order to obtain braking action. This
could result in drive wheel slip and reduced vehicle control. Your vehicle’s ABS
will not prevent this type of control loss.
348
Road salts and chemicals can adversely
affect braking efficiency. Increased pedal
force may become necessary to produce
the normal braking effect.
Depressing the brake pedal periodically
when traveling at length on salt-strewn
roads can bring road-salt-impaired braking efficiency back to normal.
If the vehicle is parked after being driven
on salt-treated roads, the braking efficiency should be tested as soon as possible after driving is resumed.
Warning!
G
Make sure not to endanger any other road
users when carrying out these braking maneuvers.
Warning!
G
If the vehicle becomes stuck in snow, make
sure snow is kept clear of the exhaust pipe
and from around the vehicle with the engine running. Otherwise, deadly carbon
monoxide (CO) gases may enter vehicle interior resulting in unconsciousness and
death.
To assure sufficient fresh air ventilation,
open a window slightly on the side of the
vehicle not facing the wind.
Warning!
G
The outside temperature indicator is not
designed to serve as an ice-warning device
and is therefore unsuitable for that purpose. Indicated temperatures just above
the freezing point do not guarantee that
the road surface is free of ice.
For more information, see "Winter driving" ( page 371).
Operation
Driving instructions
Standing water
Passenger compartment
!
G
Do not drive through flooded areas
or water of unknown depth. Before
driving through water, determine its
depth. Never accelerate before driving into water. The bow wave could
force water into the engine and auxiliary equipment, thus damaging
them.
Warning!
If you must drive through standing
water, drive slowly to prevent water
from entering the passenger compartment or the engine compartment. Water in these areas could
cause damage to electrical components or wiring of the engine or
transmission, or could result in water
being ingested by the engine
through the air intake causing severe
internal engine damage. Any such
damage is not covered by the
Maybach Limited Warranty.
The trunk is the preferred place to carry
objects.
Control and operation of radio transmitters
COMAND, radio and telephone
Always fasten items being carried as securely as possible.
Warning!
In an accident, during hard braking or sudden maneuvers, loose items will be thrown
around inside the vehicle, and cause injury
to vehicle occupants unless the items are
securely fastened in the vehicle.
Driving abroad
Abroad, there is an extensive Maybach
service network at your disposal. If you
plan to drive into areas which are not
listed in the index of your Maybach
Studio directory, you should request pertinent information from an authorized
Maybach Studio.
G
Please do not forget that your primary responsibility is to drive the vehicle safely.
Only operate the COMAND (Cockpit Management and Data System), radio or telephone1 if road, weather and traffic
conditions permit.
Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph
(approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is
covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14 m) every second.
1
Observe all legal requirements.
349
Operation
Driving instructions
Telephones and two-way radios
Warning!
G
Never operate radio transmitters equipped
with a built-in or attached antenna (i.e.
without being connected to an external
antenna) from inside the vehicle while the
engine is running. Doing so could lead to a
malfunction of the vehicle’s electronic system, possibly resulting in an accident and/
or personal injury.
Catalytic converter
Your Maybach is equipped with monolithic-type catalytic converters, an important element in conjunction with the
oxygen sensors to achieve substantial
control of the pollutants in the exhaust
emissions. Keep your vehicle in proper
operating condition by following our
recommended maintenance instructions
as outlined in your Maintenance Booklet.
!
Radio transmitters, such as a portable
telephone or citizens band unit should
only be used inside the vehicle if they are
connected to an antenna that is installed
on the outside of the vehicle.
Refer to the radio transmitter operation
instructions regarding use of an external
antenna.
350
To prevent damage to the catalytic
converters, use only premium unleaded gasoline in this vehicle.
Any noticeable irregularities in engine operation should be dealt with
promptly. Otherwise, excessive unburned fuel may reach the catalytic
converter, causing it to overheat and
start a fire.
Warning!
G
As with any vehicle, do not idle, park or operate this vehicle in areas where combustible materials such as grass, hay or leaves
can come into contact with the hot exhaust system, as these materials could be
ignited and cause a vehicle fire.
Emission control
Certain systems of the engine serve to
keep the toxic components of the exhaust gases within permissible limits required by law.
These systems, of course, will function
properly only when maintained strictly
according to factory specifications. Any
adjustments to the engine should therefore be carried out only by qualified
Maybach Studio authorized technicians.
Engine adjustments should not be altered in any way. Moreover, the specified service jobs must be carried out
regularly according to Maybach servicing
requirements. For details refer to the
Maintenance Booklet.
Operation
Driving instructions
Warning!
G
Inhalation of exhaust gas is hazardous to
your health. All exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide, and inhaling it can cause
unconsciousness and lead to death.
Do not run the engine in confined areas
(such as a garage) which are not properly
ventilated. If you think that exhaust gas
fumes are entering the vehicle while driving, have the cause determined and corrected immediately. If you must drive
under these conditions, drive with at least
one window fully open at all times.
Coolant temperature
During severe operating conditions, e.g.
stop-and-go traffic, the coolant temperature may rise close to approximately
248°F (120°C).
!
The engine should not be operated
with the coolant temperature over
248°F (120°C). Doing so may cause serious engine damage which is not
covered by the Maybach Limited
Warranty.
Warning!
G
Driving when your engine is badly overheated can cause some fluids, which may
have leaked into the engine compartment,
to catch fire. You could be seriously
burned.
Steam from an overheated engine can
cause serious burns and can occur just by
opening the engine hood. Stay away from
the engine if you see or hear steam coming
from it.
Turn off the engine, get out of the vehicle
and do not stand near the vehicle until the
engine has cooled down.
351
Operation
At the gas station
Open the fuel filler flap by pushing at
Refueling
the point indicated by the arrow.
Warning!
G
The fuel filler flap springs open.
Turn the fuel cap to the left and hold
Gasoline is highly flammable and poisonous. It burns violently and can cause serious injury. Whenever you are around
gasoline, avoid inhaling fumes and skin
contact, extinguish all smoking materials.
Never allow sparks, flame or smoking materials near gasoline!
The fuel filler flap is located on the right
hand side of the vehicle towards the
rear. Locking/unlocking the vehicle with
the SmartKey or the SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** automatically locks/
unlocks the fuel filler flap.
352
on to it until possible pressure is released.
Take off the cap and set it in the re-
cess on the fuel filler flap.
To prevent fuel vapors from escaping
1 Push to open the fuel filler flap
2 Set the fuel cap
Turn the engine off
by using the SmartKey, remove
the SmartKey from the starter
switch
by pressing the KEYLESS-GO**
start/stop button ( page 55),
open the driver's door (with the
driver's door open, starter switch
is now in position 0, same as
SmartKey removed from the starter switch).
into open air, fully insert filler nozzle
unit.
Only fill your tank until the filler noz-
zle unit cuts out – do not top up or
overfill.
Operation
At the gas station
Warning!
G
Overfilling of the fuel tank may create
pressure in the system which could cause a
gas discharge. This could cause the gas to
spray back out when removing the fuel
pump nozzle, which could cause personal
injury.
Replace the fuel cap by turning it to
the right.
i
i
Use only premium unleaded gasoline
with a minimum Posted Octane Rating of 91 (average of 96 RON/
86 MON).
Leaving the engine running and the
fuel cap open can cause
the ? lamp to illuminate.
Information on gasoline quality can
normally be found on the fuel pump.
For more information, see "Practical
hints" ( page 389).
For more information on gasoline,
see the Factory Approved Service
Products pamphlet.
You will hear when the fuel cap is
tightened.
Close the fuel filler flap.
353
Operation
At the gas station
Check regularly and before a long trip
Brake fluid
!
1
2
3
4
Brake fluid SBC system only
Coolant level
Brake fluid
Windshield washer and headlamp
cleaning system
i
Opening hood ( page 355).
If you find that the brake fluid in the
brake fluid reservoir has fallen to the
minimum mark or below, have the
brake system checked for brake pad
thickness and leaks immediately. Notify an authorized Maybach Studio
immediately. Do not add brake fluid
as this will not solve the problem. For
more information, see "Practical
hints" ( page 388).
Coolant
For more information, see "Coolant level" ( page 360) and see "Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc." ( page 464).
Windshield washer and headlamp cleaning system
For more information on refilling the reservoir, see "Windshield washer and
headlamp cleaning system"
( page 362).
354
Engine oil level
For more information, see "Engine oil"
( page 356).
Vehicle lighting
Check function and cleanliness. For more
information on replacing light bulbs,
see "Replacing bulbs" ( page 430).
See also the section on the exterior lamp
switch ( page 143).
Tire inflation pressure
For more information on tire inflation
pressure ( page 364).
Operation
Engine compartment
Engine compartment
Pull lever 1 towards you in the direc-
Hood
tion of the arrow.
Warning!
G
Do not pull the release lever while the vehicle is in motion. Otherwise the hood
could be forced open by passing air flow.
Opening
The hood lock release lever is located in
the driver’s footwell to the left of the
parking brake pedal.
The hood is unlocked and handle 2
will extend out of the radiator grille.
!
To avoid damage to the windshield
wipers or hood, never open the hood
if the wiper arms are folded forward
away from the windshield.
Pull handle 2 to its stop out of radi-
ator grille.
Pull up on the hood (do not pull up
on the handle) and then release it.
The hood will be automatically held
open at shoulder height.
Warning!
G
To help prevent personal injury, stay clear
of moving parts when the hood is open
and the engine is running. Make sure the
hood is properly closed before driving.
When closing the hood, use extreme caution not to catch hands or fingers.
The radiator fan may continue to run for
approximately 30 seconds or even restart
after the engine has been turned off. Stay
clear of fan blades.
2 Handle for opening the hood
1 Hood lock release
355
Operation
Engine compartment
Warning!
G
If you see flames or smoke coming from
the engine compartment, or if the coolant
temperature gauge indicates that the engine is overheated, do not open the hood.
Move away from vehicle and do not open
the hood until the engine has cooled. If
necessary, call the fire department.
Closing
Warning!
G
Be careful that you do not close the hood
on anyone.
Let the hood drop from a height of
approximately 1 ft (30 cm).
The hood will lock audibly.
Warning!
G
The engine is equipped with a transistorized ignition system. Because of the high
voltage it is dangerous to touch any components (ignition coils, spark plug sockets,
diagnostic socket) of the ignition system
with the engine running
while starting the engine
if ignition is "on" and the engine is
turned manually
356
Check to make sure the hood is fully
closed.
If you can raise the hood at a point
above the headlamps, then it is not
properly closed. Open it again and let
it drop with somewhat greater force.
Engine oil
The amount of oil your engine needs will
depend on a number of factors, including driving style. Higher oil consumption
can occur when
the vehicle is new
the vehicle is driven frequently at
higher engine speeds
Engine oil consumption checks should
only be made after the vehicle break-in
period.
!
Do not use any special lubricant additives, as these may damage the drive
assemblies. Using special additives
not approved by us for use on
Maybach vehicles may cause damage
not covered by the Maybach Limited
Warranty.
More information on this subject is
available at any Maybach Studio.
Operation
Engine compartment
Checking engine oil level
i
When checking the oil level the vehicle
must
If you want to interrupt the checking
procedure, press button k or j
on the multifunction steering wheel.
be parked on level ground
be at normal operating temperature
have been stationary for at least five
minutes with the engine turned off
You can check the engine oil level on the
multifunction display.
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
The standard display ( page 157)
should appear in the multifunction display.
Press button k or j on the
If necessary, add engine oil.
One of the following messages will
subsequently appear in the indicator:
OK
For more information on engine oil, see
"Technical data" ( page 464) and
( page 465).
ADD 1.0 QT. TO
REACH MAX. OIL LEVEL
(Canada: 1.0 LITER)
steering wheel until the following
message is seen in the multifunction
display:
ENGINE OIL LEVEL
MEASURING NOW!
CORRECT MEASUREMENT
ONLY IF VEH. LEVEL
ENGINE OIL LEVEL
For adding oil, see ( page 359).
ADD 1.5 QTS. TO
REACH MAX. OIL LEVEL
(Canada: 1.5 LITERS)
ADD 2.0 QTS. TO
REACH MAX. OIL LEVEL
(Canada: 2.0 LITERS)
357
Operation
Engine compartment
Other display messages
If you see the message:
If the ignition is not switched on, the following message will appear:
ENGINE OIL LEVEL
NOT WHEN ENGINE ON
FOR ENGINE OIL LEVEL
SWITCH IGNITION ON
Turn off the engine.
Switch on the ignition.
If you see the message:
PERF. SERV. ON TIME
If engine is at normal operating tem-
perature, wait five minutes before repeating check procedure.
If engine is not yet at normal operat-
ing temperature, wait 30 minutes before repeating check procedure.
If engine is at normal operating tem-
perature, wait five minutes before
checking oil.
If the engine is not yet at normal op-
erating temperature, you must wait
30 minutes before checking oil.
If there is excessive engine oil with the
engine at normal operating temperature, the following message will appear:
ENGINE OIL LEVEL
REDUCE OIL LEVEL
Have excess oil siphoned or drained
off. Contact an authorized Maybach
Studio.
!
Excessive oil must be siphoned or
drained off. It could cause damage to
the engine and catalytic converter
not covered by the Maybach Limited
Warranty.
For more information on messages in the
display concerning engine oil, see "Practical hints" ( page 408).
358
Operation
Engine compartment
!
Adding engine oil
Excessive oil must be siphoned or
drained off. It could cause damage to
the engine and catalytic converter
not covered by the Maybach Limited
Warranty.
!
Only use approved engine oils and oil
filters required for vehicles with
Maintenance System (U.S. vehicles) or
FSS (Canada vehicles). For a listing of
approved engine oils and oil filters,
refer to the Factory Approved Service
Products pamphlet in your vehicle literature portfolio, or contact an authorized Maybach Studio.
Using engine oils and oil filters of
specification other than those expressly required for the Maintenance
System (U.S. vehicles) or FSS (Canada
vehicles), or changing of oil and oil
filter at change intervals longer than
those called for by the Maintenance
System (U.S. vehicles) or FSS (Canada
Vehicles) will result in engine damage
not covered by the Maybach Limited
Warranty.
Screw the filler cap 1 back on the
filler neck.
1 Filler cap
Unscrew the filler cap 1 from filler
neck.
Add engine oil as required. Be careful
not to overfill with oil.
Be careful not to spill any oil when adding. Avoid environmental damage
caused by oil entering the ground or water.
For more information on engine oil, see
"Technical data" ( page 464) and
( page 465).
Transmission fluid level
The transmission fluid level does not
need to be checked. If you notice transmission fluid loss or gear shifting malfunctions, have an authorized Maybach
Studio check the automatic transmission.
359
Operation
Engine compartment
Coolant level
The engine coolant is a mixture of water
and anticorrosion/antifreeze. To check
the coolant level, the vehicle must be
parked on level ground and the engine
must be cool.
Warning!
G
Do not spill antifreeze on hot engine
parts. Antifreeze contains ethylene
glycol which may burn if it comes into
contact with hot engine parts.
360
Using a rag, slowly open the cap approximately ½ turn to relieve excess
pressure. If opened immediately, scalding hot fluid and steam will be blown
out under pressure.
Continue turning cap 2 to the left
The coolant level is correct if the level
for cold coolant: reaches the black
top part of the reservoir
for warm coolant: is approximately
0.6 in (1.5 cm) higher
Add coolant as required.
Use extreme caution when opening
the hood if there are any signs of
steam or coolant leaking from the
cooling system, or if the coolant temperature gauge indicates that the coolant is overheated.
Do not remove pressure cap on coolant
reservoir if coolant temperature is
above 158°F (70°C). Allow engine to
cool down before removing cap. The
coolant reservoir contains hot fluid
and is under pressure.
proximately one half turn to the left
to release any excess pressure.
and remove it.
The coolant expansion tank is located on
the passenger side of the engine compartment.
In order to avoid any possibly serious
burns:
Using a rag, turn cap 2 slowly ap-
Replace and tighten cap.
For more information on coolant, see
"Technical data" ( page 467).
1 Coolant expansion tank
2 Cap
Operation
Engine compartment
Batteries
Your vehicle is equipped with two batteries:
Starter battery (located in the engine
compartment).
Electrical consumer battery (located
in the trunk).
These batteries should always be sufficiently charged in order to achieve their
rated service life. Refer to Maintenance
Booklet for battery maintenance intervals.
If you use your vehicle mostly for shortdistance trips, you will need to have the
battery charge checked more frequently.
When replacing batteries, always use
batteries approved by us for use on
Maybach vehicles.
If you do not intend to operate your vehicle for an extended period of time,
consult an authorized Maybach Studio
about steps you need to observe.
G
Observe all safety instructions and precautions when
handling automotive batteries.
A
D
B
Risk of explosion
Batteries contain materials that can
harm the environment if disposed of improperly. Recycling of batteries is the
preferred method of disposal. Many
states require sellers of batteries to accept old batteries for recycling.
Keep flames or sparks away
from battery. Do not smoke.
Battery acid is caustic. Do not
allow it to come into contact
with skin, eyes or clothing.
In case it does, immediately
flush affected area with clear
water and seek medical help
if necessary.
E
C
F
Wear eye protection.
Keep children away.
Follow the instructions in
this Operator's Manual.
361
Operation
Engine compartment
Windshield washer and headlamp
cleaning system
Fluid for the windshield washer system
and the headlamp cleaning system is supplied from the windshield washer reservoir. It has a capacity of approximately
7.1 US qt (6.7 l).
During all seasons, add MB Windshield
Washer Concentrate "S" to water. Premix the windshield washer fluid in a suitable container.
Refill the reservoir with MB Wind-
shield Washer Concentrate and water
(or commercially available pre-mixed
windshield washer solvent/
antifreeze, depending on ambient
temperatures).
Always use washer solvent/antifreeze
where temperatures may fall below
freezing point. Failure to do so could
result in damage to the washer system/reservoir.
362
Warning!
G
Washer solvent/antifreeze is highly flammable. Do not spill washer solvent/
antifreeze on hot engine parts, because it
may ignite and burn. You could be seriously burned.
!
1 Washer fluid reservoir
For more information, see "Windshield
and headlamp washer fluid mixing ratio" ( page 469).
Only use washer fluid which is suitable for plastic lenses. Improper
washer fluid can damage the plastic
lenses of the headlamps.
Operation
Tires and wheels
Tires and wheels
See an authorized Maybach Studio for
information on tested and recommended rims and tires for summer and winter
operation. They can also offer advice
concerning tire service and purchase.
Warning!
G
Replace rims or tires with the same designation, manufacturer and type as shown
on the original part. See an authorized
Maybach Studio for further information. If
incorrectly sized rims and tires are mounted:
The wheel brakes or suspension components can be damaged
The correct operating clearance of the
wheels and the tires are no longer
guaranteed
Warning!
G
Worn, old tires can cause accidents. If the
tire tread is badly worn, or if the tires have
sustained damage, replace them.
Important guidelines
Use only sets of tires and rims of the
same type and make.
Tires must be of the correct size for
the rim.
When replacing rims, use only genuine
Maybach wheel bolts specified for the particular rim type. Failure to do so can result
in the bolts loosening and possibly an accident.
Break in new tires for approximately
60 miles (100 km) at moderate
speeds.
Regularly check the tires and rims for
damage.
Retreaded tires are not tested or recommended by us for use on Maybach vehicles, since previous damage cannot
always be recognized on retreads. We
can therefore not assure the operating
safety of the vehicle when such tires are
used.
If vehicle is heavily loaded, check tire
pressure and correct as required.
Do not allow your tires to wear down
too far. Adhesion properties on wet
roads are sharply reduced at tread
depths under 1/8 in (3 mm).
When replacing individual tires, you
should mount new tires on the front
wheels first (on vehicles with samesized wheels all around).
363
Operation
Tires and wheels
Life of tires
The service life of a tire is dependent
upon varying factors including but not
limited to:
Driving style
Tire pressure
Distance driven
Warning!
An arrow on the sidewall indicates the
intended direction of tire rotation
(spinning).
G
Tires and spare tire should be replaced after six years, regardless of the remaining
tread.
!
Keep unmounted tires in a cool, dry
place with as little exposure to light
as possible. Protect tires from contact
with oil, grease and gasoline.
364
Direction of rotation
Unidirectional tires offer added advantages, such as better hydroplaning performance. To benefit, however, you
must make sure that the tires rotate in
the direction specified.
Checking tire pressure
Warning!
G
If the tire pressure repeatedly drops:
Check the tires for punctures from foreign objects.
Check to see whether air is leaking
from the valves or from around the
rim.
Check and correct the tire pressure only
when tires are cold.
Regularly check your tire pressure at intervals at least once a month.
If the tires are warm, you should only
correct the tire pressure if it is too low for
current operating conditions.
A table on the fuel filler flap lists the
specified tire inflation pressures for
warm and cold tires as well as for various
operating conditions.
Operation
Tires and wheels
i
The pressures listed for light loads are
minimum values offering high driving comfort.
Increased inflation pressures listed
for heavier loads may also be used for
light loads. These higher pressures
produce favorable handling characteristics. The ride of the vehicle, however, will be somewhat harder. Never
exceed the max. values or inflate tires
below the min. values listed on the
fuel filler flap.
Tire pressure changes by approximately
1.5 psi (0.1 bar) per 18°F (10°C) of air
temperature change. Keep this in mind
when checking tire pressure where the
temperature is different from the outside temperature.
Tire temperature and tire pressure also
increase while driving, depending on the
driving speed and the tire load.
Warning!
G
Follow recommended inflation pressures.
Do not overinflate tires. Overinflated tires
can result in sudden deflation (blowout)
because they are more likely to become
punctured or damaged by road debris,
potholes etc.
Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated
tires wear unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and are more likely to fail from being overheated.
Do not overload the tires by exceeding the
specified vehicle capacity weight (as indicated by the label on the pillar in the driver’s door opening). Overloading the tires
can overheat them, possibly causing a
blowout.
Check the spare tire periodically for condition and inflation pressure. Spare tires
will age and become worn over time
even if never used, and thus should be inspected and replaced when necessary or
after a maximum of six years.
Checking tire pressure electronically
i
Check with an authorized Maybach
Studio to determine the equipment
installed in your vehicle.
The tire inflation pressure monitor only
functions on wheels that are equipped
with the proper electronic sensors. It
monitors the tire inflation pressure, as
selected by the driver, in all four tires. A
warning is issued to alert you to a decrease in pressure in one or more of the
tires.
Tire pressure inquiries are made using
the multifunction display ( page 157).
The inflation pressures are displayed
only after a few minutes’ travel time.
You can select the unit of measure used
for the tire inflation pressure by changing the setting in the control system
( page 157).
365
Operation
Tires and wheels
i
Switch on the ignition.
After reactivating the tire inflation
pressure monitor, the inflation pressures are displayed only after a few
minutes’ driving time.
Press button è or ÿ on the mul-
During this time, you will see the following message in the display:
TIRE PRES. DISPLAY
APPEARS AFTER
DRIVING A FEW
MINUTES
i
Possible differences between the
readings of a tire pressure gauge of
an air hose, e.g. gas station equipment, and the vehicle’s control system can occur. The readings issued by
the control system are more precise.
tifunction steering wheel repeatedly
until the standard display menu appears in the multifunction display
( page 158).
Press button k or j repeatedly
until you see the current inflation
pressures for each tire appear in the
multifunction display.
Warning!
G
When the tire pressure monitoring system
warning lamp is lit, one or more of your
tires is significantly under-inflated. You
should stop and check your tires as soon as
possible, and inflate them to the proper
pressure as indicated on the vehicle’s tire
information placard. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to
overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency
and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling and stopping ability. Each
tire, including the spare, should be
checked monthly when cold and set to the
recommended inflation pressure as specified in the vehicle placard and owner’s
manual.
i
The recommended tire inflation pressure for your vehicle can be found on
the inside of the fuel filler flap, not in
the owner’s manual.
366
Operation
Tires and wheels
Warning!
G
The tire inflation pressure monitor does
not indicate a warning for wrongly selected inflation pressures. Always adjust tire
inflation pressure according to the label
affixed on the fuel filler flap.
The tire inflation pressure monitor is not
able to issue a warning due to a sudden
dramatic loss of pressure (e.g. tire blowout
caused by a foreign object). In this case
bring the vehicle to a halt by carefully applying the brakes and avoiding abrupt
steering maneuvers.
i
Operating radio transmission equipment (e.g. wireless headsets,
two-way radios, phones etc. except
equipment approved by us for use in
your Maybach vehicle) in or near the
vehicle could cause the tire inflation
pressure monitor to malfunction.
Warning!
G
Follow recommended inflation pressures.
Do not overinflate tires. Overinflated tires
can result in a sudden deflation (blowout)
because they are more likely to become
punctured or damaged by road debris,
potholes etc.
Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated
tires wear unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and are more likely to fail from being overheated.
Do not overload the tires by exceeding the
specified vehicle capacity weight (as indicated by the label on the pillar in the driver’s door opening). Overloading the tires
can overheat them, possibly causing a
blowout.
Reactivating the tire inflation pressure
monitor
You must reactivate the tire inflation
pressure monitor in the following cases:
If you have changed the tire pressure
If you have replaced the wheels or
tires
If you have installed new wheels or
tires
Using the table on the fuel filler flap,
make sure the tire inflation pressure
of all four tires is correct.
Press button è or ÿ on the mul-
tifunction steering wheel repeatedly
until the standard display menu appears in the multifunction display
( page 157).
367
Operation
Tires and wheels
Press button k or j repeatedly
Press button æ.
until you see the current inflation
pressures for each tire appear in the
multifunction display or the following message appears in the multifunction display
The following message will appear in
the multifunction display field:
TIRE PRES. DISPLAY
APPEARS AFTER
DRIVING A FEW
MINUTES
The tire inflation pressure monitor
will now monitor the tire inflation
pressure values of all four tires.
i
If you are transporting a deflated tire
in the vehicle, do not activate the tire
inflation pressure monitor until:
the deflated tire is no longer in
the vehicle
you have inflated the tire to the
correct pressure
Press reset button J ( page 25).
The following message will appear in
the multifunction display:
MONITOR CURRENT
TIRE PRESSURES?
368
TIRE PRES. MONITOR
REACTIVATED
Afterward, the following message
will appear in the display:
TIRE PRES. DISPLAY
APPEARS AFTER
DRIVING A FEW
MINUTES
This display appears until the individual inflation pressure values are
matched with the tires. The individual values are then displayed.
If you wish to cancel activation:
Press button ç NO.
If one of the following messages appears in the display:
TIRE PRES. MONITOR
REACTIVATE AFTER
CORRECTING PRESSURE
TIRE PRESSURE
PLEASE CORRECT
Check the tire inflation pressures and
correct them if necessary.
Reactivate the tire inflation pressure
monitor.
Operation
Tires and wheels
Speed limitation in the event of tire
problems
If the tire pressure falls below a certain
value or in case of a flat tire, your vehicle
speed is automatically limited to 50 mph
(80 km/h) and the message:
LIMIT 50 MPH TIRE FAILURE
(Canada: LIMIT 80 KM/H TIRE FAILURE)
appears in the multifunction display. Additional warning messages may also appear in the multifunction display.
Observe the warning messages in the display and follow the instructions for each
message. See the "Practical hints" section ( page 416) for a listing of warning
messages and instructions.
Should the driving situation require and
allow it, you can override the automatic
speed limitation as set by the tire pressure monitoring system by depressing
the accelerator pedal fully and briskly.
This will shift the transmission to a lower
gear and accelerate the vehicle until the
accelerator pedal is released slightly or
the top speed for a particular gear is
reached.
Warning!
G
Driving with underinflated or damaged
tire(s) produces worse than normal and unexpected vehicle operational characteristics. Overriding the speed limitation is
potentially dangerous as higher speeds
and quick acceleration, as produced by
your depressing the accelerator pedal fully
and briskly, may intensify adverse vehicle
handling characteristics.
Warning!
G
You should pull over immediately. The vehicle no longer has steering stability and
may skid. Change the wheel.
Warning!
G
Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle. You may loose control of the vehicle.
Continued driving with a flat tire will cause
excessive heat build-up and possibly a fire.
369
Operation
Tires and wheels
Rotating tires
Warning!
G
Rotate front and rear wheels only if the
tires are of the same dimension.
If your vehicle is equipped with mixed-size
tires (different tire dimensions front vs.
rear), tire rotation is not possible.
Tire rotation can be performed on vehicles with tires of the same dimension all
around. If your vehicle is equipped with
tires of the same dimension all around,
tires can be rotated, observing a a frontto-rear rotation pattern that will maintain the intended rotation (spinning) direction of the tire ( page 364).
In some cases, such as when your vehicle
is equipped with mixed-size tires (different tire dimension front vs. rear), tire rotation is not possible.
370
If applicable to your vehicle's tire configuration, tires can be rotated according to
the tire manufacturer's recommended
intervals in the tire manufacturer's warranty pamphlet located in your vehicle
literature portfolio. If none is available,
tires should be rotated every 3000 to
6000 miles (5000 to 10000 km), or sooner if necessary, according to the degree
of tire wear. The same rotation (spinning) direction must be maintained
( page 364).
Rotate tires before the characteristic tire
wear pattern becomes visible (shoulder
wear on front tires and tread center
wear on rear tires).
Thoroughly clean the mounting face of
wheels and brake disks, i.e. the inner side
of the wheels/tires, during each rotation.
Check for and ensure proper tire inflation pressure, activating the tire inflation
pressure monitor if necessary.
Warning!
G
Have the tightening torque checked after
changing a wheel. Wheels could become
loose if not tightened with a torque of
110 lb-ft (150 Nm).
Only use genuine Maybach wheel bolts
specified for your vehicle's rims.
!
Your vehicle is equipped with a tire
inflation pressure monitor. Electronic
components are built into the wheel.
Do not use mounting tools in the area
of the valve as they could damage the
electronic components.
To prevent damage or incorrect installation, have the tires changed at
an authorized Maybach Studio.
For information on wheel change, see
the “Practical hints” section ( page 422)
and ( page 436).
Operation
Winter driving
Winter driving
Before the onset of winter, have your vehicle winterized at an authorized
Maybach Studio. This service includes:
Check of anticorrosion and antifreeze
concentration.
Addition of cleaning concentrate to
the water of the windshield and
headlamp cleaning system. Add MB
Concentrate "S" to a pre-mixed windshield washer solvent/antifreeze
which is formulated for temperatures
below freezing point ( page 468).
Tire speed rating for winter tires
If you install winter tires, have an authorized Maybach Studio limit the speed of
your vehicle to the speed rating of the
winter tires installed.
When the speed limitation is activated,
the segments up to the set speed limitation are illuminated, for example,
130 mph (210 km/h) as in the illustration
below.
Warning!
G
Even when permitted by law, never operate a vehicle at speeds greater than the
maximum speed rating of the tires.
Battery test. Battery capacity drops
with decreasing ambient temperature. A well-charged battery helps to
make sure the engine can be started
even at low ambient temperatures.
Tire change. We recommend for use
on Maybach vehicles M+S radial-ply
tires with a minimum tread depth of
approximately 1⁄6 in (4 mm) on all
four wheels for the winter season.
Refer to "Rims and tires" in the Technical data section ( page 459) for a
listing of winter tires approved by us
for use on Maybach vehicles.
Always observe the speed rating of the
winter tires installed on your vehicle. If
the maximum speed for which your tires
are rated is below the speed rating of
your vehicle, you must place a notice to
this effect where it will be seen by the
driver. Such notices are available from
your tire dealer or from any authorized
Maybach Studio.
Exceeding the maximum speed for which
tires are rated can lead to sudden tire failure, causing loss of vehicle control and possibly resulting in an accident and/or
personal injury and possible death, for you
and for others.
Vehicle speed limitation for winter tires in
speedometer
371
Operation
Winter driving
Winter tires
Always use winter tires at temperatures
below 45°F (7°C) and whenever wintry
road conditions prevail. Use of winter
tires is the only way to achieve the maximum effectiveness of the ABS and the
ESP in winter operation.
For safe handling, make sure all mounted winter tires are of the same make and
have the same tread design.
Warning!
G
Winter tires with a tread depth under
0.16 in (4 mm) must be replaced. They are
no longer suitable for winter operation.
Warning!
If you use your spare tire when winter tires
are fitted on the other wheels, be aware
that the difference in tire characteristics
may very well impair turning stability and
that overall driving stability may be reduced. Adapt your driving style accordingly.
Have the spare tire replaced with a winter
tire at the nearest authorized Maybach
Studio.
Snow chains
When using snow chains, the vehicle
should only be driven at vehicle height
Raised ( page 248).
Snow chains should only be driven on
snow-covered roads at speeds not to exceed 30 mph (50 km/h). Remove chains
as soon as possible when driving on
roads without snow.
372
i
G
When driving with snow chains, you
may wish to deactivate the ESP
( page 99) before setting the vehicle in motion. This will improve the
vehicle‘s traction.
Please observe the following guidelines
when using snow chains:
Using snow chains is not permissible
with all wheel/tire combinations.
Chains should only be used on the
rear wheels. Follow the manufacturer's mounting instructions.
Use only snow chains that are approved by us for use on Maybach vehicles. your authorized Maybach
Studio will be glad to advise you on
this subject.
Use of snow chains may be prohibited
depending on location. Always check
local and state laws before installing
snow chains.
Operation
Maintenance
Maintenance
We strongly recommend that you have
your vehicle serviced by an authorized
Maybach Studio, in accordance with the
Maintenance Booklet at the times called
for by the maintenance service indicator
display.
Failure to have the vehicle maintained in
accordance with the Maintenance Booklet and maintenance service indicator at
the designated times /mileage will result
in vehicle damage not covered by the
Maybach Limited Warranty.
The maintenance service indicator will
notify you when your next maintenance
service is due.
Starting approximately one month before your next maintenance service is
due, one of the following messages will
appear in the multifunction display
while you are driving or when you switch
on the ignition (example service A):
SERVICE
SERVICE
SERVICE
SERVICE
A
A
A
A
IN XXXXX MILES (KM)
IN XXX DAYS
IN X DAY
DUE NOW
The type of service due is indicated in the
multifunction display:
9
Basic service (A)
´
Extended service (B)
i
Vehicles equipped with FSS (Flexible
Service System) only (Canada vehicles):
The interval between services
depends on your driving habits.
A gentle driving style, moderate
engine speeds and the avoidance of
short-distance trips will lengthen the
interval between services.
Clearing the maintenance service indicator
The maintenance service indicator is automatically cleared after 30 seconds
when you switch on the ignition or when
reaching the maintenance service threshold while driving. You can also clear it
yourself.
Press reset button J ( page 25) in
the instrument cluster.
Maintenance service term exceeded
If you have exceeded the suggested
maintenance service term, you will see
the following message in the multifunction display:
SERVICE A EXCEEDED BY XXXX MILES (KM)
SERVICE A EXCEEDED BY XXX DAYS
SERVICE A EXCEEDED BY X DAY
In addition, a signal sounds when the
message appears.
Any authorized Maybach Studio will reset the maintenance service indicator following a completed maintenance
service.
373
Operation
Maintenance
Calling up the maintenance service indicator
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
The standard display of the control
system appears ( page 157).
Press button k or j on the mul-
tifunction steering wheel until the
maintenance service indicator with
the service symbol 9 or ´ and
the service deadline appear in the
multifunction display.
i
If the battery is disconnected, the
days of disconnection will not be included in the count shown by the
maintenance service indicator. To arrive at the true maintenance service
deadline, you will need to subtract
these days from the days shown in
the maintenance service indicator.
Do not confuse the maintenance service indicator with the engine oil level indicator :.
374
Resetting the maintenance service indicator
In the event that the maintenance service on your vehicle is not carried out by
an authorized Maybach Studio, you can
have the maintenance service indicator
reset. The automotive maintenance facility carrying out the maintenance service
will find the information for resetting
the maintenance service indicator in the
maintenance-relevant information for
your vehicle. Such information is available from either your authorized
Maybach Studio or directly from
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC.
i
If the maintenance service indicator
was inadvertently reset, have an authorized Maybach Studio correct it.
Only reset if the proper maintenance
service has been performed. Resetting the system without performing
the proper service as called for by the
maintenance service indicator will result in engine damage and/or other
vehicle damage not covered by the
Maybach Limited Warranty.
Operation
Vehicle care
Vehicle care
To avoid paint damage, you should immediately remove:
Cleaning and care of vehicle
Warning!
G
Many cleaning products can be hazardous.
Some are poisonous, others are flammable. Always follow the instructions on the
particular container. Always open your vehicle’s doors or windows when cleaning
the inside.
Never use fluids or solvents that are not
designed for cleaning your vehicle.
While in operation, even while parked,
your vehicle is subjected to varying external influences which, if gone unchecked,
can attack the paintwork as well as the
underbody and cause lasting damage.
Such damage is caused not only by extreme and varying climatic conditions,
but also by:
Air pollution
Road salt
Tar
Gravel and stone chipping
Grease and oil
Fuel
Coolant
Brake fluid
Bird droppings
Insects
Tree resins, etc.
Frequent washing reduces and/or eliminates the aggressiveness and potency of
the above adverse influences.
More frequent washings are necessary to
deal with unfavorable conditions:
near the ocean
in industrial areas (smoke, exhaust
emissions)
during winter operation
You should check your vehicle from time
to time for stone chipping or other damage. Any damage should be repaired as
soon as possible to prevent corrosion.
In doing so, do not neglect the underbody of the vehicle. A prerequisite for a
thorough check is a washing of the underbody followed by a thorough inspection. Damaged areas need to be
re-undercoated.
Your vehicle has been treated at the factory with a wax-base rustproofing in the
body cavities which will last for the lifetime of the vehicle. Post-production
treatment is neither necessary nor recommended by us for use on Maybach vehicles because of the possibility of
incompatibility between materials used
in the production process and others applied later.
We have selected car-care products and
compiled recommendations which are
specially matched to our vehicles and
which always reflect the latest technology. You can obtain car-care products approved by us for use on Maybach vehicles
at an authorized Maybach Studio.
375
Operation
Vehicle care
Scratches, corrosive deposits, corrosion
or damage due to negligent or incorrect
care cannot always be removed or repaired with the car-care products recommended here. In such cases it is best to
seek aid at an authorized Maybach Studio.
The following topics deal with the cleaning and care of your vehicle and give important "how-to" information as well as
references to car-care products approved
by us for use on Maybach vehicles.
Refrigerator**
Clean out the refrigerator regularly with
a vinegar-and-water solution. Mix the
solution in a ratio of 1 part vinegar to
10 parts water. Allow the refrigerator to
dry before using it again.
Power-wash
Tar stains
When using a power-wash for cleaning
the vehicle, always observe the manufacturer’s operating instructions.
Quickly remove tar stains before they dry
and become more difficult to remove.
A tar remover is recommended.
i
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO**:
If an outside door handle is hit by a
strong jet of water, and a SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO** is in close proximity, i.e. within approximately 3 ft
(approximately 1 m), the vehicle
could be inadvertently locked or unlocked.
!
Never use a round nozzle to
power-wash tires. The intense jet of
water can result in damage to the
tire.
Always replace a damaged tire.
Always keep the jet of water moving
across the surface. Do not aim directly
at electrical parts, electrical connectors, seals, or other rubber parts.
376
Paintwork, painted body components
Paint Care approved by us for use on
Maybach vehicles should be applied
when water drops on the paint surface
do not "bead up", normally every three
to five months, depending on climate
and washing detergent used.
Paint Cleaner approved for use on
Maybach vehicles should be applied if
the paint surface shows signs of embedded dirt (i.e. loss of gloss).
Do not apply any of these products or
wax if your vehicle is parked in the sun or
if the hood is still hot.
Use the appropriate Touch-Up Stick approved by us for use on Maybach vehicles
for quick and provisional repairs of minor paint damage (i.e. chips from stones,
vehicle doors, etc.).
Operation
Vehicle care
Engine cleaning
Prior to cleaning the engine compartment make sure to protect electrical
components and connectors from contact with water and cleaning agents.
Corrosion protection, such as Anti-corrosion Wax approved by us for use on Maybach vehicles, should be applied to the
engine compartment after every engine
cleaning. Before applying, all control
linkage bushings and joints should be lubricated. The poly-V-belt and all pulleys
should be protected from any wax.
Rinse with clear water and thoroughly
dry with a chamois. Do not allow cleaning agents to dry on the finish.
Due to the width of the vehicle, fold in
exterior rear view mirrors prior to running the vehicle through an automatic
car wash to prevent damage to the mirrors.
In the winter, thoroughly remove all
traces of road salt as soon as possible.
When washing the underbody, do not
forget to clean the inner sides of the
wheels.
Vehicle washing
i
Do not use hot water or wash your vehicle in direct sunlight. Use only a mild car
wash detergent, such as Car Shampoo
approved by us for use on Maybach vehicles.
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO**:
Thoroughly spray the vehicle with a diffused jet of water. Direct only a very
weak spray towards the ventilation intake. Use plenty of water and rinse the
sponge and chamois frequently.
Ornamental moldings
For regular cleaning and care of very
dirty chrome-plated parts, use a chrome
cleaner.
Headlamps, tail lamps, turn signal lenses
Use a mild car wash detergent, such as
Car Shampoo approved by us for use on
Maybach vehicles, with plenty of water.
To prevent scratches, never apply strong
force and use only a soft, non-scratchy
cloth when cleaning the lenses. Do not
attempt to wipe dirty lenses with a dry
cloth or sponge.
If an outside door handle is hit by a
strong jet of water, and a SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO** is in close proximity, i.e. within approximately 3 ft
(approximately 1 m), the vehicle
could be inadvertently locked or unlocked.
377
Operation
Vehicle care
Cleaning the Distronic** system sensor
cover
i
Restart the engine after cleaning sensor cover 1.
Cleaning the Parktronic system sensors
When using a steam cleaner or powerwash, aim nozzle only briefly from a minimum distance of 12 in (30 cm) at
sensors 1.
To prevent scratches, never apply strong
force and use only a soft, non-scratchy
cloth when cleaning the sensor. Do not
attempt to wipe dirty sensors with a dry
cloth or sponge.
Wiper blades
!
1 Distronic system sensor cover
Clean the sensor cover 1 using a
mild car wash detergent, such as Car
Shampoo approved by us for use on
Maybach vehicles with plenty of water and a soft, non-scratchy cloth.
To prevent scratches, never apply strong
force and use only a soft, non-scratchy
cloth when cleaning the sensor cover. Do
not attempt to wipe dirty sensors with a
dry cloth or sponge.
378
1 Parktronic system sensors
Clean the sensors 1 on the bumpers
using a mild car wash detergent, such
as Car Shampoo approved by us for
use on Maybach vehicles with plenty
of water and a soft, non-scratchy
cloth.
The windshield wipers must be in a
vertical position before folding them
away from the windshield. They
could otherwise damage the hood.
Turn on the wipers and place them in
a vertical position.
For information on how to place the wipers in a vertical position, see "Replacing
wiper blades" ( page 434).
Operation
Vehicle care
Warning!
G
For safety reasons, switch off wipers and
remove SmartKey from starter switch before cleaning the wiper blades, otherwise
the wiper motor might suddenly turn on
and cause injury.
!
Window cleaning
!
The windshield wipers must be in a
vertical position before folding them
away from the windshield. They
could otherwise damage the hood.
Turn on the wipers and place them in
Clean the wiper blade inserts with a
clean cloth and detergent solution.
!
Fold the windshield wiper arms back
onto the windshield before turning
the SmartKey in the starter switch.
Hold onto the wiper when folding
the wiper arm back. If released, the
force of the impact from the tensioning spring could crack the windshield.
Fold the windshield wiper arms back
onto the windshield before turning
the SmartKey in the starter switch.
Hold onto the wiper when folding
the wiper arm back. If released, the
force of the impact from the tensioning spring could crack the windshield.
a vertical position.
For information on how to place the wipers in a vertical position, see "Replacing
wiper blades" ( page 434).
Warning!
G
For safety reasons, switch off wipers and
remove SmartKey from starter switch before cleaning the windshield, otherwise
the wiper motor might suddenly turn on
and cause injury.
Use a window cleaning solution on all
Light alloy wheels
Wheel Care approved by us for use on
Maybach vehicles should be used for regular cleaning the light alloy wheels.
If possible, clean wheels once a week
with Wheel Care approved by us for use
on Maybach vehicles, using a soft bristle
brush and a strong spray of water.
Follow instructions on container.
i
Use only acid-free cleaning materials.
Acid could lead to corrosion.
glass surfaces.
An automotive glass cleaner is recommended.
379
Operation
Vehicle care
Press button 2.
Instrument cluster
Cup holder
Use a gentle dishwashing detergent or
mild detergent for delicate fabrics as a
washing solution. Wipe with a cloth
moistened in lukewarm solution. Do not
use scouring agents.
Use a gentle dishwashing detergent or
mild detergent for delicate fabrics as a
washing solution. Wipe with a cloth
moistened in lukewarm solution. Do not
use scouring agents.
Steering wheel and gear selector lever
Rear cup holder/bottle holder
Push the cover plate back.
Wipe with a damp cloth and dry thoroughly or clean with Leather Care approved by us for use on Maybach
vehicles.
For cleaning purposes, you can push back
the cover plate of the cup holder.
After cleaning, close the cup/bottle
The cup holder opens.
Push one of the release catches 3
upward and, at the same time, press
release catch 1 for the cup/bottle
holder.
holder.
The next time the holder is opened, the
cover plate slides out with it.
Carpet
Hard plastic trim items
Carpet and Fabric Care approved by us
for use on Maybach vehicles should be
used for cleaning of carpets in your vehicle.
Pour Interior Care approved by us for use
on Maybach vehicles onto a soft lint-free
cloth and apply with light pressure.
Roof lining
Example illustration of Maybach 57
1
2
3
4
380
Release catch for cup/bottle holder
Release catch for cup holder
Release catch for cover plate
Cover plate
Clean with a soft bristle brush, or use a
dry-shampoo cleaner in case of excessive
dirt.
Operation
Vehicle care
Seat belts
Nubuck leather
The webbing must not be treated with
chemical cleaning agents. Use only clear,
lukewarm water and soap. Do not dry
the webbing at temperatures above
176°F (80°C) or in direct sunlight.
Although Nubuck leather is treated with
a protective coating, it is a delicate leather. Wipe Nubuck leather with a damp microfiber cloth to remove dust and other
light stains. Carefully dab Nubuck leather with a dry microfiber cloth to remove
oil stains.
Warning!
G
Do not bleach or dye seat belts as this may
severely weaken them. In a crash they may
not be able to provide adequate protection.
Leather upholstery
Wearing clothing that has the tendency
to give off coloring (e.g. when wet, etc.)
may cause the upholstery to become permanently discolored. By lining the seats
with a proper intermediate cover, contact-discoloration will be prevented.
Wipe leather upholstery with a damp
cloth and dry thoroughly or clean with
Leather Care approved by us for use on
Maybach vehicles. Exercise particular
care when cleaning perforated leather as
its underside should not become wet.
Do not attempt to remove ballpoint ink
stains. We recommend allowing the ink
to migrate into the leather (which could
take as long as a few weeks); the migration process will increase the chances of
the ink stain becoming less apparent
over time. Attempting to remove ballpoint ink may damage the protective
coating and/or may leave a permanent
visible mark.
If in doubt about cleaning any Nubuck
stain, please consult your Maybach
Studio for assistance.
Plastic and rubber parts
Do not use oil or wax on these parts.
Wood trims
Dampen cloth using water and use damp
cloth to clean wood trims in your vehicle.
Do not use solvents like tar remover or
wheel cleaner nor polishes or waxes as
they may be abrasive.
!
Do not use Leather Care approved by
us for use on Maybach vehicles on
Nubuck leather or any solvents to
clean Nubuck leather. Avoid hard
scrubbing on nubuck leather.
381
Operation
Vehicle care
Press and pull both switches until you
Electrotransparent roof*
You can lower the inside panel of the
electrotransparent roof.
Warning!
G
Make sure no passengers are sitting in the
rear passenger compartment when the inside panel of the electrotransparent roof is
being lowered. The passengers could otherwise be injured by the panel.
see the message ROOF INSIDE PANEL
UNLOCKED or PRIVALITE ROOF UNLOCKED
appear in the multifunction display.
Push the switch for the electrotrans-
parent roof on the overhead control
panel forward (to open the screen).
The inside panel of the electrotransparent roof is lowered and the screen
is opened.
!
Switch on ignition ( page 54).
Make sure the rear passenger compartment is empty and that the inside
panel does not come into contact
with any objects left in the rear compartment.
and that the gear selector lever is in
position P.
Pull the switch for the electrotrans-
parent roof on the overhead control
panel backward (to close the screen)
( page 230). At the same time, push
the switch for the rear interior lighting ( page 148).
382
Do not clean the screen! Allow the
cleaned surfaces to dry before closing
the electrotransparent roof.
The inside panel is unlocked.
Lowering the inside panel
Make sure the vehicle is stationary
!
Do not lean against the lowered inside panel.
You can clean the glass panels with a
commercially available glass cleaner
and a moist cloth.
Closing the inside panel
After cleaning, pull the switch for the
electrotransparent roof on the overhead control panel backward (to
close the screen) until the screen is
completely closed.
Push the inside panel upward until it
engages.
The message disappears from the
multifunction display.
Turn the SmartKey in the starter
switch to position 0.
Warning!
G
No passengers may ride in the rear passenger compartment if the inside panel has
not been or cannot be locked. Have the inside panel repaired immediately by an authorized Maybach Studio.
Practical hints
What to do if …
Where will I find ...?
Unlocking/locking in an emergency
Opening/closing in an emergency
Pocket PC*
Replacing SmartKey batteries
Replacing bulbs
Replacing wiper blades
Flat tire
Batteries
Jump starting
Towing the vehicle
Fuses
383
Practical hints
What to do if …
Lamps in instrument cluster
Problem
v
v
General information:
Possible cause
The yellow ABS/ESP
The ESP is deactivated.
warning lamp comes on Risk of accident!
while driving.
Adapt your speed and driving to the prevailing road, weather and traffic conditions.
The yellow ABS/ESP
warning lamp flashes
while driving.
The ESP, ABS or traction control has come
into operation because of detected traction loss in at least one tire.
Distronic** is deactivated.
If a lamp in the instrument cluster fails to
come on during the lamp self-check
when switching on ignition, have it
checked and replaced if necessary.
Suggested solution
Turn the ESP back on ( page 100).
If the ESP cannot be turned back on, have
the system checked at an authorized
Maybach Studio as soon as possible.
When driving off, apply as little throt-
tle as possible.
While driving, ease up on the acceler-
ator.
Adapt your speed and driving to the
prevailing road and weather conditions.
Do not deactivate the ESP - exceptions
( page 99).
Failure to follow these instructions increases the risk of an accident.
384
Practical hints
What to do if …
Problem
Possible cause
Suggested solution
l
The red distance warn- You are too close to the vehicle in front of Apply the brakes immediately to ining lamp comes on while you to maintain selected speed.
crease the following distance.
driving.
l
The red distance warn- You are gaining too rapidly on the vehi- Apply the brakes immediately.
ing lamp comes on while
cle ahead of you.
Carefully observe the traffic situation.
driving and you hear a The distance warning system has recogYou may need to brake or maneuver
warning sound.
to avoid hitting an obstacle.
nized a stationary obstacle on your
probable line of travel.
-
The yellow ABS indicator The ABS has detected a malfunction and
Continue driving with added caution.
lamp comes on while
has switched off. The BAS and the ESP are
Wheels may lock during hard braking,
driving.
also switched off (see messages in display).
reducing steering capability.
The brake system is still functioning normally but without the ABS available.
Have the system checked at an autho-
The charging voltage has fallen below
10 volts and the ABS has switched off.
When the voltage is above this value
rized Maybach Studio as soon as possible.
If the ABS control unit is malfunctioning,
Failure to follow these instructions inother systems such as Parktronic,
Distronic**, the navigation system and the creases the risk of an accident.
automatic transmission can also malfunction.
again, the ABS is operational again.
If necessary, have the generator and
battery checked.
385
Practical hints
What to do if …
Problem
<
H
Possible cause
The red seat belt telltale The telltale reminds you to fasten seat
illuminates for a brief
belts.
period after starting the
engine.
The yellow warning
lamp for the tire pressure monitor comes on.
Suggested solution
Fasten your seat belt.
The telltale goes out.
The tire pressure monitor detects a rapid or Bring the vehicle to a halt, avoiding
significant loss of pressure in at least one
abrupt steering and braking maneutire.
vers. Observe the traffic situation
around you.
Take note of the messages in the mul-
tifunction display.
Warning!
G
When the tire pressure monitoring system
warning lamp is lit, one or more of your
tires is significantly under-inflated. You
should stop and check your tires as soon as
possible, and inflate them to the proper
pressure as indicated on the vehicle’s tire
information placard. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to
overheat and can lead to tire failure.
386
Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency
and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling and stopping ability. Each
tire, including the spare, should be
checked monthly when cold and set to the
recommended inflation pressure as specified in the vehicle placard and owner’s
manual.
i
The recommended tire inflation pressure for your vehicle can be found on
the inside of the fuel filler flap, not in
the owner’s manual.
Practical hints
What to do if …
Problem
1
Warning!
Possible cause
The red SRS indicator
lamp comes on while
driving.
Suggested solution
There is a malfunction in the restraint sys- Drive with added caution to the neartems. The airbags or emergency tensioning
est authorized Maybach Studio.
devices (ETDs) could deploy unexpectedly
or fail to activate in an accident.
G
In the event that a malfunction of the SRS
is indicated as outlined above, the SRS may
not be operational. For your safety, we
strongly recommend that you visit an authorized Maybach Studio immediately to
have the system checked; otherwise the
SRS may not be activated when needed in
an accident, which could result in serious
or fatal injury, or it might deploy unexpectedly and unnecessarily which could result in an accident and/or injury to you or
to others.
387
Practical hints
What to do if …
Problem
Possible cause
;
You are driving with the parking brake set. Release the parking brake.
(USA only)
There is a malfunction in the SBC brake sys- Read and observe the message in the
tem.
display.
The red brake warning
lamp comes on while
driving and you hear a
3
(Canada only) warning sound.
Warning!
G
Driving with the brake warning lamp illuminated can result in an accident. Have
your brake system checked immediately if
the brake warning lamp stays on. Do not
add brake fluid before checking the brake
system. Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir can result in spilling brake fluid on hot
engine parts and the brake fluid catching
fire. You can be seriously burned.
388
Suggested solution
There is insufficient brake fluid in the reser- Risk of accident! Carefully stop the vehicle and notify an authorized
voir.
Maybach Studio. Do not add brake
fluid! This will not solve the problem.
!
If you find that the brake fluid in the
brake fluid reservoir has fallen to the
minimum mark or below, have the
brake system checked for brake pad
thickness and leaks.
Practical hints
What to do if …
Problem
?
(USA only)
±
(Canada only)
Possible cause
The yellow engine mal- There is a malfunction in:
function indicator lamp The fuel management system
comes on while driving.
The ignition system
The emission control system
Systems which affect emissions
Such malfunctions may result in excessive
emissions values and may switch the engine to its emergency operation mode.
Your gas tank is empty.
Suggested solution
Have the vehicle checked as soon as
possible by an authorized Maybach
Studio.
An on-board diagnostic connector is
used by the service station to link the
vehicle to the shop diagnostics system.
It allows the accurate identification of
system malfunctions through the
readout of diagnostic trouble codes. It
is located in the front left area of the
footwell next to the parking brake
pedal.
After refuelling, start, turn off, and re-
start the engine three or four times in
succession.
The limp home mode is canceled. You do
not need to have your vehicle checked.
The yellow fuel tank re- The fuel level has dropped below the reserve warning lamp
serve mark.
comes on while driving.
Refuel at the next gas station
( page 352).
389
Practical hints
What to do if …
Lamp in center console
Problem
PASSENGER
AIRBAG OFF
Possible cause
The indicator lamp
comes on.
A BabySmartTM1 child seat is installed on
the front passenger seat. Therefore the
passenger front airbag is switched off.
The indicator lamp
comes on if there is no
BabySmartTM child seat
installed on the front
passenger seat.
The system is malfunctioning.
The indicator lamp does The system is malfunctioning.
not come on with a
BabySmartTM child seat
properly installed on the
front passenger seat.
Suggested solution
Have the system checked as soon as
possible by an authorized Maybach
Studio.
Make sure there is nothing between
the seat cushion and the child seat and
check installation of the child seat.
If the light remains out, have the sys-
tem checked as soon as possible by an
authorized Maybach Studio.
Do not use the BabySmartTM restraint
to transport children on the front passenger seat until the system has been
repaired.
1
BabySmartTM is a trademark of Siemens Automotive Corp.
390
Practical hints
What to do if …
Vehicle status messages in the multifunction display
Warning and malfunction messages appear in the multifunction display located
in the instrument cluster.
Certain warning and malfunction messages are accompanied by an audible signal.
Address these messages accordingly and
follow the additional instructions given
in this Operator’s Manual.
Selecting the vehicle status message
memory menu in the control system
( page 171) displays both cleared and
uncleared messages.
High-priority messages appear in the
multifunction display with in red color.
Certain messages of high priority cannot
be cleared from the multifunction display using reset button J ( page 25) in
the instrument cluster.
Other messages of high priority and messages of less immediate priority can be
cleared from the multifunction display
using reset button J in the instrument
cluster. They are then stored in the vehicle status message memory ( page 171).
Remember that clearing a message will
only make the message disappear. Clearing a message will not correct the condition that caused the message to appear.
Warning!
G
All categories of messages contain important information which should be taken
note of and, where a malfunction is indicated, addressed as soon as possible at an
authorized Maybach Studio.
Failure to repair condition noted may
cause damage not covered by the Maybach
Limited Warranty, or result in property
damage or personal injury.
Warning!
G
No messages will be displayed if either the
instrument cluster or the multifunction display is inoperative.
Contact your nearest authorized Maybach
Studio.
i
Switching on the ignition causes all
instrument cluster lamps as well as
the multifunction display to come on.
Make sure the lamps and multifunction display are in working order before starting your journey.
On the pages that follow, you will find a
compilation of the most important warning and malfunction messages that may
appear in the malfunction display.
High priority messages appear in red
color.
391
Practical hints
What to do if …
Text messages
Display
ABS
Possible cause
MALFUNCTION
VISIT WORKSHOP!
Possible solution
The ABS has detected a malfunction Continue driving with added caution.
and has switched off. The ESP and the
Wheels may lock during hard braking, reBAS are also deactivated.
ducing steering capability.
The SBC brake system is still function- Have the system checked at an authorized
Maybach Studio as soon as possible.
ing normally but without the ABS
available.
Failure to follow these instructions increases
the risk of an accident.
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE
VISIT WORKSHOP!
The ABS or the ABS display is malfunctioning.
Continue driving with added caution.
Wheels may lock during hard braking, reducing steering capability.
Have the system checked at an authorized
Maybach Studio as soon as possible.
Failure to follow these instructions increases
the risk of an accident.
AIR CLEANER CHANGE CARTRIDGE
The air filter is clogged.
CONVEN. FUNCTIONS
BATTERY
PROTECTION: TEMPORARILY
SHUT OFF
392
Have the air filter checked by an autho-
rized Maybach Studio.
VISIT WORKSHOP!
The battery for electrical consumers
has insufficient voltage and can no
longer supply the convenience functions such as seat ventilation*.
As soon as the on-board voltage is sufficient,
you will see the following message in the multifunction display: NOTE: CONVEN. FUNCTIONS
AVAILABLE AGAIN. The electrical consumers are
switched on again.
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
DISTRONIC
Possible cause
Possible solution
EXTERNAL MALFUNCTION
REACTIVATE
Distronic** is switched off and is tem- Try activating Distronic** again later.
porarily unavailable.
DRIVE TO WORKSHOP!
Distronic** is malfunctioning or the
display is malfunctioning.
CURRENTLY
UNAVAILABLE
SEE OPERATORS MANUAL
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio as soon
as possible.
Clean if necessary the Distronic** cover in
the front bumper ( page 378).
the Distronic** cover in the front
bumper is dirty.
Restart the vehicle.
Distronic** is switched off because:
the functionality is impaired due
to heavy rain.
Or
Distronic** becomes operational again without re-starting the engine if:
dirt comes off during driving (e.g. slush or
snow)
the system recognizes full sensor availability (due to lessening rain or the road surface
drying)
the message disappears from the multifunction display
you see the speed last stored blink in the
display for five seconds.
You can now use Distronic** normally.
393
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
ESP
Possible cause
Possible solution
MALFUNCTION
VISIT WORKSHOP!
The ESP is deactivated because of a
malfunction.
Continue driving with added caution.
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE
VISIT WORKSHOP!
The ESP or the ESP display is malfunc- Continue driving with added caution.
tioning.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio as soon
as possible.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio as soon
as possible.
The SBC brake system is still functioning normally but without the ESP
Failure to follow these instructions increases
available.
the risk of accident.
The ABS may still be operational.
Failure to follow these instructions increases
the risk of an accident.
394
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
ESP
Possible cause
UNAVAILABLE
SEE OPERATORS MANUAL
Possible solution
The ESP is deactivated because of in- Synchronize the ESP. With the vehicle staterrupted power supply.
tionary and the engine running, turn the
steering wheel completely to the left and
The SBC brake system is still functionthen to the right to synchronize the ESP.
ing normally but without the ESP
available.
If the ESP message does not go out:
The ABS may still be operational.
Continue driving with added caution.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio as soon
as possible.
Failure to follow these instructions increases
the risk of an accident.
!
When adjusting the ESP, make sure
you can turn the steering wheel in
both directions as far as it will go
without the wheels hitting any objects (e.g. a curb).
395
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
Possible cause
MOVE SELECTOR LEVER
TO PARK
You have tried to turn off the engine Place the gear selector lever in position P.
with the KEYLESS-GO** start/stop
button ( page 55) with the gear selector lever not in P.
SRS
RESTR. SYS. DEFECT.
DRIVE TO WORKSHOP!
The system is malfunctioning.
MALFUNCTION
DRIVE TO WORKSHOP!
One or more main functions of the
Tele Aid system are malfunctioning.
TELE AID
396
Possible solution
Drive with added caution to the nearest
authorized Maybach Studio.
Have the Tele Aid system checked by an au-
thorized Maybach Studio.
Practical hints
What to do if …
Symbol messages
Display
P
AIRMATIC
STOP, CAR TOO LOW!
Possible cause
Possible solution
The vehicle level is too low.
Wait until the vehicle level has
been adjusted.
The message then disappears.
The vehicle level control is malfunctioning. In addition, the following message
appears: AIRMATIC VISIT WORKSHOP!
Stop and press the vehicle level
control button to select a higher
vehicle level ( page 248).
Do not turn steering wheel too far
to avoid damaging the front fenders.
Listen for scraping noises.
Do not exceed a speed of 50 mph
(80 km/h).
Visit a service center as soon as pos-
sible.
Failure to follow these instructions increases the risk of an accident.
AIRMATIC
VISIT WORKSHOP!
The Airmatic system has only limited op- Do not exceed a speed of 50 mph
eration.
(80 km/h).
The display for Airmatic or the Airmatic
system itself is malfunctioning.
AIRMATIC
LEVEL CANCELLED!
Visit a service center as soon as pos-
sible.
At speeds above 75 mph (120 km/h), the Reactivate the "Raised Level" set"Raised Level" setting is canceled.
ting.
397
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
#
Possible cause
BATTERY CHARGE
STOP VEHICLE
Possible solution
The battery, the alternator or the electri- Stop the vehicle as soon as it is safe
cal system control unit is malfunctioning.
to do so. Adjust driving to be consistent with reduced braking reThe SBC brake system requires electrical
sponsiveness.
energy and therefore has only limited
Notify an authorized Maybach
operation. Considerably greater brake
Studio.
pedal force is required and the stopping
distance is increased.
Failure to follow these instructions increases the risk of accident.
Read and observe the additional
messages about the SBC brake system in the display.
398
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
#
BATTERY CHARGE
VISIT WORKSHOP!
Possible cause
Possible solution
The battery is no longer charging.
Stop immediately and check the
Possible causes:
poly-V-belt.
alternator malfunctioning
If it is broken:
broken poly-V-belt
Do not continue to drive. Other-
Do not forget that the brake system requires electrical energy and may be operating with restricted capability.
Considerably greater brake pedal force is
required and the stopping distance is
longer.
wise the engine will overheat
due to an inoperative water
pump which may result in damage to the engine. Notify an authorized Maybach Studio.
If it is intact:
Drive immediately to the near-
est authorized Maybach Studio.
Adapt driving to be consistent
with reduced braking responsiveness.
Read and observe the additional
messages about the SBC brake system in the display.
!
PARKING BRAKE
RELEASE BRAKE!
You are driving with the parking brake
engaged.
Release the parking brake
( page 68).
399
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
Possible cause
Possible solution
2
BRAKE PAD WEAR
VISIT WORKSHOP!
The brake pads have reached their wear Have the brake pads replaced as
limit.
soon as possible at an authorized
Maybach Studio.
T
BRAKE MALFUNCTION
STOP VEHICLE
The SBC brake system is in the emergency Stop the vehicle as soon as it is safe
operation mode. Considerably greater
to do so.
brake pedal force is required and the
Do not drive any further.
stopping distance is increased.
Prevent the vehicle from rolling
The maximum speed is limited to 55 mph
away by blocking wheels with
(90 km/h).
wheel chocks or other sizable,
heavy objects ( page 437).
Call for Roadside Assistance.
;
(USA only)
BRAKE FLUID
VISIT WORKSHOP!
3
(Canada only)
There is insufficient brake fluid in the res- Risk of accident! Stop the vehicle
ervoir.
and notify an authorized Maybach
Studio. Do not add brake fluid! This
will not solve the problem.
Failure to follow these instructions increases the risk of accident.
i
!
If you find that the brake fluid in the
brake fluid reservoir has fallen to the
minimum mark or below, have the
brake system checked for brake pad
thickness and leaks.
Brake pad thickness must be visually
checked by a qualified technician at
the intervals specified in the Maintenance Booklet.
400
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
;
(USA only)
3
(Canada only)
REDUCED BRAKE PERF.
START ENGINE
INCR. STOPPING DIST.
START ENGINE
REDUCED BRAKE PERF.
VISIT WORKSHOP!
INCR. STOPPING DIST.
VISIT WORKSHOP!
Possible cause
Possible solution
The battery has insufficient voltage and
cannot supply sufficient power to the
SBC brake system.
Start the engine.
The message disappears when sufficient voltage is available.
The SBC brake system is in the emergency Continue driving with added cauoperation mode. Considerable brake
tion.
pedal force is required and the stopping Adjust driving to be consistent with
distance is increased.
reduced braking responsiveness.
Drive immediately to the nearest
authorized Maybach Studio.
BRAKES OVERHEATED
DRIVE CAREFULLY!
The brake system is overheated due to an Relieve the load on the brake sysexcessive load on the brakes.
tem.
Drive more smoothly and think
ahead to avoid unnecessary braking.
When driving down slopes, shift
into a lower gear to use the engine’s braking power ( page 187).
Cautiously continue driving so that
the air stream will cool down the
brakes.
SERVICE BRAKE
VISIT WORKSHOP!
There are malfunctions, but the SBC
brake system is operating normally.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
as soon as possible.
401
Practical hints
What to do if …
Warning!
G
Driving while these messages are displayed
can result in an accident. Have your brake
system checked immediately.
If there is a malfunction in the SBC brake
system, we recommend that the vehicle be
transported with all wheels off the ground
using flatbed or appropriate wheel lift/dolly equipment. A tow bar must be used if
circumstances do not permit the use of the
recommended towing methods and the
vehicle requires towing with all four
wheels on the ground. Towing the vehicle
with all four wheels on the ground is only
permissible for distances up to 30 miles
(50 km) and at a speed not to exceed
30 mph (50 km/h). For more information,
refer to "Towing the vehicle"
( page 447).
402
If the SBC brake system enters its emergency operation mode, the driver must apply
significantly greater brake pedal pressure
and depress the pedal much further than
normal to obtain braking effect. If necessary, apply full pressure to the brake pedal.
Brakes are only applied to the front
wheels. Stopping distance is increased!
Low brake fluid in the reservoir may cause
the braking system to fail!
Don’t add brake fluid before checking the
brake system. Overfilling the brake fluid
reservoir can result in spilling brake fluid
on hot engine parts and the brake fluid
catching fire. You can be seriously burned.
Warning!
G
Inhalation of exhaust gas is hazardous to
your health. All exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide, and inhaling it can cause
unconsciousness and lead to death.
Do not run the engine in confined areas
(such as a garage) which are not properly
ventilated. If you think that exhaust gas
fumes are entering the vehicle while driving, have the cause determined and corrected immediately. If you must drive
under these conditions, drive with at least
one window fully open.
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
B
COOLANT
CHECK LEVEL!
Possible cause
Possible solution
The coolant level is too low.
Add coolant ( page 360).
If you have to add coolant fre-
quently, have the cooling system
checked by an authorized Maybach
Studio.
Warning!
G
Do not spill antifreeze on hot engine parts.
Antifreeze contains ethylene glycol which
may burn if it comes into contact with hot
engine parts. You can be seriously burned.
!
Do not ignore the low engine coolant
level warning. Extended driving with
the message and symbol displayed
may cause serious engine damage
not covered by the Maybach Limited
Warranty.
Do not drive without a sufficient
amount of coolant in the cooling system. The engine will overheat, causing major engine damage.
403
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
Ï
COOLANT
VISIT WORKSHOP!
Possible cause
Possible solution
The cooling fan for the coolant is malfunctioning.
Observe the coolant temperature
gauge ( page 154).
Have the fan replaced as soon as
possible.
COOLANT
STOP, ENGINE OFF
The coolant is too hot.
Stop the vehicle and turn off the
engine.
Only start the engine again after
the message disappears. You could
otherwise damage the engine.
Warning!
G
Driving when your engine is badly overheated can cause some fluids which may
have leaked into the engine compartment
to catch fire. You could be seriously
burned.
Steam from an overheated engine can
cause serious burns and can occur just by
opening the engine hood. Stay away from
404
the engine if you see or hear steam coming
from it.
Turn off the engine, get out of the vehicle
and do not stand near the vehicle until the
engine has cooled down.
During severe operating conditions, e.g.
stop-and-go traffic, the coolant temperature may rise close to approximately
248°F (120°C).
!
The engine should not be operated
with the coolant temperature above
248°F (120°C). Doing so may cause serious engine damage which is not
covered by the Maybach Limited
Warranty.
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
Ï
COOLANT
STOP, ENGINE OFF
Possible cause
Possible solution
The poly-V-belt could be broken.
Stop immediately and check the
poly-V-belt.
If it is broken:
Do not continue to drive. Other-
wise the engine will overheat due
to an inoperative water pump
which may result in damage to the
engine.
Notify an authorized Maybach
Studio.
If it is intact:
Restart the engine only after the
message disappears from the multifunction display. Doing so could result in serious engine damage that
is not covered by the Maybach Limited Warranty.
Observe the coolant temperature
gauge ( page 154).
Drive immediately to the nearest
authorized Maybach Studio. Adjust
driving to be consistent with reduced braking responsiveness.
405
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
Î
±
G
406
Possible cause
Possible solution
CRUISE CONTROL
DRIVE TO WORKSHOP!
Cruise control or Distronic** is malfunctioning.
Have cruise control or Distronic**
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE
VISIT WORKSHOP!
Certain electronic systems are unable to
relay information to the control system.
The following systems may have failed:
Have the electronic systems
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE
VISIT WORKSHOP!
Coolant temperature display
Tachometer
Cruise control display
checked by an authorized Maybach
Studio.
checked by an authorized Maybach
Studio.
The displays for several systems have mal- Continue driving with added caufunctioned. Some systems themselves
tion.
may also have malfunctioned.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
as soon as possible.
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
Possible cause
Possible solution
V
DOOR OPEN
You are attempting to drive with one or Close the doors.
more doors open.
?
VISIT WORKSHOP!
There may be a malfunction in the:
:
ENGINE OIL LEVEL
STOP, ENGINE OFF
Fuel injection system
Ignition system
Exhaust system
Fuel system
There is no oil in the engine. There is a
danger of engine damage.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
as soon as possible.
Carefully bring the vehicle to a halt
as soon as possible.
Turn off the engine.
Add engine oil.
ENGINE OIL LEVEL
VISIT WORKSHOP!
The measuring system is malfunctioning. Have the measuring system
checked by an authorized Maybach
Studio.
407
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
:
ADD 1.0 QT. OIL
AT FILLING STATION
Possible cause
Possible solution
The engine oil level is too low.
Add engine oil ( page 359) and
check the engine oil level
( page 357).
(Canada: 1 LITER)
ENGINE OIL LEVEL
REDUCE OIL LEVEL
You have added too much engine oil.
Have oil siphoned or drained off.
There is a risk of damaging the engine or
Observe all legal requirements with
the catalytic converter.
respect to its disposal.
ENGINE OIL
VISIT WORKSHOP!
The engine oil has dropped to a critical
level.
Check the engine oil level
( page 356) and add oil as re-
quired.
If you must add engine oil fre-
quently, have the engine checked
for possible leaks.
There is water in the oil.
When the ADD 1.0 QT. OIL AT FILLING
STATION (Canada: 1 LITER) message appears while the engine is running and at
operating temperature, the engine oil
level has dropped to approximately the
minimum level.
408
When this occurs, the warning will first
come on intermittently and then stay on
if the oil level drops further.
If no oil leaks are noted, continue to
drive to the nearest service station where
the engine oil should be topped to the
required level with an approved oil specified in the Factory Approved Service
Products pamphlet.
Have the oil checked.
!
The engine oil level warnings should
not be ignored. Extended driving
with the symbol displayed could result in serious engine damage that is
not covered by the Maybach Limited
Warranty.
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
_
Possible cause
ENTRANCE POSITION
DO NOT DRIVE
Possible solution
Seat, mirrors and steering wheel have
Wait until the seat, mirrors and
not yet moved to their preset driving posteering wheel have moved to their
sitions.
driving positions.
The message will disappear.
Y
F
HOOD OPEN!
You are driving with the hood open.
Close the hood ( page 355).
KEY
CHECK BATTERY
The SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO** batteries are discharged.
Change the batteries ( page 429).
KEY
NOT RECOGNIZED
The SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO** is not Stop the vehicle as soon as it is safe
recognized while the engine is running
to do so.
because
Search for the SmartKey with
the SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO** is
KEYLESS-GO**.
not in the vehicle
Otherwise the vehicle cannot be
centrally locked nor can the engine
there is strong radio-frequency interbe started again after the engine is
ference
stopped.
KEY
NOT RECOGNIZED
The SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO** is mo- Change the position of the
mentarily not recognized.
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO** in
the vehicle.
Operate the vehicle with the
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO** in
the starter switch if necessary.
KEY
STILL IN VEHICLE
The SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO** left in Take the SmartKey with
the vehicle was recognized while locking
KEYLESS-GO** out of the vehicle.
the vehicle from the outside.
409
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
F
.
Possible cause
Possible solution
AUTOM. LIGHT ON
REMOVE KEY!
SmartKey in starter switch position 1 or 2. Remove the SmartKey from the
starter switch.
REMOVE KEY!
You have forgotten to remove the
SmartKey.
Remove the SmartKey from the
REPLACE KEY
DRIVE TO WORKSHOP!
The SmartKey is malfunctioning.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
LIGHT SENSOR
DRIVE TO WORKSHOP!
The lamp sensor is malfunctioning. The
headlamps switch on automatically.
starter switch.
as soon as possible.
In the control system, set lamp operation to manual ( page 177).
Switch on headlamps using the ex-
terior lamp switch.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
as soon as possible.
410
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
STOP LAMP
VISIT WORKSHOP!
Brake lamp illumination is delayed or
lamp is permanently on.
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE
VISIT WORKSHOP!
The display for the lamps or the system is Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
malfunctioning.
as soon as possible.
TURN OFF LIGHTS
Lamps have been turned on although the Turn the exterior lamp switch
SmartKey in the starter switch is in
to M ( page 143).
position 0.
MIRROR TURN SIG., L
CHECK LIGHT
The left turn signal in the side mirror is
malfunctioning. This message will only
appear if all light emitting diodes have
stopped working.
as soon as possible.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
as soon as possible.
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
.
Possible cause
Possible solution
MIRROR TURN SIG., R
CHECK LIGHT
The right turn signal in the side mirror is Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
malfunctioning. This message will only
as soon as possible.
appear if all light emitting diodes have
stopped working.
FRONT TURN SIGNAL, L
SUBSTITUTE LAMP ON!
The left front turn signal lamp is malfunc- Replace the bulb as soon as possible
tioning. A substitute bulb is being used.
or visit an authorized Maybach
Studio as soon as possible.
FRONT TURN SIGNAL, R
SUBSTITUTE LAMP ON!
The right front turn signal lamp is malfunctioning. A substitute bulb is being
used.
Replace the bulb as soon as possible
HIGH BEAM, LEFT
CHECK LIGHT
The left high beam flasher lamp is malfunctioning.
Replace the bulb as soon as possible
HIGH BEAM, RIGHT
CHECK LIGHT
The right high beam flasher lamp is mal- Replace the bulb as soon as possible
functioning.
or visit an authorized Maybach
Studio as soon as possible.
MARKER LIGHT, FL
CHECK LIGHT
The left front side marker lamp is malfunctioning.
Replace the bulb as soon as possible
MARKER LIGHT, FR
CHECK LIGHT
The right front side marker lamp is malfunctioning.
Replace the bulb as soon as possible
or visit an authorized Maybach
Studio as soon as possible.
or visit an authorized Maybach
Studio as soon as possible.
or visit an authorized Maybach
Studio as soon as possible.
or visit an authorized Maybach
Studio as soon as possible.
411
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
.
412
Possible cause
Possible solution
STANDING LIGHT, L
SUBSTITUTE LAMP ON!
The left parking lamps are malfunctioning. A substitute bulb is being used.
Replace the bulb as soon as possible
STANDING LIGHT, R
SUBSTITUTE LAMP ON!
The right parking lamps are malfunction- Replace the bulb as soon as possible
ing. A substitute bulb is being used.
or visit an authorized Maybach
Studio as soon as possible.
FRONT FOGLAMP, LEFT
CHECK LIGHT
The left front fog lamp is malfunctioning. Replace the bulb as soon as possible
or visit an authorized Maybach Studio as soon as possible.
FRONT FOGLAMP, RIGHT
CHECK LIGHT
The right front fog lamp is malfunction- Replace the bulb as soon as possible
ing.
or visit an authorized Maybach Studio as soon as possible.
LOW BEAM, LEFT
CHECK LIGHT
The left low beam lamp is malfunctioning.
LOW BEAM, RIGHT
CHECK LIGHT
The right low beam lamp is malfunction- Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
ing.
as soon as possible.
3RD BRAKE LIGHT
CHECK LIGHT
The high mounted brake lamp is malfunctioning.
BRAKE LIGHT LEFT
SUBSTITUTE LAMP ON!
The left brake lamp is malfunctioning. A Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
substitute bulb is being used.
as soon as possible.
BRAKE LIGHT RIGHT
SUBSTITUTE LAMP ON!
The right brake lamp is malfunctioning.
A substitute bulb is being used.
or visit an authorized Maybach
Studio as soon as possible.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
as soon as possible.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
as soon as possible.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
as soon as possible.
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
.
Possible cause
Possible solution
REVERSE LIGHT, LEFT
CHECK LIGHT
The left reverse lamp is malfunctioning.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
REVERSE LIGHT, RIGHT
CHECK LIGHT
The right reverse lamp is malfunctioning. Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
as soon as possible.
REAR FOGLIGHT
CHECK LIGHT
The rear fog lamp is malfunctioning.
LICENSE PLATE L, L
CHECK LIGHT
The left license plate lamp is malfunctioning.
Replace the bulb as soon as possible
LICENSE PLATE L, R
CHECK LIGHT
The right license plate lamp is malfunctioning.
Replace the bulb as soon as possible
TAIL LIGHT, LEFT
SUBSTITUTE LAMP ON!
The left tail lamp is malfunctioning. A
substitute bulb is being used.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
TAIL LIGHT, RIGHT
SUBSTITUTE LAMP ON!
The right tail lamp is malfunctioning. A
substitute bulb is being used.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
REAR TURN SIGNAL, L
SUBSTITUTE LAMP ON!
The left rear turn signal lamp is malfunc- Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
tioning. A substitute bulb is being used.
as soon as possible.
REAR TURN SIGNAL, R
SUBSTITUTE LAMP ON!
The right rear turn signal lamp is malfunctioning. A substitute bulb is being
used.
as soon as possible.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
as soon as possible.
or visit an authorized Maybach
Studio as soon as possible.
or visit an authorized Maybach
Studio as soon as possible.
as soon as possible.
as soon as possible.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
as soon as possible.
413
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
<
K
414
Possible cause
Possible solution
SEAT BELT SYSTEM
DRIVE TO WORKSHOP!
The seat belt system is malfunctioning.
Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
CLOSE
SUNROOF!
You have opened the driver’s door with
the SmartKey removed from the starter
switch and the tilt/sliding sunroof open.
as soon as possible.
Close the tilt/sliding sunroof
( page 222).
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
Possible cause
Possible solution
CLOSE
SUNROOF!
You have opened the driver’s door with
the SmartKey removed from the starter
switch and the tilt/sliding sunroof open.
Close the tilt/sliding sunroof
( page 222)
_
STEERING GEAR OIL
CHECK
The steering oil has dropped to a critical Visit an authorized Maybach Studio
level.
as soon as possible.
L
TELE AID BATTERY
DRIVE TO WORKSHOP!
The emergency power battery for the
Have the Tele Aid system checked
Tele Aid system is malfunctioning. If the
by an authorized Maybach Studio.
vehicle battery is also discharged, Tele
Aid will not be operational.
TELE AID
NOT ACTIVATED
You do not have a Tele Aid service contract or you have not extended your existing one.
TANK OPEN!
CHECK FILLER CAP!
A loss of pressure has been detected in
Check the fuel cap ( page 352).
the fuel system. The fuel cap may not be If it is not closed properly:
closed properly or the fuel system may be
Close the fuel cap.
leaky.
If it is closed properly:
J
A
Obtain a Tele Aid service contract
or have your existing one extended
in an authorized Maybach Studio.
Have the fuel system checked by an
authorized Maybach Studio.
Ê
TRUNK OPEN
This message will appear whenever the
trunk lid is open.
Close the trunk lid.
W
WASHER FLUID
CHECK LEVEL!
The fluid level has dropped to about 1/3
of total reservoir capacity.
Add washer fluid ( page 362).
415
Practical hints
What to do if …
Tire pressure messages
Display
50 MPH
Canada:
LIMIT
TIRE FAILURE
Possible cause
Possible solution
The maximum speed is limited to
50 mph (80 km/h).
Pull over immediately. Change the wheel
( page 436).
There was a tire pressure warning
message.
Reactivate the tire pressure monitor after
80 KM/H
TIRE PRES. MONITOR
REACTIVATE AFTER
CORRECTING PRESSURE
The yellow warning lamp for the tire
pressure monitor lights up and you
have not reactivated the system since
the last tire pressure check.
TIRE PRESSURE DISPLAY ONLY AVAILABLE
WHEN IGNITION IS ON!
Warning!
G
Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle.
416
correcting the tire pressure values
( page 367).
Switch on the ignition.
You may lose control of the vehicle. Continued driving with a flat tire will cause excessive heat build-up and possibly a fire.
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
Possible cause
TIRE PRES. MONITOR
REACTIVATED
The tire pressure monitor is using the current pressure values as the basis for monitoring.
TIRE PRES. MONITOR
CURRENTLY
UNAVAILABLE
The tire pressure monitor is temporarily
inoperative because
Remove the additional wheel sen-
an additional wheel sensor is in the
vehicle
the maximum temperature of the
wheel sensor has been exceeded
As soon as the causes of the malfunction have been removed, the tire pressure monitor automatically becomes
active again.
a radio source is causing interference
unrecognized wheel sensors are installed
TIRE PRES. MONITOR
NOT OPERATIONAL
Warning!
G
Possible solution
sor from the vehicle
The tire pressure monitor or the wheel
sensor is malfunctioning.
Have the tire inflation pressure
A wheel without proper sensor was installed.
Have the wheels checked.
monitor checked by an authorized
Maybach Studio.
You may lose control of the vehicle. Continued driving with a flat tire will cause excessive heat build-up and possibly a fire.
Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle.
417
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
H
Possible cause
Possible solution
TIRE PRESSURE
PLEASE CORRECT
The pressure is low in one or more tires.
Check and correct tire pressure as
required ( page 364).
TIRE PRESSURE
CAUTION TIRE DEFECT!
One or more tires is deflating.
Carefully bring the vehicle to a halt,
avoiding abrupt steering and braking maneuvers. Carefully observe
the traffic situation.
Repair or change the wheel
( page 436).
One or more tires is deflating.
TIRE PRESSURE
CHECK TIRES!
Carefully bring the vehicle to a halt,
avoiding abrupt steering and braking maneuvers. Carefully observe
the traffic situation.
Repair or change the wheel
( page 436).
Warning!
G
Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle.
You may lose control of the vehicle. Continued driving with a flat tire will cause excessive heat build-up and possibly a fire.
418
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
H
TIRE PRES., LF
CAUTION TIRE DEFECT!
Possible cause
Possible solution
The left front tire is deflating.
Carefully bring the vehicle to a halt,
avoiding abrupt steering and braking maneuvers. Carefully observe
the traffic situation.
Repair or change the wheel
( page 436).
The left front tire pressure is low.
TIRE PRES., LF
CHECK TIRES!
Carefully bring the vehicle to a halt
and observe the traffic situation.
Check the tire.
Check and correct tire pressure as
required.
TIRE PRES., RF
CAUTION TIRE DEFECT!
The right front tire is deflating.
Carefully bring the vehicle to a halt,
avoiding abrupt steering and braking maneuvers and observe the
traffic situation.
Repair or change the wheel
( page 436).
Warning!
G
You may lose control of the vehicle. Continued driving with a flat tire will cause excessive heat build-up and possibly a fire.
Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle.
419
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
H
TIRE PRES., RF
CHECK TIRES!
Possible cause
Possible solution
The right front tire pressure is low.
Carefully bring the vehicle to a halt
and observe the traffic situation.
Check the tire.
Check and correct tire pressure as
required.
TIRE PRES., LR
CAUTION TIRE DEFECT!
The left rear tire is deflating.
Carefully bring the vehicle to a halt,
avoiding abrupt steering and braking maneuvers. Carefully observe
the traffic situation.
Repair or change the wheel
( page 436).
The left rear tire pressure is low.
TIRE PRES., LR
CHECK TIRES!
Carefully bring the vehicle to a halt
and observe the traffic situation.
Check the tire.
Check and correct tire pressure as
required.
Warning!
G
Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle.
420
You may lose control of the vehicle. Continued driving with a flat tire will cause excessive heat build-up and possibly a fire.
Practical hints
What to do if …
Display
H
TIRE PRES., RR
CAUTION TIRE DEFECT!
Possible cause
Possible solution
The right rear tire is deflating.
Carefully bring the vehicle to a halt,
avoiding abrupt steering and braking maneuvers. Carefully observe
the traffic situation.
Repair or change the wheel
( page 436).
The right rear tire pressure is low.
TIRE PRES., RR
CHECK TIRES!
Carefully bring the vehicle to a halt
and observe the traffic situation.
Check the tire.
Check and correct tire pressure as
required.
Warning!
G
Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle.
You may lose control of the vehicle. Continued driving with a flat tire will cause excessive heat build-up and possibly a fire.
421
Practical hints
Where will I find ...?
First aid kit
The first aid kit is stored in the storage
compartment under the front passenger
seat.
!
Vehicle jack, vehicle tool kit, luggage
bowl, spare wheel
The spare wheel, the vehicle tool kit and
the luggage bowl are stored in the compartment underneath the trunk floor.
To prevent damage, always disengage trunk floor handle from trunk
edge and lower trunk floor before
closing the trunk lid.
The vehicle tool kit includes:
1 Tabs
Press tabs 1 together.
Fold the cover forward.
Remove first aid kit.
i
Check expiration dates and contents
for completeness at least once a year
and replace missing/expired items.
1
2
3
4
5
Vehicle jack
Spare wheel
Luggage bowl
Vehicle tool kit
Chock
Lift up the trunk floor cover and en-
gage trunk floor handle in upper
edge of trunk.
You can now remove the tools and
accessories.
422
One pair of universal pliers
Two open-end wrenches
One hex-socket wrench
One interchangeable slot/Phillips
screwdriver
One towing eye bolt
One wheel wrench
One alignment bolt
One fuse extractor
One fuse chart
Spare fuses
Practical hints
Unlocking/locking in an emergency
Unlocking/locking in an emergency
Unlocking the vehicle
If you are unable to unlock the vehicle
using the SmartKey or KEYLESS-GO**,
open the driver’s door and the trunk using the mechanical key.
Removing the mechanical key
Unlocking the driver’s door
1 Mechanical key locking tab
2 Mechanical key
1 Unlocking
i
Unlocking the driver’s door and/or
the trunk with the mechanical key
will trigger the anti-theft alarm system.
To cancel the alarm, insert the
SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** in the starter switch.
Move locking tab 1 in direction of
arrow.
Slide mechanical key 2 out of the
housing.
Insert the mechanical key into the
driver’s door lock until it stops.
Turn the mechanical key counter-
clockwise to position 1.
The driver’s door is unlocked.
423
Practical hints
Unlocking/locking in an emergency
Unlocking and opening the trunk lid
!
A minimum height clearance of 6.2 ft
(1.89 m) is required to open the trunk lid.
The trunk lid swings open automatically. Always make sure there is sufficient overhead clearance.
The trunk lid lock is located next to the
handle above the rear license plate recess.
Turn the mechanical key back and re-
move it from the trunk lid lock.
Locking the vehicle
If you are unable to lock the vehicle with
the SmartKey or KEYLESS-GO**, do the
following:
Close the passenger doors and the
trunk lid.
Press the central locking switch on
the center console ( page 125).
1 Unlocking in an emergency
2 Handle
Insert the mechanical key into the
trunk lid lock until it stops.
Turn the mechanical key counter-
clockwise to position 1.
The trunk lid unlocks.
Pull on handle 2.
The trunk lid opens.
424
Check to see whether the locking
knobs on the passenger doors have
moved down.
If necessary push them down manual-
ly.
Except for the driver's door, the vehicle should now be locked.
1 Locking
Remove the mechanical key out of
the SmartKey ( page 423).
Insert the mechanical key into the
driver’s door lock until it stops.
Turn the mechanical key clockwise to
position 1.
The driver’s door is locked.
Practical hints
Opening/closing in an emergency
Opening/closing in an emergency
Power tilt/sliding sunroof
(Maybach 57)
You can open or close the tilt/sliding sunroof manually should an electrical malfunction occur.
Pull cover 1 off at the location
marked by the arrow.
Insert crank 2 through hole.
Turn crank 2 clockwise to:
slide roof closed
raise roof at the rear
Turn crank 2 counterclockwise to:
The tilt/sliding sunroof roof drive is located behind cover 1 on the overhead control panel.
slide roof open
lower roof at the rear
The tilt/sliding sunroof must be resynchronized after being operated manually ( page 224).
2 Crank
Remove the crank 2 from the Oper-
ator’s Manual pouch.
1 Cover
425
Practical hints
Opening/closing in an emergency
Power tilt/sliding sunroof
(Maybach 62)
The tilt/sliding sunroof drive is located
behind cover 1 in the roof lining with
the rear passenger compartment instruments.
Pull cover 2 off of the rear center in-
strument.
Remove the crank 1 from the Oper-
ator’s Manual pouch.
Insert crank 1 inclined through hole.
Turn crank 1 clockwise to:
slide roof closed
raise roof at the rear
Turn crank 1 counterclockwise to:
slide roof open
lower roof at the rear
The tilt/sliding sunroof must be resynchronized after being operated manually ( page 229).
1 Crank
2 Cover
426
Practical hints
Pocket PC*
Pocket PC*
Installing the memory card
The memory card slot is located in the
top panel of the Pocket PC.
Do not remove the memory card from
the Pocket PC.
If the memory card was inadvertently removed from the Pocket PC, you have to
insert the memory card again.
Push memory card 1 into slot 2 un-
til it engages.
The reset button is on the lower righthand side of the bottom panel.
The side of the memory card 1 with
the rounded corner should be on the
lower left.
Resetting the Pocket PC
The reset button is on the lower righthand side of the bottom panel.
Installing
Pocket PC 2
1 Reset button
Make sure the memory card is installed in the Pocket PC ( page 427).
Remove the stylus from the upper
Pocket PC 1
Pocket PC 1 shown; Pocket PC 2 varies slightly
1 Memory card
2 Slot
1 Reset button
right-hand corner of your Pocket PC
( page 312) or ( page 315).
Insert the stylus into reset button 1
for approx. one second.
Remove the stylus from reset
button 1.
The Pocket PC is automatically
switched on.
427
Practical hints
Replacing SmartKey batteries
If the batteries in the SmartKey or
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO** are discharged, the vehicle can only be locked
or unlocked using the mechanical key
( page 423). It is recommended to have
the batteries replaced at an authorized
Maybach Studio.
Warning!
G
Batteries contain poisonous and corrosive
substances. Therefore keep the batteries
out of reach of children.
If a battery is swallowed, seek medical help
immediately.
428
Batteries contain materials that can
harm the environment if disposed of improperly. Recycling of batteries is the
preferred method of disposal. Many
states require sellers of batteries to accept old batteries for recycling.
i
When inserting the batteries, make
sure they are clean and free of lint.
i
When replacing batteries, always replace both batteries.
The required replacement batteries
are available at any Maybach Studio.
Practical hints
Replacing SmartKey batteries
Remove the mechanical key out of
the SmartKey ( page 423).
Pull battery compartment 2 out of
the housing in direction of arrow.
Using a lint-free cloth, insert new
batteries 3 under the contact
spring 4 with the plus (+) side facing
up.
Return battery compartment 2 into
the housing until it locks into place.
Slide mechanical key 1 back into the
SmartKey.
Check the operation of the SmartKey/
KEYLESS-GO**.
1 Mechanical key
2 Battery compartment
3 Battery
4 Contact spring
Replacement batteries: Lithium, type
CR 2025 or equivalent.
Remove the batteries 3.
Insert mechanical key 1 inside open-
ing and push gray slide in direction of
arrow.
The battery compartment 2 is unlatched.
429
Practical hints
Replacing bulbs
Safe vehicle operation depends on proper exterior lighting and signaling. It is
therefore essential that all bulbs and
lamp assemblies are in good working order at all times.
Correct headlamp adjustment is extremely important. Have headlamps
checked and readjusted at regular intervals and when a bulb has been replaced.
See an authorized Maybach Studio for
headlamp adjustment.
i
Back-up bulbs will be used when the
following lamps malfunction:
Turn signal lamps
Brake lamps
Parking lamps
Tail lamps
430
Bulbs
Front lamps
Lamp
Type
1
Additional turn
signal and side
marker lamp
LED
2
Turn signal lamp
SAE J573
2357 A
12.8 V-30CP
3
Side marker lamp W 5 W
4
Low beam and
high beam
5
High beam flasher H7-55 W
6
Parking and
standing lamp
W 5 W Blue
7
Fog lamp
H7 55 W
1
Xenon1
D2S-35 W
Bi-Xenon headlamps: For safety reasons (high
voltage), do not replace the Xenon bulb yourself.
See an authorized Maybach Studio.
Practical hints
Replacing bulbs
Rear lamps
Notes on bulb replacement
Lamp
Type
8
High mounted
brake lamp
LED
9
License plate lamp C 5 W
a
Brake lamp
LED
Tail, parking and
standing lamp
LED
Warning!
G
Keep bulbs out of reach of children.
Bulbs and bulb sockets can get very hot.
Allow the lamp to cool down before
changing a bulb.
Halogen lamps contain pressurized gas.
A bulb can explode if you
Side marker lamp LED
touch or move it when hot
Back-up lamp
H 24 W
drop the bulb
Rear fog lamp,
driver’s side
LED
scratch the bulb
Turn signal lamp
LED
Wear eye and hand protection.
Because of high voltage in Xenon lamps, it
is dangerous to replace the bulb or repair
the lamp and its components. We recommend that you have such work done by a
qualified technician.
Use only 12-volt bulbs of the same
type and with the specified watt rating.
Switch lights off before changing a
bulb to prevent short circuits.
Always use a clean lint-free cloth
when handling bulbs.
Your hands should be dry and free of
oil and grease.
If the newly installed bulb does not
come on, visit an authorized
Maybach Studio.
Have the LEDs and bulbs for the following lamps replaced by an authorized Maybach Studio:
Additional turn signal lamp and
side marker lamp in the exterior
rear view mirrors
Bi-Xenon lamp
Rear fog lamp
High mounted brake lamp
Brake lamp
Rear side marker lamp
Rear turn signal lamp
Tail lamp
Rear parking and standing lamp
431
Practical hints
Replacing bulbs
High beam flasher bulbs or fog lamps
Replacing bulbs for front lamps
Switch off the lights.
Open the hood ( page 355).
Twist housing cover 1 counterclock-
wise and pull out.
Twist bulb socket 5 (high beam
flasher bulb) or 7 (fog lamps) counterclockwise and pull out.
Push bulb into socket, turn counter-
1 Housing cover for fog lamps, high
beam flasher bulb, parking and
standing lamp
2 Bulb socket for turn signal lamp
3 Bulb socket for side marker
4 Low beam and high beam (Bi-Xenon)
housing cover
5 Bulb socket for high beam flasher
bulb
6 Parking and standing lamp
7 Bulb socket for fog lamps
G
Do not remove the cover for the Bi-Xenon
headlamp. Because of high voltage in Xenon lamps, it is dangerous to replace the
bulb or repair the lamp and its components. We recommend that you have such
work done by a qualified technician.
432
twist clockwise.
Reinsert bulb socket 5 (high beam
flasher bulb) or 7 (fog lamps) in
lamp and twist clockwise.
Low beam and high beam bulbs
Warning!
clockwise and remove.
Insert new bulb in socket, push in and
Align housing cover 1 and twist
clockwise.
Practical hints
Replacing bulbs
Turn signal bulb
Insert a new bulb in the socket.
Switch off the lights.
Reinstall bulb socket 6.
Turn the round cover in the wheel
Align housing cover 1 and twist
housing trim counter-clockwise and
remove cover.
Twist bulb socket 2 counterclock-
wise and pull out.
Push bulb into socket, turn counter-
clockwise and remove.
Insert new bulb in socket, push in and
twist clockwise.
Reinsert bulb socket 2 in lamp and
twist clockwise.
Replace round cover in wheel hous-
ing trim and turn it clockwise.
clockwise.
Side marker lamp bulb
Switch off the lights.
Turn the round cover in the wheel
housing trim counter-clockwise and
remove cover.
Twist bulb socket 3 counterclock-
wise and pull out.
Push bulb into socket, turn counter-
clockwise and remove.
Insert new bulb in socket, push in and
twist clockwise.
Parking and standing lamp bulb
Switch off the lights.
Open the hood ( page 355).
Twist housing cover 1 counterclock-
License plate lamp
Reinsert bulb socket 3 in lamp and
twist clockwise.
Replace round cover in wheel hous-
1 Screws
2 License plate lamp
Switch off the lights.
Loosen both screws 1 and remove li-
cense plate lamp 2.
Replace the tubular lamp and rein-
stall lamp.
Tighten the screws 1.
ing trim and turn it clockwise.
wise and pull out.
Pull out bulb socket 6 with the bulb.
Pull the bulb out of the bulb
socket 6.
433
Practical hints
Replacing wiper blades
!
To avoid damage to the hood, the
wiper arms should only be folded forward when in the vertical position.
Removing wiper blades
Turn the SmartKey in the starter
switch to position 1.
Turn combination switch to wiper
setting II ( page 71).
With wiper arm in vertical
position 1, turn the SmartKey in the
starter switch to position 0.
Warning!
G
Slide the wiper blade sideways out of
retainer 2.
For safety reasons, remove SmartKey from
starter switch before replacing a wiper
blade, otherwise the motor could suddenly
turn on and cause injury.
1 Wiper arm vertical
Fold the wiper arm forward.
You should hear it snap into place.
Turn the wiper blade at a right angle
to wiper arm.
434
Practical hints
Replacing wiper blades
Installing wiper blades
Slide the wiper blade into the cutout
on the wiper arm.
!
Rotate the wiper blade into position
Hold on to the wiper when folding
the wiper arm back. If released, the
force of the impact from the tensioning spring could crack the windshield.
parallel to wiper arm.
Fold the wiper arm back so that blade
rests on windshield. Make sure you
hold on to the wiper when folding
the wiper arm back.
Never open the hood when the wiper
arm is folded forward.
Do not allow the wiper arms to contact the windshield glass without a
wiper blade inserted.
Make certain that the wiper blades
are properly installed. Improperly installed wiper blades may cause windshield damage.
For your convenience, you should
have this work carried out by an authorized Maybach Studio.
435
Practical hints
Flat tire
Preparing the vehicle
Park the vehicle as far as possible
from moving traffic on a hard surface.
Turn on the hazard warning flashers.
Engage the steering wheel lock in the
straight ahead position and set the
parking brake.
Move the gear selector lever to P.
Have any passenger exit the vehicle
at a safe distance from the roadway.
Removing the spare wheel
Mounting the spare wheel
Turn the luggage bowl counterclockwise ( page 422).
Spare wheel
The spare wheel rim is mounted with a
full-sized tire of the same type as on the
vehicle, and it is fully functional.
Remove the spare wheel.
When you replace the vehicle’s tires, you
can use the spare wheel as a regular
wheel if:
Place spare wheel in wheel well and
it is not more than six years old
rim and tire are the same model as
the regular wheels
Warning!
G
If the spare tire is more than six years old
or is not the same model as the regular
tires, have the spare tire replaced with a
new tire at the nearest Maybach Studio.
Never operate the vehicle with more than
one spare tire.
For more information on spare wheel,
see "Technical data" ( page 459).
436
Storing the spare wheel
secure it with luggage bowl.
Turn the luggage bowl clockwise to
its stop.
Preparing the vehicle
Take vehicle tool kit tray and vehicle
jack out of trunk.
Take the spare wheel out of wheel
well.
Practical hints
Flat tire
Lifting the vehicle
When changing wheel on a hill:
Place chock and another sizeable,
heavy object on the downhill side
blocking both wheels of the axle
not being worked on.
1 Chock
Prevent the vehicle from rolling away
by blocking wheels with wheel
chock 1 and another sizable, heavy
object.
When changing wheel on a level surface:
Place one chock in front of and
another sizeable, heavy object behind the wheel that is diagonally
opposite to the wheel being
changed.
2 Two-piece wheel wrench
Take the two-piece wheel wrench 2
out of the vehicle tool kit tray. Assemble wheel wrench.
Warning!
G
The jack is designed exclusively for jacking
up the vehicle at the jack support tube
hole built into the vehicle. To help avoid
personal injury, use the jack only to lift the
vehicle during a wheel change. Never get
beneath the vehicle while it is supported
by the jack. Keep hands and feet away
from the area under the lifted vehicle. Always firmly set parking brake and block
wheels before raising vehicle with jack.
Do not disengage parking brake while the
vehicle is raised. Be certain that the jack is
always vertical (plumb line) when in use,
especially on hills. Always try to use the
jack on level surface. Make sure the jack
arm is fully seated in the jack support tube
hole. Always lower the vehicle onto sufficient capacity jackstands before working
under the vehicle.
On wheel to be changed, loosen but
do not yet remove the wheel bolts
(approximately one full turn with
wrench).
437
Practical hints
Flat tire
The tube openings are located directly
behind the front wheel housings and in
front of the rear wheel housings.
Take ratchet 5 out of vehicle tool
Removing the wheel
kit.
Place ratchet 5 on jack 3 so that
you can see the letters UP.
Crank ratchet 5 up and down until
the tire is a maximum of 1.2 in (3 cm)
off the ground.
Warning!
The jack is intended only for lifting the vehicle briefly for wheel changes. It is not
suited for performing maintenance work
under the vehicle.
3 Jack
4 Jack support tube hole
5 Ratchet
Insert jack 3 fully into tube hole 4
up to the stop.
Warning!
G
Insert the jack arm fully into the jack support tube hole up to the stop. Otherwise
the vehicle may fall from the jack and
cause personal injury or damage to the vehicle.
438
G
Never start the engine when the vehicle is raised.
Never lie down under the raised vehicle.
6 Alignment bolt
Unscrew uppermost wheel bolt and
remove.
Replace this wheel bolt with align-
ment bolt 6 supplied in the tool kit.
Remove the remaining bolts.
!
Do not place wheel bolts in sand or
dirt. This could result in damage to
the bolt and wheel hub threads.
Remove the wheel.
Practical hints
Flat tire
Mounting the new wheel
Warning!
Clean contact surfaces of wheel and
wheel hub.
Use only genuine equipment Maybach
wheel bolts. Other wheel bolts may come
loose.
!
To avoid paint damage, place wheel
flat against hub and hold it there
while installing first wheel bolt.
Warning!
G
Always replace wheel bolts that are damaged or rusted.
Do not tighten the wheel bolts when the
vehicle is raised. Otherwise the vehicle
could fall off the jack.
Guide the spare wheel onto the
alignment bolt and push it on.
Lowering the vehicle
Place ratchet on jack so that you can
see the letters DOWN.
Lower vehicle by cranking ratchet up
Never apply oil or grease to wheel bolts.
and down until vehicle is resting fully
on its own weight.
Damaged wheel hub threads should be repaired immediately. Do not continue to
drive under these circumstances! Contact
an authorized Maybach Studio or call
Roadside Assistance.
Incorrect mounting bolts or improperly
tightened mounting bolts can cause the
wheel to come off. This could cause an accident. Make sure you are using the correct
mounting bolts.
G
Remove the jack.
Insert wheel bolts and tighten them
slightly.
Unscrew the alignment bolt, install
last wheel bolt and tighten slightly.
439
Practical hints
Flat tire
Warning!
G
Have the tightening torque checked after
changing a wheel. The wheels could come
loose if they are not tightened to a torque
of 110 lb-ft (150 Nm).
Before storing the jack in the trunk, it
1-5
Wheel bolts
Tighten the five wheel bolts evenly,
following the diagonal sequence illustrated (1 to 5), until all bolts are
tight. Observe a tightening torque of
110 lb-ft (150 Nm).
440
should be fully collapsed, with handle
folded in.
Place the wheel bolt wrench, chock,
alignment bolt and jack back in the
trunk.
Replacing jack support tube cover
Slide tongue of cover under the up-
per edge of the tube opening.
Applying even pressure, press cover
until it snaps into place. Be careful
not to damage the locking tabs or
clamp the plastic retaining strap.
!
You can also secure the damaged
wheel down into the spare wheel
well in the trunk.
Do not activate the tire inflation pressure monitor ( page 365) until the
depressurized tire is no longer in the
vehicle.
Practical hints
Batteries
Batteries
Your vehicle is equipped with two batteries:
The starter battery (located in the engine compartment)
The battery for electrical consumers
(located in the trunk)
Warning!
G
Failure to follow these instructions can result in severe injury or death.
Never lean over batteries while connecting, you might get injured.
4 Cover over positive terminal
5 Battery for electrical consumers
6 Negative terminal
Battery fluid contains sulfuric acid. Do not
allow this fluid to come in contact with
eyes, skin or clothing. In case it does, immediately flush affected area with water
and seek medical help if necessary.
A battery will also produce hydrogen gas,
which is flammable and explosive. Keep
flames or sparks away from battery, avoid
improper connection of jumper cables,
smoking, etc.
1 Negative terminal
2 Starter battery
3 Cover over positive terminal
441
Practical hints
Batteries
!
Never loosen or detach battery terminal clamps while the engine is running or the SmartKey is in the starter
switch. Otherwise the alternator and
other electronic components could
be severely damaged.
Have the battery checked regularly
by an authorized Maybach Studio.
Refer to Maintenance Booklet for
maintenance intervals or contact an
authorized Maybach Studio for further information.
Warning!
G
Do not place metal objects on the battery
as this could result in a short circuit.
Use leak-proof battery only to avoid the
risk of acid burns in the event of an accident.
442
Warning!
G
The SBC brake system requires electrical
power to operate.
A malfunction in the vehicle’s power supply or electrical system may impair brake
system operation and switch it into its
emergency operation mode. The same applies if battery is disconnected. To brake,
the driver must then apply significantly
greater brake pedal pressure and depress
the pedal much further to obtain the expected braking effect. If necessary, apply
full pressure to the brake pedal. Brakes are
only applied to the front wheels. Stopping
distance is increased! Adjust your driving
style accordingly. For more information,
refer to "SBC brake system" ( page 101).
Warning!
G
With a disconnected battery
you will no longer be able to turn the
SmartKey in the starter switch and
pressing the KEYLESS-GO** start/stop
button ( page 55) on the gear selector lever will have no effect
the gear selector lever will remain
locked in position P
Practical hints
Batteries
Disconnecting the batteries
!
Always disconnect the batteries in the
order described below, even if you
only want to charge the starter battery, for example. Otherwise, the vehicle’s electronics could be damaged.
i
It is only possible to maintain the existing charge in the battery for electrical consumers using the battery
charge maintenance unit
( page 279).
Turn off the engine ( page 75).
Turn off all electrical consumers.
Remove SmartKey from starter
Remove trunk floor from right hand
side of the trunk.
The consumer battery is located in
the trunk on the right hand side.
Disconnect negative terminal from
consumer battery.
Open hood.
The starter battery is located in the
engine compartment on the passenger side.
Disconnect negative terminal of start-
er battery.
Remove cover from positive terminal.
Disconnect the positive lead of con-
sumer battery and of the starter battery.
Removing the batteries
switch.
In vehicles with KEYLESS-GO**:
Open the driver‘s door.
Depress parking brake firmly or move
gear selector lever to position P.
Open trunk.
Removing the consumer battery
Loosen the screws that hold the con-
sumer battery in the trunk in place.
Removing the starter battery
Loosen the screw that holds the start-
er battery in the engine compartment in place.
Swing the bar up and remove bat-
tery.
Charging and reinstalling
the batteries
Charge batteries in accordance with
the instructions of the battery charger manufacturer.
Reinstall the charged battery. Follow
the previously described steps in reverse order.
Warning!
G
Never charge a battery while still installed
in the vehicle. Gases may escape during
charging and cause explosions that may result in paint damage, corrosion or personal
injury.
Remove battery’s support and brack-
et. Take battery out of trunk.
443
Practical hints
Batteries
Reconnecting the batteries
!
Always connect the batteries in the
order described below. Otherwise,
the vehicle’s electronics could be
damaged.
!
i
Never invert the terminal connections.
The following procedures must be
carried out following any interruption of consumer battery power
(e.g. due to reconnecting):
Reinstall carpet on the right hand
side of the trunk.
Set the clock. Refer to the separate COMAND and Rear-Cabin
Audiovisual System operating instructions.
Resynchronize the ESP
( page 395)
Resynchronize side windows
( page 220).
Resynchronize tilt/sliding sunroof
( page 224) or ( page 229).
Have a Maybach Studio check engine
Turn off all electrical consumers.
Install starter battery in the designat-
ed location in the engine compartment.
Install consumer battery in the desig-
nated location in the trunk.
Attach supports and brackets and
tighten screws.
Connect positive lead of the consum-
er battery and of the starter battery
and fasten covers.
Connect negative lead of the starter
battery in the engine compartment.
Connect negative lead of the con-
sumer battery in the trunk.
444
control units for error messages and
have them erased.
!
The batteries, their filler caps and the
vent tube must always be securely installed when the vehicle is in operation.
Batteries contain materials that can
harm the environment if disposed of improperly. Large 12-volt storage batteries
contain lead. Recycling of batteries is the
preferred method of disposal. Many
states require sellers of batteries to accept old batteries for recycling.
Practical hints
Jump starting
Jump starting
Warning!
G
Failure to follow these directions will cause
damage to the electronic components, and
can lead to a battery explosion and severe
injury or death.
Never lean over batteries while connecting
or jump starting, you might get injured.
Battery fluid contains sulfuric acid. Do not
allow this fluid to come in contact with
eyes, skin or clothing. In case it does, immediately flush affected area with water,
and seek medical help if necessary.
If the starter battery is discharged, the
engine can be started with jumper cables
and the battery of another vehicle. Observe the following:
Jump starting should only be performed when the engine and catalytic converter are cold.
Do not start the engine if the battery
is frozen. Let the battery thaw out
first.
A battery will also produce hydrogen gas,
which is flammable and very explosive.
Keep flames or sparks away from battery,
avoid improper connection of jumper cables, smoking, etc.
Attempting to jump start a frozen battery
can result in it exploding, causing personal
injury.
Read all instructions before proceeding.
Only jump start from batteries with
the same voltage rating (12 V). Jump
starting with a more powerful battery could damage the vehicle‘s electrical system, which will not be
covered by the Maybach Limited
Warranty.
Use only jumper cables with sufficient
cross-section and insulated terminal
clamps.
Always make sure the jumper cables
are not on or near pulleys, fans or
other parts that move when an engine is started or running.
!
Jump starting should only be performed on the starter battery installed in the engine compartment.
Avoid repeated and lengthy starting
attempts.
Do not attempt to start the engine
using a battery quick charge unit.
If engine does not run after several
unsuccessful starting attempts, have
it checked at the nearest authorized
Maybach Studio.
Excessive unburned fuel generated
by repeated failed starting attempts
may damage the catalytic converter
and may present a fire risk.
Make sure the jumper cables do not
have loose or missing insulation.
Make sure the cable clamps do not
touch any other metal part while the
other end is still attached to a battery.
445
Practical hints
Jump starting
Warning!
Start engine of the vehicle with the
G
charged battery and run at idle
speed.
Keep flames or sparks away from battery.
Do not smoke.
Connect negative terminal 1 of the
charged battery with negative
terminal 3 of the discharged battery
with the jumper cable. Clamp cable
to charged battery 1 first.
Observe all safety instructions and precautions when handling automotive batteries
( page 361).
Jump starting should only be performed
on the starter battery. The starter battery
is located in the engine compartment on
the passenger side.
Make sure the two vehicles do not
touch.
Turn off all electrical consumers, ex-
cept hazard warning flashers or work
lights.
Apply parking brake.
Shift gear selector lever to position P.
Open hood ( page 355).
Start the engine of the disabled vehi-
cle.
1 Negative terminal of charged battery
2 Positive terminal of charged battery
3 Negative terminal of discharged battery
4 Positive terminal of discharged battery
Connect positive terminal 2 of the
charged battery with positive
terminal 4 of the discharged battery
with the jumper cable. Clamp cable
to charged battery 2 first.
!
Never invert the terminal connections.
446
Now you can again turn on the electrical
consumers. Do not turn on the lights under any circumstances.
Remove the jumper cables first from
negative terminals 3 and 1 and
then from positive terminals 4
and 2.
You can now turn on the lights.
Have the starter battery checked at
the nearest authorized Maybach Studio.
i
Do not tow-start the vehicle.
Practical hints
Towing the vehicle
Towing the vehicle
We recommend that Maybach vehicles
be transported with all wheels off the
ground using flatbed or appropriate
wheel lift/dolly equipment.
!
Use flatbed or wheel lift/dolly equipment with SmartKey in starter switch
turned to position 0.
Do not tow with sling-type equipment. Towing with sling-type equipment over bumpy roads will damage
radiator and supports.
To prevent damage during transport,
do not tie down vehicle by its chassis
or suspension parts.
Switch off the tow-away alarm
( page 106) and the automatic central locking ( page 181).
When circumstances do not permit the
recommended towing methods, the vehicle may be towed with all wheels on
the ground or front wheels raised only so
far as necessary to have the vehicle
moved to a safe location where the recommended towing methods can be employed.
!
If the vehicle is towed with the front
axle raised, the engine must be shut
off (SmartKey in starter switch
position 0 or 1). Otherwise, the ESP
will immediately be engaged and will
apply the rear wheel brakes.
When towing the vehicle with all
wheels on the ground, the gear selector lever must be in position N and
the SmartKey must be in starter
switch position 2.
When towing the vehicle with all
wheels on the ground or the front
axle raised, the vehicle may be towed
only for distances up to 30 miles
(50 km) and at a speed not to exceed
30 mph (50 km/h).
!
To be certain to avoid a possibility of
damage to the transmission, however, we recommend the drive shaft be
disconnected at the rear axle drive
flange for any towing beyond a short
tow to a nearby garage.
Warning!
G
If circumstances require towing the vehicle
with all wheels on the ground, always tow
with a tow bar if:
the engine will not run
there is a malfunction in the SBC brake
system
there is a malfunction in the power
supply or in the vehicle’s electrical system
as that will be necessary to adequately
control the towed vehicle.
Prior to towing the vehicle with all wheels
on the ground, make sure the SmartKey is
in starter switch position 2.
If the SmartKey is left in starter switch
position 0 for an extended period of time,
it can no longer be turned in the switch. In
this case, the steering is locked. To unlock,
remove SmartKey from starter switch and
reinsert.
447
Practical hints
Towing the vehicle
i
To signal turns while being towed
with the hazard warning flasher in
use, switch on ignition and activate
the combination switch for the left or
right turn signal in the usual manner
– only the selected turn signal will operate.
Upon canceling the turn signal, the
hazard warning flasher will operate
again.
Warning!
G
The SBC brake system requires electrical
power to operate.
A malfunction in the vehicle’s power supply or electrical system may impair brake
system operation and switch it into its
emergency operation mode. To brake, the
driver must then apply significantly greater brake pedal pressure and depress the
pedal much further to obtain the expected
braking effect. If necessary, apply full pressure to the brake pedal.
448
Brakes are only applied to the front
wheels. Stopping distance is increased!
Adapt your driving style accordingly. For
more information, refer to "SBC brake system" ( page 101).
With the engine not running, there is no
power assistance for the brake and steering system. In this case, it is important to
keep in mind that a considerably higher
degree of effort is necessary to brake and
steer the vehicle. Adapt your driving accordingly.
!
To prevent the vehicle door locks
from locking, deactivate the automatic central locking ( page 181).
The vehicle should only be towed using the properly installed towing eye
bolt. Never attach tow cable, tow
rope or tow rod to the vehicle chassis,
frame or suspension parts.
i
If the battery is disconnected or discharged:
the SmartKey will not turn in the
starter switch. For information,
see "Batteries" ( page 441) and
"Jump starting" ( page 445)
the gear selector lever will remain
locked in position P.
When towing the vehicle with all
wheels on the ground, please note
the following:
With the automatic central locking
activated and the SmartKey in starter
switch position 2, or KEYLESS-GO**
start/stop button ( page 55) in
position 2, the vehicle doors lock if
the left front wheel as well as the
right rear wheel are turning at vehicle speeds of approximately 9 mph
(15 km/h) or more.
Practical hints
Towing the vehicle
Installing towing eye bolt
Front of vehicle
To remove cover:
Rear of vehicle
Pry off cover 1 using lower recess.
Lift cover off to reveal threaded hole
for towing eye bolt.
The towing eye bolt is supplied with the
tool kit (located in the storage compartment under the trunk floor).
Screw towing eye bolt in to its stop
and tighten with lug wrench.
To reinstall cover:
Fit cover 1 and snap into place.
1 Cover on right side of front bumper
1 Cover on right side of rear bumper
To remove cover:
Pry off cover 1 using lower recess.
Fold cover down to reveal threaded
hole for towing eye bolt.
The towing eye bolt is supplied with the
tool kit (located in the storage compartment under the trunk floor).
Screw towing eye bolt in to its stop
and tighten with lug wrench.
To reinstall cover:
Fit cover 1 and snap into place.
449
Practical hints
Fuses
Fuses are designed to protect the electrical circuits in your vehicle from a short
circuit. If a fuse is blown, the component(s) and systems controlled by that
fuse will stop working.
The following aids are available to help
you replace fuses ( page 422):
Fuse chart
Spare fuses
Fuse extractor
450
Warning!
G
Only use fuses approved by us for use on
Maybach vehicles and which have the specified amperage. Using other fuses may
cause an overload and lead to a fire, or
cause damage to electrical components
and/or systems.
!
Never attempt to repair or bridge a
blown fuse. Have the cause determined and remedied by an authorized Maybach Studio.
Your vehicle’s electrical fuses are located
in various fuse boxes:
In the engine compartment on the
passenger-side ( page 451)
In the engine compartment on the
driver’s side ( page 451)
In the dashboard on the
passenger-side ( page 452)
In the trunk on the driver’s side
( page 452)
Practical hints
Fuses
Aids for replacing fuses
Fuse chart
A chart explaining fuse allocation and
fuse amperages can be found in the vehicle tool kit in the trunk ( page 422).
Fuse boxes in engine compartment
There are two fuse boxes located in the
engine compartment the driver’s and
front passenger side in front of the firewall (dividing wall between engine compartment and passenger compartment).
2
Spare Fuses
Spare Fuses are found in the vehicle tool
kit in the trunk ( page 422).
2 Fuse box cover, passenger-side
Fuse extractor
Opening
The fuse extractor is found in the vehicle
tool kit in the trunk ( page 422).
Take crank out of vehicle document
pouch.
Loosen retaining screws with crank.
1 Fuse box cover, driver’s side
Remove cover from fuse box.
Closing
Re-attach cover to fuse box.
Make sure the cover fits correctly.
Tighten retaining screws with crank.
451
Practical hints
Fuses
Fuse box in passenger compartment
The fuse box is located in the dashboard
on the front passenger-side.
Opening
Open the passenger door.
Insert flat, blunt object as a lever into
Fuse box in the trunk
The fuse box is located in the trunk behind the left-hand trim panel.
the edge of the cover 1 at the position indicated by the arrow.
Loosen cover 1 from dashboard
using lever.
Using your hands, pull cover 1 out
and remove.
Closing
Hook cover 1 into the opening at
the front.
1 Cover
!
Do not use sharp objects such as a
screw driver to open the fuse box
cover 1 in the dashboard, as this
could damage it.
Press cover 1 back on until it engag-
es.
1 Locking knob
2 Trim panel
Opening
Turn locking knob 1 90°.
Pull trim panel 2 upward and
remove it.
Closing
Attach trim panel 2 into the
opening at the top.
Turn locking knob 1 90°.
452
Technical data
Parts service
Warranty coverage
Identification labels
Layout of poly-V-belt drive
Engine
Rims and tires
Electrical system
Main dimensions
Weights
Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc.
Consumer information
453
Technical data
Parts service
The "Technical data" section provides
the necessary technical data for your vehicle.
All authorized Maybach Studios maintain a stock of genuine Maybach parts required for maintenance and repair work.
In addition, strategically located parts
distribution centers provide quick and
reliable parts service.
Genuine Maybach parts are subjected to
stringent quality inspections. Each part
has been specifically developed, manufactured or selected for and adapted to
Maybach vehicles.
Therefore, genuine Maybach parts
should be installed.
454
!
The use of non-genuine Maybach
parts and accessories not authorized
by us for use on Maybach vehicles
could damage the vehicle, which is
not covered by the Maybach Limited
Warranty, or could compromise the
vehicle’s durability or safety.
Technical data
Warranty coverage
Warranty coverage
Your vehicle is covered under the terms
of the warranties printed in the Service
and Warranty Information booklet. Your
authorized Maybach Studio will exchange or repair any defective parts originally installed in the vehicle in
accordance with the terms of the following warranties:
New Vehicle Limited Warranty
Emission System Warranty
Emission Performance Warranty
California, Maine, Massachusetts,
and Vermont Emission Control Systems Warranty
Replacement parts and accessories are
covered by the Maybach Parts and Accessories warranties, copies of which are
available at any Maybach Studio.
Loss of Service and Warranty
Information Booklet
Should you lose your Service and Warranty Information booklet, have an authorized Maybach Studio arrange for a
replacement. It will be mailed to you.
455
Technical data
Identification labels
1 Certification label, includes Paintwork code (on driver’s B pillar)
2 Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
(located in the trunk)
3 Engine number (engraved on engine)
4 VIN, visible (lower edge of windshield)
5 Emission control information label,
includes both federal and California
certification exhaust emission standards
Vacuum line routing diagram label
i
When ordering parts, please specify
vehicle identification and engine
numbers.
456
Technical data
Layout of poly-V-belt drive
Layout of poly-V-belt drive
1
Automatic belt tensioner
2
Power steering pump
3
Air conditioning compressor
4
Crankshaft
5
Coolant pump
6
Generator (alternator)
7
Idler pulley
8
Air conditioning compressor
9
Idler pulley
a
Idler pulley
b
Idler pulley
457
Technical data
Engine
Model
Maybach 1
Engine
285
Mode of operation
4-stroke engine, gasoline injection
No. of cylinders
12
Bore
3.23 in (82.00 mm)
Stroke
3.43 in (87.00 mm)
Total piston displacement
336.4 cu in (5513 cm3)
Compression ratio
9:1
Output acc. to SAE J 1349
543 hp/5250 rpm 2
(405 kW/5250 rpm)
Maximum torque acc. to SAE J 1349
664 lb-ft/2300–3000 rpm
(900 Nm/2300–3000 rpm)
1
2
Maximum engine speed
5950 rpm
Firing order
1-12-5-8-3-10-6-7-2-11-4-9
Poly-V-belt
2713 mm
The quoted data apply only to the standard vehicle. See an authorized Maybach Studio for the corresponding data of all special bodies and special equipment.
Premium fuel required. Performance may vary with fuel octane rating.
458
Technical data
Rims and tires
Rims and tires
Use only tires and rims which have been
specifically developed for your vehicle
and tested and approved by us for use on
Maybach vehicles. Other tires and rims
can have detrimental effects, such as
poor handling characteristics
increased noise
increased fuel consumption
!
i
Moreover, tires and rims not approved by us for use on Maybach vehicles may, under load, exhibit
dimensional variations and different
tire deformation characteristics that
could cause them to come into contact with the vehicle body or axle
parts. This may result in damage to
the tires or the vehicle.
Further information on tires and rims
is available at any authorized
Maybach Studio. A tire inflation pressure table is located on the fuel filler
cap of the vehicle. The tire pressure
should be checked regularly and
should only be adjusted on cold tires.
Follow tire manufacturer's maintenance recommendation included
with vehicle.
459
Technical data
Rims and tires
Same size tires
Summer tires (radial-ply tires)
275/50 R19 112W XL or Extra Load MO
Wheel offset
2.64 in (67 mm)
Rims (light alloy)
8J x 19
Winter tires (radial-ply tires)
275/50 R19 112H XL or Extra Load M+S MO
Wheel offset
2.64 in (67 mm)
Rims (light alloy)
8J x 19
Spare wheel
Summer tire (radial-ply tire)
275/50 R19 112W XL or Extra Load MO
Wheel offset
2.64 in (67 mm)
Rim (light alloy)
8J x 19
460
Technical data
Electrical system
Electrical system
Generator (alternator)
14 V/350 A
Starter motor
12 V/1.7 kW
Starter battery
12 V/40 Ah
Electrical consumer battery
12 V/95 Ah
Spark plugs
NGK IFR 6 Q-G
Electrode gap
0.028 in (0.7 mm)
Tightening torque
15–22 lb-ft (20–30 Nm)
461
Technical data
Main dimensions
Model
Maybach 57
Maybach 62
Overall vehicle length
225.5 in (5728 mm)
242.7 in (6165 mm)
Overall vehicle width
78.0 in (1980 mm)
78.0 in (1980 mm)
Overall vehicle height
61.9 in (1572 mm)
61.9 in (1573 mm)
Wheelbase
133.5 in (3390 mm)
150.7 in (3827 mm)
Track, front
65.9 in (1675 mm)
65.9 in (1675 mm)
Track, rear
66.7 in (1695 mm)
66.7 in (1695 mm)
462
Technical data
Weights
Weights
1
Roof load max.
no roof load1
Trunk load max.
220 lb (100 kg)
To avoid potential damage to the roof, solar
panel* or electrotransparent roof*, roof rails and
any roof-mounted devices must not be used.
463
Technical data
Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc.
Capacities
Vehicle components and their respective
lubricants must match. Therefore use
only brands tested and approved by us.
Capacity
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc.
Engine with oil filter
10.5 US qt (10.0 l)
Approved engine oils
Automatic transmission
7.9 US qt (7.5 l)
MB Automatic Transmission Fluid
Rear axle
2.1 US qt (2.0 l)
Hypoid gear oil SAE 85 W 90
Power steering
approx 1.45 (1.65 l)
MB Power Steering Fluid (Pentosin CHF 11S)
Front wheel hubs
approx. 0.35 oz (10 g) each High temperature roller bearing grease
Cooling system
approx. 18 US qt (17.0 l)
MB 325.0 Anticorrosion/Antifreeze
Low temperature cooling system approx. 2.3 US qt (2.2 l)
MB 325.0 Anticorrosion/Antifreeze
Fuel tank
including a reserve of
Premium unleaded gasoline:
Minimum Posted Octane 91 (average of 96 RON/86 MON)
29.1 US gal (110.0 l)
3.7 US qt (14.0 l)
Air conditioning system
Windshield washer and headlamp cleaning system
1
Please refer to the Factory Approved Service Products pamphlet, or inquire at
your Maybach Studio.
R-134a refrigerant and special PAG lubricant oil (never R-12)
7.1 US qt (6.7 l)
MB Windshield Washer Concentrate1
Use MB Windshield Washer Concentrate "S" and water for temperatures above freezing point or MB Windshield Washer Concentrate "S" and commercially available premixed windshield washer solvent/antifreeze for temperatures below freezing point. Follow suggested mixing ratios ( page 469).
464
Technical data
Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc.
Engine oils
Engine oils are specifically tested for
their suitability in our engines and durability for our service intervals. Therefore,
only use approved engine oils and oil filters required for vehicles with Maintenance System (U.S. vehicles) or FSS
(Canada vehicles). For a listing of approved engine oils and oil filters, refer to
the Factory Approved Service Products
pamphlet, or contact an authorized
Maybach Studio.
Using engine oils and oil filters of specification other than those expressly required for the Maintenance System
(U.S. vehicles) or FSS (Canada vehicles),
or changing of oil and oil filter at change
intervals longer than those called for by
the Maintenance System (U.S. vehicles)
or FSS (Canada Vehicles) will result in engine damage not covered by the Maybach Limited Warranty.
Please follow Maintenance System
(U.S vehicles) or FSS (Canada vehicles)
recommendations. Failure to do so could
result in engine damage not covered by
the Maybach Limited Warranty.
Engine oil additives
Do not blend oil additives with engine
oil. They may damage the engine.
Damage or malfunctions resulting from
blending oil additives are not covered by
the Maybach Limited Warranty.
Air conditioning refrigerant
R-134a (HFC) refrigerant and special PAG
lubricating oil is used in the air conditioning system.
Never use R-12 (CFC) or mineral-based lubricating oil. Otherwise damage to the
system will occur.
465
Technical data
Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc.
Brake fluid
During vehicle operation, the boiling
point of the brake fluid is continuously
reduced through the absorption of moisture from the atmosphere. Under extremely strenuous operating conditions,
this moisture content can lead to the formation of bubbles in the system, thus reducing the system’s efficiency.
Therefore, the brake fluid must be replaced every two years, preferably in the
spring.
Only brake fluid approved by us for use
on Maybach vehicles is recommended.
Your authorized Maybach Studio will
provide you with additional information.
Premium unleaded gasoline
!
To maintain the engine’s durability
and performance, premium unleaded
gasoline must be used. If premium
unleaded is not available and low octane fuel is used, follow these precautions:
Have the fuel tank only partially
filled with unleaded regular and
fill up with premium unleaded as
soon as possible.
Avoid full throttle driving and
abrupt acceleration.
Unleaded gasoline containing oxygenates such as Ethanol, IPA, IBA and TBA
can be used provided the ratio of any
one of these oxygenates to gasoline does
not exceed 10%; MTBE must not exceed
15%.
Do not exceed an engine speed of
3000 rpm if the vehicle is loaded
with a light load such as two persons and no luggage.
466
Fuel requirements
Use only premium unleaded fuel
Do not exceed 2/3 of maximum accelerator pedal position if the vehicle is fully loaded or operating in
mountainous terrain.
The octane number (posted at the
pump) must be 91 min. It is an average of both the Research (R) octane
number and the Motor (M) octane
number: (R+M)/2. This is also known
as the ANTI-KNOCK INDEX.
The ratio of Methanol to gasoline must
not exceed 3% plus additional cosolvents.
Using mixtures of Ethanol and Methanol
is not allowed. Gasohol, which contains
10% Ethanol and 90% unleaded gasoline, can be used.
These blends must also meet all other
fuel requirements, such as resistance to
spark knock, boiling range, vapor pressure, etc.
Technical data
Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc.
Gasoline additives
A major concern among engine manufacturers is carbon build-up caused by
gasoline. We recommend only the use of
quality gasoline containing additives
that prevent the build-up of carbon deposits.
Products Pamphlet for a listing of approved product(s). Follow directions on
product label.
After an extended period of using fuels
without such additives, carbon deposits
can build up especially on the intake
valves and in the combustion area, leading to engine performance problems
such as:
Damage or malfunction resulting from
poor fuel quality or from blending additional fuel additives other than those
tested and approved by us for use on
Maybach vehicles listed in the Factory
Approved Service Products Pamphlet are
not covered by the Maybach Limited
Warranty.
Warm-up hesitation
Unstable idle
Knocking/pinging
Misfire
Power loss
In areas where carbon deposits may be
encountered due to lack of availability of
gasolines which contain these additives,
we recommend only the use of additives
approved by us for use on Maybach vehicles. Refer to Factory Approved Service
Do not blend any specific fuel additives
with fuel. This only results in unnecessary
costs and may be harmful to the engine
operation.
Coolants
The engine coolant is a mixture of water
and anticorrosion/antifreeze, which provides:
Corrosion protection
Freeze protection
Boiling protection (by increasing the
boiling point)
The cooling system was filled at the factory with a coolant providing freeze protection to approximately –22°F (–30°C)
and corrosion protection.
If the antifreeze mixture is effective to
–22°F (–30°C), the boiling point of the
coolant in the pressurized cooling system
is reached at approximately 266°F
(130°C).
The coolant solution must be used year
round to provide the necessary corrosion
protection and increase in the boil-over
protection. Refer to Maintenance Booklet for replacement interval.
Coolant system design and coolant used
stipulate the replacement interval. The
replacement interval published in the
Maintenance Booklet is only applicable if
MB 325.0 anticorrosion/antifreeze solution or other products approved by us for
use on Maybach vehicles of equal specification (see Factory Approved Service
Products pamphlet) are used to renew
the coolant concentration or bring it
back up to the proper level.
467
Technical data
Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc.
To provide important corrosion protection, the solution must be at least 45%
anticorrosion/antifreeze [equivalent to
freeze protection to approximately –22°F
(–30°C)]. If you use a solution that is more
than 55% anticorrosion/antifreeze
[freeze protection to approximately
–49°F (–45°C)], the engine temperature
will increase due to the lower heat transfer capability of the solution. Therefore,
do not use more than this amount of anticorrosion/antifreeze.
If the coolant level is low, water and
MB 325.0 anticorrosion/antifreeze
should be used to bring it up to the proper level (have cooling system checked for
signs of leakage). Please make sure the
mixture is in accordance with label instructions.
The water in the cooling system must
meet minimum requirements, which are
usually satisfied by normal drinking water. If you are not sure about the water
quality, consult an authorized Maybach
Studio.
Anticorrosion/antifreeze
Your vehicle contains a number of aluminum parts. The use of aluminum components in motor vehicle engines
necessitates that anticorrosion/antifreeze coolant used in such engines be
specifically formulated to protect the
aluminum parts. (Failure to use such
anticorrosion/antifreeze coolant will result in a significantly shortened service
life).
Anticorrosion/antifreeze quantity
Approximately freeze protection
–35°F (–37°C)
–49°F (–45°C)
Cooling system
9.0 US qt (8.5 l)
9.9 US qt (9.35 l)
Low temperature cooling system
1.16 US qt (1.1 l)
1.27 US qt (1.2 l)
468
Therefore, the following product is
strongly recommended for use in your
vehicle: Maybach 325.0 Anticorrosion/
Antifreeze Agent.
Before the start of the winter season (or
once a year in hot southern regions), you
should have the anticorrosion/antifreeze
concentration checked. The coolant is
also regularly checked each time you
bring your vehicle to an authorized Maybach Studio for service.
The anticorrosion/antifreeze quantities
listed in the table below are in relation
to total filling capacity.
Technical data
Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc.
Windshield and headlamp washer
system
Both the windshield and headlamp
washer systems are supplied from the
windshield washer fluid reservoir.
The windshield and headlamp washer
fluid reservoir has a capacity of approximately 7.1 US qt (6.7 l).
Refill the reservoir with MB Wind-
shield Washer Concentrate and water
(or concentrate and commercially
available pre-mixed windshield washer solvent/antifreeze, depending on
ambient temperatures).
Warning!
Windshield and headlamp washer fluid
mixing ratio
For temperatures above freezing point,
use MB Windshield Washer Concentrate
"S" and water:
G
Washer solvent/antifreeze is highly flammable. Do not spill washer solvent/antifreeze on hot engine parts, because it may
ignite and burn. You can be seriously
burned.
1 part "S" to 100 parts water
(1.34 floz [40 ml] "S" to
1 gallon [4.0 l] water)
For temperatures below freezing point,
use MB Windshield Washer Concentrate
"S" and commercially available premixed windshield washer solvent/
antifreeze:
1 part "S" to 100 parts solvent
(1.34 floz [40 ml] "S" to
1 gallon [4.0 l] solvent)
469
Technical data
Consumer information
The following text is published as required of all manufacturers of passenger
cars under Title 49, Code of U.S. Federal
Regulations, Part 575 pursuant to the
"National Traffic and Motor Vehicle
Safety Act of 1966."
Uniform tire quality grading
Quality grades can be found, where applicable, on the tire sidewall between
tread shoulder and maximum section
width. For example:
Treadwear
Traction
Temperature
200
AA
A
All passenger car tires must conform to
federal safety requirements in addition
to these grades.
graded 100. The relative performance of
tires depends upon the actual conditions
of their use, however, and may depart
significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices
and differences in road characteristics
and climate.
Traction
The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B, and C. Those grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet
pavement as measured under controlled
conditions on specified government test
surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire
marked C may have poor traction performance.
Warning!
G
Treadwear
The treadwear grade is a comparative
rating based on the wear rate of the tire
when tested under controlled conditions
on a specified government test course.
For example, a tire graded 150 would
wear one and one-half (11/2) times as
well on the government course as a tire
470
The traction grade assigned to this tire is
based on straight ahead braking traction
tests, and does not include acceleration,
cornering, hydroplaning, or peak traction
characteristics.
Temperature
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C, representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its
ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified
indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained
high temperature can cause the material
of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire
life, and excessive temperature can lead
to sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which
all passenger car tires must meet under
the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent
higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law.
Warning!
G
The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly inflated
and not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either
separately or in combination, can cause excessive heat build-up and possible tire failure.
Technical terms
ABS
(Antilock Brake System)
Prevents the wheels from locking up
during braking so that the vehicle can
continue to be steered.
ADS
(Adaptive Damping System)
Automatically adapts the optimum
suspension damping to prevailing
driving conditions.
Airmatic DC
(Airmatic Dual Control)
Automatically selects the optimum
suspension tuning and ride height for
your vehicle. Airmatic consists of
three components:
Adaptive Damping System
(->ADS)
Stiffness of spring
Vehicle level control
Alignment bolt
Metal pin with thread. The centering
pin is an aid used when changing a
tire to align the wheel with the wheel
hub.
BabySmartTM1 airbag deactivation
system
This system detects if a special system
compatible child restraint seat is installed on the front passenger seat.
The system will automatically deactivate the passenger front airbag when
such a seat is properly installed
(PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp located in the center console
comes on). See an authorized
Maybach Studio for availability.
BabySmartTM compatible child seats
Special restraint system for children.
The sensor system for the passenger
seat prevents deployment of the passenger front airbag if a BabySmartTM
compatible child seat is installed.
Bi-Xenon headlamps
Headlamps which use an electric arc
as a light source and produce a more
intense light than filament headlamps. Bi-Xenon headlamps produce
low beam and high beam.
CAN system
(Controller Area Network)
Data bus network serving to control
vehicle functions such as door locking
or windshield wiping.
Cockpit
All instruments, switches, buttons
and indicator/warning lamps in the
passenger compartment needed for
vehicle operation and monitoring.
BAS
(Brake Assist System)
System for potentially reducing braking distances in emergency braking
situations. The system is activated
when it senses an emergency based
on how fast the brake is applied.
1
BabySmartTM is a trademark of Siemens
Automotive Corp.
471
Technical terms
COMAND
(Cockpit Management and Data System)
Information and operating center for
vehicle sound and communications
systems, including the radio and navigation system, as well as other
equipment (CD changer, telephone,
etc.).
Control system
The control system is used to call up
vehicle information and to change
component settings. Information and
messages appear in the multifunction
display. The driver uses the buttons
on the multifunction steering wheel
to navigate through the system and
to adjust settings.
Cruise control
Driving convenience system that automatically maintains the vehicle
speed set by the driver.
Distronic**
A driving convenience cruise control
system which helps the driver maintain a pre-selected speed:
If there is no vehicle directly
ahead, the system operates in the
same way as conventional ->cruise
control.
If a slower moving vehicle is
ahead, Distronic will reduce your
vehicle speed to the extent permitted by reduced throttle and up
to 20% braking power to maintain the preset minimum following distance.
ELCODE
(Electronic Code System)
System that electronically checks
whether a person entering or driving
the vehicle is authorized to do so. It is
part of the Maybach anti-theft protection program.
472
Engine number
The number set by the manufacturer
and placed on the cylinder block to
uniquely identify each engine produced.
Engine oil viscosity
Measurement for the inner friction
(viscosity) of the oil at different temperatures. The higher the temperature an oil can tolerate without
becoming thin, or the lower the temperature it can tolerate without becoming viscous, the better the
viscosity.
ESP
(Electronic Stability Program)
Improves vehicle handling and directional stability.
ETD
(Emergency Tensioning Device)
Device which deploys in certain frontal and rear collisions exceeding the
system's threshold to tighten the seat
belts.
->SRS
Technical terms
FSS (Canada vehicles)
(Flexible Service System)
Maintenance service indicator in the
multifunction display that informs
the driver when the next vehicle
maintenance service is due. FSS evaluates engine temperature, oil level, vehicle speed, engine speed, distance
driven and the time elapsed since
your last maintenance service, and
calls for the next maintenance service
accordingly.
Gear range
Number of gears which are available
to the automatic transmission for
shifting. The automatic gear shifting
process can be adapted to specific operating conditions using the gear selector lever.
GPS
(Global Positioning System)
Satellite-based system for relaying
geographic location information to
and from vehicles equipped with special receivers. Employs DVD digital
maps for navigation.
Instrument cluster
The displays and indicator/warning
lamps in the driver’s field of vision, including the tachometer, speedometer and fuel gauge.
KEYLESS-GO**
System for entering and operating
the vehicle with only carrying the
SmartKey along.
Kickdown
Depressing the accelerator past the
point of resistance shifts the transmission down to the lowest possible
gear. This very quickly accelerates the
vehicle and should not be used for
normal acceleration needs.
Lock button
Button on the door which indicates
whether the door is locked or unlocked. Pushing the lock button
down on an individual door from inside will lock that door.
Maintenance System (U.S. vehicles)
Maintenance service indicator in the
multifunction display that informs
the driver when the next vehicle
maintenance service is due. The
Maintenance System in your vehicle
tracks distance driven and the time
elapsed since your last maintenance
service, and calls for the next maintenance service accordingly.
Maybach Assistance Center
Voice connection between the Customer Assistance Center and the vehicle passengers for information about
operating the vehicle
Maybach products
Maybach services
Maybach Relationship Manager
Your personal contact person at
Maybach Studios for any questions
you might have regarding your Maybach.
473
Technical terms
Memory function
Used to store three individual seat,
steering wheel and mirror positions
for each SmartKey.
Multifunction display
The display field in the instrument
cluster used to present information
provided by the control system.
Poly-V-belt drive
Drives engine-components (alternator, AC compressor, etc.) from the engine.
MON
(Motor Octane Number)
The Motor Octane Number for gasoline as determined by a standardized
method. It is an indication of a gasoline's ability to resist undesired detonation (knocking). The average of
both the MON (Motor Octane Number) and ->RON (Research Octane
Number) is posted at the pump, also
known as ANTI-KNOCK INDEX.
Multifunction steering wheel
Steering wheel with buttons for operating the control system.
Power train
Collective term designating all components used to generate and transmit motive power to the drive axles,
including:
474
Overspeed range
Engine speeds within the red marking on the tachometer dial. Avoid this
engine speed range, as it may result
in serious engine damage that is not
covered by the Maybach Limited
Warranty.
Parktronic
System which uses visual and acoustic
signals to assist the driver during
parking maneuvers.
Engine
Clutch/torque converter
Transmission
Transfer case
Drive shaft
Differential
Axle shafts/axles
Technical terms
Program mode selector switch
Used to switch the automatic transmission between sport operation S
and comfort operation C.
REST
(Residual engine heat utilization)
Feature that uses the engine heat
stored in the coolant to heat the vehicle interior for a short time after the
engine has been turned off.
Restraint systems
Seat belts, belt tensioners, airbags
and child restraint systems. As independent systems, their protective
functions complement one another.
RON
(Research Octane Number)
The Research Octane Number for gasoline as determined by a standardized method. It is an indication of a
gasoline's ability to resist undesired
detonation (knocking). The average
of both the ->MON (Motor Octane
Number) and RON (Research Octane
Number) is posted at the pump, also
known as ANTI-KNOCK INDEX.
SBC
(Sensotronic Brake Control)
Electronically controlled hydraulic
braking system for increased braking
safety and comfort.
Shift lock
When the vehicle is parked, this lock
prevents the transmission gear selector lever from being moved out of
position P without SmartKey turned/
KEYLESS-GO** start/stop button
pressed and brake pedal depressed.
SRS
(Supplemental Restraint System)
Seat belts, emergency tensioning device and airbags. Though independent systems, they are closely
interfaced to provide effective occupant protection.
Tele Aid System
(Telematic Alarm Identification on
Demand)
The Tele Aid system consists of three
types of response: automatic and
manual emergency, roadside assistance and information. Tele Aid is initially activated by completing a
subscriber agreement and placing an
acquaintance call.
The Tele Aid system is operational
provided that the vehicle’s battery is
charged, properly connected, not
damaged and cellular and GPS coverage is available.
475
Technical terms
Telematics
A combination of the terms "telecommunications" and "informatics."
Tightening torque
Force times lever arm (e.g. a lug
wrench) with which threaded fasteners such as wheel bolts are tightened.
Tire speed rating
Part of a tire designation; indicates
the speed range for which a tire is approved.
Traction
Force exerted by the vehicle on the
road via the tires.
476
Vehicle level control
The ground clearance of the vehicle is
automatically controlled according to
a selected setting and speed. The
driver can set the ground clearance
manually, for example, on very rough
roads.
VIN
(Vehicle Identification Number)
The number set by the manufacturer
and placed on the body to uniquely
identify each vehicle produced.
Voice control system
Voice control system for car phones,
portable cell phones and audio systems (radio, CD, etc.).
Index
A
ABS 471
Indicator lamp 25, 97, 385
Messages in display 392
Warning lamp 385
ABS/ESP
Warning lamp 25, 384
Activating
Air conditioner (cooling) 208, 217
Air recirculation mode 205
Anti-theft alarm system 105
Automatic climate control 203, 215
Central locking (control system) 181
Charcoal filter 207
Distance warning function** 244
Distronic** 240
Easy-entry/exit feature 183
Exterior rear view mirror parking
position 194
Hazard warning flasher 148
High beam 147
Immobilizer 104
Rear window defroster 198
Residual heat 208, 217
Seat heater 138
Tow-away alarm 106
Adaptive Damping System (ADS) 471
Adding
Coolant 360
Engine oil 359
Additional turn signals 430
Adjusting
Air distribution 203, 215
Air volume 204, 216
Exterior rear view mirrors 61
Head restraint
Front seats 59
Rear seats 129
Head restraint height 58
Head restraint tilt 59
Instrument cluster illumination 153
Interior rear view mirror 61
Mirrors 61
Passenger seat 50
Rear seats
Head restraint tilt 129
Right front passenger seat 49
Seat 57, 58
Seat backrest tilt 58
Seat cushion depth 58
Seat cushion tilt 58
Seat fore and aft adjustment 58
Seat height 58
Seat in the lumbar region 137
Seat in the shoulder region 137
Steering wheel 23, 60
Volume of two-way intercom* 46,
47, 48
Air conditioner (cooling)
Turning off 208, 216, 217
Air conditioning refrigerant 465
Air pressure see Tire inflation pressure
Air recirculation mode 205
Activating 205
Deactivating 206
Air vent grille 23, 258
Air volume
Adjusting 204, 216
AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp 390
Airbags 79
BabySmartTM airbag deactivation
system 471
BabySmartTM deactivation system 89
Children 80
Airmatic DC 247, 471
Damping button 28, 29, 248
Level control button 28, 29, 249
Messages in display 397
Setting vehicle level 248
Switch
Damping button 248
477
Index
Alarm
Audible 104
Visual 104
Alarm system 104
Alignment bolt 422, 438, 471
Ambient lighting 46, 47, 48, 152
Setting 180
Anti-glare
Automatic 192
Anti-lock Brake System see ABS
Anti-theft alarm system 104
Activating 105
Canceling the alarm 105
Deactivating 105
Indicator lamp 27
Anti-theft systems 104
Anti-theft alarm system 104
Immobilizer 104
Tow-away alarm 106
Armrest
Storage compartment in front of
armrest 268
Ashtray 28, 29, 272
In the front 272
In the rear 46, 47, 48, 273
Vehicles with rear center seat* 261,
262
At the gas station 352
478
Audio menu 163
Selecting radio station 163
Selecting satellite radio station (USA
only) 163
Automatic anti-glare function 30
Automatic anti-glare rear view
mirrors 192
Switching off 193
Switching on 193
Automatic central locking
Activating/deactivating (control
system) 181
Automatic climate control 199
Adjusting air volume 204, 216
Air recirculation mode 205
Cockpit 200
Control unit
Rear passenger compartment of
Maybach 57 210
Rear passenger compartment of
Maybach 62 212
Defrosting 205
Front passenger compartment 27
Operating from the rear 209
Overview of rear passenger compartment
Maybach 57 210
Maybach 62 212
Rear compartment 33, 35, 37
Rear window defroster 198
Setting the temperature 203, 215
Automatic headlamp mode 143, 144
Automatic lighting control
Activating 148
Deactivating 149
Automatic locking when driving 124
Automatic shift program
Automatic transmission 189
Automatic transmission 185
Automatic shift program 189
Driving tips 190
Emergency operation (limp home
mode) 191
Fluid level 359
Gear ranges 187
Gear selector lever position 188
Gear shifting malfunctions 191
Gearshift pattern 66
Kickdown 190
One-touch gearshifting 186
Program mode selector 28, 29
Selector lever 28, 29
Selector lever position 185
Transmission fluid 359
Winter program mode 189
AUX sockets 39, 41, 43, 45, 267
Index
B
BabySmartTM
Airbag deactivation system 89, 471
Compatible child seats 89, 471
Installing/Removing 92
Self-test 90
Backrest supports
Lumbar region 137
Shoulder region 137
Back-up lamps 431
Bulbs 431
BAS 97, 471
Batteries, SmartKey
Check lamp 110, 115
Replacing 428
Batteries, vehicle 361, 441
Charging 443
Charging the consumer battery 279
Disconnecting 443
For electrical consumers 441
For starter 441
Reconnecting 444
Reinstalling 443
Removing 443
Battery charge maintenance
socket 279
Battery discharged
Jump starting 445
Battery indicator lamp
SmartKey 108, 112
Beverage holder
In the rear 39, 41
Bi-xenon headlamps 430, 471
Blocking
Rear window operation 94
Bottle holder 271
In the rear 39, 41, 269
Brake Assist System see BAS
Brake fluid 354, 466
Brake lamp
Bulbs 431
High mounted 431
Brake pads
Message in display 400
Brake warning lamp 25
Brakes 344
Warning lamp 388
Break-in period 342
Bulbs, replacing 430
Back-up lamps 431
Brake lamps 431
Fog lamps 430
Front lamps 430
High beam 430
High beam flasher 430
License plate lamps 431, 433
Parking lamps 430, 431, 433
Rear fog lamp 431
Side marker lamps 430, 433
Standing lamps 430, 431, 433
Tail lamp assemblies 431
Turn signal lamps 430, 431
Turn signals 433
C
Calling up
Distronic** settings 168
Maintenance service indicator 374
Range (distance to empty) 170
CAN system 471
Cargo tie-down hooks 256
Carpet
Cleaning 380
Catalytic converter 350
CD changer
Compartment for 39, 43, 45, 266, 267
Storage compartment for 41
Cellular phone holder
Closing 290
Opening 290
Cellular phone in the front 290
Cradle
Removing 291
479
Index
Cellular phone in the rear 291
Cradle
Removing 293
Delayed switch-off time 292
Holder
Re-inserting 293
Inserting the cradle 291
Making calls
Hands-free mode 293
Private mode 292
Center console
AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp 390
Ashtray 272
Lighter 273
Centigrade
Setting temperature units 175
Central locking
Automatic 124
From inside 125
Switch 27, 46, 47, 48, 125
Switch in the front 27
Switch in the rear 46, 47, 48
Switching on/off (control system) 181
Unlocking from inside 125
Central unlocking
Switch 27, 46, 47, 48, 125
Switch in the front 27
Switch in the rear 46, 47, 48
480
Champagne flute holder 271
Setting down champagne flutes 271
Changing
Key setting 182
Vehicle level 249
Charcoal filter 207
Activating 207
Deactivating 207
Charging
Vehicle battery 443
Vehicle consumer battery 279
CHECK ENGINE malfunction
Indicator lamp 389
Checking
Coolant level 360
Oil level 354, 356, 357
Tire inflation pressure 354
Vehicle lighting 354
Checking tire pressure
electronically 365
Child safety
Airbags 80
Override switch 94
Child safety switch see Blocking of rear
window operation
Child seat anchors
LATCH-type 92
Children in the vehicle 87
Cleaning
Carpet 380
Distronic** system sensor cover 378
Electrotransparent roof* 382
Gear selector lever 380
Hard plastic trim items 380
Headlamps 192
Headliner 380
Instrument cluster 380
Leather upholstery 381
Light alloy wheels 379
Parktronic system sensor 378
Plastic and rubber parts 381
Seat belts 381
Steering wheel 380
Tumbler holder 380
Windows 379
Wiper blades 378
Wood trims 381
Clock 25
In the rear 33, 35, 37, 156
Instrument cluster 156
Closing 76
Cellular phone holder 290
Compartment for the front
telephone 260
Cup holders
Cockpit 269, 270
Curtains 27, 46, 280, 281
Index
Electrotransparent roof*
Screen 231
Folding table* 276
Front door windows 31, 49, 50
Glove box 259
Hood 356
Left rear side window curtain* with
Pocket PC* 323
Partition curtain* with Pocket
PC* 322
Partition* 47, 48, 284
Partition* curtain 29, 47, 48
Power tilt/sliding sunroof (Maybach
57) 222
Power tilt/sliding sunroof (Maybach
62) 225, 227, 228
In an emergency 425
Power window with SmartKey 220
Power window with SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** 220
Rear door windows 31
Rear doors automatically from the inside (Maybach 62) 117
Rear window curtain with Pocket
PC* 326
Refrigerator** 278
Right rear side window curtain* with
Pocket PC* 325
Side windows 219
Trunk 119, 120
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO** 121,
122
Tumbler holder
In the rear 270
Windows 218
Closing in an emergency
Power tilt/sliding sunroof 425, 426
Cockpit 22, 471
Cockpit management and data system
(COMAND) 472
COMAND 27, 472
COMAND see separate operating instructions
Combination switch 23, 70, 71, 147
High beam flasher 147
Communication system 288
Compartment for the front
telephone 260
Closing 260
Consumer battery
Removing 443
Control and operation of radio
transmitters 349
Control system 157, 472
Audio menu 163
Convenience submenu 182
Digital speedometer display 162
Distronic** menu 168
Functions 161
Instrument cluster submenu 175
Lighting submenu 176
Menus 160, 161
Multifunction display 157
Multifunction steering wheel 158
Navigation menu 168
Operating 26, 158
Selecting radio system 163
Settings menu 172
Standard display 162
Standard display menu 162
Submenus 161
Trip computer menu 169
Vehicle status message memory
menu 171
Vehicle submenu 181
Convenience closing feature 221
481
Index
Convenience submenu 182
Activating easy-entry/exit
feature 183
Setting automatic locking 181
Setting fold-in function for exterior
rear view mirrors 184
Setting parking position for exterior
rear view mirror 184
Coolant 360, 467
Adding 360
Checking level 360
Messages in display 403, 404
Temperature 351
Temperature gauge 25, 154
Warning lamp 404
Coolant level 354
Checking 360
Coolant temperature gauge 25
Courtesy lighting 149
Cruise control 233, 472
Canceling 234
Driving downhill 234
Driving uphill 234
Fine adjustment 235
Lever 23, 240
Setting current speed 234
Setting speeds 235
482
Cup holder 27, 269
Cockpit 269
In the rear 269
Rear
Cleaning 380
Curtain
Opening/Closing 27, 46, 280
Rear side window* 46, 281
Operating from cockpit 281
Operating from the rear 282
Rear side windows* 27, 46, 47, 48
Opening/Closing 46, 281
Rear window 27, 46, 280
Operating from cockpit 280
Operating from the rear 46, 47, 48,
281, 286
D
Damping button
Airmatic DC 28, 29, 248
Daytime running lamp mode 145
Setting 177
Deactivating
Air conditioner (cooling) 208, 216
Air recirculation mode 206
Anti-theft alarm system 105
Central locking (control system) 181
Cruise control 234
Defrost 205
Distance warning function** 244
Distronic** 242
Hazard warning flasher 148
Headlamps 75
Immobilizer 104
Interior lighting delayed switchoff 180
Rear window defroster 198
Residual heat 208, 217
Seat heater 138
Seat ventilation* 139
Tow-away alarm 106
Deactivation button
Parking assist (Parktronic system) 28,
29, 255
Deceleration
With Distronic** 239
Deep water see Standing water
Defrosting 205
Delayed switch-off
Interior lighting 180
Delayed switch-off time
Cellular phone in the rear 292
Dialing
A number (telephone) 166
Digital clock 25
Digital speedometer 162
Direction of rotation (tires) 364
Index
Discharged battery
Jump starting 445
Disconnecting
Vehicle batteries 443
Displays
Digital speedometer 162
Distronic** 237
Instrument cluster 25
Messages 358
Showing malfunctions 171
Vehicle status messages 391
Distance
Decreasing in Distronic** 243
Increasing in Distronic** 243
Setting in Distronic** 243
Warning function** 243
Distance warning function** 243
Activating 244
Deactivating 244
Distronic** warning lamp 243
Intermittent warning sound 243
Switching off 243
Switching on 243
Symbol in multifunction display 168
Distance warning lamp 25
Distronic** 236, 472
Activated 239
Activating 240
Calling up settings 168, 239
Cleaning system sensor 378
Cruise control lever 240
Deactivated 239
Deactivating 242
Deceleration 239
Decreasing distance 243
Decreasing time interval 243
Displays in the speedometer dial 237
Distance to empty (range)
Calling up 169
Distance warning function** 243
Driving hints 244
Fine adjustment 241
Increasing distance 243
Increasing time interval 243
Intermittent signal tone 238
Malfunction indicator lamp 385
Menu 239
Messages in display 393
Sensor cover 378
Setting a higher speed 241
Setting a lower speed 241
Setting following distance 243
Setting the current speed 240
Setting to last stored speed ("Resume"
function) 242
Thumbwheel for setting distance 28,
29
Warning and indicator lamps 238
Warning lamp 25, 385
Door
Inside door handle 117
Door control panel 23
Driver’s 31
In the rear
Maybach 57 49
Maybach 62 50
Door handle 31, 49, 50
Lock button (KEYLESS-GO**) 76
Doors
Closing the rear doors automatically
from the inside (Maybach 62) 117
Locking knob 117
Message in display 407
Opening from inside vehicle 117
Remote rear door closing switch 118
483
Index
Downhill driving
Cruise control 234
Downshifting
One-touch gearshifting 186
Drinking and driving 343
Driving 63, 68
Abroad 349
General instructions 343
Hydroplaning 346
In winter 348
Through standing water
With Distronic** 244
Driving abroad 349
Driving hints
SBC brake system 103
Driving instructions 343
Driving off 345
Driving safety systems 96
ABS 96
BAS 97
ESP 98, 473
SBC brake system 101
Driving systems 233
Airmatic DC 247
Cruise control 233
Distronic** 236
Parktronic 251
Vehicle level control 248
484
Driving tips
Automatic transmission 190
Dual control
Airmatic DC 247
DVD player
Compartment for 39, 43, 45, 266, 267
Storage compartment for 41
E
Easy-entry/exit feature 127
Activating 183
ELCODE 472
Electrical fuses 450
Electrical system 461
Electronic Stability Program (ESP) control switch 28, 29
Electronic Stability Program see ESP
Electrotransparent roof lighting* 152
Electrotransparent roof* 230
Cleaning 382
Lowering panel 382
Making opaque 231, 232
Making transparent 231, 232
Opaque/transparent 48
Opening 382
Opening/closing screen 231, 232
Operating from the cockpit 230
Operating from the rear 232
Operating the screen 30, 230
To make opaque/transparent with
Pocket PC* 324
To open/close the screen with Pocket
PC* 330
Emergency call system 294
Emergency calls
Initiating an emergency call 297
With Tele Aid 296
Emergency operation (limp home
mode) 191
Emergency operations
Closing power tilt/sliding sunroof 425
Locking the vehicle 424
Opening power tilt/sliding
sunroof 425
Remote door unlock 302
Unlocking the trunk lid 424
Unlocking the vehicle 423
Emergency tensioning device (ETD) 86
Emergency tensioning device see ETD
Emission control 350
Emission control information label, includes both federal and California certification exhaust emission
standards 456
Ending
A call (telephone) 166
Index
Engine
Compartment 355
Message in display 389
Oils 465
Turning off
with KEYLESS-GO** 75
Engine cleaning 377
Engine compartment 355
Fuse box in 451
Hood 355
Engine malfunction
Indicator lamp 25
Engine malfunction indicator lamp 389
Engine number 473
Engine oil 356
Adding 359
Additives 465
Checking level 356, 357
Consumption 356
Display messages 407
Messages in display 358, 408
Viscosity 473
Engine oil level see Oil level
Entry position
Messages in display 409
ESP 98, 473
Switching off 99
Switching on 100
Warning lamp 384
ETD 86, 473
Exterior lamp switch 23, 70, 143
Exterior lamps
Warning sound 144
Exterior mirror adjustment 31
Exterior rear view mirrors
Adjusting 61
Folding 195
Parking position for 184
External communication 288
Listening 288
Speaking 288
External communication (special order
equipment) 288
F
Fahrenheit
Setting temperature units 175
Fastening the seat belts 63
Fine adjustment
Cruise control 235
Distronic** 241
First aid kit 422
Flat tire 436
Lowering the vehicle 439
Mounting the spare wheel 436
Preparing the vehicle 436
Speed limitation 369
Flexible Service System (FSS, Canada
vehicles) 473
Flexible Service System, Canada vehicles
(FSS) 373
Fog lamp
Rear 146, 431
Fog lamps
Front
Messages in display 412
Switching on 146
Replacing bulbs 430
Folding
Exterior rear view mirrors 195
Folding table* 39, 41, 275
Closing 276
Opening 275
Folding the exterior mirrors in and
out 31
Front airbags 83
Front center console 27
Lower part 28
Upper part 27, 28
Front door windows
Closing 31, 49, 50
Opening 31, 49, 50
485
Index
Front lamps
Messages in display 411–412
Replacing bulbs 430, 432
Switching off 143
Switching on 143
Front passenger seat
Setting from rear 135
Front storage compartment 23
Front storage compartment for telephone
Opening 260
FSS (Flexible Service System, Canada
vehicles) 373, 473
Fuel 353
Fuel reserve warning lamp 389
Premium unleaded gasoline 353
Fuel consumption statistics
From the start 169
Since last reset 170
Fuel content
Gauge 25
Fuel filler flap 352
Locking 352
Unlocking 352
Fuel requirements 466
Fuel reserve
Warning lamp 25
Fuel tank
Filler flap 352
486
Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc. 464
Functions (control system) 161
Fuse box 451, 452
Fuse chart 422
Fuses 450
Fuse box in engine compartment 451
Fuse box in passenger
compartment 452
Fuse box in the trunk 452
Fuse chart 422
Fuse extractor 422
Replacing 451
Spare fuses 422
G
Garage door opener 30, 304
Integrated remote control 305
Gasoline additives 467
Gasoline see Fuel
Gear range 473
Automatic transmission 187
Limiting 187
Shifting into optimal 186
Gear range limit
Canceling 186
Gear selector lever
Cleaning 380
Position 188
Gearshift pattern 66
Glare
From the front 197
From the sides 197
Global locking
KEYLESS-GO** 114
SmartKey 109
Global Positioning System (GPS)
Global unlocking
KEYLESS-GO** 114
SmartKey 109
Glove box 23, 258, 259
Closing 259
Heating and cooling 209
Lid release 23
Lock 23
Opening 259
Good visibility 192
GPS 295, 473
473
H
Hand-held transmitter
Programming integrated remote control (Garage door opener) 305
Hard plastic trim items
Cleaning 380
Hazard warning flasher 147
Switching off 148
Switching on 148
Index
Head restraint
Adjusting 58, 59
Front seats 59
Rear seats 129
Headlamp cleaning system 354, 362
Washer button 23, 192
Headlamps
Automatic control 144
Bi-xenon 430, 471
Cleaning 377
Cleaning system 192, 362, 469
Refilling washer fluid 362
Switching 70
Switching off 75
Washer button 23, 192
Headliner
Cleaning 380
Headliner lamps and pillar
uplights* 152
Lighting 47
Headphone jacks 39, 41, 43, 45, 266,
267
Headphones
Storage compartments
In rear doors 261, 262
Heated steering wheel 308
Lever 23
Height adjustments
Vehicle level 248
High beam 23, 147
Lamps 430
Messages in display 411
Switching 70
High beam flasher 147
Replacing bulbs 430
High beam headlamps
Indicator lamp 25
Switching on 147
High mounted brake lamp 431
Hood 355
Closing 356
Message in display 409
Opening 355
Horn 23
Hydroplaning 346
I
Identification labels 456
Certification label 456
Engine number 456
Vacuum line routing diagram
label 456
Vehicle Identification Number
(VIN) 456
Immobilizer 104
Activating 104
Deactivating 104
Indicator lamps see Lamps, indicator and
warning
Infant and child restraint systems
Installing 91, 92
Information
Button for Tele Aid 300
Infrared reflecting windshield 308
Inside door handle 117
Inside rear view mirror
Anti-glare 192
Installing
BabySmartTM 92
Infant and child restraint systems 91,
92
Wiper blades 435
Instrument cluster 24, 153, 473
Cleaning 380
Coolant temperature gauge 154
Illumination 153
Multifunction display 157
Outside temperature indicator 155
Selecting language 176
487
Index
Integrated remote control
Hand-held transmitter (Garage door
opener) 305
Interior lamps
In the rear 46
Interior lighting
Activating automatic control 148
Control
In the front 30, 148
Deactivating automatic control 149
Delayed switch-off 180
In the front 30, 148
In the rear 30, 46, 150
Manual operation in the front 149
Manual operation in the rear 152
Interior rear view mirror
Adjusting 61
Interior storage spaces
Compartment for the front
telephone 260
Glove box 259
Storage compartment in front of
armrest 268
Intermittent wiping 71
488
J
Jump starting 445
K
Key see SmartKey or SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO**
Key, mechanical 423
Key, SmartKey 52, 108
Battery check lamp 110, 116
Checking the batteries 110
Factory setting 109
Locking 76
Replacing the batteries 428
Key, SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO**
Checking the batteries 116
KEYLESS-GO** 473
Closing
Trunk 121, 122
Factory setting 114
Global locking 114
Global unlocking 114
Important notes 113
Locking 76
Locking the vehicle 115, 122
Opening, trunk lid 111, 116
Positions 55
Remote control 111
Start/stop button 28, 29, 55, 66
Starting the engine 66
Turning off the engine 75
Unlocking 53
Unlocking, trunk lid 111, 116
Kickdown 190, 473
Kilometers/miles in speedometer 175
Km/h or mph in speedometer 175
Knob for instrument cluster
illumination 25
L
Lamp bulbs, exterior 430
Lamps
Low beam headlamps 430
Messages in display 410–413
Lamps, exterior
Front 430
Light sensor 410
Messages in display 412
Rear 431
Lamps, indicator and warning
ABS 25, 385
ABS/ESP 25, 98
Anti-theft alarm system 27
Battery (SmartKey) 110, 116
Brake warning lamp 25
Brakes 388
Center console 390
CHECK ENGINE 389
Index
Coolant 403
Distance warning lamp 25
Distronic** 25, 238, 385
Engine diagnostics 389
Engine malfunction 25
ESP 384
Fuel reserve 25, 389
High beam headlamp 25
Instrument cluster 384–389
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF 27, 390
Restraint system 25
SBC 101
Seat belt telltale 25
Seat belts 386
SRS 79
Tire pressure (Vehicles produced after
approximately November 2003) 25,
386
Tow away alarm 105
Turn signals 25
Language
Multifunction display 176
Setting 176
Layout of poly-V-belt drive 457
Leather upholstery
Cleaning 381
Level control button
Airmatic DC 28, 29, 249
Level control system
Airmatic DC 247
Lever
For cruise control 240
for heated steering wheel 23
License plate lamps
Replacing bulbs 431, 433
Light alloy wheels
Cleaning 379
Light sensor 410
Lighter 28, 29, 46, 47, 48
Center console 273
Rear compartment 274
Lighting 143
Ambient 46, 47, 48, 152
Dimming 46, 47, 48
Ambient and roof*
Dimming 152
Automatic headlamp mode 144
Combination switch 147
Daytime running lamp mode 145
Electrotransparent roof* 152
Exterior lamp switch 143
Front fog lamps 146
Headliner illumination strips*
Dimming 152
Headliner lamps and pillar
uplights* 47, 152
Dimming 47
High beam 147
High beam flasher 147
Instrument cluster illumination 153
Locator lighting 145
Low beam 143
Night security illumination 145
Parking lamps 143
Rear fog lamp 146
Settings (control system) 176
Limiting the gear range 187
Limp home mode 191
Loading 256
Cargo tie-down hooks 256
Instructions 256
489
Index
Locator lighting 145
Setting 178
Lock button 473
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO** 112
Trunk 115
Lock button on the door handle (KEYLESS-GO**) 76
Locking 74, 76
Central locking switch 27, 46, 47, 48
Fuel filler flap 352
Vehicle
From the front 125
From the rear 125
Vehicle in an emergency 424
Vehicle with KEYLESS-GO** 115, 122
with the KEYLESS-GO** 76
with the SmartKey 76
Locking and unlocking 108, 109, 114
Locking knob
Doors 117
Locking the vehicle 122
Loss of keys 111, 116
Loss of Service and Warranty Information Booklet 455
490
Low beam headlamps
Bulbs 430
Messages in display 411, 412
Lowering
Power tilt/sliding sunroof (Maybach
62) 228, 229
Vehicle 439
M
Main dimensions 462
Main odometer 25
Maintenance service
Calling up the maintenance service
indicator 374
Overdue 373
Maintenance service indicator
Calling up 374
Clearing 373
Resetting 374
Maintenance, U.S. vehicles 373
Making calls
Hands-free mode 293
Private mode 292
Manual operations
Interior lighting control in the
front 149
Interior lighting control in the
rear 152
Locking the vehicle 424
Power tilt/sliding sunroof 425, 426
Unlocking the driver’s door 423
Unlocking the trunk lid 424
Massage function 137
MAXCOOL maximum cooling 205
Maybach Assistance Center 474
Maybach Relationship Manager 474
Maybach 62 with partition*
Storage pocket 37, 265
Maybach 62 without partition*
Storage pocket 265
Mechanical key 423
Locking tab 108, 112
Memory function 140, 474
Recalling positions from memory 141
Storing exterior rear view mirror parking positions 142
Storing key dependent settings 141
Index
Menus
Audio 163
Distronic** 168, 239
In control system 160, 161
Navigation 168
Settings menu 172
Standard display 162
Trip computer 169
Vehicle status message memory 171
Microphone 288
Changing switch (Microphone) 288
External communication 288
Miles/kilometers in speedometer
Setting 175
Mirrors 61
Activating exterior rear view mirror
parking position 194
Adjusting 61
Automatic anti-glare for rear view
mirror 192
Exterior rear view mirror parking
position 184
Exterior rear view mirror parking
positions 184
Storing exterior rear view mirror parking position 142
MON (Motor Octane Number) 353, 474
Mph or km/h in speedometer 175
Multicontour seat 136
Driver’s seat/Front passenger
seat 136
Rear passenger seats 39, 43
Rear seats 41, 45
Multicontour seats
Rear seats (Maybach 57) 136
Rear seats (Maybach 62) 137
Multifunction display 25, 26, 157, 158,
162, 474
Selecting language 176
Standard display 161, 162
Multifunction display messages
ABS 392
Airmatic DC 397
Brake fluid 400
Brake pads 400
Check engine 389
Coolant 404
Coolant level 403
Distronic** 393
Doors 407
Engine 389
Engine oil level 408
Entry position 409
Hood 409
Lamps 412
Parking brake 399
Power tilt/sliding sunroof 414
SBC brake system 400, 401
Seat belt system 414
Selector lever 396
SmartKey 410
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO** 409
Steering oil 415
Tele Aid 396
Tires 416–421
Trunk 415
Washer fluid 415
Multifunction steering wheel 23, 26,
158, 474
Buttons 158
N
Navigation system
Operating 168
See separate COMAND operating instructions
Navigation system DVD drive 268
Night security illumination 145
Non-smokers equipment* 274
491
Index
O
Occupant safety 78
Children and airbags 80
Oil
Adding 359
Checking level 357
Consumption 356
Viscosity 473
Oil level
Checking
One-touch gearshifting 186
Canceling gear range limit 186
Downshifting 186
Upshifting 186
Opening
Ashtray 272
Cellular phone holder 290
Curtains 27, 46, 280, 281
Doors from the inside 117
Electrotransparent roof* 382
Screen 231, 232
Folding table* 275
Front door windows 31, 49, 50
Front storage compartment for
telephone 260
Fuel filler flap 352
Glove box 259
Hood 355
492
Left rear side window curtain* with
Pocket PC* 323
Partition curtain* with Pocket
PC* 322
Partition* 47, 48, 285
Partition* curtain 29, 47, 48
Power tilt/sliding sunroof (Maybach
57) 222
Power tilt/sliding sunroof (Maybach
62) 225, 227, 228
Power tilt/sliding sunroof
In an emergency 425
Power window with SmartKey 220
Power window with SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** 220
power window with SmartKey with
KEYLESS-GO** 220
Rear door windows 31
Rear window curtain with Pocket
PC* 326
Refrigerator** 277
Remote trunk lid switch 119
Right rear side window curtain* with
Pocket PC* 325
Side windows 219
Tilt/sliding sunroof 30
Trunk 118, 119
Trunk lid 108, 112
Trunk lid with KEYLESS-GO** 111,
116
Trunk lid with SmartKey 111, 116
Windows 218, 219
Opening button
Trunk lid 108, 112
Opening in an emergency
Power tilt/sliding sunroof 425, 426
Operating
COMAND see separate operating instructions
Control system 26, 158
Electrotransparent roof* 230
Electrotransparent roof* screen 30
Navigation system 168
Radio 163
Radio transmitters 349
Operation
Pocket PC* 318
Ornamental moldings 377
Outside microphone 288
Outside temperature indicator 155
Instrument cluster 25, 33, 35, 37
Overdue maintenance service 373
Overhead control panel 30
Override switch for rear passenger
compartment 31, 94
Overspeed range 474
Index
P
Paintwork 376
Panic button 108, 112
Parking 74, 345
Parking assist (Parktronic system)
Deactivation button 28, 29, 255
Parking brake 74
Message in display 399
Release 23, 68
Step 74
Parking brake pedal 23
Parking lamps 143
Replacing bulbs 430, 431, 433
Parking position
Exterior rear view mirrors 142, 184,
194
Parktronic 251, 474
Cleaning sensors 378
Malfunctioning 255
Warning indicator 23, 39, 41, 43, 45,
253, 254
Warning sound 255
Partition* 284
Opening/Closing 47, 48, 285
Opening/Closing the curtain 29, 47,
48
To open/close with Pocket PC* 327
Parts service 454
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
Indicator lamp 27, 89, 390
Passenger compartment 349
Fuse box in 452
Passenger seat
Adjusting from the rear 49, 50
Pedals 343
Phone book
Loading 166
Quick search 167
Phone number
Dialing 166
Redialing 167
Plastic and rubber parts
Cleaning 381
Pliers, universal (vehicle tool kit) 422
Pocket PC* 309, 312, 315
Display 317
Electrotransparent roof*
To make opaque/transparent 324
To open/close the screen 330
Left rear side window
Opening/Closing the curtain* 323
Main menu function buttons 318
Maybach 57 310
Cradle 310
Holder 310
Inserting 310
Removing 310
Maybach 62 311
Cradle 311
Inserting 311
Removing 311
Navigation button 318
Operation 318
Partition*
Opening/Closing the curtain 322
To open/close 327
Pocket PC settings 333
Power tilt/sliding sunroof
To open/close 328
To raise/lower 332
Rear seats
Extending and retracting rear seat
head restraints 331
Rear window
Opening/Closing the curtain 326
Removing and inserting the
stylus 313, 316
493
Index
Right rear side window
Opening/Closing the curtain* 325
Selecting main menu
Light 320
Manual Adjustments 326
Privacy 321
Switching interior lighting on/off 320
Switching off 314, 317
Switching on 313, 316
Troubleshooting 339
Pocket PC* (vehicles with a rear center
seat*) 309
Poly-V-belt drive 475
Positions (Memory function)
Recalling from memory 141
Storing in memory 141
Power assistance 343
Power closing assist for doors and trunk
lid 124
Power tilt/sliding sunroof 222
Closing in an emergency 425, 426
In the rear
Lowering 47
Message in display 414
Opening in an emergency 425, 426
Synchronizing 224, 229
To open/close with Pocket PC* 328
To raise/lower with Pocket PC* 332
494
Power tilt/sliding sunroof (Maybach 57)
Closing 222
Opening 222
Stopping 224
Synchronizing 224, 229
Power tilt/sliding sunroof (Maybach 62)
Closing 225
Opening 225
Opening/closing 227, 228
Opening/closing screen 226, 228
Operating from cockpit 226
Operating from the rear passenger
compartment 227
Raising/lowering 228, 229
Stopping 227, 228
Power train 475
Power windows 218
Blocking of rear window operation
Opening and closing with
SmartKey 220
Opening and closing with SmartKey
with KEYLESS-GO** 220
Side windows 218
Synchronizing 220
Power-wash 376
Practical hints
First aid kit 422
Fuses 450
Lamp in center console 390
Lamps in instrument cluster 384
Vehicle status messages in the multifunction display 391
Vehicle tool kit 422
Premium unleaded gasoline 466
Problems while driving 73
Program mode selector
automatic transmission 28, 29
Program mode selector switch 475
PULSE function (Massage function) 137
Q
Quick search
Phone book
167
R
Radial-ply tires
Summer tires 460
Winter tires 460
Radio
Selecting satellite radio station (USA
only) 163
Selecting stations 163
Index
Radio transmitters, control and
operation 349
Raising
Power tilt/sliding sunroof (Maybach
62) 228, 229
Range (distance to empty)
Calling up 170
Reading lamp
In the front 30
In the rear 46, 47, 48
Rear bench seat
Maybach 57 with rear center seat* 42
Maybach 62 with rear center seat* 44
Rear center console 46
Maybach 57 46
Maybach 62 with electrotransparent
roof* 48
Maybach 62 with power tilt/sliding
sunroof 47
Rear compartment
Ashtray 273
Lighter 274
Rear door control panel
Maybach 57 49
Maybach 62 50
Rear door windows
Closing 31
Opening 31
Rear fog lamp 431
Bulb 431
Switching on 146
Rear interior lamps
Switching on/off 152
Rear lamps
Messages in display 412–413
Rear lamps see Tail lamps
Rear passenger compartment
Control panel 32
Maybach 57 32
Maybach 62 34
Maybach 62 with partition* 34, 36
Rear seat adjustment 49, 50
Rear seat head restraints
Extending 134
Extending/retracting 28, 29
Retracting 133
Rear seats 129
Adjusting
Head restraint tilt 129
Extending and retracting rear seat
head restraints 133
Extending and retracting rear seat
head restraints with Pocket PC* 331
Extending/retracting head
restraints 28, 29
Maybach 57 38
Maybach 62 40
Rear view mirror 30
Rear view mirrors automatic antiglare 192
Rear view mirrors see Mirrors
Rear window
Blocking operation 94
Rear window defroster 198
Activating 198
Deactivating 198
Reconnecting
Vehicle batteries 444
Recovery services
For stolen vehicle 303
Refrigerator**
Closing 278
Controlling temperature 278
Opening 277
Rear center armrest 266
Switching on/off 278
Vehicle care 376
Refueling 352
Regular checks 354
Reinstalling vehicle batteries 443
Remote control
Pocket PC* (vehicles with a rear center
seat*) 309
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO** 111
495
Index
Remote controls
Integrated (Garage door opener) 305
Remote door unlock
With Tele Aid 302
Remote rear door closing switch
Doors 118
Remote trunk lid switch
Trunk 23, 119
Removing
BabySmartTM 92
Vehicle batteries 443
Wheel 438
Replacing
Bulbs 430
Front lamp bulbs 432
Fuses 451
License plate lamp bulbs 433
Parking lamp bulbs 433
Rear lamp bulbs 431
Side marker lamp bulbs 433
Wiper blades 434
Reset button 25
Reset button in the instrument
cluster 172
Resetting
All functions (control system) 172
Fuel consumption 170
Maintenance service indicator 374
Trip odometer 154
496
Residual heat utilization 208, 217, 475
Residual ventilation 208, 217
REST (Residual engine heat
utilization) 475
Restraint system
Indicator lamp 25
Restraint systems 78
Airbags 79
Emergency tensioning device
(ETD) 86
Seat belt force limiter 86
Seat belts 84
Rims (light alloy) 460
Rims and Tires 459
Roadside Assistance
Tele Aid 298
RON (Research Octane Number) 353,
475
Roof lighting
Switching on 231
Roof lighting*
Roof lining
Lighting* 48
Rubber parts
Cleaning 381
S
SBC brake system 475
Activation 102
Deactivation 103
Driving hints 103
Messages in display 400, 401
Self-check 102
Warning lamp 101
Screwdriver (vehicle tool kit) 422
Seat
Adjusting 57, 58
Fore and aft adjustment 58
Seat heating 138
Seat ventilation* 139
Seat adjustment 31, 49, 50
Seat backrest tilt
Adjusting 58
Seat belt
Telltale 25
Seat belt force limiter 86
Seat belt system
Message in display 414
Seat belts 84
Cleaning 381
Fastening 63
Telltale 386
Index
Seat cushion depth
Adjusting 58
Seat cushion tilt
Adjusting 58
Seat heating 31, 49, 50, 138
Seat height
Adjusting 58
Seat ventilation* 31, 49, 50, 139
Switching off 139
Switching on/off 139
Seats
Adjusting lumbar support 137
Adjusting shoulder support 137
Massage function 137
Securing cargo
Cargo tie-down hooks 256
Selector lever
Message in display 396
Position 185
Selector lever for automatic
transmission 28, 29
Selector lever lock 66
Self-test
BabySmartTM airbag deactivation
system 90
Tele Aid 295
Sensotronic Brake Control see SBC
Service (maintenance) 373
Service life (tires) 364
Service System, Canada vehicles see FSS
Setting
Ambient lighting 180
Convenience functions 182
Cruise control 234
Daytime running lamp mode 177
Digital clock 25
Distronic** time interval 243
Exterior rear view mirror parking
position 184
Following distance in Distronic** 243
Front passenger seat 135
Higher speed in cruise control 235
Higher speed in Distronic** 241
Individual vehicle settings 172
Interior lighting delayed switchoff 180
Lamps and lighting (control
system) 176
Language, multifunction display 176
Last stored speed ("Resume" function)
in Distronic** 242
Locator lighting 178
Lower speed in cruise control 235
Lower speed in Distronic** 241
Miles/kilometers in speedometer 175
Parking position for exterior rear view
mirrors 184
Slower speed in cruise control 235
Speed in cruise control 235
Speed in Distronic** 240
Speedometer display mode 175
Temperature (interior) 203, 215
Temperature indicator 175
Units
Speedometer 175
Temperature 175
Vehicle level control 248
Setting current speed 234
Setting distance in Distronic**
Thumbwheel 28, 29
Setting key dependency 182
Settings
Calling up Distronic** 168, 239
Convenience functions 182
Factory, KEYLESS-GO** 114
Individual 109, 114
Lighting (control system) 176
Resetting all (control system) 172
Settings menu
Functions in 172
Individual vehicle settings 172
Submenus 173
Shift lock 475
Shifting
Gear selector lever positions 188
Into optimal gear range (automatic
transmission) 186
497
Index
Shoulder support
Seat adjustment 137
Side impact airbags 83
Side marker lamps 430
Replacing bulbs 430, 431, 433
Side windows
Automatic closing 219
Automatic opening 219
Cleaning 379
Closing 218, 219
Closing fully (Express-close) 219
Opening 218, 219
Opening fully (Express-open) 219
Stopping 220
Synchronizing power windows 220
SmartKey 52, 108
Battery check lamp 110, 116
Checking the batteries 110, 116
Factory setting 109
Global locking 109
Global unlocking 109
Individual setting 109, 114
Lock button 108
Locking 76
Loss of 111
Opening and closing power window
with 220
Replacing the batteries 428
498
Restoring to factory setting 110, 115
Starting the engine 66
Unlock button 108
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO**
Checking the batteries 110, 116
Lock button 112
Locking the vehicle 115
Loss of 116
Messages in display 409
Opening and closing power window
with 220
Remote control 111
Restoring to factory setting 110, 115
Unlock button 112
Snow chains 372
Socket (12 V) 41, 278
Solar panel* 217
Spare fuses 422
Spare wheel 460
Mounting 436
Speed
Setting current 234
Setting to last stored speed ("Resume"
function) in Distronic** 242
Speed limitation
With flat tire 369
Speed settings
Cruise control 235
Distronic** 240, 241
Speedometer 25
Displaying gear range 187
Displays 237
In the rear 33, 35, 37
Settings units 175
Speedometer display mode
Selecting 175
SRS 476
Indicator lamp 387
SRS indicator lamp 78
Standing lamps 143
Replacing bulbs 430, 431, 433
Standing water
Driving instructions 349
Starter battery 441
Removing 443
Starter switch 23
Positions 54
Starting the engine
With the KEYLESS-GO** 66
With the SmartKey 66
Steering column
Adjusting in or out 60
Adjusting up or down 60
Index
Steering oil
Message in display 415
Steering wheel 60
Adjusting 60
Adjustment stalk 23
Cleaning 380
Heated 308
Stolen vehicle
Recovery services 303
Stopping
Power tilt/sliding sunroof (Maybach
57) 224
Power tilt/sliding sunroof (Maybach
62) 227, 228
Windows 220
Storage compartment/drawer
Between the front seats (Maybach 62
with partition*) 263
Storage compartments 41, 45, 258
Armrest 268
Between rear seats 266
For headphones 39, 41, 43, 45
For wireless surround sound
headphones 261, 262
Between the front seats (Maybach 62
with partition*) 263
Center armrest
In the front 274
Compartment for the front
telephone 260
For CD changer 39, 41, 43, 45, 266,
267
For DVD player 39, 41, 43, 45, 266,
267
Glove box 259
In front doors 31, 261
Maybach 57 261
In glove box 23, 258
In rear center console 263
In rear doors 262
For headphones 261, 262
Rear center armrest 275
Refrigerator** 266
Telephone 266
Under the driver’s seat 262
With navigation system DVD
drive 268
Storage pocket
Maybach 62 with partition* 37, 265
Maybach 62 without partition* 265
Storing (Memory function)
Positions into memory 141
Submenus
Convenience 182
In control system 161
Instrument cluster 175
Lighting 176
Selecting 173
Settings menu 173
Vehicle 181
Summer opening feature 220
Sun visor 197
Mirror in 257
Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) 476
Switching off
Automatic anti-glare rear view
mirrors 193
Automatic central locking (control
system) 181
Distance warning function** 243
ESP 99
Front lamps 143
Hazard warning flasher 148
Headlamps 75
Pocket PC* 314, 317
Refrigerator** 278
Two-way intercom* 28, 29, 46, 47, 48
499
Index
Switching on
Automatic anti-glare rear view
mirrors 193
Automatic central locking (control
system) 181
Distance warning function** 243
ESP 100
Front fog lamps 146
Front lamps 143
Hazard warning flasher 148
Headlamps 70
High beam 70, 147
Pocket PC* 313, 316
Rear fog lamp 146
Refrigerator** 278
Roof lighting 231
Seat ventilation* 139
Two-way intercom* 28, 29, 46, 47, 48
Windshield wipers 71
Symbol for activated distance warning
function (Distronic**)
Distance warning function** 168
Synchronizing
Power tilt/sliding sunroof 224, 229
Power tilt/sliding sunroof (Maybach
57) 224, 229
Power windows 220
500
T
Tachometer 25, 155
Overspeed range 155
Tail lamps
Cleaning 377
Replacing bulbs 431
Tar stains 376
Tele Aid 294, 476
Emergency calls 296
Information 300
Initiating an emergency call
manually 297
Messages in display 396
Remote door unlock 302
Roadside Assistance 298
Stolen Vehicle Recovery services 303
System self-check 295
Tele Aid System 294
Upgrade signals 301
Tele Aid (emergency call system) 30,
46, 47, 48
Telematics 476
Telephone 26, 158, 289
Answering a call 166
Compartment in rear center
armrest 266
Dialing a number from the phone
book 166
Ending a call 166
Loading phone book 166
Redialing 167
Temperature
Display mode 175
Setting interior temperature 203, 215
Setting units in display 175
Tires 365
Tie-down hooks (Trunk) 256
Tightening torque 476
Tightening torque (Wheel bolts) 440
Tilt/sliding sunroof
Opening/closing 30
Tire inflation pressure
Checking 354, 364
Tire pressure
Warning lamp (Vehicles produced after approximately November
2003) 25, 386
Index
Tire speed rating 347, 476
Winter tires 371
Tire traction 347
Tires 363
Direction of rotation 364
Driving instructions 346
Messages in display 416–421
Retreads 363
Rotating 370
Service life 364
Temperature 365
Tread depth 372
Wear pattern 370
Winter 372
Tools 422
Tow-away alarm 106
Activating 106
Arming 106
Deactivating 106
Disarming 106
Disarming for transport 106
Tow-away alarm button 30
Towing eye bolt (vehicle tool kit) 422
Installing 449
Towing the vehicle 447
Traction 190, 476
Transmission see Automatic transmission
Tread depth (tires) 372
Trip computer 169
Trip odometer 25
Resetting 154
Trunk
Closing 120
From the inside 119
From the outside 120
Fuse box in 452
Lock button 115
Lock button, KEYLESS-GO** 115
Message in display 415
Opening 118, 119
Remote switch 119
Remote trunk lid switch 23, 119
Tie-down hooks 256
Trunk lid 118
Trunk lid emergency release 123
Unlocking and opening with
SmartKey 111, 116
Unlocking in an emergency 424
Unlocking with KEYLESS-GO** 111,
116
Trunk lid closing switch 120, 121
Trunk lid emergency release 123
Tumbler holder 270
Cleaning 380
Turn signals 23, 71
Additional in mirrors 430
Cleaning lenses 377
Front bulbs 430
Indicator lamp 25
Rear bulbs 431
Replacing bulbs 430, 431, 433
Turning off
Engine with KEYLESS-GO** 75
Turning off engine 75
Turning off the engine
Warning sound 75
Two-way intercom* 287
Adjusting volume 46, 47, 48
Operating 287
Switching off 28, 29
Switching on 28, 29
Switching on/off 46, 47, 48
501
Index
U
Umbrella 268
Units
Setting speedometer units 175
Setting temperature units 175
Unlock button
SmartKey 108
SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO** 112
Unlocking
Central locking switch 27, 46, 47, 48
Driver’s door in an emergency 423
Fuel filler flap 352
In an emergency 423
Individual settings 109, 114
Trunk in an emergency 424
Trunk lid with KEYLESS-GO** 111,
116
Trunk lid with SmartKey 111, 116
Vehicle in an emergency 302
With KEYLESS-GO** 53
Upgrade signals
Tele Aid 301
Uphill driving
Cruise control 234
Upshifting
One-touch gearshifting 186
502
Useful features
Ashtrays 272
Garage door opener 304
Storage compartments 258
Tele Aid 294
V
Vanity mirror
In the rear 257
In the sun visor 257
Opening/closing 257
Vehicle
Individual settings 172, 174
Locking
From the front 125
From the rear 125
Locking in an emergency 424
Lowering 439
Service batteries 441
Towing 447
Unlocking in an emergency 423
Vehicle batteries 441
Vehicle care 375
Carpet 380
Distronic** system sensor cover 378
Engine cleaning 377
Gear selector lever 380
Hard plastic trim items 380
Headlamps 377
Instrument cluster 380
Leather upholstery 381
Light alloy wheels 379
Ornamental moldings 377
Paintwork 376
Parktronic system sensor 378
Plastic and rubber parts 381
Power-wash 376
Refrigerator** 376
Seat belts 381
Steering wheel 380
Tail lamps 377
Tar stains 376
Tumbler holder 380
Turn signals 377
Vehicle washing 377
Window cleaning 379
Wiper blades 378
Wood trims 381
Vehicle level 248
Changing 249
Setting 249
Automatic 249
Manual 249
Vehicle level control system
Airmatic DC 247
Vehicle lighting
Checking 354
Index
Vehicle status message memory 171
Calling up 171
Displaying 171
Vehicle tool kit 422
Alignment bolt 422
Fuse chart 422
Fuse extractor 422
Hex-socket wrench 422
Open-end wrench 422
Screwdriver 422
Spare fuses 422
Universal pliers 422
Wheel wrench 422
Vehicle washing 377
Video monitor 33, 35, 37
VIN (Vehicle Identification
Number) 476
Voice control system 476
W
Warning indicator
Parktronic 253
Warning lamp
ABS/ESP 384
Warning lamps see Lamps, indicator and
warning
Warning sounds
Distance warning function** 243
Distronic** 238
Exterior lamps 144
Parktronic 255
Turning off the engine 75
Warranty coverage 455
Washer button
Headlamps 23, 192
Washing the vehicle 375
Wear pattern (tires) 370
Weights 463
Wheel change
Tightening torque 440
Wheel offset 460
Wheels
Tires and wheels 363
Window curtain airbag 84
Windows see Side windows
Windshield
Infrared reflecting 308
Refilling washer fluid 362
Replacing wiper blades 434
Washer fluid 362, 469
Windshield washer 354
Windshield washer fluid
Message in display 415
Refilling 362, 469
Windshield wipers 23, 71
Fast wiper speed 71
Intermittent wiping 71, 72
Replacing wiper blades 434
Single wipe 72
Switching on 71
Wiping with windshield washer
fluid 72
Winter driving 371
Snow chains 372
Tires 372
Transmission program mode 189
Winter driving instructions 348
Winter tires 372
Tire speed rating 371
Wiper blades
Cleaning 378
Installing 435
Replacing 434
Wood trims
Cleaning 381
Wrench, hex-socket (vehicle tool
kit) 422
Wrench, open-end (vehicle tool
kit) 422
Wrench, wheel (vehicle tool kit) 422
X
Xenon headlamps
Bi-xenon 430, 471
503
504